* Your assessment is very important for improving the workof artificial intelligence, which forms the content of this project
Download INDICO 100 SERIES X-RAY GENERATOR SERVICE MANUAL
Electrical substation wikipedia , lookup
Vacuum tube wikipedia , lookup
Resistive opto-isolator wikipedia , lookup
History of electric power transmission wikipedia , lookup
Electric machine wikipedia , lookup
Power inverter wikipedia , lookup
Three-phase electric power wikipedia , lookup
Variable-frequency drive wikipedia , lookup
Pulse-width modulation wikipedia , lookup
Voltage optimisation wikipedia , lookup
Immunity-aware programming wikipedia , lookup
Electrification wikipedia , lookup
Voltage regulator wikipedia , lookup
Power electronics wikipedia , lookup
Mains electricity wikipedia , lookup
Buck converter wikipedia , lookup
Alternating current wikipedia , lookup
Oscilloscope history wikipedia , lookup
CPI Communications & Power Industries communications & medical products division INDICO 100 SERIES X-RAY GENERATOR SERVICE MANUAL PREPARED BY: COMMUNICATIONS & POWER INDUSTRIES 45 RIVER DRIVE GEORGETOWN, ONTARIO, CANADA, L7G 2J4 TELEPHONE: (905) 877-0161 CPI Canada Inc. SERVICE AND INSTALLATION MANUAL P.N. #740855 PRE-INSTALLATION 1¾ INSTALLATION AND CALIBRATION 2¾ CONFIGURATION PROGRAMMING 3¾ ACCEPTANCE TEST 4¾ TROUBLESHOOTING 5¾ REGULAR MAINTENANCE 6¾ THEORY OF OPERATION 7¾ SPARES 8¾ SCHEMATICS 9¾ The original version of this manual (Aug.21,1997) has been drafted in the English language by: Communications & Power Industries communications & medical products division. Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-00 Rev. A Page 0-1 CPI Canada Inc. (This page intentionally left blank) Page 0-2 Rev. A Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-00 CPI Canada Inc Pre-installation 1 CHAPTER 1 PRE-INSTALLATION 1.0 INTRODUCTION 1.1 Purpose This manual applies to the Indico 100 family of generators and provides instructions for the installation and maintenance of all models of that generator. This Chapter contains the following sections. SECTION 1A 1B 1C 1D 1E TITLE Introduction Safety Preparing for installation Compatibility listing Generator layout and Major Components Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-01 Rev. A Page 1-1 1 Pre-installation CPI Canada Inc (This page intentionally left blank.) Page 1-2 Rev. A Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-01 CPI Canada Inc. Introduction 1A CHAPTER 1 SECTION 1A INTRODUCTION CONTENTS: Section Title 1A.1.0 INTRODUCTION .......................................................................................................................................1A-2 1A.1.1 Purpose..................................................................................................................................................1A-2 1A.2.0 GENERATOR DESCRIPTION ..................................................................................................................1A-2 1A.3.0 PHYSICAL SPECIFICATIONS..................................................................................................................1A-3 1A.4.0 APPLICATIONS.........................................................................................................................................1A-5 1A.5.0 FEATURES................................................................................................................................................1A-5 1A.6.0 ROTOR CONTROL ...................................................................................................................................1A-6 1A.7.0 AUXILIARY POWER OUTPUTS ...............................................................................................................1A-6 1A.8.0 SYSTEM DOCUMENTATION ...................................................................................................................1A-6 1A.9.0 REGULATORIES AND DESIGN STANDARDS........................................................................................1A-7 1A.9.1 Environmental Specifications.................................................................................................................1A-7 1A.9.2 Applicable Standards .............................................................................................................................1A-7 1A.9.3 Electromagnetic Compatibility (EMC) ..................................................................................................1A-11 1A.10.0 TECHNIQUE FACTORS DEFINITIONS ..............................................................................................1A-11 Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-00 Rev. L Page 1A-1 1A Introduction CPI Canada Inc. 1A.1.0 INTRODUCTION 1A.1.1 Purpose This manual provides instructions for the installation and service of Millenia and Indico 100 X-ray generators. This section of the manual applies to the Millenia and Indico 100 family of X-ray generators. Some of the sections / chapters in the balance of this manual are common to Millenia and Indico 100 X-ray generators; other sections / chapters are unique to each generator series. 1A.2.0 GENERATOR DESCRIPTION Depending on configuration and options, the generator provides the power and interfacing to operate X-ray tubes, Buckys, Rad tables, GI (gastro-intestinal) tables, remote R&F tables, tomographic devices, and digital imaging systems. The generator consists of power supply and control systems housed in the upper and lower cabinets, a control console, and an optional remote fluoro control along with the necessary interconnecting cable(s). Major items provided are: • • • • • • Page 1A-2 X-ray generator housed in upper and lower cabinets. Control console. Optional remote fluoro control. Interconnecting cable(s). Operator's manual. Service and installation manual. Rev. L Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-00 CPI Canada Inc. Introduction 1A 1A.3.0 PHYSICAL SPECIFICATIONS Figure 1A-1 shows the outline of the Millenia series X-ray generator, control console, and remote fluoro control. Figure 1A-2 shows the Indico 100 series X-ray generator outline. Figure 1A-1: Generator outline drawing (Millenia) Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-00 Rev. L Page 1A-3 1A Introduction CPI Canada Inc. 1A.3.0 PHYSICAL SPECIFICATIONS (CONT) Figure 1A-2 shows the outline of the Indico 100 series X-ray generator. 21.7 (552) 18 (457) * TOP * THE SHADED AREAS (MARKED *) REPRESENT OPTIONAL WIRING CHANNELS. REFER TO CHAPTER 2, THE SECTION REMOVING THE EXTERNAL COVERS, FOR FURTHER DETAILS. ANCHORING PLATES 4 PLACES 16.1 (408) RIGHT SIDE 12.3 (313) 12.3 (313) 4.5 (114) REAR 16.4 (417) 3.7 (94) 14.3 (363) 16.4 (417) MAXIMUM 10.9 (277) 3.7 (94) 6.5 (164) 24.6 (626) 39.7 (1008) * FRONT 16.6 (422) 3.0 (76) * 38.7 (984) 48.7 (1237) 9 (229) 18.1 (459) R&F CONSOLE RAD CONSOLE ALL DIMENSIONS ARE IN INCHES (MM) TOUCH SCREEN CONSOLE FIGURE 1A-1 SHOWS THE OUTLINE FOR THE 23 X 56 (CM) CONSOLE. THIS FIGURE SHOWS THE OUTLINE FOR THE 31 X 42 (CM) INDICO 100 R&F CONSOLE, THE INDICO 100 RAD-ONLY CONSOLE, AND THE TOUCH SCREEN CONSOLE. AN OPTIONAL LINE-ADJUSTING TRANSFORMER IS AVAILABLE THAT MOUNTS ON THE BOTTOM OF THE GENERATOR CABINET. THIS TRANSFORMER HAS THE SAME WIDTH AND DEPTH AS THE GENERATOR CABINET, AND A HEIGHT OF APPROXIMATELY 8.1 INCHES (206 mm). IN_OL.CDR Figure 1A-2: Generator outline drawing (Indico 100) Page 1A-4 Rev. L Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-00 CPI Canada Inc. Introduction 1A 1A.4.0 APPLICATIONS RAD SYSTEMS: • Bucky table, tabletop and off-table radiography. • Vertical bucky/cassette radiography. • Conventional tomography. R&F SYSTEMS • Fluoroscopic and spot film applications. • Tomography with conventional and/or remote R&F tables. • Optional digital compatible. • Optional high-level fluoro for therapy simulators (Indico 100). 1A.5.0 FEATURES • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • High frequency generator. One or two tube operation, Rad or Rad / Fluoro. Single or dual filament supplies. Low speed or dual speed X-ray tube stator supply. Optimal matching of X-ray tubes by PROMs. Repetitive self checks of generator functions, provides display of system faults and operating errors. Optional AEC, up to four inputs. Optional ABS with kV or kV/mA fluoro stabilizer. Optional remote fluoro control box for tabletop use or SFD mounting. Optional Dose-Area Product (DAP) display (Indico 100). X-ray Tube protection. The generator allows setting the following limits: a) Maximum mA, adjustable for each focal spot. b) Maximum kV, adjustable for each X-ray tube. c) Maximum kW, adjustable for each focal spot. d) Maximum filament current limit, adjustable for large and small focal spots. e) Anode heat warning and anode heat alarm levels. Calibration features: a) Microprocessor design allows all calibration and programming to be performed via the Console. b) mA calibration is automated. Messages and diagnostic information: For users and service personnel, the generator console displays various messages indicating status or equipment problems. The user is prompted in case of errors. Error log stores last 200 errors and associated generator settings. Service and diagnostic information available via a laptop computer (optional). KV range: Radiography 40 to 150 kV. Fluoroscopy 40 to 125 kV. mA range: Radiography 10 to 320 mA (30 kW), 10 to 400 mA (32 kW), 10 to 500 mA (40 kW), 10 to 630 mA (50 kW), 10 TO 800 mA (65 kW) and 10 to 1000 mA (80 and 100 kW). Fluoroscopy 0.5 to 6.0 mA, 0.5 to 20 mA with optional high-level fluoroscopy. mAs range: tube dependent, max 1000 mAs. Time range: Radiography 1.0 to 6300 ms (Indico 100), 2.0 to 6300 ms (Millenia). Fluoroscopy 0 to 5 or 0 to 10 minutes. Refer to the compatibility statement / product description (end of section 1D) for compatibility and features of this specific generator. Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-00 Rev. L Page 1A-5 1A Introduction CPI Canada Inc. 1A.6.0 ROTOR CONTROL The generator will be equipped with a low speed starter, or optional dual speed starter. DUAL SPEED STARTER Number of tubes permissible: Current monitoring Dual speed starter output frequency Braking Rotor boost time Duty cycle LOW SPEED STARTER Current monitoring Duty cycle Maximum of 32 tube types. Tube type is switch selectable Both stator circuits 50 or 60 Hz (low speed) 150 or 180 Hz (high speed). (Independent of line frequency) Dynamic braking when in high speed rotation Determined by tube selection plus incremental boost time changes from 100 to 700 msec. Not to exceed 2 high speed starts per minute. Both stator circuits Not to exceed 5 consecutive boosts, followed by a minimum 10 second wait period. 1A.7.0 AUXILIARY POWER OUTPUTS The generator supplies the following power outputs for X-ray room equipment: • • • 24 VDC, 4 Amp. 120 VAC, 2.5 Amp. 240 VAC, 1.5 Amp. 2.5 AMPS IS AVAILABLE AT 120 VAC OR 1.5 AMPS IS AVAILABLE AT 240 VAC, BUT BOTH ARE NOT AVAILABLE SIMULTANEOUSLY. The above voltage sources are not compatible with: • • • Collimator lamps (24 VDC 150 watts). These lamps exceed the 4 Amp rating of the 24 VDC supply. Fluorescent lamps. These have high starting currents and generate transients when the tube strikes. Some inductive loads may cause difficulties (some motors and solenoids). 1A.8.0 SYSTEM DOCUMENTATION The Millenia and Indico 100 series of X-ray generators includes the following documentation: • • • Page 1A-6 Operator’s manual. Service and installation manual. Insert and application notes as required. Rev. L Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-00 CPI Canada Inc. Introduction 1A 1A.9.0 REGULATORIES AND DESIGN STANDARDS 1A.9.1 Environmental Specifications OPERATING Ambient temperature range Relative humidity Atmospheric pressure range 10 to 40 °C 30 to 75% 500 to 1060 hPa (375 to 795 mm Hg) TRANSPORT AND STORAGE Ambient temperature range Relative humidity Atmospheric pressure range -20 to 70 °C 10 to 95%, including condensation 500 to 1060 hPa (375 to 795 mm Hg) 1A.9.2 Applicable Standards A) SAFETY The Millenia / Indico 100 family of generators comply with the following regulatory requirements and design standards: • FDA Center for Devices & Radiological Health (CDRH) - 21 CFR title 21 subchapter J (USA). • Radiation Emitting Devices Act - C34 (Canada). • Medical Device Regulations (Canada). • EC Directive 93/42/EEC concerning Medical Devices (European Community). • • EN 60601-1/IEC 60601-1, EN 60601-2-7/IEC 60601-2-7, CSA 601.1, UL2601.1 -Type of protection against electric shock: Class I equipment. -Degree of protection against electric shock: Not classified. -Degree of protection against harmful ingress of water: Ordinary equipment. -Mode of operation: Continuous operation with intermittent loading (standby - exposure). -Equipment not suitable for use in presence of a flammable anesthetic mixture with air or with oxygen or nitrous oxide. EN 60601-1-4/IEC 60601-1-4, EN ISO 14971. Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-00 Rev. L Page 1A-7 1A Introduction CPI Canada Inc. B) EMC (EN 60601-1-2:2001/IEC 60601.1.2:2001) Guidance and manufacturer’s declaration – electromagnetic emissions The VZW2926 and VZW2930 series of X-ray generators are intended for use in the electromagnetic environment specified below. The customer or the user of the VZW2926 or VZW2930 series should assure that it is used in such an environment. Emissions test Compliance Electromagnetic environment - guidance RF emissions CISPR 11 Group 1 RF emissions CISPR 11 Class A (The VZW2926 and VZW2930 series of X-ray generators in combination with shielded location) Not Applicable The VZW2926 and VZW2930 series of X-ray generators use RF energy only for their internal functions. Therefore, the RF emissions are very low and are not likely to cause any interference in nearby electronic equipment. The VZW2926 and VZW2930 series of X-ray generators must be used only in a shielded location with a minimum RF shielding effectiveness and, for each cable that exits the shielded location, a minimum RF filter attenuation of 40dB from 30 MHz to 230 MHz and 47dB from 230 MHz to 1 GHz. (The minimum at 30 MHz is 40dB and the minimum at 230 MHz is 47dB). The VZW2926 and VZW2930 series is suitable for use in all Harmonic establishments other than domestic and those directly connected emissions to the public low-voltage power supply network that supplies IEC 61000-3-2 buildings used for domestic purposes. Voltage Not Applicable fluctuations/ flicker emissions IEC 61000-3-3 NOTE It is essential that the actual shielding effectiveness and filter attenuation of the shielded location be verified to assure that they meet the minimum specifications. Page 1A-8 Rev. L Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-00 CPI Canada Inc. Introduction 1A Guidance and manufacturer’s declaration – electromagnetic immunity The VZW2926 and VZW2930 series of X-ray generators are intended for use in the electromagnetic environment specified below. The customer or the user of the VZW2926 or VZW2930 series should assure that it is used in such an environment. Immunity test IEC 60601 test level Compliance level Electromagnetic environment – guidance Electrostatic discharge (ESD) IEC 61000-4-2 Electrical fast transient/burst IEC 61000-4-4 ± 6 kV contact ± 8 kV air ± 6 kV contact ± 8 kV air Floors should be wood, concrete or ceramic tile. If floors are covered with synthetic material, the relative humidity should be at least 30%. ± 2 kV for power supply lines ± 1 kV for input/output lines ± 1 kV differential mode ± 2 kV common mode < 5 % UT (> 95 % dip in UT) for 0.5 cycle ± 2 kV for power supply lines ± 1 kV for input/output lines ± 1 kV differential mode ± 2 kV common mode < 5 % UT (> 95 % dip in UT) for 0.5 cycle Mains power quality should be that of a typical commercial or hospital environment. 40 % UT (60 % dip in UT) for 5 cycles 40 % UT (60 % dip in UT) for 5 cycles 70 % UT (30 % dip in UT) 70 % UT (30 % dip in UT) < 5 % UT (> 95 % dip in UT) for 5 s 3 A/m < 5 % UT (> 95 % dip in UT) for 5 s 3 A/m Surge IEC 61000-4-5 Voltage dips, short interruption, and voltage variations on power supply input lines IEC 60601-4-11 Mains power quality should be that of a typical commercial or hospital environment. Mains power quality should be that of a typical commercial or hospital environment. If the user of the VZW2926 and VZW2930 series X-ray generator requires continued operation during power mains interruptions, it is recommended that the X-ray generator be powered from an uninterruptible power supply or battery. Power frequency Power frequency magnetic fields should be at (50/60 Hz) levels characteristic of a typical location in a typical commercial or hospital environment IEC 61000-4-8 NOTE: UT is the A.C. mains voltage prior to application of the test level. Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-00 Rev. L Page 1A-9 1A Introduction CPI Canada Inc. Guidance and manufacturer’s declaration – electromagnetic immunity The VZW2926 and VZW2930 series of X-ray generators are intended for use in the electromagnetic environment specified below. The customer or the user of the VZW2926 or VZW2930 series should assure that it is used in such an environment. Immunity test IEC 60601 test level Compliance level Electromagnetic environment - guidance Conducted RF IEC 61000-4-6 3 Vrms 150 kHz to 80MHz 3 Vrms 150 kHz to 80MHz Radiated RF IEC 61000-4-3 3 V/m 80MHz to 2.5 GHz 3 V/m 80MHz to 2.5 GHz The VZW2926 and VZW2930 series of X-ray generators must be used only in a shielded location with a minimum RF shielding effectiveness and, for each cable that enters the shielded location, a minimum RF filter attenuation of 40dB from 30 MHz to 230 MHz and 47dB from 230 MHz to 1 GHz. (The minimum at 30 MHz is 40dB and the minimum at 230 MHz is 47dB.) Field strengths outside the shielded location from fixed RF transmitters, as determined by an electromagnetic site survey, should be less than 3 V/m.a Interference may occur in the vicinity of equipment marked with the following symbol: NOTE 1 These guidelines may not apply all situations. Electromagnetic propagation is affected by absorption and reflection from structures, objects and people. NOTE 2 It is essential that the actual shielding effectiveness and filter attenuation of the shielded location be verified to assure that they meet the minimum specification. a Field strengths from fixed transmitters, such as base stations for radio (cellular/cordless) telephones and land mobile radios, amateur radio, AM and FM radio broadcast and TV broadcast cannot be predicted theoretically with accuracy. To assess the electromagnetic environment due to fixed RF transmitters, an electromagnetic site survey should be considered. If the measured field strength in the location in which the VZW2926 or VZW2930 series of X-ray generators is used exceeds the applicable RF compliance level above, the X-ray generator should be observed to verify normal operation. If abnormal performance is observed, additional measures may be necessary, such as re-orienting or relocating the X-ray generator. Page 1A-10 Rev. L Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-00 CPI Canada Inc. Introduction 1A 1A.9.3 Electromagnetic Compatibility (EMC) In accordance with the intended use, this X-ray generator complies with the European Council Directive concerning Medical Devices. The CE marking affixed to this product signifies this. One of the harmonized standards of this Directive defines the permitted levels of electromagnetic emission from this equipment and its required immunity from the electromagnetic emissions of other devices. It is not possible, however, to exclude with absolute certainty the possibility that other high frequency electronic equipment, which is fully compliant to the EMC regulations, will not adversely affect the operation of this generator. If the other equipment has a comparatively high level of transmission power and is in close proximity to the generator, these EMC concerns (the risk of interference) may be more pronounced. It is therefore recommended that the operation of equipment of this type such as mobile telephones, cordless microphones and other similar mobile radio equipment be restricted from the vicinity of this X-ray generator. 1A.10.0 TECHNIQUE FACTORS DEFINITIONS • • KV: TIME: • • mA: mAs KV peak after any initial kV overshoot. Time in milliseconds, (ms) that the high voltage (anode to cathode) is greater than or equal to 75% of the desired kV. Average Tube Beam Current (in mA) during the exposure TIME. milliampere-seconds (mA x TIME). Address any questions regarding X-ray generator operation to: Mail: Customer Support Department Communications and Power Industries Canada Inc. 45 River Drive Georgetown, Ontario, Canada L7G 2J4 Telephone: (905) 877-0161 Fax: (905) 877-8320 Attention: Customer Support Department E-mail: [email protected] Attention: Customer Support Department Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-00 Rev. L Page 1A-11 1A Introduction CPI Canada Inc. (This page intentionally left blank) Page 1A-12 Rev. L Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-00 CPI Canada Inc. Safety 1B CHAPTER 1 SECTION 1B SAFETY CONTENTS: Section Title 1B.1.0 INTRODUCTION .......................................................................................................................................1B-2 1B.2.0 SAFETY AND WARNING SYMBOLS .......................................................................................................1B-2 1B.3.0 SAFETY NOTICES AND WARNINGS ......................................................................................................1B-2 1B.4.0 SAFETY WARNING LABELS - INTRODUCTION.....................................................................................1B-4 1B.4.1 Safety Warning Labels - Organization ...................................................................................................1B-5 1B.5.0 SAFETY LABELS / NOTICES COMMON TO MILLENIA AND INDICO 100 ............................................1B-5 1B.5.1 Caution HV Behind Cover Label............................................................................................................1B-5 1B.5.2 Weight Label ..........................................................................................................................................1B-6 1B.5.3 DC Bus Label .........................................................................................................................................1B-6 1B.5.4 Console CPU Board / Console Board....................................................................................................1B-7 1B.5.5 Generator Interface Board .....................................................................................................................1B-7 1B.5.6 Room Interface Board............................................................................................................................1B-7 1B.5.7 AEC Board .............................................................................................................................................1B-7 1B.5.8 Power Input Board .................................................................................................................................1B-7 1B.5.9 Dual Speed Starter Board......................................................................................................................1B-8 1B.6.0 SAFETY LABELS / NOTICES UNIQUE TO MILLENIA ............................................................................1B-8 1B.6.1 HT Tank - Transformer Terminals Label................................................................................................1B-8 1B.6.2 Live Mains / Fuses / Ground Label ........................................................................................................1B-9 1B.6.3 Live Mains / Fuses Label .......................................................................................................................1B-9 1B.6.4 Caution - Hazardous Voltages Label ...................................................................................................1B-10 1B.6.5 Warning / Caution / Caution Label.......................................................................................................1B-11 1B.6.6 Tank Vent Label ...................................................................................................................................1B-11 1B.6.7 mA Test Jacks Label............................................................................................................................1B-12 1B.6.8 mA test Jacks.......................................................................................................................................1B-12 1B.6.9 F3 (Auxiliary Power Fuseblock) ...........................................................................................................1B-12 1B.7.0 SAFETY LABELS / NOTICES UNIQUE TO INDICO 100 .......................................................................1B-12 1B.7.1 Caution HV Exposed Label..................................................................................................................1B-12 1B.7.2 Caution HV Label.................................................................................................................................1B-13 1B.7.3 Danger HV Label .................................................................................................................................1B-13 1B.7.4 High Voltage Warning Label ................................................................................................................1B-13 1B.7.5 HT Tank - Transformer Terminals .......................................................................................................1B-14 1B.7.6 Danger High Tension ...........................................................................................................................1B-14 1B.7.7 F1 (Primary of Auxiliary Transformer)..................................................................................................1B-14 Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-01 Rev. H Page 1B-1 1B Safety CPI Canada Inc. 1B.1.0 INTRODUCTION This section contains important safety warnings and safety information required for installing and servicing the generator. 1B.2.0 SAFETY AND WARNING SYMBOLS The following advisory symbols are used on the safety warning labels, and/or on circuit boards, and/or on the operator console and the optional remote fluoro control. High voltage symbol used to indicate the presence of high voltage. WARNING THIS X-RAY UNIT MAY BE DANGEROUS TO PATIENT AND OPERATOR UNLESS SAFE EXPOSURE FACTORS AND OPERATING INSTRUCTIONS ARE OBSERVED. Warning symbol used to indicate a potential hazard to operators, to service personnel, or to the equipment. It indicates a requirement to refer to the accompanying documentation for details. Radiation exposure symbol used on operator console. Lights to indicate that an exposure is in progress. This is accompanied by an audible tone from the console. Fluoro radiation exposure symbol used on operator console and on optional remote fluoro control unit. Lights to indicate that a fluoro exposure is in progress. This is accompanied by an audible tone from the console. Radiation warning label on console, used in certain jurisdictions. Never allow unqualified personnel to operate the Xray generator. 1B.3.0 SAFETY NOTICES AND WARNINGS WARNING: PROPER USE AND SAFE OPERATING PRACTICES WITH RESPECT TO X-RAY GENERATORS ARE THE RESPONSIBILITY OF USERS OF SUCH GENERATORS. CPI CANADA INC. PROVIDES INFORMATION ON ITS PRODUCTS AND ASSOCIATED HAZARDS, BUT ASSUMES NO RESPONSIBILITIES FOR AFTER-SALE OPERATING AND SAFETY PRACTICES. THE MANUFACTURER ACCEPTS NO RESPONSIBILITY FOR ANY GENERATOR NOT MAINTAINED OR SERVICED ACCORDING TO THIS SERVICE AND INSTALLATION MANUAL, OR FOR ANY GENERATOR THAT HAS BEEN MODIFIED IN ANY WAY. THE MANUFACTURER ALSO ASSUMES NO RESPONSIBILITY FOR X-RAY RADIATION OVEREXPOSURE OF PATIENTS OR PERSONNEL RESULTING FROM POOR OPERATING TECHNIQUES OR PROCEDURES. Page 1B-2 Rev. H Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-01 CPI Canada Inc. Safety 1B SAFETY NOTICES AND WARNINGS (cont) WARNING: THIS X-RAY UNIT MAY BE DANGEROUS TO PATIENT AND OPERATOR UNLESS SAFE EXPOSURE FACTORS AND OPERATING INSTRUCTIONS ARE OBSERVED. X-ray radiation exposure may be damaging to health, with some effects being cumulative and extending over periods of many months or even years. Operators and service personnel should avoid any exposure to the primary beam and take protective measures to safeguard against scatter radiation. Scatter radiation is caused by any object in the path of the primary beam and may be of equal or less intensity than the primary beam that exposes the film. No practical design can incorporate complete protection for operators or service personnel who do not take adequate safety precautions. Only authorized and properly trained service and operating personnel should be allowed to work with this X-ray generator equipment. The appropriate personnel must be made aware of the inherent dangers associated with the servicing of high voltage equipment and the danger of excessive exposure to X-ray radiation during system operation. DO NOT CONNECT UNAPPROVED EQUIPMENT TO THE REAR OF THE CONSOLE. For the 23 X 56 (cm) console, J5 is used for the interconnect cable to the generator main cabinet, J4 is not used, J2 is a serial port for use by an external computer, and J1 is for connection of an optional printer. For the 31 X 42 (cm) console, J5 is used for the interconnect cable to the generator main cabinet, J2 is a serial port for use by an external computer, and J13 is for connection of an external hand switch and / or foot switch. For the Rad-only console, J3 is for connection of an external hand switch, J4 is a serial port for use by an external computer, and J8 is for the interconnect cable to the main cabinet. For the touch screen console, J2 on the touch screen interface board is for the interconnect cable to the generator main cabinet, J3 is for connection of an external hand switch, J5 connects to the membrane switch assembly with the on / off and prep / expose switches, and J4 is a serial port for use by an external computer. INCORRECT CONNECTIONS OR USE OF UNAPPROVED EQUIPMENT MAY RESULT IN INJURY OR EQUIPMENT DAMAGE.. CAUTION: DO NOT EXCEED THE TUBE MAXIMUM OPERATING LIMITS. INTENDED LIFE AND RELIABILITY WILL NOT BE OBTAINED UNLESS GENERATORS ARE OPERATED WITHIN PUBLISHED SPECIFICATIONS. Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-01 Rev. H Page 1B-3 1B Safety CPI Canada Inc. SAFETY NOTICES AND WARNINGS (cont) WARNING: HAZARDOUS VOLTAGES EXIST INSIDE THE GENERATOR WHENEVER THE MAIN POWER DISCONNECT IS SWITCHED ON. THOSE AREAS INCLUDE THE MAIN FUSEHOLDER AND ASSOCIATED CIRCUITS IN THE HV POWER SUPPLY, PORTIONS OF THE GENERATOR INTERFACE BOARD IN THE UPPER PORTION OF THE GENERATOR (MILLENIA AND INDICO 100), AND THE TERMINALS ON THE LINE ADJUSTING TRANSFORMER IN THE LOWER GENERATOR CABINET IF FITTED (MILLENIA ONLY). THE CONSOLE ON/OFF SWITCH DOES NOT DISCONNECT THE MAIN POWER FROM THE ABOVE AREAS INSIDE THE GENERATOR. THE BUS CAPACITORS, LOCATED IN THE POWER SUPPLY PRESENT A SAFETY HAZARD FOR AT LEAST 5 MINUTES AFTER THE POWER HAS BEEN REMOVED FROM THE UNIT. CHECK THAT THESE CAPACITORS ARE DISCHARGED BEFORE SERVICING THE GENERATOR. 1B.4.0 SAFETY WARNING LABELS - INTRODUCTION The safety warning label subsections define the safety labels used inside and outside the generator cabinets. Depending on configuration, your X-ray generator may contain some or all of the labels shown. NOTE: THESE LABELS AND WARNINGS ARE LOCATED TO ALERT SERVICE PERSONNEL THAT SERIOUS INJURY WILL RESULT IF THE HAZARD IDENTIFIED IS IGNORED. NOTE: DUE TO THE DIVERSITY OF GENERATOR MODELS, THE EQUIPMENT MAY NOT BE EXACTLY AS SHOWN. WARNING: SWITCH OFF THE MAIN POWER DISCONNECT AND ALLOW SUFFICIENT TIME FOR ALL CAPACITORS TO DISCHARGE BEFORE REMOVING ANY COVERS OR OPENING ANY SERVICE DOOR. WARNING: IF ANY BARRIERS OR COVERS MUST BE REMOVED FOR SERVICE, TAKE ALL REQUIRED PRECAUTIONS WITH RESPECT TO THE HAZARD(S) AND IMMEDIATELY REPLACE THE BARRIERS/COVERS WHEN THE NEED FOR REMOVAL IS COMPLETED. REPLACE ALL FUSES IN THIS GENERATOR WITH THE SAME TYPE AND RATING. This information is provided to help you establish safe operating conditions for both you and your CPI Xray generator. Do not operate this X-ray generator except in accordance with these precautions, and any additional information provided by the X-ray generator manufacturer and/or competent safety authorities. Page 1B-4 Rev. H Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-01 CPI Canada Inc. Safety 1B 1B.4.1 Safety Warning Labels - Organization The safety warning label information is organized into three subsections: • • • Safety labels/notices common to Millenia and Indico 100 Safety notices unique to Millenia Safety notices unique to Indico 100 1B.5.0 SAFETY LABELS / NOTICES COMMON TO MILLENIA AND INDICO 100 1B.5.1 Caution HV Behind Cover Label MILLENIA: This label is attached to a cover over the main power contactor. This area will have mains voltage applied as long as the main disconnect is switched on. MILLENIA: This label is attached to a cover over the resonant circuit and low speed starter components if a low speed starter is fitted. The resonant components (resonant capacitors etc) may be energized for 5 minutes after the console is switched off, or the main disconnect is switched off. If a low speed starter is fitted, the associated components will have up to 240 VAC applied when the console is switched on. MILLENIA: This label is attached to each of the access panels on the rear of the generator. The high voltage hazards behind these panels is similar to that behind the upper and lower entrance doors, see 1B.7.4. MILLENIA: This label is attached to a cover over the line adjusting transformer (if fitted). The terminals on the transformer will have mains voltage applied as long as the main disconnect is switched on. If access to the transformer connections is needed, SWITCH OFF THE MAIN DISCONNECT FIRST. INDICO 100: This label is attached to a cover over the inverter board(s). The inverter assembly is connected to the main DC bus and will have high voltage applied at all times that the generator is switched on. This assembly will remain energized for 5 minutes after the generator is switched off, or the main disconnect is switched off. INDICO 100: This label is attached to a cover over the main input fuses on the power input board. This area will have mains voltage applied as long as the main disconnect is switched on. Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-01 Rev. H Page 1B-5 1B Safety CPI Canada Inc. 1B.5.2 Weight Label MILLENIA: This label is attached to the upper and lower generator cabinets and to the HT oil tank and states the approximate weight of each of the generator sections and of the HT oil tank. This label cautions against attempting to lift those assemblies without proper assistance. INDICO 100: This label is attached to the lower generator cabinet and to the HT oil tank and states the approximate weight of the lower generator cabinet and of the HT oil tank. This label cautions against attempting to lift those assemblies without proper assistance. 1B.5.3 DC Bus Label MILLENIA: This label is attached to a cover over the DC bus capacitors. These capacitors will hold a lethal charge for 5 minutes after the console is switched off, or the main disconnect is switched off. Do not remove the cover for a minimum of 5 minutes after the power has been switched off. INDICO 100: This label is attached to the removable panels on the lower (power supply) cabinet. The internal capacitors will hold a lethal charge for 5 minutes after the console is switched off, or the main disconnect is switched off. Do not remove the cover for a minimum of 5 minutes after the power has been switched off. WARNING: Page 1B-6 WAIT A MINIMUM OF 5 MINUTES AFTER THE INPUT MAINS POWER HAS BEEN REMOVED BEFORE REMOVING ANY COVERS OR ACCESS PANELS. ONCE THE COVER(S) / PANEL(S) ARE REMOVED CHECK THAT THE VOLTAGE ACROSS THE DC BUS CAPACITORS IS LESS THAN 48 VDC BEFORE SERVICING. Rev. H Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-01 CPI Canada Inc. Safety 1B 1B.5.4 Console CPU Board / Console Board For 23 X 56 (cm) consoles: HIGH VOLTAGE HAZARD: Approximately 400 VAC is present on this board in the area of U32 and J10. This voltage is used to light the backlight for the LCD display assembly in the console. For 31 X 42 (cm) Indico 100 R&F consoles: HIGH VOLTAGE HAZARD: Approximately 400 VAC is present on this board in the area of T1, C57, and J10. This is a high voltage source for the fluorescent backlight on the LCD display. For Indico 100 Rad-only consoles: HIGH VOLTAGE HAZARD: Approximately 400 VAC is present on this board in the area of T1, C36, and J5. This is a high voltage source for the fluorescent backlight on the LCD display. FUSE RATING: F1: 1.6A 250V 1B.5.5 Generator Interface Board This symbol is printed on the generator interface board in the high volage (mains) area. HIGH VOLTAGE HAZARD: Components within the dashed line on the board have high voltage applied at all times that the main disconnect is switched ON. These components are live EVEN WITH THE CONSOLE SWITCHED OFF. This symbol is printed on the generator interface board near fuses F1 to F6. FUSE RATINGS: F1: 1.6A 250V slow blow F2, F5: 2.5A 250V slow blow F3, F4: 5A 250V slow blow F6: 2A 250 V slow blow 1B.5.6 Room Interface Board This symbol is printed on the room interface board near the 110/220 VAC terminal blocks. HIGH VOLTAGE HAZARD: 110/220 VAC may be present on this board at all times that the AC mains to the generator is switched on. 1B.5.7 AEC Board This symbol is printed on some versions of AEC board with a high voltage power supply for a PMT or ion chamber. HIGH VOLTAGE HAZARD: Depending on the AEC board type, up to approximately 1000 VDC may be present on the AEC board at all times that the generator is switched on. 1B.5.8 Power Input Board Power input boards for single phase 240 VAC generators are fitted with several high power resistors that operate at temperatures sufficient to cause skin burn. Ensure that these resistors have cooled sufficiently after the power has been switched off before servicing. Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-01 Rev. H Page 1B-7 1B Safety CPI Canada Inc. 1B.5.9 Dual Speed Starter Board This symbol is printed on the dual speed starter board if fitted. HIGH VOLTAGE HAZARD: Approximately 600 VDC is present on this board. This voltage is supplied from the DC bus capacitors in the HF power supply. USE EXTREME CAUTION WHEN SERVICING, this voltage and current combination is lethal. Ensure that the DC bus capacitors are fully discharged before servicing as these capacitors will hold a lethal charge for 5 minutes AFTER THE EQUIPMENT IS SWITCHED OFF. WARNING: COMPONENTS BEHIND VARIOUS COVERS, AS NOTED IN THIS SECTION, REMAIN LIVE EVEN WITH THE OPERATOR CONSOLE SWITCHED OFF. THE ONLY WAY TO REMOVE POWER FROM THESE AREAS IS TO SWITCH OFF THE MAIN DISCONNECT. 1B.6.0 SAFETY LABELS / NOTICES UNIQUE TO MILLENIA 1B.6.1 HT Tank - Transformer Terminals Label This label indicates that if the power supply inverter leads that attach to the high tension transformer primary terminals are not connected the generator must not be energized. This label also cautions against over tightening the nuts on the transformer feedthrough terminals mentioned in the above paragraph. Page 1B-8 Rev. H Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-01 CPI Canada Inc. Safety 1B 1B.6.2 Live Mains / Fuses / Ground Label This label is attached to a cover over the main fuse block and fuses. This area will have mains voltage applied as long as the main disconnect is switched on. The main system ground is also located behind this cover. 1B.6.3 Live Mains / Fuses Label This label is attached to a cover over the fuse block and fuses for the room interface transformer. This area will have mains voltage applied as long as the main disconnect is switched on. Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-01 Rev. H Page 1B-9 1B Safety CPI Canada Inc. 1B.6.4 Caution - Hazardous Voltages Label CAUTION HAZARDOUS VOLTAGES ARE PRESENT INSIDE THE CABINET FOR A PERIOD OF FIVE (5) MINUTES AFTER DE-ENERGIZING THIS EQUIPMENT. This label is attached to the main access doors on the generator. Wait a minimum of five minutes after the main power has been removed from the generator before opening the cabinet doors. This will allow for internal capacitors to discharge to a safe level. The upper door provides access to the HV power supply driver section, room interface board and associated control circuits. The lower door allows access to the HT transformer, dual speed starter chassis if fitted, line adjusting transformer if fitted, and access to the tube stator connections and thermal switch connections. Additionally, the grounding location for the X-ray tube housing is located in this area. Hazards associated with each area within are outlined in the relevant sections of this chapter. Page 1B-10 Rev. H Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-01 CPI Canada Inc. Safety 1B 1B.6.5 Warning / Caution / Caution Label This label is attached to a cover over the dual speed starter assembly (if fitted). DC bus voltage is present behind this panel, see 1B.5.9. Ensure that the generator has been turned OFF for five minutes before removing the cover or disconnecting the DC supply. Replace fuses with the same type and rating, refer to spares list (chapter 8) for details. 1B.6.6 Tank Vent Label This label is attached to the HT tank clamping bracket on generator models equipped with an HT tank vent screw. This screw must be loosened to allow venting of the HT tank before use of the generator when the tank is so equipped. The screw must be fully tightened to prevent insulating oil spills or leaks from the HT tank during transportation or shipping. Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-01 Rev. H Page 1B-11 1B Safety CPI Canada Inc. 1B.6.7 mA Test Jacks Label This label is attached to the top of the HT tank on generator models equipped with mA test jacks. A similar warning is printed on tank lid boards using this connector; see 1B.6.8 below for details. 1B.6.8 mA test Jacks This symbol is printed on tank lid boards with mA/mAs test jacks. Replace the shorting jumper immediately after use. Do not attempt exposures without either the shorting jumper in place, or an approved mA/mAs measuring device properly connected. The warning “CAUTION: 48V MAX” printed on some tank lid boards does not apply in Millenia generator applications. 1B.6.9 F3 (Auxiliary Power Fuseblock) This symbol is on a label under the fuseholder for F3 (to the right of the HF power supply). FUSE RATING: 3A 500V slow blow. This fuse is only used if the generator is fitted with the neutral block option. 1B.7.0 SAFETY LABELS / NOTICES UNIQUE TO INDICO 100 1B.7.1 Caution HV Exposed Label This label is attached to the removable panels on the lower (power supply) cabinet. High voltage is present within this cabinet at all times that the mains power is switched on. Page 1B-12 Rev. H Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-01 CPI Canada Inc. Safety 1B 1B.7.2 Caution HV Label This label is attached to the power input board, and to the resonant board assembly. The input power board has line voltage components attached that will be live at all times that the main disconnect is switched on. This includes the input fuses, main line contactor, mains rectifier and associated components. The resonant board assembly has components that may be energized at all times that the generator is on. These components may retain their charge for 5 minutes after the console is switched off, or the main disconnect is switched off. 1B.7.3 Danger HV Label This label is attached to the primary terminals on the HT oil tank. These terminals may be energized at all times that the generator is switched on, and for 5 minutes after the console or the main disconnect is switched off. 1B.7.4 High Voltage Warning Label This label is attached to the inverter board(s) and to the low speed starter assembly if fitted. The inverter assembly is connected to the main DC bus and will have high voltage applied at all times that the generator is switched on. This assembly will remain energized for 5 minutes after the generator is switched off, or the main disconnect is off. Components on the low speed starter assembly will have 240 VAC applied when the console is switched on. Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-01 Rev. H Page 1B-13 1B Safety CPI Canada Inc. 1B.7.5 HT Tank - Transformer Terminals This notice is printed on the HT oil tank lid and indicates that if the power supply inverter leads that attach to the high tension transformer primary terminals are not connected the generator must not be energized. This notice also cautions against over tightening the nuts on the transformer feedthrough terminals mentioned in the above paragraph. 1B.7.6 Danger High Tension This notice is printed on the HT oil tank lid. High voltage may be present at the primary terminals on the tank lid board, at the output high voltage connectors, and at the mA/mAs measuring jacks if the shorting link is opened for mA/mAs measurements. 1B.7.7 F1 (Primary of Auxiliary Transformer) This symbol is on a label above the fuse holder for F1 (to the left of the main input fuses on the power input board). FUSE RATING: Single phase generators: 3A 250V slow blow. Three phase generators: 2A 500V slow blow. Page 1B-14 Rev. H Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-01 CPI Canada Inc. Preparing for Installation 1C CHAPTER 1 SECTION 1C PREPARING FOR INSTALLATION CONTENTS: 1C.1.0 INTRODUCTION ..................................................................................................................................... 1C-2 1C.2.0 GENERATOR POWER REQUIREMENTS............................................................................................. 1C-2 1C.2.1 32 kW Single Phase ............................................................................................................................ 1C-2 1C.2.2 40 kW Single Phase ............................................................................................................................ 1C-2 1C.2.3 32 kW Three Phase ............................................................................................................................. 1C-2 1C.2.4 40 kW Three Phase ............................................................................................................................. 1C-3 1C.2.5 50 kW Three Phase ............................................................................................................................. 1C-3 1C.2.6 65 kW Three Phase ............................................................................................................................. 1C-3 1C.2.7 80 kW Three Phase ............................................................................................................................. 1C-4 1C.2.8 100 kW Three Phase ........................................................................................................................... 1C-4 1C.2.9 Service Disconnect (All Models).......................................................................................................... 1C-4 1C.3.0 POWER LINE REQUIREMENTS............................................................................................................ 1C-5 1C.4.0 GROUND REQUIREMENTS .................................................................................................................. 1C-7 1C.5.0 OUTLINE DRAWINGS ............................................................................................................................ 1C-7 1C.5.1 Generator Outline ................................................................................................................................ 1C-7 1C.5.2 Generator Weight ................................................................................................................................ 1C-7 1C.5.3 Generator Shipping Containers: Dimensions ...................................................................................... 1C-8 1C.6.0 LOCATING THE GENERATOR CABINET AND CONTROLLER........................................................... 1C-8 1C.6.1 Locating The Equipment In The X-Ray Room..................................................................................... 1C-9 1C.6.2 Seismic Centers and mounting hole locations .................................................................................. 1C-10 1C.7.0 ENVIRONMENTAL REQUIREMENTS ................................................................................................. 1C-12 1C.8.0 CABLES SUPPLIED WITH THE INDICO 100 GENERATOR .............................................................. 1C-12 1C.9.0 PRE-INSTALLATION CHECK LISTS ................................................................................................... 1C-13 1C.9.1 Site Logistics...................................................................................................................................... 1C-13 1C.9.2 Installation Equipment ....................................................................................................................... 1C-13 Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-02 Rev. N Page 1C-1 1C Preparing for Installation CPI Canada Inc. 1C.1.0 INTRODUCTION The following items must be considered before installing your generator: • Power level of your generator. • Power line requirements. • Ground requirements. • Physical placement of the generator. • Environmental requirements for the generator. • Cable runs from the generator to all room components: tables, Buckys, X-ray tubes etc. 1C.2.0 GENERATOR POWER REQUIREMENTS 1C.2.1 32 kW Single Phase Line Voltage 230 VAC ± 10%, 1∅. Line Frequency 50/60 Hz. Momentary Current 200 Amps. Standby Current 5 Amps. 1C.2.2 40 kW Single Phase Line Voltage 230 VAC ± 10%, 1∅. Line Frequency 50/60 Hz. Momentary Current 250 Amps. Standby Current 5 Amps. 1C.2.3 32 kW Three Phase 400 VAC ± 10%, 3∅. Line Voltage 480 VAC ± 10%, 3∅ with optional line adjusting transformer. Line Frequency 50/60 Hz. Momentary Current 65 Amps/phase at 400 VAC. 55 Amps/phase at 480 VAC. Standby Current Page 1C-2 5 Amps. Rev. N Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-02 CPI Canada Inc. Preparing for Installation 1C 1C.2.4 40 kW Three Phase Line Voltage 400 VAC ± 10%, 3∅. 480 VAC ± 10%, 3∅ with optional line adjusting transformer. Line Frequency 50/60 Hz. Momentary Current 80 Amps/phase at 400 VAC. 65 Amps/phase at 480 VAC. Standby Current 5 Amps. 1C.2.5 50 kW Three Phase Line Voltage 400 VAC ± 10%, 3∅ (for 400 VAC input generators). 480 VAC ± 10%, 3∅ with optional line adjusting transformer, (for 400 VAC input generators). 480 VAC ± 10%, 3∅ (for 480 VAC input generators). * SEE NOTE AT THE END OF 1C.2.8 Line Frequency 50/60 Hz. Momentary Current 100 Amps/phase at 400 VAC. 80 Amps/phase at 480 VAC. Standby Current 5 Amps. 1C.2.6 65 kW Three Phase Line Voltage 400 VAC ± 10%, 3∅ (for 400 VAC input generators). 480 VAC ± 10%, 3∅ with optional line adjusting transformer, (for 400 VAC input generators). 480 VAC ± 10%, 3∅ (for 480 VAC input generators). * SEE NOTE AT THE END OF 1C.2.8 Line Frequency 50/60 Hz. Momentary Current 125 Amps/phase at 400 VAC. 105 Amps/phase at 480 VAC. Standby Current Indico 100 Series Service Manual 5 Amps. Ch # 740895-02 Rev. N Page 1C-3 1C Preparing for Installation CPI Canada Inc. 1C.2.7 80 kW Three Phase 400 VAC ± 10%, 3∅ (for 400 VAC input generators). Line Voltage 480 VAC ± 10%, 3∅ with optional line adjusting transformer, (for 400 VAC input generators). 480 VAC ± 10%, 3∅ (for 480 VAC input generators). * SEE NOTE AT THE END OF 1C.2.8 Line Frequency 50/60 Hz. Momentary Current 155 Amps/phase at 400 VAC. 130 Amps/phase at 480 VAC. Standby Current 5 Amps. 1C.2.8 100 kW Three Phase 400 VAC ± 10%, 3∅ (for 400 VAC input generators). Line Voltage 480 VAC ± 10%, 3∅ with optional line adjusting transformer, (for 400 VAC input generators). 480 VAC ± 10%, 3∅ (for 480 VAC input generators). * SEE NOTE AT THE END OF 1C.2.8 Line Frequency 50/60 Hz. Momentary Current 195 Amps/phase at 400 VAC. 160 Amps/phase at 480 VAC. Standby Current 5 Amps. 50 kW AND HIGHER THREE-PHASE INDICO 100 GENERATORS ARE AVAILABLE IN 400 VAC AND 480 VAC MODELS. 400 VAC MODELS MUST BE OPERATED FROM 400 VAC MAINS, OR MAY BE OPERATED FROM 480 VAC MAINS WITH AN OPTIONAL LINE ADJUSTING TRANSFORMER. 480 VAC MODELS MUST BE OPERATED FROM 480 VAC MAINS (THESE ARE THE NOMINAL MAINS VOLTAGES, THE ALLOWED TOLERANCES ARE AS DETAILED IN THE PREVIOUS TABLES). *NOTE: 1C.2.9 Service Disconnect (All Models) Refer to the following table for the recommended service disconnect ratings for the Generators (Power Supplies). Page 1C-4 Rev. N Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-02 CPI Canada Inc. Preparing for Installation 1C 1C.3.0 POWER LINE REQUIREMENTS The following table defines the power line requirements for the generators. NOTE: THE FOLLOWING TABLE CONTAINS RECOMMENDED VALUES FOR THE WIRE SIZES BETWEEN THE MAINS DISCONNECT AND THE GENERATOR. THE ACTUAL VALUES USED AT AN INSTALLATION ARE DEPENDENT ON THE QUALITY OF THE INPUT LINE (VOLTAGE LEVEL) THE CURRENT REQUIREMENTS AND THE LENGTH OF THE CABLE RUN AND MUST BE CONFIRMED BY THE INSTALLER. FINAL SELECTION OF GENERATOR INPUT WIRE AND DISCONNECTS AS WELL AS THE CABLING FROM THE DISTRIBUTION TRANSFORMER TO THE MAINS DISCONNECT, MUST MEET THE REQUIREMENTS OF THE LOCAL ELECTRICAL CODES AND IS USUALLY DETERMINED BY HOSPITAL/CONTRACTOR ENGINEERING. ALL THE RATINGS LISTED CONSIDER THE GENERATOR REQUIREMENTS ONLY. THE INSTALLER MUST MAKE THE NECESSARY COMPENSATION FOR ADDITIONAL LOAD REQUIREMENTS A POOR QUALITY INPUT LINE MAY RESULT IN THE INSTALLER HAVING TO DERATE THE GENERATOR'S MAXIMUM POWER Mains Voltage Minimum Recommended Mains Disconnect to Generator 15 ft/5 m max) Generator Momentary Line Current Minimum Recommended Generator Service Rating Minimum Recommended Distribution Transformer Rating #4 200 A 120 A 50 kVA Ground Wire Size Apparent Mains Resistance #4 0.055 Ω 32 kW 1∅ Generator 230 VAC 2 2 (25 mm ) (25mm ) 40 kW 1∅ Generator 230 VAC #4 250 A 120 A 65 kVA 2 0.045 Ω #4 2 (25 mm ) (25mm ) 32 kW 3∅ Generator 400 VAC #6 65 A 100 A 45 kVA (15 mm2) 480 VAC #6 0.27 Ω #4 (25mm2) 55 A 100 A 45 kVA 2 0.40 Ω #4 2 (15 mm ) (25mm ) 40 kW 3∅ Generator 400 VAC #6 80 A 100 A 55 kVA 2 2 (15 mm ) 480 VAC #6 (25mm ) 65 A 100 A 2 55 kVA 0.32 Ω #4 2 (15 mm ) Indico 100 Series Service Manual 0.22 Ω #4 (25mm ) Ch # 740895-02 Rev. N Page 1C-5 1C Preparing for Installation Mains Voltage CPI Canada Inc. Minimum Recommended Mains Disconnect to Generator 15 ft/5 m max) Generator Momentary Line Current Minimum Recommended Generator Service Rating Minimum Recommended Distribution Transformer Rating #6 100 A 100 A 65 kVA Ground Wire Size Apparent Mains Resistance #4 0.17 Ω 50 kW 3∅ Generator 400 VAC 2 2 (15 mm ) 480 VAC #6 (25mm ) 80 A 100 A 65 kVA 2 0.24 Ω #4 2 (15 mm ) (25mm ) 65 kW 3∅ Generator 400 VAC #6 125 A 100 A 85 kVA 2 2 (15 mm ) 480 VAC #6 0.13 Ω #4 (25mm ) 105 A 100 A 85 kVA 2 0.19 Ω #4 2 (15 mm ) (25mm ) 80 kW 3∅ Generator 400 VAC #6 155 A 100 A 105 kVA 2 2 (15 mm ) 480 VAC #6 0.11 Ω #4 (25mm ) 130 A 100 A 105 kVA 2 0.15 Ω #4 2 (15 mm ) (25mm ) 100 kW 3∅ Generator 400 VAC #6 195 A 100 A 130 kVA 2 2 (15 mm ) 480 VAC #6 (25mm ) 160 A 100 A 130 kVA 2 • Page 1C-6 0.12 Ω #4 2 (15 mm ) • • • 0.09 Ω #4 (25mm ) All wiring and grounding should be in compliance with the national electrical code or equivalent. All wiring must be copper. For all installations, a separate copper ground cable #4 AWG (25 mm2) is required from the building distribution ground to the ground terminal located inside the main disconnect switch fuse block. The disconnect switch shall be located within reach of the operator. Rev. N Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-02 CPI Canada Inc. Preparing for Installation 1C 1C.4.0 GROUND REQUIREMENTS POWER LINE: • A suitable flexible copper cable #6 AWG (15 mm2) or larger must be supplied (usually part of the line cable) to connect from the disconnect switch to the main ground of the generator, located to the left of the main fuse block on the power input board. • If a neutral line is provided with the system under no circumstances is it to be used for ground purposes. The ground conductor must carry fault currents only. X-RAY TUBE HOUSING: • A copper ground cable, #10 AWG (6 mm2) or greater, is to be connected from each X-ray tube’s housing to the H.T. tank ground stud (located at the top of the H.T. tank). STATOR CABLE: • For units with a low speed starter, shielded stator cables are recommended. For units with a dual speed starter, shielded stator cables MUST be used. The shield for the stator cable(s) must be properly grounded at the chassis ground studs as per chapter 2. 1C.5.0 OUTLINE DRAWINGS 1C.5.1 Generator Outline Refer to chapter 1A for the Indico 100 generator outline. 1C.5.2 Generator Weight The weight of the generator cabinet and of the available consoles is listed below: Generator cabinet Control console (23 X 56 cm) Control console (31 X 42 cm) Control console (Rad only) Control console (Touch screen) Indico 100 Series Service Manual 235 lbs (107 kg). 7 lbs (3.2 kg). 8 lbs (3.7 kg). 6 lbs (2.7 kg). 24 lbs (10.9 kg). Ch # 740895-02 Rev. N Page 1C-7 1C Preparing for Installation CPI Canada Inc. 1C.5.3 Generator Shipping Containers: Dimensions The overall dimensions of the Indico 100 shipping pack are shown below. Figure 1C-1: Generator shipping container 1C.6.0 LOCATING THE GENERATOR CABINET AND CONTROLLER The generator cabinet is self standing and does not need to be supported. However, the installation should meet the following requirements: • • • • • • Page 1C-8 The floor must be flat and level. The floor must be capable of supporting a load of approximately 250 lbs (115 Kg). The generator installation area must be clean and free of dirt or debris. Sufficient room must be provided to allow access to the rear and side panels for installation. Clearance must also be provided at both sides of the cabinet, at the front, and at the rear of the upper cabinet to allow access for service. See Figure 1C-2 for recommended clearances. A cable conduit should be provided from the control console to the generator cabinet to allow routing of the control cable if required. Allow for a 2 inch conduit. See Figure 1C-3. Refer to 1C.6.2 for the seismic center location and for the mounting-hole locations to secure the generator to the floor, if required. Rev. N Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-02 CPI Canada Inc. Preparing for Installation 1C 1C.6.1 Locating The Equipment In The X-Ray Room Figure 1C-2 shows recommended clearances around the generator. Figure 1C-3 shows recommended clearances for through-the-wall cable routing. Figure 1C-2: Generator clearances Figure 1C-3: Typical through the wall installation. Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-02 Rev. N Page 1C-9 1C Preparing for Installation CPI Canada Inc. 1C.6.2 Seismic Centers and mounting hole locations Figure 1C-4 shows the seismic center location for the Indico 100 X-ray generator. The dimensions are shown as a range of values because the seismic center location will vary slightly, depending on model and configuration of the generator. The installer will need to confirm the exact seismic center location if the published range is insufficiently precise. The generator should be secured to the floor via the 5/8 inch (16 mm) diameter clearance holes that are located in the base of the cabinet as shown in figure 1C-6, or by means of the anchoring plates shown in figure 1C-5. Figure 1C-4: Indico 100 seismic centers Page 1C-10 Rev. N Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-02 CPI Canada Inc. Preparing for Installation 1C 1C.6.2 Seismic Centers and mounting hole locations (Cont) 0.39 (10 mm ) DIA 13.9 (353) 16.1 (409) 3.3 (85) TOP VIEW FRONT LEVELLING FEET (4 PLACES) 20.1 (511) DIMENSIONS ARE IN INCHES (MM) SPACERS SUPPLIED BY CUSTOMER (4 PLACES) FILE: IN_MTG.CDR Figure 1C-5: Anchoring plates for securing the generator 16.1 (409) 12.3 (312) 0.63 (16 mm ) DIA TOP VIEW FRONT 1.5 (38) 15.0 (380) DIMENSIONS ARE IN INCHES (MM) FILE: IN_MTG2.CDR Figure 1C-6: Holes in base of cabinet for securing the generator Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-02 Rev. N Page 1C-11 1C Preparing for Installation CPI Canada Inc. 1C.7.0 ENVIRONMENTAL REQUIREMENTS Listed below are the ventilation requirements for the Indico 100 series generator: • • • • Unrestricted air flow must be provided at the front and sides of the cabinet, as well as underneath the unit. Do not allow storage on top of the cabinet. Typical heat output of the generator during stand-by is 75 BTU/hr, or 4000 BTU/hr during fluoro operation. Control console heat output is negligible (150 BTU/hr). 1C.8.0 CABLES SUPPLIED WITH THE INDICO 100 GENERATOR Figure 1C-7 shows the cabling supplied with the generator: • • The cable supplied for the console is a 15 conductor cable with a standard length of 50 ft. (15 m). The cable supplied for the optional remote fluoro control is a 9 conductor cable with a standard length of 50 ft. (15 m). Figure 1C-7: Cabling supplied with generator Page 1C-12 Rev. N Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-02 CPI Canada Inc. Preparing for Installation 1C 1C.9.0 PRE-INSTALLATION CHECK LISTS The following checklists are provided to help the installer during a pre-installation site visit, prior to installing the generator: • • Site logistics Installation equipment 1C.9.1 Site Logistics Before starting the generator installation, review the following checklist for site logistics. CHECK √ DESCRIPTION Is there an unloading area to transport the generator from the delivery truck to the inside of the building? If the installation is not on the same floor as the delivery entrance, is there an elevator available? Are all halls and doorways large enough to allow the generator to pass through? Is there a transport dolly or similar device to move the Generator? It must have a minimum rating of 250 lb. (115 Kg.) Do any regulatory bodies need to be notified prior to installation? If movers are required, have arrangements for time and equipment been completed? Are lifting straps or some other suitable device available to lift the generator off the shipping pallet? 1C.9.2 Installation Equipment The following is a checklist of recommended tools and test equipment for installation and calibration of the generator. NOTE: Please note that GenWare® and a laptop computer are required for programming and calibration of the touch screen console. Refer to chapter 3C for details. CHECK √ DESCRIPTION GenWare® and a laptop computer for setup and calibration if required. This is needed for programming and calibration of the touch screen console. General hand tools for installation: Wrenches, nut drivers, assortment of screwdrivers, pliers, etc. If the generator is to be anchored to the floor, suitable hardware and drills, drill bits etc must be available. A supply of connectors for wiring: lugs, caps, line splices etc. A calibrated DVM which indicates true RMS voltages. Dual trace memory oscilloscope with a minimum 20 MHz bandwidth; appropriate leads, probes, etc. Device for measuring true kVp and mA (mAs). This may be a Dynalyzer equivalent or a non-invasive system such as the Keithly TRIAD system. A calibrated radiation meter with detectors that will allow for R/min and uR type measurements (or uGy and Gy/min). A strobe or reed type tachometer to verify that the anode is rotating up to speed. A sufficient selection of patient absorbers to allow AEC and ABS calibration. A suggested selection is 3/4 inch Al (quantity 2); 1 mm of Cu (quantity 8), Water in containers of 5.0. 10.0, 15.0 cm thickness. Test phantoms to verify the imaging system with the generator. Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-02 Rev. N Page 1C-13 1C Preparing for Installation CPI Canada Inc. (This page intentionally left blank) Page 1C-14 Rev. N Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-02 CPI Canada Inc Compatibility Listing 1D CHAPTER 1 SECTION 1D COMPATIBILITY LISTING CONTENTS: Section Title 1D.1.0 INTRODUCTION ...................................................................................................................................... 1D-2 1D.2.0 COMPATIBLE DEVICES AND OPTIONS ................................................................................................. 1D-2 1D.2.1 X-Ray Tubes ......................................................................................................................................... 1D-2 1D.2.2 Stators................................................................................................................................................... 1D-2 1D.2.3 AEC Devices......................................................................................................................................... 1D-2 1D.2.4 ABS Pickups ......................................................................................................................................... 1D-2 1D.2.5 Tomographic Tables ............................................................................................................................. 1D-2 1D.2.6 Digital Interfaces (R&F Generators) ..................................................................................................... 1D-2 1D.2.7 DAP (Dose Area Product)..................................................................................................................... 1D-3 1D.2.8 Options.................................................................................................................................................. 1D-3 1D.3.0 X-RAY TUBE DATA ................................................................................................................................. 1D-3 1D.4.0 COMPATIBILITY STATEMENT / PRODUCT DESCRIPTION ................................................................ 1D-4 Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-02 Rev. C Page 1D-1 1D Compatibility Listing CPI Canada Inc 1D.1.0 INTRODUCTION This section details external equipment that is compatible with your specific generator, and lists options that are included in that generator. 1D.2.0 COMPATIBLE DEVICES AND OPTIONS The Millenia and Indico 100 family of generators may be factory or user configured to be compatible with various external devices. Certain features must be factory configured, others are user configurable. Please refer to chapter 2 and 3 of this manual and / or consult the factory for further specifics. 1D.2.1 X-Ray Tubes Various makes and models of inserts and housings are supported. CAUTION: PLEASE ENSURE THAT THE X-RAY TUBE INSERT IS AS STATED ON THE COMPATIBILITY STATEMENT / PRODUCT DESCRIPTION. IF THE HOUSING HAS BEEN RELOADED WITH ANOTHER INSERT TYPE, CALIBRATION MAY BE SERIOUSLY AFFECTED AND MAY CAUSE TUBE DAMAGE. 1D.2.2 Stators Various types / impedances of stators are supported. 1D.2.3 AEC Devices The Millenia / Indico 100 family of X-ray generators may be configured to be compatible with various AEC devices (ionization, solid state or PMT) via the optional AEC board. Refer to the compatibility statement / product description at the end of this section for AEC device compatibility of this specific generator. 1D.2.4 ABS Pickups Various ABS pickups (light diode, composite video, PMT, etc) are supported on R&F generators depending on configuration. Refer to the compatibility statement / product description at the end of this section, and chapter 3E. 1D.2.5 Tomographic Tables Various. Please note that the generator is used as a backup timer ONLY in tomography. AEC is NOT available for tomography. 1D.2.6 Digital Interfaces (R&F Generators) The generator may be configured to be compatible with various digital imaging systems. Refer to the compatibility statement / product description at the end of this section. Page 1D-2 Rev. C Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-02 CPI Canada Inc Compatibility Listing 1D 1D.2.7 DAP (Dose Area Product) A DAP (Dose-Area Product) meter is available as an option on Indico 100 X-ray generators. Refer to chapter 3F for details. 1D.2.8 Options Major options include AEC board, DAP (Indico 100 only), remote fluoro control unit, dual speed starter, line adjusting transformer, and two tube HT transformer. NOTE: REFER TO THE COMPATIBILITY STATEMENT / PRODUCT DESCRIPTION AT THE END OF THIS SECTION FOR COMPATIBILITY OF THIS SPECIFIC GENERATOR. 1D.3.0 X-RAY TUBE DATA PLEASE INSERT THE TUBE RATING CHARTS FOR THE X-RAY TUBES USED WITH THIS GENERATOR. TUBE #1 HOUSING (MAKE / MODEL): INSERT (MAKE / MODEL): SERIAL #: STATOR TYPE: TUBE #2 HOUSING (MAKE / MODEL): INSERT (MAKE / MODEL): SERIAL #: STATOR TYPE: Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-02 Rev. C Page 1D-3 1D Compatibility Listing CPI Canada Inc 1D.4.0 COMPATIBILITY STATEMENT / PRODUCT DESCRIPTION The compatibility statement / product description for this generator follows this page. Page 1D-4 Rev. C Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-02 CPI Canada Inc Compatibility Listing 1D REPLACE (DISCARD) PAGE 5, 6 AND REPLACE WITH "COMPATIBILITY STATEMENT / PRODUCT DESCRIPTION” FORM 1 PAGE FOR CS FORM 2 PAGES FOR PD FORM Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-02 Rev. C Page 1D-5 1D Compatibility Listing CPI Canada Inc (This page intentionally left blank) Page 1D-6 Rev. C Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-02 CPI Canada Inc Generator Layout and Major Components 1E CHAPTER 1 SECTION 1E GENERATOR LAYOUT AND MAJOR COMPONENTS CONTENTS: 1E.1.0 INTRODUCTION .......................................................................................................................................1E-1 1E.2.0 MAJOR COMPONENT LAYOUT ..............................................................................................................1E-2 1E.2.1 Generator Cabinet Assembly.................................................................................................................1E-2 1E.2.2 Console Assembly .................................................................................................................................1E-4 1E.2.3 Remote Fluoro Control...........................................................................................................................1E-6 1E.2.4 Dual Speed Starter EPROM location.....................................................................................................1E-6 1E.1.0 INTRODUCTION This section contains generator layout drawings and figures that identify the major generator components and circuit board assemblies. This section also shows the location and correct orientation of the power EPROM (located on the generator CPU board, the console EPROM (located on the console CPU board), and the dual speed starter EPROM (located on the dual speed starter board if the dual speed starter option is used). Refer to the applicable figures to ensure correct EPROM placement and orientation should EPROM replacement be necessary. Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-03 Rev. H Page 1E-1 1E Generator Layout and Major Components CPI Canada Inc 1E.2.0 MAJOR COMPONENT LAYOUT 1E.2.1 Generator Cabinet Assembly The following major assemblies are located within the generator cabinet: • • • • • • • • Auxiliary power supply. Generator control circuits. Room interface for the X-ray system. Low speed starter or optional dual speed starter. High frequency inverter. H.T. transformer. Optional AEC board (automatic exposure control). Optional DAP interface board. Figure 1E-1 shows the major components within the front and right side of the generator cabinet. Figure 1E-2 shows the major components accessible from the left side and the rear of the generator cabinet. Figure 1E-1: Major generator subassemblies & power EPROM location Page 1E-2 Rev. H Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-03 CPI Canada Inc Generator Layout and Major Components 1E 1E.2.1 Generator Cabinet Assembly (Cont) Figure 1E-2: Major generator subassemblies (right side and rear) Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-03 Rev. H Page 1E-3 1E Generator Layout and Major Components CPI Canada Inc 1E.2.2 Console Assembly Figure 1E-3 is an overview of the 23 X 56 cm console, the 31 X 42 cm console, the Rad-only console, and the touch screen console for Indico 100 generators. Figure 1E-4 is an internal view of these console styles (except touch screen), showing the major components and cabling in the console assembly. The touch screen console contains no user serviceable parts, and must be returned to the factory for service. INDICO 100 23 X 56 cm Console 31 X 42 cm Console Rad only Console Touch Screen Console FILE: IN_CON1.CDR Figure 1E-3: Console top / external view Page 1E-4 Rev. H Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-03 CPI Canada Inc Generator Layout and Major Components 1E 1E.2.2 Console Assembly (Cont) Figure 1E-4: Console internal view including EPROM location Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-03 Rev. H Page 1E-5 1E Generator Layout and Major Components CPI Canada Inc 1E.2.3 Remote Fluoro Control Figure 1E-5 is an overview of the optional remote fluoro control for the Indico 100 generators. This allows operation of fluoro functions from a location other than the main console. Figure 1E-5: Remote fluoro control unit overview 1E.2.4 Dual Speed Starter EPROM location Figure 1E-6: EPROM location inside the dual speed starter Page 1E-6 Rev. H Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-03 CPI Canada Inc. Installation 2 CHAPTER 2 INSTALLATION CONTENTS: 2.1.0 INTRODUCTION .......................................................................................................................................... 2-3 2.2.0 RECEIVING .................................................................................................................................................. 2-3 2.2.1 Major Shipping Assemblies ....................................................................................................................... 2-4 2.3.0 REMOVAL FROM PACK .............................................................................................................................. 2-4 2.3.1 Lifting The Generator ................................................................................................................................ 2-5 2.4.0 REMOVING THE EXTERNAL COVERS...................................................................................................... 2-6 2.5.0 LINE ADJUSTING TRANSFORMER............................................................................................................ 2-8 2.6.0 MAJOR COMPONENT LAYOUT.................................................................................................................. 2-8 2.7.0 INSPECTING THE HT TANK ....................................................................................................................... 2-8 2.8.0 EQUIPMENT PLACEMENT.......................................................................................................................... 2-8 2.8.1 Equipment Cabinet .................................................................................................................................... 2-8 2.8.2 Control Console......................................................................................................................................... 2-8 2.8.3 Anchoring The Generator To The Floor .................................................................................................... 2-9 2.8.4 Leveling ..................................................................................................................................................... 2-9 2.9.0 WIRING TO THE GENERATOR................................................................................................................... 2-9 2.9.1 Control Console......................................................................................................................................... 2-9 2.9.2 Remote Fluoro Control (Optional) ........................................................................................................... 2-12 2.9.3 Hand Switch Installation .......................................................................................................................... 2-12 2.9.4 X-Ray Tube Stator & Thermal Switch Connections ................................................................................ 2-14 2.9.5 Generator Mains Connection .................................................................................................................. 2-15 2.9.6 Room Equipment..................................................................................................................................... 2-16 2.9.7 Emergency Power Off / Power Distribution Relay .................................................................................. 2-16 2.10.0 X-RAY TUBE HOUSING GROUND ......................................................................................................... 2-16 2.11.0 HIGH TENSION CABLES......................................................................................................................... 2-16 2.12.0 PROGRAMMING THE LOW SPEED STARTER ..................................................................................... 2-18 2.12.1 Low Speed Starter Tube Select Table .................................................................................................. 2-18 2.12.2 Low Speed Starter Boost Voltage Selection ......................................................................................... 2-18 2.12.3 Low Speed Starter Run Voltage Selection............................................................................................ 2-20 2.12.4 Low Speed Starter Boost Time Selection ............................................................................................. 2-21 2.13.0 PROGRAMMING THE DUAL SPEED STARTER .................................................................................... 2-21 2.13.1 Setting tube type ................................................................................................................................... 2-21 2.13.2 Confirming/Changing DSS Starter Type ............................................................................................... 2-23 2.13.3 Dual Speed Starter Tube Select Table ................................................................................................. 2-25 2.13.4 Configuring dual speed starter 733317-08 / 735925-08 ....................................................................... 2-25 2.14.0 GENERATOR LOCKOUT SWITCH ......................................................................................................... 2-26 2.15.0 SAFETY INTERLOCKS ............................................................................................................................ 2-27 2.16.0 CHECKING THE RAM BACKUP BATTERY VOLTAGE .......................................................................... 2-27 2.17.0 DIP SWITCH SETTINGS.......................................................................................................................... 2-31 2.18.0 INITIAL RUN-UP ....................................................................................................................................... 2-32 2.18.1 Initial Voltage Measurements ................................................................................................................ 2-32 2.18.2 Initial Power Up ..................................................................................................................................... 2-33 2.18.3 Single Phase Primary Tap Selection..................................................................................................... 2-34 2.18.4 Three Phase Primary Tap Selection ..................................................................................................... 2-36 Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-04 Rev. AM Page 2-1 2 Installation CPI Canada Inc. 2.19.0 PROGRAMMING AND CALIBRATION USING THE CONSOLE.............................................................2-37 2.19.1 Entering Into Programming/Calibration Mode .......................................................................................2-37 2.19.2 Menu Selections ....................................................................................................................................2-38 2.20.0 TUBE AUTO CALIBRATION ....................................................................................................................2-40 2.21.0 FINAL CHECKS ........................................................................................................................................2-41 Page 2-2 Rev. AM Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-04 CPI Canada Inc. 2.1.0 Installation 2 INTRODUCTION This chapter contains instructions for unpacking, positioning, and cabling the Indico 100 series of generators to allow initial operation and calibration. The instructions in this chapter allows the installation engineer to: • Install the generator and control console. • Install the optional remote fluoro control. • Connect power. • Calibrate one or two X-ray tube(s), depending on the generator model, without completing the room interface connections. This allows for simpler installation and troubleshooting on the generator itself. 2.2.0 RECEIVING WARNING: THE INDICO 100 GENERATOR CONSISTS OF THE FOLLOWING ITEMS: UPPER AND LOWER CABINETS (FACTORY ASSEMBLED), CONTROL CONSOLE, AND AN OPTIONAL REMOTE FLUORO CONTROL. THE COMPLETE GENERATOR WEIGHS APPROXIMATELY 250 POUNDS (115 KG) IN ITS SHIPPING CONTAINER. THE OPTIONAL LINE ADJUSTING TRANSFORMER IS SUPPLIED IN A SEPARATE ENCLOSURE, THE WEIGHT OF THAT ASSEMBLY IS APPROXIMATELY 100 POUNDS (45 KG). THE OIL TANK IS LOCATED IN THE LOWER (POWER SUPPLY) CABINET. ONE PERSON SHOULD NOT ATTEMPT TO LIFT OR MOVE THE GENERATOR ASSEMBLY OR OPTIONAL LINE ADJUSTING TRANSFORMER WITHOUT ADEQUATE ASSISTANCE OR PROPER EQUIPMENT. Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-04 Rev. AM Page 2-3 2 Installation 2.2.1 CPI Canada Inc. Major Shipping Assemblies Refer to figure 1A-2 (chapter 1A). This shows the upper (control cabinet) and lower (power supply) cabinet fully assembled, along with the control console and optional remote fluoro control unit. 2.3.0 REMOVAL FROM PACK 1. Inspect the pack for evidence of shipping damage. If there is evidence of shipping damage, note this in the event that a damage claim is justified. 2. Locate any documentation attached to the outside of the cardboard sleeve. Be sure to read and understand this documentation before unpacking the generator. Then set this documentation aside temporarily until it can be transferred to a storage location close to the generator for future reference. 3. Remove the cardboard outer pack(s). CAUTION: OPEN THE CARDBOARD PACK(S) CAREFULLY. SHARP TOOLS MAY DAMAGE THE CONTENTS. 4. Set aside the cardboard pack(s). 5. Unscrew the bolts that secure the generator to the shipping pallet. Carefully lift the generator from the pallet. Refer to 2.3.1 for the procedure for lifting the generator. 6. Inspect for internal and external shipping damage. Refer to 2.4.0 for instructions for removing the external covers. 7. Unscrew the leveling feet at the bottom of the generator by a minimum of 1 ½ in. (35 mm). This will provide the required air flow underneath the generator cabinet and allow room to make leveling adjustments when the generator is placed in its final location. 8. Remove and unpack the control console, the optional line adjusting transformer if used, the optional remote fluoro control if used, and the optional hand switch kit if included, and check these items for any damage. 9. Remove and unpack the manuals and any other paperwork that may be packed with the generator. 10. Keep the shipping containers. In case of shipping damage, place the unit(s) back in its shipping pack and notify the carrier and the customer support group at CPI Canada Inc. Page 2-4 Rev. AM Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-04 CPI Canada Inc. 2.3.1 Installation 2 Lifting The Generator One of the following methods is recommended for lifting or maneuvering the generator. Since the generator weighs more that 30 kg (65 lbs), proper lifting equipment should be used or additional help should be obtained to lift the unit. Refer to figure 1E-1 and figure 2-2 for identification of the panels referenced below. • Lifting straps can be used along with a hoist to raise the generator. The straps should be placed underneath the generator cabinet and along the four sides to properly support the cabinet as it is raised. • Remove the main access panel and the lower wiring access panel from the generator cabinet (refer to 2.4.0 - removing the external covers). The metal cross brace found at the front of the cabinet (below the circuit board mounting panel) may be used, in conjunction with the lip at the upper edge of the opening for the lower wiring access panel, as lifting points. Two people (one on each side) will be required to lift or maneuver the generator cabinet. Figure 2-1: Generator lifting points Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-04 Rev. AM Page 2-5 2 Installation 2.4.0 CPI Canada Inc. REMOVING THE EXTERNAL COVERS NOTE: A POTENTIAL HAZARD EXISTS TO OPERATORS, SERVICE PERSONNEL, OR TO THE EQUIPMENT IF THE GENERATOR IS OPERATED WITH ANY OF THE GROUND LEADS TO THE EXTERNAL COVERS DISCONNECTED OR IMPROPERLY CONNECTED. BE SURE TO PROPERLY RECONNECT ALL GROUND LEADS AFTER COMPLETING ANY PROCEDURE THAT REQUIRES THEIR REMOVAL. REFER TO FIGURE 2-2 FOR IDENTIFICATION OF COVERS / PANELS DESCRIBED IN THIS SECTION. Upper Cabinet Hood Remove the four screws that secure the upper cabinet hood to the generator (two on each side). Carefully lift the hood off the generator. Temporarily disconnect the ground lead connecting the upper cabinet hood to the generator, if necessary. Reverse the above steps to reconnect the ground wire(s), and to reinstall the upper cabinet hood. Main Access Panel Remove the upper cabinet hood as described above (this must be done before the main access panel can be removed). Then remove the screws that secure the main access panel to the generator cabinet (these screws are located on both sides of the main access panel). The panel may then be pulled away from the frame. Temporarily disconnect the ground lead connecting the panel to the cabinet, if necessary. Reverse the above steps to reconnect the ground wire(s), and to reinstall the access panel. Lower Wiring Access Panel THIS PANEL IS NOT FITTED IF THE OPTIONAL WIRING CHANNELS ARE USED. Remove the screw from the upper right hand corner of the panel. Pull out the snaps on the three nylon fasteners such as to release the panel. Remove the panel from the generator. Upper & Lower Wiring Channels The wiring channels are optional. If the wiring channels are fitted, the cable access covers in the upper part of the cabinet and the lower wiring access panel will not be used. To remove these panels, remove the screws from the upper left hand and upper right hand corner of the panel to be removed. Then slide the wiring channel up such that the shoulder rivets clear the keyhole slot at the bottom of the channel. The wiring channel may then be removed from the generator. Page 2-6 Rev. AM Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-04 CPI Canada Inc. 2.4.0 Installation 2 REMOVING THE EXTERNAL COVERS (Cont) Figure 2-2: Removable external covers on generator cabinet Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-04 Rev. AM Page 2-7 2 Installation 2.5.0 CPI Canada Inc. LINE ADJUSTING TRANSFORMER An optional line-adjusting transformer is available if required to allow 480 VAC generators to operate from 400 VAC mains, or to allow 400 VAC generators to be operated from 480 VAC mains. The line adjusting transformer is supplied in a separate enclosure. Please consult the factory for further details regarding this option. 2.6.0 MAJOR COMPONENT LAYOUT Refer to chapter 1E for major component identification and layout. 2.7.0 INSPECTING THE HT TANK Before continuing with the installation of the generator, the HT oil tank should be inspected as per the following steps: • Verify that there is no obvious shipping damage to the tank (i.e. dents to the tank surface). • Carefully check the inside of the generator cabinet and the HT tank for evidence of any oil loss. Refer to chapter 6 if it is suspected that there has been some loss of oil. • Verify that the clamps supporting the HT oil tank are tight. • Verify that all the connections to the tank lid are secure. • Verify that the rubber vent plug on the top of the tank is snug. 2.8.0 EQUIPMENT PLACEMENT 2.8.1 Equipment Cabinet Place the equipment cabinet in a location that will allow the following: • • • • 2.8.2 Easy front and side access for service and sufficient clearance at the rear for room interface cables. Refer to chapter 1C. Air circulation - a minimum height of 1 ½ in. (35 mm) is recommended to allow airflow underneath the generator. Do not cover or block the cooling slots on the cabinet. Stable footing - the leveling feet at the bottom of the cabinet will be used to prevent movement during normal operation. Close proximity to service disconnect boxes - cables should not be on the floor where they could be stepped on. Control Console Locate the control console in its intended position and ensure that it is stable. Refer to chapter 1C: • • • • Page 2-8 If the console is located on a shelf, supply index pins or equivalent hardware to the base of the console to prevent slipping. Ensure that the console is mounted at a height and angle to allow easy viewing of the displays. If the optional CPI pedestal stand is to be used for the console mounting, follow the mounting instructions supplied with the stand. Leave sufficient slack in the cabling to the console to allow for future service and maintenance. Rev. AM Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-04 CPI Canada Inc. 2.8.2 Installation 2 Control Console (Cont) NOTE: DO NOT LOCATE THE CONTROL CONSOLE WHERE X-RADIATION MAY BE PRESENT DURING INSTALLATION OR OPERATION. NOTE: IT IS RECOMMENDED THAT THE CONSOLE CABLE NOT BE DISASSEMBLED FOR SYSTEM INSTALLATION. HOWEVER, IF THIS IS ABSOLUTELY NECESSARY TO ROUTE THE CABLE, PLEASE ENSURE CAREFUL AND CORRECT REASSEMBLY OF THE CONNECTOR SHELL TO AVOID ANY POSSIBILITY OF PINCHING OF THE INTERNAL WIRES BY THE SHELL. YOU MAY CHOOSE TO TEMPORARILY LOCATE THE CONSOLE NEAR TO THE GENERATOR FOR INITIAL PROGRAMMING AND CALIBRATION. IF THIS IS SO, PLEASE COMPLETE THE FINAL CONSOLE INSTALLATION PER THIS SECTION WHEN THE GENERATOR INSTALLATION IS COMPLETED. 2.8.3 Anchoring The Generator To The Floor If it is desired to anchor the generator to the floor, refer to chapter 1C. This should not be done until all cable hookups are completed that require rear access to the generator. 2.8.4 Leveling Adjust the leveling feet such that the generator is level and stable. This adjustment must be made for both anchored and freestanding generator installations. As noted in 2.3.0, the leveling feet must be unscrewed by a minimum of 1 ½ in. (35 mm) to allow for proper airflow underneath the generator. 2.9.0 WIRING TO THE GENERATOR 2.9.1 Control Console 1. Route the generator end of the console cable into the generator cabinet via the access cover in the upper part of the cabinet nearest to J4 on the generator interface board. 2. Connect the console cable to J4 on the generator interface board. For the Rad-only console, connect the console cable to J16 on the generator interface board. 3. Connect the free end of the console cable as follows: For the 23 X 56 (cm) console and the 31 X 42 (cm) console, connect the free end of the console cable to J5 at the rear of the console. For the Rad-only console, connect the free end of the console cable to the J8 at the rear of the console. For the touch screen console, connect the free end of the console cable to J2 on the touch screen interface board at the rear of the console. Ensure that the screw locks are fully tightened to secure the connectors. Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-04 Rev. AM Page 2-9 2 Installation 2.9.1 CPI Canada Inc. Control Console (Cont) 4. FOR THE TOUCH SCREEN CONSOLE ONLY: a) Connect one end of the supplied ground wire to the touch screen console ground screw, shown in figure 2-3. Connect the other end of the ground wire to one of the ground studs on the generator chassis, under the room interface board. b) Connect the supplied line cord from the rear of the touch screen to the generator as follows: • Green (ground) to one of the ground studs on the generator chassis, under the room interface board. • White (neutral) to any terminal on TB7 on the room interface board. • Black (line) to any terminal on TB9 on the room interface board. c) JW1 on the generator interface board should be set such that the 110 / 220 VAC supply on the room interface board is on at all times that the generator main disconnect is switched on. The procedure for setting this jumper is described in chapter 3B. THE POWER CABLE FOR THE TOUCH SCREEN CONSOLE MUST BE CONNECTED TO THE GENERATOR AS DESCRIBED ABOVE, AND NOT CONNECTED TO AN INDEPENDENT SOURCE OF AC. THE CONSOLE REQUIRES THE LINE ISOLATION PROVIDED BY THE ROOM INTERFACE TRANSFORMER IN THE GENERATOR IN ORDER TO MEET IEC REGULATIONS. 5. Figure 2-3 shows the designations and functions of the connectors on the rear panel of the control console. DO NOT CONNECT UNAPPROVED EQUIPMENT TO THE REAR OF THE CONSOLE. For the 23 X 56 (cm) console, J5 is used for the interconnect cable to the generator main cabinet, J4 is not used, J2 is a serial port for use by an external computer, and J1 is for connection of an optional printer. For the 31 X 42 (cm) console, J5 is used for the interconnect cable to the generator main cabinet, J2 is a serial port for use by an external computer, and J13 is for connection of an external hand switch and / or foot switch. For the Rad-only console, J3 is for connection of an external hand switch, J4 is a serial port for use by an external computer, and J8 is for the interconnect cable to the main cabinet. For the touch screen console, J2 on the touch screen interface board is for the interconnect cable to the generator main cabinet, J3 is for connection of an external hand switch, J5 connects to the membrane switch assembly with the on / off and prep / expose switches, and J4 is a serial port for use by an external computer. INCORRECT CONNECTIONS OR USE OF UNAPPROVED EQUIPMENT MAY RESULT IN INJURY OR EQUIPMENT DAMAGE. Page 2-10 Rev. AM Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-04 CPI Canada Inc. 2.9.1 Installation 2 Control Console (Cont) Figure 2-3: Rear of control console Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-04 Rev. AM Page 2-11 2 Installation 2.9.2 CPI Canada Inc. Remote Fluoro Control (Optional) 1. Connect the free end of the 9 conductor remote fluoro cable (from the optional remote fluoro control box) to J11 of the generator CPU board. Ensure that the screw locks are fully tightened to secure the connector. Refer to figure 2-4 for the location of J11 on the generator CPU board. The cable should be routed into the generator via the access cover in the upper part of the cabinet closest to J11 on the generator CPU board. Figure 2-4: Remote fluoro connector on generator CPU board 2.9.3 Hand Switch Installation FOR 23 X 56 (CM) CONSOLES: The optional hand switch is supplied as a kit that must be user installed. If this option is used, refer to separate installation instructions packaged along with the hand switch. For reference, a drawing is supplied in this section showing the hand switch connections to the console CPU board. See figure 2-5. Figure 2-5: Hand switch connections on console CPU board Page 2-12 Rev. AM Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-04 CPI Canada Inc. 2.9.3 Installation 2 Hand Switch Installation (Cont) FOR 31 X 42 (CM) CONSOLES, RAD-ONLY CONSOLES, AND TOUCH SCREEN CONSOLES: The optional hand switch, if ordered from CPI Canada Inc, is supplied pre-wired to a male 9 pin subminiature ‘D’ connector. This connects to J13 on the rear of the 31 X 42 cm console, to J3 on the rear of the Rad-only console, or to J3 on the touch screen interface board on the rear of the touch screen console. Fluoro foot switch connections may also be made to this connector (31 X 42 cm console with fluoro option only). For the touch screen console, the fluoro foot switch connections must be made to the room interface board as per chapter 3B. The table below shows the pin designations for the hand switch connector on the console. A male 9 pin subminiature ‘D’ connector will need to be provided by the installer if the CPI supplied hand switch is not used. PIN NUMBER 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 J13 PIN CONNECTIONS 31 X 42 CM CONSOLE Hand Switch: X-Ray No Connection Hand Switch: Prep No Connection Hand Switch: Common (ground) No Connection Foot Switch: ‘live’ terminal No Connection Foot Switch: ‘ground’ terminal Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-04 J3 PIN CONNECTIONS RAD-ONLY CONSOLE AND TOUCH SCREEN CONSOLE Hand Switch: X-Ray No Connection Hand Switch: Prep No Connection Hand Switch: Common (ground) NOT USED NOT USED NOT USED NOT USED Rev. AM Page 2-13 2 Installation 2.9.4 CPI Canada Inc. X-Ray Tube Stator & Thermal Switch Connections Refer to figure 2-6 for the X-ray tube stator and thermal switch connections. 1. Route the X-ray tube stator cable(s) through the lower wiring access panel panel on the rear of the generator cabinet, then route the cables towards the stator terminal blocks as shown in the figure below. FOR UNITS WITH A LOW SPEED STARTER, SHIELDED STATOR CABLES ARE RECOMMENDED. FOR UNITS WITH A DUAL SPEED STARTER, SHIELDED STATOR CABLES MUST BE USED. THE SHIELD FOR THE STATOR CABLE(S) MUST BE PROPERLY GROUNDED AT THE CHASSIS GROUND STUD(S) SHOWN IN FIGURE 2-6. 2. Connect the wires to the appropriate terminal as shown. The tube thermal switch will normally be connected to the THERMAL SWITCH connections on the stator terminal block, but may optionally be connected to the room interface board (refer to chapter 3B). 3. Ensure that all terminal connections are tight, then dress and secure the cables. NOTE: ONE TUBE ONLY GENERATORS WILL HAVE 1 STATOR TERMINAL BLOCK FITTED. THE LOWER TERMINAL BLOCK IN FIGURE 2-6 IS ONLY FITTED ON TWO TUBE GENERATORS. Figure 2-6: Stator connections to generator Page 2-14 Rev. AM Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-04 CPI Canada Inc. 2.9.5 Installation 2 Generator Mains Connection WARNING: TO AVOID ELECTRICAL SHOCK, ENSURE THAT THE AC MAINS DISCONNECT IS LOCKED IN THE OFF POSITION, AND THAT ALL MAINS CABLES ARE DE-ENERGIZED BEFORE CONNECTING TO THE GENERATOR. Refer to chapter 1C for generator power and generator power line requirements. 1. Pass the AC mains cable through the access hole located at the lower rear of the generator. 2. Use an appropriate cable clamp to secure the mains cable at the cabinet entrance. 3. Temporarily remove the safety cover from the main fuses. Strip sufficient cable jacket to allow the ground wire to reach the main ground connector located at the left side of the main fuse block. Refer to figure 2-7. 4. Connect the ground wire to the chassis ground connector, and connect the mains wires to the terminals on the bottom of the main fuse holder (3 wires for 3 phase systems, 2 wires for single phase systems). Be sure to replace the main fuse safety cover after all connections are made and properly tightened. 5. DO NOT SWITCH ON MAINS POWER AT THIS TIME. Figure 2-7: Generator mains connections Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-04 Rev. AM Page 2-15 2 Installation 2.9.6 CPI Canada Inc. Room Equipment Refer to chapter 3B, 3D, 3E, and 3F for connection of the room equipment (Buckys, miscellaneous inputs and outputs, AEC, ABS, DAP, etc.). It is suggested that these items not be connected until after the initial run-up of the generator is complete, and the tube auto calibration has been performed as described near the end of this chapter. 2.9.7 Emergency Power Off / Power Distribution Relay To connect an external emergency power-off switch, disconnect the jumper from J17-1 to J17-2 on the generator interface board. Then connect the emergency-off switch to J17-1 and J17-2. Refer to MD-0762 in chapter 9. For installations where installer-supplied auxiliary power distribution circuits are added to the generator, 24 VDC is available on the generator interface board to drive the coil of the power distribution relay. Connect the coil to J17-3 (+) and J17-4 (ground). Refer to MD-0788 in chapter 9. The maximum current available from this source is 100 mA. 2.10.0 X-RAY TUBE HOUSING GROUND A separate ground wire (10 AWG, 6mm2) must be connected from each X-ray tube housing to one of the ground studs on the HT tank. Refer to figure 2-8 or 2-9. These ground locations may have other ground wires already connected, ensure that these existing ground wires are not disconnected when making the X-ray tube ground connection. Failure to make this ground connection may result in intermittent operation and/or exposure errors. 2.11.0 HIGH TENSION CABLES The X-ray tube(s) should be mounted on their normal fixtures i.e. tube stand, G.I. table or other devices. 1. Verify that the HT cable terminations are clean, in good condition i.e. no cracks, and coated with vapor proof compound. 2. Remove the plastic caps that cover the high voltage terminals on the HT tank. These should be saved in case of a future requirement to transport the generator or HT tank. 3. Connect the high tension cables as per the installation requirements. Use the right angle connectors for the HT transformer end. Ensure that the cables for tube 1 (and tube 2 if used) are plugged into the proper connectors on the HT tank. Refer to figure 2-8 and 2-9. On two tube R&F generators, the fan may need to be removed in order to install the tube 2 HT connectors. To do this, disconnect the AC power leads from the fan. Next, remove and temporarily set aside the two socket - head screws and washers from the fan mounting bracket. Slide the fan assembly forward, and then remove the fan assembly to connect the HT cables. To re-install the fan assembly, slide the fan assembly into position under the inverter assembly, using the tabs on the mounting bracket to support the inside end of the bracket. Replace the screws and washers to secure the fan assembly. Lastly, reconnect the AC power leads to the fan. 4. Be sure that the HT cable connectors are tight and there is no play between the connector insulator and the screw down ring. Page 2-16 Rev. AM Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-04 CPI Canada Inc. Installation 2 2.11.0 HIGH TENSION CABLES (cont) Figure 2-8: HV connectors (1 tube tanks) Figure 2-9: HV connectors (2 tube tanks) NOTE: PLEASE OBSERVE THE FOLLOWING IF USING METAL CENTER SECTION X-RAY TUBES The mA feedback signals, as measured at the mA test points on the control board, represent anode mA. X-ray emission in the tube is a result of the anode current. The mA measured at terminals E17 - E18 of the HT tank is cathode current. In a metal center section tube, the anode current will be less than the cathode current, the difference being body current. In a metal center section tube, the cathode current may exceed the anode current by up to 15%. Although the anode and cathode currents may be unequal, the anode to cathode kV regulation is not affected. Due to the presence of body current, filament drive and emission may need to be greater than expected for a given mA station. The power “lost” to body current may need to be considered relative to the maximum generator output. When installing a metal center section tube, it is essential that the center section of the X-ray tube be securely grounded; otherwise premature tube failure may result. Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-04 Rev. AM Page 2-17 2 Installation CPI Canada Inc. 2.12.0 PROGRAMMING THE LOW SPEED STARTER This section applies only to units fitted with the low speed starter. PLEASE BE SURE TO READ AND UNDERSTAND THIS SECTION FULLY BEFORE PROCEEDING. Before continuing, note the part number of the low speed starter in the generator. Part number 732752-00 has a 33 µF phase-shift capacitor; part number 732752-01 has a 12.5 µF capacitor, and part number 732752-02 has a 45 µF capacitor. Confirm that the phase shift capacitor is compatible with the desired tube(s) as listed in table 1 in Supplement 746026, which follows chapter 2. The starter boost voltage is set to approximately 240 VAC, (except where specifically noted in table 1), and the starter run voltage is selectable to be 52, 73, or 94 VAC. Boost times are selectable to be either 1.5 seconds, or 2.5 seconds. Therefore, the generator may be configured to be compatible with stator types as per table 1 only. If the desired tube type is not listed, please contact CPI product support for assistance. WARNING: 240 VAC IS PRESENT ON THE LOW SPEED STARTER BOARD AT ALL TIMES THAT THE GENERATOR IS SWITCHED ON. TAKE APPROPRIATE PRECAUTIONS WHEN SERVICING THIS BOARD 2.12.1 Low Speed Starter Tube Select Table See Supplement 746026, which immediately follows this chapter. 2.12.2 Low Speed Starter Boost Voltage Selection THIS APPLIES TO ONE-TUBE GENERATORS ONLY. Follow the steps below to verify and configure the correct low speed starter boost voltage. 1. Page 2-18 Confirm the required BOOST VOLTAGE for the selected tube type per table 1 in supplement 746026, which follows chapter 2. The requirement for the vast majority of tubes in table 1 is 240 V. For tubes that require 120 V boost, this is noted along with the run voltage, boost time, etc for that tube. • Refer to figure 2-10 (power supply auxiliary transformer). Locate this transformer under the power input board; refer to chapter 1E for details. • If there is only one connection on the 120V tap on the power supply auxiliary transformer, the boost voltage is set to 240 VAC. • If there are two connections on the 120V tap, the boost voltage is set to 120 VAC. • Confirm the correct boost voltage at F1 on the low speed starter board if a suitable voltmeter is available. • Go to 2.12.3 if the boost voltage is properly set for the selected tube type and therefore does NOT need to be changed. Rev. AM Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-04 CPI Canada Inc. Installation 2 2.12.2 Low Speed Starter Boost Voltage Selection (Cont) THIS APPLIES TO ONE-TUBE GENERATORS ONLY. 2. If the boost voltage tap on the power supply auxiliary transformer needs to be changed from 240V to 120V, proceed as follows: • Loosen the clamping screws for the 240V tap and for the 120V tap. • Move the boost voltage lead from the 240V tap to the 120V tap. The boost voltage lead is the lead that connects directly to J1 on the low speed starter board. Do not disturb the other leads on the 120V and / or 240V taps. • Ensure that the wires are positioned between the two metal clamps on the transformer terminal block. • Retighten both of the clamping screws. • Confirm the correct boost voltage at F1 on the low speed starter board if a suitable voltmeter is available. 3. If the boost voltage tap on the power supply auxiliary transformer needs to be changed from 120V to 240V, proceed as follows: • Loosen the clamping screws for the 120V tap and for the 240V tap. • Move the boost voltage lead from the 120V tap to the 240V tap. The boost voltage lead is the lead that connects directly to J1 on the low speed starter board. Do not disturb the other leads on the 120V and / or 240V taps • Ensure that the wires are positioned between the two metal clamps on the transformer terminal block. • Retighten both of the clamping screws. • Confirm the correct boost voltage at F1 on the low speed starter board if a suitable voltmeter is available. Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-04 Rev. AM Page 2-19 2 Installation CPI Canada Inc. 2.12.3 Low Speed Starter Run Voltage Selection Follow the steps below to verify and configure the correct low speed starter run-voltage. 1. Note the required RUN VOLTAGE for the selected tube type per table 1 in Supplement 746026 which follows chapter 2. Then confirm the low speed starter run-voltage in the generator. This is determined by the run-voltage setting on the power supply auxiliary transformer. Refer to figure 2-10. • Locate this transformer under the power input board; refer to chapter 1E for details. • Locate the run-voltage output on the transformer. This will be set to the 52V, 73V, or 94V tap, and must match the required run-voltage for the selected tube in table 1. • Go to 2.12.4 if the run-voltage setting is correct for the selected tube type, and therefore does NOT need to be changed. 2. If the run-voltage setting on the power supply auxiliary transformer needs to be changed, proceed as follows: • Loosen the clamping screws for the current run-voltage tap, and for the required run-voltage tap. • Move the run-voltage output lead from the current tap position to the required tap position (52V, 73V, or 94V). Ensure that the wire is positioned between the two metal clamps on the transformer terminal block. • Retighten both of the clamping screws. Figure 2-10: Low speed run-voltage tap selection Page 2-20 Rev. AM Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-04 CPI Canada Inc. Installation 2 2.12.4 Low Speed Starter Boost Time Selection Follow the steps below to verify and configure the low speed starter boost time. 1. Confirm the current low speed starter boost time selection: • Locate jumper JW1 on the auxiliary board. Refer to chapter 1E for the board location. • Confirm that the current boost time setting matches the tube in use: Jumper position “1.5S” = 1.5 second boost, no jumper at JW1 = 2.5 second boost. Do not use the “.15S” position. 2. If required, adjust the boost time by changing the JW1 jumper position as described above. NOTE: CONFIRM PROPER LOW SPEED STARTER CONFIGURATION USING A SUITABLE TACHOMETER BEFORE MAKING ANY EXPOSURES. 2.13.0 PROGRAMMING THE DUAL SPEED STARTER This section applies only to units fitted with the dual speed starter option. The dual speed starter must be programmed for the X-ray tube type(s) used at this site. This is done via DIP switches SW1 and SW2 on the dual speed starter. The following tube functions are set with these switches: • High speed start and run voltages • Low speed start and run voltages • Brake time and brake voltage (high speed) • Boost times • Boost time increments. Boost time may be increased in 100 ms steps in the range of 100 to 700 ms SW1 and SW2 on the dual speed starter must be set correctly to match the X-ray tube(s) in use. Failure to set these correctly may result in improper anode RPM and therefore may damage the X-ray tube. PLEASE BE SURE TO READ AND UNDERSTAND THIS SECTION FULLY BEFORE PROCEEDING. 2.13.1 Setting tube type 1. Select the desired tube type from table 2 in Supplement 746026 which follows Chapter 2. Record the tube type number (housing and insert) and the binary code as per the third column in the table. Please note that the tube compatibility applies only to the housing and inserts listed, i.e. for the specific manufacturer(s) shown. 2. If the desired tube type is not listed, please contact CPI product support for assistance. 3. The generator is factory configured to support one type of stator only (for example “R” type stator), therefore only stators of that type may be used with this generator. Refer to the customer product description form in chapter 1D of this manual for compatible X-ray tubes. REFER TO SECTION 2.13.2 IF IT IS DESIRED TO USE TUBES WITH STATOR TYPES NOT COMPATIBLE WITH THIS GENERATOR, OR IF YOU ARE NOT CERTAIN THAT THIS GENERATOR IS COMPATIBLE WITH THE STATOR IN YOUR TUBE. Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-04 Rev. AM Page 2-21 2 Installation CPI Canada Inc. 2.13.1 Setting tube type (cont) 4. Refer to figure 2-11. Set the DIP switch SW1 (for tube 1) with the binary code for the selected tube. The binary code shown in the table programs the tube type (housing and insert), for example housing type Varian Diamond with standard “R” stator and inserts per table 2 in Supplement 746026 which follows Chapter 2, requires SW1-1 to be set OFF, SW1-2 OFF, SW13 ON, SW1-4 OFF and SW1-5 OFF. This programs the voltages, brake times, and boost times in table 2. Additionally, SW1-6 to SW1-8 may be set to give incremental increases in boost time over the preselected values (for example to run an older tube with worn bearings). For example, binary 000 gives zero increase, binary 001 gives 100 ms increase, binary 100 gives 400 ms increase, and binary 111 gives a 700 ms increase in boost time. SW1-6 represents bit 1, SW1-7 bit 2, and SW1-8 represents bit 3. EXAMPLE: Binary 100 = decimal 4 = 400 ms incremental boost time increase: 1 Bit 3 SW1-8 0 Bit 2 SW1-7 0 Bit 1 SW1-6 5. The example DIP switch setting shown in figure 2-11 is for the example in step 4 with an incremental increase in boost time of 200 ms. 6. If this is a two-tube installation, repeat steps 1 to 4 using DIP switch SW2 for the second tube. 7. Please confirm all settings using a suitable tachometer to ensure proper anode RPM before making any exposures. NOTE: FOR TUBES WHERE “LOW SPEED OPERATION ONLY” IS INDICATED, THE DUAL SPEED STARTER MUST BE PROGRAMMED FOR LOW SPEED ONLY, AND WHERE “HIGH SPEED OPERATION ONLY” IS INDICATED, THE DUAL SPEED STARTER MUST BE PROGRAMMED FOR HIGH SPEED OPERATION ONLY. REFER TO THE TUBE SELECTION SECTION IN CHAPTER 3C FOR THE PROCEDURE TO DO THIS. NOTE THAT THE EXAMPLE DIP SWITCH SHOWN IN FIGURE 2-11 IS REPRESENTATIVE OF ONE STYLE OF SWITCH ONLY. DEPENDING ON MANUFACTURER, YOUR DIP SWITCH STYLE MAY VARY. PLEASE NOTE THE ON/OFF POSITIONS CAREFULLY FOR YOUR UNIT. Page 2-22 Rev. AM Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-04 CPI Canada Inc. Installation 2 2.13.1 Setting tube type (cont) Figure 2-11: DIP switches on dual speed starter. 2.13.2 Confirming/Changing DSS Starter Type The low speed and high speed phase shift capacitors for the stator start winding must be matched to the desired stator type, for example the required high speed phase shift capacitor is 6 uF for “R” type stators and 7.5 uF for GE Maxiray type stators. Therefore, for example, a dual speed starter configured for an “R” type stator CANNOT drive a GE Maxiray type stator. Use the steps in this section to verify that the dual speed starter is compatible with the stator in the desired tube. 1. Record the part number of the dual speed starter assembly in the subject generator. This is printed on a label near the top of the dual speed starter chassis. Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-04 Rev. AM Page 2-23 2 Installation CPI Canada Inc. 2.13.2 Confirming/Changing DSS Starter Type (Cont) 2. Locate that part number in table 2 in Supplement 746026 which follows Chapter 2, then note the value of the H.S. SHIFT CAPAC and the L.S. SHIFT CAPAC per the table. Those are the values of the phase shift capacitors in the dual speed starter. Only tubes requiring those capacitor values may be connected to the dual speed starter. 3. If it is desired to use a different tube from that shown in the compatible X-ray tubes section of the customer product description form, confirm that the desired tube (housing and insert) is listed in table 2 AND that the required dual speed starter part number for that tube per table 2 is the same as is fitted in your generator. 4. If the preceding steps confirm that the desired tube is fully compatible with the generator, you may proceed with setting the tube type as per section 2.13.1. 5. If in the preceding steps it is determined that the desired stator IS NOT compatible with the generator, the phase shift capacitors in the dual speed starter will need to be changed to match the requirements of the desired tube. Replacement capacitor kits are available to do this as noted in the next step. 6. Note the required H.S. SHIFT CAPAC and L.S. SHIFT CAPAC values, and the corresponding dual speed starter part number for the desired tube per table 2. Using those capacitor values, refer to table 2-1. From this table select the required conversion kit to convert to capacitors as required for the selected tube. The conversion kits are available through the factory/customer support. IF MAKING THE ABOVE CONVERSION, PLEASE BE SURE TO CHANGE THE PART NUMBER IDENTIFIED IN STEP 1 TO THE NEW CONFIGURATION USING AN INDELIBLE MARKER. THIS WILL ENSURE THAT CONFIGURATION CONTROL OF THE PRODUCT IS MAINTAINED HIGH SPD SHIFT CAPAC 6 uF 7.5 uF 20 uF 5 uF 5 uF 3.4 uF 6 uF 5 uF / 6 uF 12.5 uF NOTE: Page 2-24 TABLE 2-1 LOW SPD SHIFT CAPAC 31uF 47 uF 60 uF 30 uF 45 uF N/A 46 uF 30 / 31 uF 37.5 uF CONVERSION KIT P/N 734424-00 734424-01 734424-02 734424-03 734424-04 734424-05 734424-07 734424-08 734424-09 CAPACITOR VALUES SHOWN IN TABLES 1 AND 2 (IN SUPPLEMENT 746026) ARE EQUIVALENT VALUES OF THE PHASE SHIFT CAPACITORS IN THE DUAL SPEED STARTER. FOR EXAMPLE, THE STANDARD “R” VERSION OF THE DUAL SPEED STARTER USES TWO 12.5 uF CAPACITORS CONNECTED IN SERIES TO GIVE NOMINAL 6 uF FOR HIGH SPEED USE. THIS 6 uF CAPACITANCE IS CONNECTED IN PARALLEL WITH A 25 uF CAPACITOR TO GIVE 31 uF FOR LOW SPEED USE AS SHOWN IN THE TABLES. Rev. AM Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-04 CPI Canada Inc. Installation 2 2.13.3 Dual Speed Starter Tube Select Table See Supplement 746026, which immediately follows this chapter. 2.13.4 Configuring dual speed starter 733317-08 / 735925-08 Dual speed starter part number 733317-08 / 735925-08 is a special configuration in which the phase shift capacitors may be set to 5 and 30 uF, or to 6 and 31 uF. This is intended for use in installations where it may be necessary to interface to either IAE tubes, or to “R” stator tubes. Refer to figure 2-12. In configuration “A”, (5 / 30 uF) each of the leads on the upper left capacitor is connected to one side of the capacitor. Thus the capacitor is in-circuit in this configuration. Configuration “B” (6 / 31 uF) has both leads connected to terminals on the same side of the capacitor, thus the capacitor is out of the circuit. • To change from configuration “A” to “B”, disconnect the right hand lead from the upper left capacitor in figure 2-12, and connect it to one of the spare terminals on the terminal cluster that has the other capacitor lead connected to it. This removes that capacitor from the circuit. • To change from configuration “B” to “A” in figure 2-12, disconnect one of the leads from the terminal cluster on the left side of the capacitor shown in the figure, and connect it to one of the terminals on the other side of the capacitor. This connects the capacitor into the circuit. After the phase shift capacitors are correctly configured, set the DIP switches as follows: • Locate the desired IAE or “R” type tube in table 2 in Supplement 746026 which follows Chapter 2. With dual speed starter 733317-08 / 735925-08 set to configuration “B”, it is only compatible with “R” stator tubes using dual speed starter 733317-01 / 735925-01. When set to configuration “A”, it is only compatible with IAE tubes using dual speed starter 733317-05 / 735925-05. • Note the DIP switch setting for the desired tube as per table 2. • Set the DIP switches as per 2.13.1. Figure 2-12: Selection of phase shift capacitance Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-04 Rev. AM Page 2-25 2 Installation CPI Canada Inc. 2.14.0 GENERATOR LOCKOUT SWITCH A safety lockout switch (S3) is provided on the generator interface board. When this switch is in the LOCKOUT position, the generator cannot be switched on either from the console or from the adjacent service switch S2 on the generator interface board. This prevents inadvertent switching on of the generator while it is being serviced. S3, the generator lockout switch, must be in the NORMAL position to enable switching the generator on. Refer to figure 2-13 for these switch locations. Figure 2-13: Location of lockout switch and local ON/OFF switches Page 2-26 Rev. AM Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-04 CPI Canada Inc. Installation 2 2.15.0 SAFETY INTERLOCKS It is strongly recommended that the following two interlocks be wired to the generator before preparing to make any exposures: DOOR INTERLOCK The room door interlock switch must be wired to TB4-4 and TB4-5 on the room Interface board. This switch will provide a closed contact when the door is closed. X-RAY TUBE THERMAL SWITCH The X-ray tube(s) thermal switch(s) should be connected to the generator for tube thermal protection. These may be connected either at the stator terminal blocks (section 2.9.4), or at the room interface board. The connections on the room interface board are TB4-8 and TB4-9 for tube 1, and TB4-6 and TB4-7 for tube 2. 2.16.0 CHECKING THE RAM BACKUP BATTERY VOLTAGE It is recommended that the backup battery voltage be checked before continuing. The normal life expectancy of these batteries is estimated at 5 years. CONSOLE CPU BOARD (23 X 56 cm consoles): 1. Turn the operator console upside down carefully to protect the front panel. Remove the 6 screws securing the base to the molded case. 2. Open the Console carefully such that the interconnecting cables are not strained. 3. Locate the battery on the console CPU board, refer to figure 2-15. Measure the battery voltage with a DVM. The top of the battery is the positive side; ground (TP2 on the board) is the negative side. 4. The nominal battery voltage should be approximately 3.0V, replace the battery if it is under 2.80V. 5. Before closing the console, refer to section 2.17.0, console CPU board DIP switch settings. 6. Re-assemble the console. DO NOT OVER TIGHTEN THE SCREWS SECURING THE BASE TO THE MOLDED CONSOLE TOP. CONSOLE BOARD (31 X 42 cm consoles): The RAM backup battery and EPROM are accessible by removing an access cover on the bottom of the console. To remove the access cover, remove the screw holding the cover, and then remove the access cover. This cover is reinstalled by sliding the end opposite the screw hole into the slot formed in the console bottom, then by replacing and tightening the fastening screw. Refer to figure 2-14. 1. Locate the battery on the console board, refer to figure 2-15. Measure the battery voltage with a DVM. The easiest way to do is to measure the voltage across C23, the capacitor directly below the battery. This capacitor is in parallel with the battery. 2. The nominal battery voltage should be approximately 3.0V, replace the battery if it is under 2.80V. 3. Before closing the console, refer to section 2.17.0, console CPU board DIP switch settings. Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-04 Rev. AM Page 2-27 2 Installation CPI Canada Inc. 2.16.0 CHECKING THE RAM BACKUP BATTERY VOLTAGE (Cont) Figure 2-14: Access panel on bottom of console Follow the procedure below if you need to open the entire console. This allows access to components or assemblies not accessible by removing the battery and EPROM access cover. The console bottom normally needs to be removed to replace major assemblies only, i.e. the console board or display assembly. 1. Disconnect all connections, including the console ground connection, from the rear of the operator console. 2. Turn the console upside down carefully to protect the front panel. Remove and temporarily set aside the jackscrews from the ‘D’ connectors on the rear of the console. Remove and temporarily set aside the hardware from the console ground stud. 3. Remove the 8 screws securing the base to the molded case. 4. Gently remove the console bottom (the metal bottom panel with the feet attached). 5. Re-assemble the console in the reverse order of the above. Use of a removable thread locker (loctite or equivalent) is recommended when reinstalling the jackscrews to prevent them from loosening if the mating connectors are removed. Reconnect the console ground and all cables removed in step 1. Page 2-28 Rev. AM Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-04 CPI Canada Inc. Installation 2 2.16.0 CHECKING THE RAM BACKUP BATTERY VOLTAGE (Cont) CONSOLE BOARD (Rad-only consoles): 1. Disconnect all connections, including the console ground connection, from the rear of the operator console. 2. Turn the console upside down carefully to protect the front panel. Remove and temporarily set aside the jackscrews from the ‘D’ connectors on the rear of the console. Remove and temporarily set aside the hardware from the console ground stud. 3. Remove the 6 screws securing the base to the molded case. 4. Gently remove the console bottom (the metal bottom panel with the feet attached). 5. Locate the battery on the console board, refer to figure 2-15. Measure the battery voltage with a DVM. The easiest way to do is to measure the voltage across C7, the capacitor directly to the left of the battery. This capacitor is in parallel with the battery. 6. The nominal battery voltage should be approximately 3.0V, replace the battery if it is under 2.80V. 7. Re-assemble the console in the reverse order of the above. Use of a removable thread locker (loctite or equivalent) is recommended when reinstalling the jackscrews to prevent them from loosening if the mating connectors are removed. Reconnect the console ground and all cables removed in step 1. GENERATOR CPU BOARD: 1. Locate the battery on the generator CPU board, refer to figure 2-15. Measure the battery voltage with a DVM. The top of the battery is the positive side, ground (TP21 on the board) is the negative side. 2. The nominal battery voltage should be approximately 3.0V, replace the battery if it is under 2.80V. Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-04 Rev. AM Page 2-29 2 Installation CPI Canada Inc. 2.16.0 CHECKING THE RAM BACKUP BATTERY VOLTAGE (cont) Figure 2-15: Location of batteries on generator and console CPU boards Page 2-30 Rev. AM Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-04 CPI Canada Inc. Installation 2 2.17.0 DIP SWITCH SETTINGS Before continuing, verify the DIP switch settings on the console CPU board and generator CPU board. These switches have been factory set but may have been readjusted, particularly if this generator is a reinstall. CONSOLE CPU BOARD (23 X 56 cm console) AND CONSOLE BOARD (31 X 42 cm console): For the 31 X 42 cm console, DIP switch SW1 is only active if running the console software from EPROM. Refer to the section Console software / EPROM in chapter 6 for details. If the console software is running from flash memory, SW1 is inactive and the selections described below are accessed in console utilities screen 2 as described in chapter 3C. The selections described below are accessed in console utilities screen 2 on all versions of the Rad-only console. • Verify the settings on SW1 (If applicable, as described above). Refer to console utilities screen 2 in chapter 3C for a description of these functions. LANGUAGE English German French Italian Swedish Spanish SW1-5 SW1-6 SW1-7 SW1-8 SW1 -4 OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF SW1-3 OFF OFF OFF OFF ON ON SW1-2 OFF OFF ON ON OFF OFF SW1-1 OFF ON OFF ON OFF ON NOT USED NOT USED OFF > LOGO NOT DISPLAYED ON > LOGO DISPLAYED OFF > CONSOLE DEFAULTS OFF * ON > LOAD CONSOLE DEFAULTS * GENERATOR CPU BOARD: • Verify the settings on SW1. Refer to the table below for the proper settings for this switch. GENERATOR POWER 32 kW 40 kW 50 kW 65 kW 80 kW 100 kW SW1-4 SW1-5 SW1-6 SW1-7 SW1-8 MAXIMUM mA 400 mA 500 mA 630 mA 800 mA 1000 mA 1000 mA SW1 -3 ON ON OFF OFF OFF OFF SW1-2 ON OFF ON ON OFF OFF SW1-1 OFF ON ON OFF ON OFF OFF > 2 FILAMENT BOARDS OFF > 150 kV MAXIMUM OFF > DUAL SPEED STARTER OFF > 2 TUBE GENERATOR ON > I FILAMENT BOARD ON > 125 kV MAXIMUM ON > LOW SPEED STARTER ON > 1 TUBE GENERATOR OFF > SET FACTORY DEFAULTS * ON > DEFAULTS DISABLED * * Refer to Resetting Factory Defaults in chapter 6 for details regarding this function. Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-04 Rev. AM Page 2-31 2 Installation CPI Canada Inc. 2.18.0 INITIAL RUN-UP This section describes the procedure for initial power-on of the generator after it has first been installed. PLEASE OBSERVE THE FOLLOWING POINTS REGARDING THE MAIN DISTRIBUTION TRANSFORMER: • IF USING A DISTRIBUTION TRANSFORMER WITH AN ISOLATED SECONDARY, THE SECONDARY WINDING MUST BE A WYE (STAR) CONFIGURATION WITH THE CENTER POINT GROUND REFERENCED. DO NOT USE A DELTA CONFIGURED SECONDARY AS THERE IS NO GROUND REFERENCE IN THIS CONFIGURATION. • IF USING AN AUTOTRANSFORMER TYPE DISTRIBUTION TRANSFORMER, THE A.C. INPUT TO THE TRANSFORMER MUST BE GROUND REFERENCED. 2.18.1 Initial Voltage Measurements 1. Verify that the mains voltage and current capacity is correct for the generator installation. Refer to the product ID label on the generator cabinet and chapter 1C of this manual. 2. Temporarily remove the safety cover over the main input fuses in the generator. 3. If the mains supply is compatible with the generator, switch on the main breaker and/or disconnect switch and check for the following voltages: NOTE: DO NOT SWITCH ON THE GENERATOR AT THIS TIME (ONLY THE AC MAINS TO THE GENERATOR IS TO BE SWITCHED ON AT THIS TIME). WARNING: 1. USE EXTREME CARE IN MEASURING THESE VOLTAGES. ACCIDENTAL CONTACT WITH MAINS VOLTAGES MAY CAUSE SERIOUS INJURY OR DEATH. 2. MAINS VOLTAGE WILL BE PRESENT INSIDE THE GENERATOR CABINET, EVEN WITH THE CONSOLE SWITCHED OFF. 3. THE BUS CAPACITORS, LOCATED ON THE POWER INPUT BOARD OR ON THE BUS CAPACITOR ASSEMBLY (SINGLE PHASE UNITS ONLY), PRESENT A SAFETY HAZARD FOR A MINIMUM OF 5 MINUTES AFTER THE POWER HAS BEEN REMOVED FROM THE UNIT. CHECK THAT THESE CAPACITORS ARE DISCHARGED BEFORE TOUCHING ANY PARTS. PLEASE NOTE THAT THE VOLTAGE MEASURED IN STEP 4 WILL NOT NECESSARILY BE THE SAME AS THE VOLTAGE AT THE MAIN DISCONNECT BOX IN THE ROOM. THE REASON FOR THIS IS THAT A LINE ADJUSTING TRANSFORMER MAY BE USED WITH THE GENERATOR WHICH STEPS THE INCOMING LINE VOLTAGE TO THE GENERATOR UP OR DOWN. GENERATORS WITH NO LINE ADJUSTING TRANSFORMER SHOULD HAVE THE SAME VOLTAGE IN STEP 4 AS IS SUPPLIED AT THE MAIN DISCONNECT BOX IN THE ROOM. UNITS WITH A LINE ADJUSTING TRANSFORMER SHOULD HAVE THE FOLLOWING VOLTAGES AT THE MAIN LINE FUSES IN THE POWER SUPPLY CABINET. VOLTAGE AT MAIN DISCONNECT BOX (LINE ADJUSTING TRANSFORMER INPUT) 480 VAC ± 10 % 400 VAC ± 10 % Page 2-32 Rev. AM VOLTAGE AT MAIN FUSES IN POWER SUPPLY (LINE ADJUSTING TRANSFORMER OUTPUT) 400 VAC ± 10 % 480 VAC ± 10 % Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-04 CPI Canada Inc. Installation 2 2.18.1 Initial Voltage Measurements (Cont) 4. 5. Measure and record the voltage across the main line fuses in the generator. Single phase units will only use one set of voltage measurements. L1 phase to L2 phase: ______ VAC. L1 phase to ground: ______ VAC. L1 phase to L3 phase: ______ VAC. L2 phase to ground: ______ VAC. L2 phase to L3 phase: ______ VAC. L3 phase to ground: ______ VAC. Are these voltages within specification for the unit as per chapter 1C for generators without a line adjusting transformer, or within specification per the table above for units with a line adjusting transformer? For 3 phase units, the phase to ground voltage should be 230 V ± 10 % for 400 V units, and 277 V ± 10 % for 480 V units. For single phase 230 V units, the line to ground voltage should be 115 V ± 10 %. ___ Check BEFORE CONTINUING, REFER TO SECTION 2.18.3 OR 2.18.4 FOR THE PROCEDURE FOR ADJUSTING LINE VOLTAGE TAPS ON THE ROOM INTERFACE TRANSFORMER AND THE POWER SUPPLY AUXILIARY TRANSFORMER. 6. Switch OFF the mains power to the generator. Verify that there is no voltage present across any of the mains input phases. Replace the safety cover on the main input fuse block, then switch ON the mains and generator. 7. Verify that the red LED (DS1) located near the center of the generator interface board is lit. _____ Check 8. Verify that the red LED (DC BUSS OK) located on the power input board is lit. _____ Check 2.18.2 Initial Power Up 1. Switch on the generator at the console and observe the startup sequence on the console APR display. • • • 2. MEMORY TEST.... will be displayed. HIGH FREQUENCY GENERATOR XX KW WILL BE DISPLAYED (XX will be the kW rating for that model). The next screen will show console software revision and power software revision. In the upper part of the generator cabinet, verify the following: • • Verify that DS1 on the room interface board is lit. On the generator CPU board verify that the following LEDs are lit (these indicate presence of the DC rails as indicated): DS38 DS41 DS43 DS45 DS46 Indico 100 Series Service Manual +5 V +15 V -15 V +12 V -12 V Ch # 740895-04 Rev. AM Page 2-33 2 Installation CPI Canada Inc. 2.18.2 Initial Power Up (Cont) 3. In the lower part of the generator cabinet, verify the following: • On the auxiliary board verify that the following LEDs are lit: CNTCTR CLSD S.S. OK +12V -12V +/- 35V 2.18.3 Single Phase Primary Tap Selection THIS SECTION APPLIES TO SINGLE PHASE GENERATORS ONLY. ENSURE THAT THE AC MAINS IS SWITCHED OFF AND LOCKED OUT, AND THAT ALL CAPACITORS ARE DISCHARGED BEFORE PROCEEDING. 1. Note the position of the 208 / 240V tap on the power supply auxiliary transformer (this is factory set to 240 VAC). Refer to figure 2-10, this shows the locations of the transformer taps. 2. Based on the line voltage measured in section 2.18.1, step 4, set the tap referenced in the previous step as follows. Refer to figure 2-16, this shows the line voltage taps schematically. • Use the 208V tap if the line voltage is 215 VAC or less. • Use the 240V tap if the line voltage is 216 VAC or higher. 3. Note the primary voltage tap setting on the room interface transformer (this is factory set to 240 VAC). Refer to figure 2-17 and 2-18. The primary windings are connected in parallel for 200 / 240 VAC operation as per figure 2-18. • Use the 200V taps if the line voltage is 215 VAC or less. • Use the 240V taps if the line voltage is 216 VAC or higher. Figure 2-16: Schematic, primary of power supply aux transformer Page 2-34 Rev. AM Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-04 CPI Canada Inc. Installation 2 2.18.3 Single Phase Primary Tap Selection (Cont) Figure 2-17: Room interface transformer primary taps Figure 2-18: Schematic, primary of room I/F transformer (200/240V) Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-04 Rev. AM Page 2-35 2 Installation CPI Canada Inc. 2.18.4 Three Phase Primary Tap Selection THIS SECTION APPLIES TO 400 VAC THREE PHASE GENERATORS ONLY. NO TAP CHANGE IS NEEDED ON 480 VAC UNITS. ENSURE THAT THE AC MAINS IS SWITCHED OFF AND LOCKED OUT, AND THAT ALL CAPACITORS ARE DISCHARGED BEFORE PROCEEDING. 1. Note the position of the 380 / 400V tap on the power supply auxiliary transformer (this is factory set to 400 VAC). Refer to figure 2-10, this shows the locations of the transformer taps. 2. Based on the line voltage measured in section 2.18.1, step 4, set the tap referenced in the previous step as follows. Refer to figure 2-16, this shows the line voltage taps schematically. • Use the 380V tap if the line voltage is 389 VAC or less. • Use the 400V tap if the line voltage is 390 VAC or higher. 3. Note the primary voltage tap setting on the room interface transformer (this is factory set to 400 VAC). Refer to figure 2-17 and 2-19. The primary windings are connected in series for 380 / 400 VAC operation as per figure 2-19. • Use the 380V setting (180V tap on top winding) if the line voltage is 389 VAC or less.. • Use the 400V setting (200V tap on top winding) if the line voltage is 390 VAC or higher. Figure 2-19: Schematic, primary of room I/F transformer (380/400V) Page 2-36 Rev. AM Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-04 CPI Canada Inc. Installation 2 2.19.0 PROGRAMMING AND CALIBRATION USING THE CONSOLE For the touch screen console, programming and calibration must be performed using GenWare®. Operator accessible system utilities are described in the touch screen operator’s manual. The balance of sections 2.19 and 2.20 do not apply to touch screen, except for the section DATA LINK which does apply to the touch screen console. 2.19.1 Entering Into Programming/Calibration Mode This section presents a brief overview of the generator setup menu only. For more detail, refer to chapter 3C. To enter into the programming and calibration mode for the generator follow the steps below. Refer to Figure 2-20 for references to APR buttons. This figure shows the APR button layout for the 23 X 56 (cm) console, the 31 X 42 (cm) console, and the Rad-only console respectively. Figure 2-20: Programming/calibration mode reference Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-04 Rev. AM Page 2-37 2 Installation CPI Canada Inc. 2.19.1 Entering Into Programming/Calibration Mode (Cont) 1. Start with the generator switched OFF. 2. While pressing and holding the RESET button [5], press the generator POWER ON button on the console 3. The generator will go through the start-up sequence, then display the message ENTER PASSWORD. 4. Enter the factory default password by pressing the following button sequence: [1] - [2] - [3] - [4]. 5. The APR menu will now display the following: * GENERATOR SETUP * APR EDITOR: DISABLED GEN CONFIGURATION DATA LINK UTILITY EXIT SETUP 2.19.2 Menu Selections UTILITY Allows access to the following functions: SET TIME & DATE: Allows setting of: YEAR, MONTH, DAY, HOUR, and MINUTE ERROR LOG: Allows review of the generators error log for recorded errors. STATISTICS: Allows review of the tube exposure counter(s), the fluoro exposure counter if applicable, and the generator accumulated exposure counter. Also allows resetting of the tube exposure counter(s), and the fluoro exposure counter if used. CONSOLE: Allows setting the following parameters for the installation: key speed (scroll rate for the displays), speaker volume, LCD screen mode, and APR mode. APR EDITOR This enables or disables technique factor changes. When APR EDITOR is set to ENABLED, the technique factors may be changed. The new values may then be saved to overwrite the existing values. Refer to chapter 3C for further information. Page 2-38 Rev. AM Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-04 CPI Canada Inc. Installation 2 2.19.2 Menu Selections (Cont) GEN CONFIGURATION Allows the service engineer to access the following functions. Further details are in chapter 3C. • TUBE SELECTION Selects from the available group of X-ray tubes. • GENERATOR LIMITS Sets the operating limits of the generator. • RECEPTOR SETUP Allows programming of each image receptor. • I/O CONFIGURATION Allows setting the inputs and outputs of all image receptors. • AEC SETUP Defines properties for each channel of the AEC device. • AEC CALIBRATION Allows calibration of the AEC device. • FLUORO SETUP (all except Rad-only console). Allows setting of the fluoro properties. • TUBE CALIBRATION Enables the X-ray tube auto calibration feature. • DAP SETUP Allows setup and calibration of the optional DAP. DATA LINK Used with the CPI GenWare® utility software. This allows for data communication with a computer in order to download additional tube types, transfer APR data, edit APR text, run the A2EC2 ™ utility, perform setup and calibration functions, and for other minor functions. Further documentation is included with GenWare®. A computer (i.e. laptop) and a 9 pin null modem cable with socket connectors (female) on both ends are required to run this software and interface to the generator. NOTE: The GenWare® program should be closed before exiting the DATA LINK function on the console. Failure to do so may require that the console be switched off and then on again in order to reinitialize communication with the generator. Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-04 Rev. AM Page 2-39 2 Installation CPI Canada Inc. 2.20.0 TUBE AUTO CALIBRATION It is recommended that the generator be tested at this point with only the rotor and high tension cables connected. The generator should be able to complete an X-ray tube calibration and seasoning cycle without other equipment connected to the generator (other than the basic interlocks as noted below). This will allow for easier fault isolation as each section of the system is connected and tested. Before being able to make X-ray exposures, the room door interlock must be closed and the thermal switch must be closed. Prior to beginning tube auto calibration, the tube(s) used in this installation must be properly selected, and the generator limits should be programmed. Refer to chapter 3C. It is recommended that the tube(s) be conditioned (seasoned) before beginning tube auto calibration; refer to chapter 6. WARNING: THE FOLLOWING PROCEDURES PRODUCE X-RAYS. TAKE ALL SAFETY PRECAUTIONS TO PROTECT PERSONNEL FROM X-RADIATION. CAUTION: ALWAYS VERIFY THE MANUFACTURER OF THE TUBE INSERT. IF THE X-RAY TUBE HAS BEEN REBUILT, THE TUBE INSERT AND TUBE HOUSING MAY BE FROM DIFFERENT MANUFACTURERS. Step 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. NOTE: Page 2-40 Action From the GENERATOR SETUP menu (section 2.19.1) select GEN CONFIGURATION. Select TUBE CALIBRATION. Select the desired tube (tube 1 or tube 2) by pressing the TUBE button. Press FOCAL SPOT to toggle between SMALL and LARGE. Start with SMALL. Press and hold the X-RAY button (or use the optional hand switch) to begin the calibration procedure. Press RETURN to repeat calibration on the other focal spot or on the other tube. When auto-calibration is completed, press EXIT to exit the tube auto calibration menu. Press EXIT to return to the GENERATOR SETUP menu. Press EXIT SETUP to exit out of the setup and calibration mode and return to the normal operation mode. Result The TUBE CALIBRATION menu will display. The TUBE AUTO-CAL menu appears. The selected tube will appear. Selection of the second tube is only available on two tube generators. The selected focal spot displays. The menu will indicate the mA and filament current while the generator takes a series of exposures. The GEN CONFIGURATION menu will display. The GENERATOR SETUP menu will display. REFER TO THE NOTE ON THE NEXT PAGE REGARDING A SPECIAL DIAGNOSTIC MODE THAT IS ENTERED WHEN EXITING OUT OF THE AUTO-CALIBRATION MODE. SHOULD AN ERROR OCCUR DURING AUTO CALIBRATION, AN ERROR MESSAGE WILL BE DISPLAYED. THE GENERATOR WILL THEN LIMIT THE TUBES OPERATION TO THE RANGE IN WHICH IT WAS CALIBRATED, THUS ALLOWING FOR PARTIAL OPERATION OF THE GENERATOR. Rev. AM Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-04 CPI Canada Inc. Installation 2 2.20.0 TUBE AUTO CALIBRATION (Cont) NOTE: A SPECIAL DIAGNOSTIC MODE IS INVOKED WHEN YOU EXIT THE AUTO-CALIBRATION ROUTINE. THIS MODE REMAINS IN EFFECT UNTIL THE GENERATOR IS SWITCHED OFF. THIS ALLOWS LIMITED FUNCTIONALITY OF THE GENERATOR IN CASE THE AUTO CALIBRATION COULD NOT BE COMPLETED DUE TO A FAULT. WHILE IN THIS MODE, THE GENERATOR WILL DEFAULT THE FILAMENT CURRENT TO 2.0 AMPS FOR ALL UNCALIBRATED MA STATIONS. ADDITIONALLY, THE MA TOLERANCE CHECK WILL BE DISABLED. THIS ALLOWS ONE TO EXIT TO THE NORMAL OPERATING MODE WHERE THE PREP STATE MAY BE ENTERED. THE FILAMENT AND ROTOR CIRCUITS CAN BE OBSERVED, AND AN EXPOSURE MAY BE TAKEN AT THIS TIME. THE EXPOSURE WILL OBVIOUSLY BE INCORRECT AS THE FILAMENT CURRENT IS SET TO 2 AMPS, BUT THIS ALLOWS KV MEASUREMENTS TO BE PERFORMED ALONG WITH OTHER SYSTEM CHECKS TO AID IN TROUBLESHOOTING. 2.21.0 FINAL CHECKS The room interface connections may now be completed. These items are described in 2.9.6. NOTE: • When finished all wiring, check that all connections are tight and secure. • • Check that all cables are dressed neatly inside the main cabinet, and secured as necessary. Reconnect any grounds that have been removed from covers. Then reinstall all covers before placing the generator into service. THE INSTALLER SHOULD ENSURE THAT ALL CABLE CONNECTIONS TO THE GENERATOR ARE SECURE, AND ALL CABLES EXTERNAL TO THE GENERATOR ARE ADEQUATELY PROTECTED AGAINST ACCIDENTAL DISCONNECTION. Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-04 Rev. AM Page 2-41 2 Installation CPI Canada Inc. (This page intentionally left blank) Page 2-42 Rev. AM Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-04 CPI Canada Inc X-Ray Tube Stator Compatibility Tables SUPPLEMENT X-RAY TUBE STATOR COMPATIBILITY TABLES CONTENTS: 1.0 INTRODUCTION.................................................................................................................................................. 2 2.0 LOW SPEED STARTER TUBE SELECT TABLE................................................................................................ 3 3.0 DUAL SPEED STARTER TUBE SELECT TABLE .............................................................................................. 6 X-Ray Generator Service Manual Supplement 746026-00 Rev. D Page 1 X-Ray Tube Stator Compatibility Tables 1.0 CPI Canada Inc INTRODUCTION This supplement contains the X-Ray Tube Stator Compatibility Tables for the Low Speed Starter and the Dual Speed Starter. The Dual Speed Starter table does not apply to the Indico 100L model. Page 2 Rev. D X-Ray Generator Service Manual Supplement 746026-00 CPI Canada Inc 2.0 X-Ray Tube Stator Compatibility Tables LOW SPEED STARTER TUBE SELECT TABLE TUBE TYPE (HOUSING) CGR Statorix 200A/240/260 550 (50/110 Ω 24 slot) Chirana Rotax KA 125 20/50 Ω stator Chirana Rotax KA 125 20/20/20 Ω stator Comet DO7 25/50 Ω stator Comet DO9 25/50 Ω stator Comet DO9 25/50 Ω stator Comet DO10 25/50 Ω stator Comet DX10 25/50 Ω stator Comet XSTAR8 XSTAR74 25/50 Ω stator Dunlee PX1300 3” anode “S” stator (15/30 Ω) Dunlee PX1400 4” anode “S” stator (15/30 Ω) GE Maxiray 75 3” anode 23/23 Ω equal impedance “E” stator TABLE 1: TUBE TYPES (LOW SPEED STARTER) TUBE TYPE RUN BOOST SHIFT (INSERT) VOLTAGE TIME CAPAC 94 VAC 2.5 Sec 12.5 µF LOW SPD STARTER PART NO. 732752-01 73 VAC 1.5 Sec 33 µF 732752-00 RIK-T 30/50 1.2/2.0 52 VAC 1.5 Sec 732752-04 DX7 52 VAC 1.5 Sec 100 µF 52 mH Inductor 33 µF 732752-00 DX9 0.6/2.0 DX9 1.2/2.0 DX91HS DX92HS DX93HS DX10HS 0.6/1.0 DX10HS 1.0/2.0 DX101HS DX104HS DX105HS XST-8 XST-74 52 VAC 1.5 Sec 33 µF 732752-00 52 VAC 1.5 Sec 33 µF 732752-00 52 VAC 1.5 Sec 33 µF 732752-00 52 VAC 1.5 Sec 33 µF 732752-00 52 VAC 1.5 Sec 33 µF 732752-00 PX1302 PX1312 52 VAC 2.5 Sec 33 µF 732752-00 PX1429 PX1431 PX1436 PX1482 PX1483 0.6/1.0 11° 0.6/1.5 15° 1.0/2.0 15° 52 VAC 2.5 Sec 33 µF 732752-00 73 VAC 1.5 Sec 45 µF 732752-02 MN640 M641 MN641 M643 MS740 MSN742 RN620 RN640 RSN722 RSN742 RIK-T 12/50 0.8/2.0 X-Ray Generator Service Manual Supplement 746026-00 Rev. D Page 3 X-Ray Tube Stator Compatibility Tables 2.0 LOW SPEED STARTER TUBE SELECT TABLE (Cont) TUBE TYPE (HOUSING) GE Maxiray 100 4” anode 23/23 Ω equal impedance “E” stator Gilardoni Rotagil S/AS IAE C52 Super C100 20/40 Ω stator IAE C52 C352 C52 Super 20/40 Ω stator IAE C52 C352 20/40 Ω stator Philips ROT350 ROT351 Siemens Opti-150 “S” stator (14/37 Ω) Toshiba Rotanode XH-106V-2 XS-RB stator Toshiba Rotanode XH-106V-2 XS-AL stator Toshiba Rotanode XH-121 XS-RB stator Toshiba Rotanode XH-126 Toshiba XH-157 Page 4 CPI Canada Inc TUBE TYPE (INSERT) 0.3/1.0 11° 0.6/1.0 11° 0.6/1.2 11° 0.6/1.5 11° 0.6/1.5 12° 0.6/1.25 12.5° 1.0/2.0 15° AR11-30 AR30-60 RTC 600HS RTC 700HS RTC1000HS RTM 101H/HS RTM 102H/HS RTM 90H/HS RTM 92H/HS 73 VAC 1.5 Sec 45 µF LOW SPD STARTER PART NO. 732752-02 52 VAC 1.5 Sec 33 µF 732752-00 52 VAC 1.5 Sec 33 µF 732752-00 52 VAC 1.5 Sec 33 µF 732752-00 RTM 78H/HS AP DX104 X40 X50/AH RO 17/50 SRO 22/50 SRO 33/100 30/52R 20/40 52 VAC 1.5 Sec 33 µF 732752-00 52 VAC 1.5 Sec 33 µF 732752-00 52 VAC 2.5 Sec 45 µF 732752-02 E7252X E7813X 52 VAC 1.5 Sec 33 µF 732752-00 E7239X E7242X E7252X E7813X E7132X E7239X E7240X E7299X E7242FX 52 VAC 1.5 Sec E7254X E7254FX E7255X Rev. D RUN VOLTAGE BOOST TIME SHIFT CAPAC 33 µF 732752-00 Note: The starter boost voltage is 120 VAC. This is only available with one-tube generators. 52 VAC 1.5 Sec 732752-00 33 µF 52 VAC 1.5 Sec 33 µF 732752-00 73 VAC 1.5 Sec 33 µF 732752-00 X-Ray Generator Service Manual Supplement 746026-00 CPI Canada Inc 2.0 X-Ray Tube Stator Compatibility Tables LOW SPEED STARTER TUBE SELECT TABLE (Cont) TUBE TYPE (HOUSING) Varian B100 DX52 Std “R”stator (16/50 Ω) Varian B100 “STD” stator (16/50 Ω) Varian B130 B150 Std “R”stator (16/50 Ω) Varian Diamond Std “R”stator (16/50 Ω) Varian Emerald Std “R” stator Varian Saphire Std “R” stator Varian DX62 300-400 kHu, “STD” stator (23/56 Ω) Varian DX62U Universal 300-400 kHu, configured as “STD” or “R” stator (15/36 Ω) TUBE TYPE (INSERT) A102 A132 A142 52 VAC 1.5 Sec 33 µF LOW SPD STARTER PART NO. 732752-00 A102 A132 A142 A192 A272 A282 A286 A292 G256 G292 RAD13 RAD14 0.3/1.2 RAD14 0.6/1.2 RAD14 0.6/1.5 RAD 8 RAD 68 RAD 74 RAD21 RAD56 0.6/1.0 RAD56 0.6/1.2 RAD60 RAD92 RAD94 A192B A197 A256 A272 A282 A286 A292 A192B A197 A256 A272 A282 A286 A292 52 VAC 1.5 Sec 33 µF 732752-00 52 VAC 1.5 Sec 33 µF 732752-00 52 VAC 1.5 Sec 33 µF 732752-00 52 VAC 1.5 Sec 33 µF 732752-00 52 VAC 1.5 Sec 33 µF 732752-00 52 VAC 1.5 Sec 33 µF 732752-00 52 VAC 1.5 Sec 33 µF 732752-00 X-Ray Generator Service Manual Supplement RUN VOLTAGE 746026-00 BOOST TIME Rev. D SHIFT CAPAC Page 5 CPI Canada Inc. 3.0 X-Ray Tube Stator Compatibility Tables DUAL SPEED STARTER TUBE SELECT TABLE The Dual Speed Starter synthesizes its output frequencies independently of the line frequency and will operate all tubes at 60 and 180 Hz, unless a particular tube only has published ratings to operate at 150 Hz, as indicated in the table. In this case, the starter will output 150 Hz when set for these tubes. TUBE TYPE (HOUSING) CGR Statorix 200A/240/260 550 (50/110 Ω 24 slot) Comet DO7 25/50 Ω stator Comet DO9 25/50 Ω stator Comet DO10 25/50 Ω stator Comet DO10 25/50 Ω stator Comet DO700WX 25/50 Ω stator TUBE TYPE (INSERT) MN640 M641 MN641 M643 MS740 MSN742 RN620 RN640 RSN722 RSN742 DX7 CODE Switches 1........5 00111 TABLE 2: TUBE TYPES (HIGH SPEED STARTER) H.S. H.S. H.S. H.S. BOOST L.S. L.S. START RUN BRAKE BRAKE TIME START RUN VOLTS VOLTS VOLTS TIME VOLTS VOLTS 450 150 120 3.0 sec 3.0 sec HIGH SPEED OPERATION ONLY H.S. SHIFT CAPAC 3.4 uF L.S. SHIFT CAPAC N/A DUAL SPD STARTER PART NO. 733317-07 * 735925-07 733317-01 * 735925-01 733317-01 * 735925-01 733317-01 * 735925-01 (See note 1 at end of this table) 00000 LOW SPEED OPERATION ONLY 1.4 sec 240 50 6 uF 31 uF 1.4 sec 240 50 6 uF 31 uF (See note 1 at end of this table) DX9 0.6/2.0 DX9 1.2/2.0 DI104 0.3/0.8 DI104 0.6/1.0 DI104 0.6/1.3 DI104 0.6/1.8 DI106 0.3/0.8 DI106 0.6/1.0 DI106 0.6/1.3 DI700 0.6/1.0 DI700 1.0/1.8 00000 LOW SPEED OPERATION ONLY (See note 1 at end of this table) 00011 420 80 150 3.0 sec 1.8 sec 240 80 6 uF 31 uF 10011 420 80 150 3.0 sec 2.2 sec 240 80 6 uF 31 uF 733317-01 * 735925-01 10011 420 80 150 3.0 sec 2.2 sec 240 80 6 uF 31 uF 733317-01 * 735925-01 X-Ray Generator Service Manual Supplement 746026-00 Rev. D Page 6 CPI Canada Inc. 3.0 X-Ray Tube Stator Compatibility Tables Dual Speed Starter Tube Select Table (cont) TUBE TYPE (HOUSING) Dunlee PX1300 3” anode “S“ stator (15/30 Ω) Dunlee PX1400 4” anode “S” stator (15/30 Ω) (see note 2 at end of this table) Dunlee PX1400 4” anode “S” stator (15/30 Ω) PX1302 PX1312 11100 H.S. START VOLTS 240 PX1429 PX1431 PX1436 PX1482 PX1483 01100 240 120 100 3.0 sec 4.5 sec 240 70 6 uF 31 uF 733317-01 * 735925-01 PX1429 PX1431 PX1436 PX1482 10000 400 120 100 3.0 sec 1.9 sec 240 70 6 uF 31 uF 733317-01 * 735925-01 PX1429 PX1431 PX1436 PX1482 PX1483 1.0/2.0 15° 0.6/1.0 11° 10110 340 60 100 3.0 sec 1.0 sec 240 70 20 uF 60 uF 733317-02 * 735925-02 01110 400 90 80 2.0 sec 0.9 sec 230 70 7.5 uF 47 uF TUBE TYPE (INSERT) CODE Switches 1........5 H.S. RUN VOLTS 120 H.S. BRAKE VOLTS 100 H.S. BRAKE TIME 3.0 sec BOOST TIME 2.3 sec L.S. START VOLTS 240 L.S. RUN VOLTS 50 H.S. SHIFT CAPAC 6 uF L.S. SHIFT CAPAC 31 uF DUAL SPD STARTER PART NO. 733317-01 * 735925-01 (see note 2 at end of this table) Dunlee PX1400 4” anode “Q” stator (6/12 Ω) GE Maxiray 75 (3” anode) 23/23Ω equal impedance “E” stator GE Maxiray 100 (4” anode) 23/23 Ω equal impedance “E” stator 0.3/1.0 11° 0.6/1.0 11° 0.6/1.2 11° 0.6/1.5 11° 0.6/1.25 12.5° 1.0/2.0 15° 733317-03 * 735925-03 00101 400 X-Ray Generator Service Manual Supplement 90 80 3.0 sec 1.0 sec 230 70 7.5 uF 47 uF 733317-03 * 735925-03 746026-00 Rev. D Page 7 CPI Canada Inc. 3.0 X-Ray Tube Stator Compatibility Tables Dual Speed Starter Tube Select Table (cont) TUBE TYPE (HOUSING) Gilardoni Rotagil Gilardoni Rotagil A/A5 IAE C52 Super C100 20/40 Ω stator IAE C52 C352 C52 Super 20/40 Ω stator IAE C52 C352 20/40 Ω stator IAE tubes AND standard “R” stator tubes Philips ROT350 ROT351 TUBE TYPE (INSERT) AR11-30 AR30-60 AR20-50 AR30-100 AR40-100 RTC 600HS RTC 700HS RTC 1000HS RTM 101H/HS RTM 102H/HS RTM 90H/HS RTM 92H/HS CODE Switches 1........5 10101 H.S. H.S. H.S. H.S. START RUN BRAKE BRAKE VOLTS VOLTS VOLTS TIME LOW SPEED OPERATION ONLY BOOST TIME 1.4 sec (See note 1 at end of this table) L.S. START VOLTS 220 50 Hz 220 50 Hz L.S. RUN VOLTS 60 50 Hz 60 50 Hz H.S. SHIFT CAPAC 6 uF L.S. SHIFT CAPAC 31 uF 6 uF 31 uF DUAL SPD STARTER PART NO. 733317-01 * 735925-01 733317-01 * 735925-01 01101 340 150 Hz 60 150 Hz 80 3.0 sec 1.4 sec 11011 440 100 120 1.8 sec 1.0 sec 220 80 5 uF 45 uF 733317-05 * 735925-05 11011 440 100 120 1.8 sec 1.0 sec 220 80 5 uF 45 uF 733317-05 * 735925-05 5 uF 45 uF 733317-05 * 735925-05 5 uF 30 uF 6 uF 31 uF 733317-08 * 735925-08 6 uF 31 uF RTM 78H/HS 11011 440 100 120 1.8 sec 1.0 sec 220 80 AP DX104 X40 X50/AH Dual speed starters 733317-08 / 735925-08 are special configurations. These may be jumperconfigured to support IAE tubes that require dual speed starter 733317-05 / 735925-05 per this table, or to support “R” type stators that use dual speed starter 733317-01 / 735925-01 per this table. Please refer to note 3 at the end of this section before attempting to use this dual speed starter configuration. RO 17/50 00000 1.4 sec 240 50 LOW SPEED OPERATION ONLY (See note 1 at end of this table) SRO 22/50 SRO 33/100 X-Ray Generator Service Manual Supplement 746026-00 Rev. D 733317-01 * 735925-01 Page 8 CPI Canada Inc. 3.0 X-Ray Tube Stator Compatibility Tables Dual Speed Starter Tube Select Table (cont) TUBE TYPE (HOUSING) TUBE TYPE (INSERT) Philips SRM ROT350 ROT500 Siemens BI 125/20/40 Biangulix 8500 RPM (configured for 150 Hz operation) Siemens 30/52R Opti-150 20/40 “S” stator Siemens OptiTop 150/40/80HC-100L 150/40/80HC-102L 14/37 Ω stator Siemens Optilix SV150/40/80C-100L SV150/30/50C-100L Toshiba E7252X XH-106V-2 E7813X Toshiba E7239X XH-106V-2 E7242X XS-AL stator E7252X E7813X Toshiba E7132X XH-121 E7239X E7240X E7299X Toshiba E7242FX XH-126 CODE Switches 1........5 01111 11101 H.S. START VOLTS 420 H.S. RUN VOLTS 50 H.S. BRAKE VOLTS 150 H.S. BRAKE TIME 3.0 sec 1.8 sec 400 150 Hz 90 150 Hz 80 3.0 sec 1.9 sec BOOST TIME L.S. START VOLTS 240 L.S. RUN VOLTS 50 HIGH SPEED OPERATION ONLY H.S. SHIFT CAPAC 12.5 uF L.S. SHIFT CAPAC 37.5 uF DUAL SPD STARTER PART NO. 733317-10 * 735925-10 5 uF N/A 733317-04 (See note 1 at end of this table) 00000 400 90 80 3.0 sec 1.9 sec 240 50 5 uF 45 uF 733317-05 * 735925-05 01011 400 80 120 3.0 sec 1.0 sec 240 80 5 uF 30 uF 733317-06 * 735925-06 01011 400 80 120 3.0 sec 1.0 sec 240 80 5 uF 30 uF 733317-06 * 735925-06 00100 400 100 100 3.0 sec 1.2 sec 240 50 6 uF 31 uF 10111 220 60 80 3.0 sec 1.2 sec 130 50 6 uF 46 uF 733317-01 * 735925-01 733317-09 * 735925-09 1.4 sec 240 50 6 uF 31 uF 00000 LOW SPEED OPERATION ONLY (See note 1 at end of this table) 00000 X-Ray Generator Service Manual Supplement LOW SPEED OPERATION ONLY (See note 1 at end of this table) 746026-00 Rev. D 733317-01 * 735925-01 1.4 sec 240 50 6 uF 31 uF 733317-01 * 735925-01 Page 9 CPI Canada Inc. 3.0 X-Ray Tube Stator Compatibility Tables Dual Speed Starter Tube Select Table (cont) TUBE TYPE (HOUSING) Toshiba XH-157 Varian B100 DX52 Std “R” stator (16/50 Ω) Varian B100 “Q” stator (6/11 Ω) Varian B130 B150 Std “R” stator (16/50 Ω) Varian B130 B150 “Q” stator (6/11 Ω) Varian B160 B180 “R” Stator (16/50 Ω) 10011 H.S. START VOLTS 420 H.S. RUN VOLTS 80 H.S. BRAKE VOLTS 150 H.S. BRAKE TIME 3.0 sec 01000 400 100 100 A102 A132 A142 11010 290 70 A192 A272 A282 A286 A292 G256 G292 A192 A272 A282 A286 A292 G256 G292 G1082 G1086 G1092 G1582 G1592 00000 400 00110 11110 TUBE TYPE (INSERT) E7254X E7254FX E7255X A102 A132 A142 CODE Switches 1........5 BOOST TIME 2.2 sec L.S. START VOLTS 240 L.S. RUN VOLTS 80 H.S. SHIFT CAPAC 6 uF L.S. SHIFT CAPAC 31 uF DUAL SPD STARTER PART NO. 733317-01 * 735925-01 3.0 sec 1.0 sec 240 60 6 uF 31 uF 733317-01 * 735925-01 60 3.0 sec 0.8 sec 150 50 20 uF 60 uF 733317-02 * 735925-02 100 100 3.0 sec 1.4 sec 240 50 6 uF 31 uF 733317-01 * 735925-01 290 70 60 3.0 sec 1.3 sec 150 50 20 uF 60 uF 733317-02 * 735925-02 400 100 150 3.0 sec 5.0 sec 240 70 6 uF 31 uF 733317-01 * 735925-01 X-Ray Generator Service Manual Supplement 746026-00 Rev. D Page 10 CPI Canada Inc. 3.0 X-Ray Tube Stator Compatibility Tables Dual Speed Starter Tube Select Table (cont) TUBE TYPE (HOUSING) Varian Diamond Std “R” stator Varian Emerald Std “R” stator Varian Saphire Std “R” stator (20/50 Ω) Varian DX62 300-400 kHu, “STD” stator (23/56 Ω) Varian DX62U Universal 300-400 kHu, configured as “STD” or “R” stator (15/36 Ω) TUBE TYPE (INSERT) RAD13 RAD14 0.3/1.2 RAD14 0.6/1.2 RAD14 0.6/1.5 RAD 8 RAD 68 RAD 74 RAD21 RAD56 0.6/1.0 RAD56 0.6/1.2 RAD60 RAD92 RAD94 A192B A197 A256 A272 A282 A286 A292 A192B A197 A256 A272 A282 A286 A292 CODE Switches 1........5 00100 H.S. START VOLTS 400 00000 H.S. RUN VOLTS 100 H.S. BRAKE VOLTS 100 H.S. BRAKE TIME 3.0 sec LOW SPEED OPERATION ONLY BOOST TIME 1.2 sec L.S. START VOLTS 240 L.S. RUN VOLTS 50 H.S. SHIFT CAPAC 6 uF L.S. SHIFT CAPAC 31 uF 1.4 sec 240 50 6 uF 31 uF (See note 1 at end of this table) DUAL SPD STARTER PART NO. 733317-01 * 735925-01 733317-01 * 735925-01 10100 400 100 100 3.0 sec 2.3 sec 240 50 6 uF 31 uF 733317-01 * 735925-01 00000 400 100 100 3.0 sec 1.4 sec 240 50 6 uF 31 uF 733317-01 * 735925-01 00000 400 100 100 3.0 sec 1.4 sec 240 50 6 uF 31 uF 733317-01 * 735925-01 X-Ray Generator Service Manual Supplement 746026-00 Rev. D Page 11 CPI Canada Inc. 3.0 X-Ray Tube Stator Compatibility Tables Dual Speed Starter Tube Select Table (cont) THE DUAL SPEED STARTER USES MODULATION STRATEGIES TO OBTAIN THE DESIRED OUTPUTS. MEASURED VOLTAGES MAY NOT AGREE WITH THOSE LISTED IN THE TABLE. HOWEVER, THE CURRENTS FLOWING IN THE STATOR WINDINGS ARE EQUIVALENT TO THOSE THAT WOULD EXIST IF THE STATOR WAS EXCITED WITH THESE VOLTAGES. NOTE 1: Tube types designated as low speed only or high speed only must be programmed for low speed only or high speed only operation. Refer to chapter 3, section 3C.5.1 for details (Indico 100 only). NOTE 2: Two settings are shown for the Dunlee PX1400 tube with “S” stator. The settings with the 4.5 sec boost times are per older Dunlee data sheets. The values with the 1.9 sec boost times are per newer Dunlee data sheets (May 2002). The installer must verify tube compatibility per the appropriate Dunlee tube data sheet. * Dual speed starter part numbers 733317-XX are used in 400 VAC 3φ generators / power supplies and in 480 VAC 3φ generators / power supplies with a line adjusting transformer. Dual speed starter part numbers 735925-XX are used in 230 VAC 1φ generators / power supplies and in 480 VAC 3φ direct input generators / power supplies (using no line adjusting transformer). NOTE 3: Dual speed starters 733317-08 / 735925-08 have a jumper selectable phase shift capacitor that allows selection of 5 uF and 30 uF capacitors for operation with IAE tubes that use dual speed starter 733317-05 / 735925-05 as per table 2, or this may be set to 6 uF and 31 uF for operation with “R” type stators that use dual speed starter 733317-01 / 735925-01 as per table 2. THIS STARTER IS TYPICALLY FACTORY SET TO THE 5 uF AND 30 uF POSITION. CONFIRM PROPER CONFIGURATION PER THE SECTION “CONFIGURING DUAL SPEED STARTER 733317-08 / 735925-08” IN CHAPTER 2 BEFORE PROCEEDING. X-Ray Generator Service Manual Supplement 746026-00 Rev. D Page 12 CPI Canada Inc. Interfacing and Calibration 3 CHAPTER 3 SYSTEM INTERFACING, PROGRAMMING, AEC/ABS CALIBRATION, AND DAP SETUP AND CALIBRATION (INDICO 100) 3.0.0 INTRODUCTION 3.1.0 Purpose This chapter describes the interfacing to the generator of the X-ray room imaging equipment, and programming of the Millenia and Indico 100 family of generators. This chapter also allows the installer to record the necessary information to complete the installation, as well as to record the programming values. The installation of the AEC (Automatic Exposure Control) and ABS (Automatic Brightness Stabilization) devices and their calibration are also covered in this chapter. Chapter 3F is used in Indico 100 manuals only, and covers setup and calibration of the optional DAP (Dose-Area Product) meter. This Chapter contains the following sections. Section 3A 3B 3C 3D 3E 3F Title Setup information. System interfacing Programming the generator Automatic Exposure Control (AEC) calibration Automatic Brightness Stabilization (ABS) calibration DAP (Dose-Area Product) setup and calibration. Indico 100 only. Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-03 Rev. B Page 3-1 3 Interfacing and Calibration CPI Canada Inc. (This page intentionally left blank.) Page 3-2 Rev. B Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-03 CPI Canada Inc. Setup Information 3A CHAPTER 3 SECTION 3A SETUP INFORMATION CONTENTS: 3A.1.0 INTRODUCTION ...............................................................................................................................................3A-2 3A.2.0 INSTALLATION RECORD ................................................................................................................................3A-2 3A.2.1 X-Ray Tubes ..................................................................................................................................................3A-2 3A.2.2 Mains Supply And Fusing ..............................................................................................................................3A-3 3A.2.3 Automatic Exposure Control ..........................................................................................................................3A-3 3A.2.4 Collimator .......................................................................................................................................................3A-3 3A.2.5 Image System ................................................................................................................................................3A-3 3A.2.6 ABS Pickup Assembly....................................................................................................................................3A-4 3A.2.7 Table Type .....................................................................................................................................................3A-4 3A.2.8 Wall Receptor.................................................................................................................................................3A-4 3A.2.9 Receptor Assignment.....................................................................................................................................3A-4 3A.2.10 Miscellaneous Notes....................................................................................................................................3A-4 3A.3.0 X-RAY TUBE AND GENERATOR PARAMETER WORKSHEET.....................................................................3A-5 3A.4.0 IMAGE RECEPTOR PROGRAMMING WORKSHEET.....................................................................................3A-6 3A.5.0 I/O CONFIGURATION WORKSHEET ..............................................................................................................3A-7 Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-04 Rev. B Page 3A-1 3A Setup Information CPI Canada Inc. 3A.1.0 INTRODUCTION Please record the setup information for your installation in this section before programming the generator. Enter the information appropriate for your generator model. The data tables will accommodate installations up to a standard R&F installation with the following: tilting G.I. table with bucky, spot film device, standard image tube with a medical T.V. system, wall bucky and an overhead tube stand, spot film camera and a digital acquisition system. 3A.2.0 INSTALLATION RECORD 3A.2.1 X-Ray Tubes Please enter the appropriate information. a) Over table X-ray tube (or TUBE # 1) b) Manufacturer and type: c) d) e) f) g) h) i) j) k) l) m) n) o) Focal spot combination: kW of each focal spot: Maximum kVp: Type of stator: Dual or single speed: Stator delay: Start and run voltage, low speed: Start and run voltage, high speed: Brake voltage: Maximum filament current: Minimum filament current, stand-by: Thermal switch included: Under table X-ray tube (or TUBE # 2) p) q) r) s) t) u) v) w) x) y) z) aa) bb) cc) Manufacturer and type: Focal spot combination: kW of each focal spot: Maximum kVp: Type of stator: Dual or single speed: Stator delay: Start and run voltage, low speed: Start and run voltage, high speed: Brake voltage: Maximum filament current: Minimum filament current, stand-by: Thermal switch included: X-ray tube fan included: Page 3A-2 Rev. B large = large = sec = start volts = start volts = volts = amps = amps = large = large = sec = start volts = start volts = volts = amps = amps = small = small = run volts = run volts = small = small = run volts = run volts = Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-04 CPI Canada Inc. Setup Information 3A 3A.2.2 Mains Supply And Fusing Please record the following information on the mains voltage and current capacity. Check that the information is appropriate for the generator according to the nameplate on the generator cabinet. Line voltage: ________ VAC Line frequency: 50 Hz. 60 Hz. Disconnect fuses (main): Line capacity: kVa amps 3A.2.3 Automatic Exposure Control Chamber Type (optional): Solid State: __________________ Ion Chamber ______________ Make: _______________________ Model: _________________ PMT _____________ Receptors with AEC (optional): Table bucky Wall bucky yes yes Spot film device Auxiliary bucky yes yes Digital System yes 3A.2.4 Collimator Type: Compatible with X-ray tube: Exposure interlock (dry contacts): Tomo/stereo by-pass: __________________ yes no yes no yes no 3A.2.5 Image System Conventional: ________________________________________ (make and model) Digital: ______________________________________________(make and model) Image intensifier: 24 hour supply: Image system park/position switch. Fluoro foot switch to initiate fluoro and spot exposure: Spot film advance delay: greater than 850 mSec. __ yes Remote Fluoro controller. AEC compensation for multi-spot SFD use. Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual dual mode __ yes __ yes __ yes __ no __ yes __ yes Ch # 740904-04 tri-mode __ no __ no __ no __ no __ no Rev. B Page 3A-3 3A Setup Information CPI Canada Inc. 3A.2.6 ABS Pickup Assembly Optical diode: _______ PMT: _______ Proportional DC: _______ Make: _______________________ Model: _________________ Composite Video _______ 3A.2.7 Table Type Table type: ______________________________________ Grid: ___________ Ratio: __________ Model/Make: _______________________ L/P Inch: __________ Focus Distance: __________ L/P Inch: __________ Focus Distance: __________ 3A.2.8 Wall Receptor Type: ______________________________ Grid: ___________ Ratio: __________ 3A.2.9 Receptor Assignment Receptor 1: _______________________ Receptor 2: _______________________ Receptor 3: _______________________ Receptor 4: _______________________ Receptor 5: _______________________ Receptor 6: _______________________ 3A.2.10 Miscellaneous Notes _____________________________________________________________________________________ _____________________________________________________________________________________ _____________________________________________________________________________________ _____________________________________________________________________________________ _____________________________________________________________________________________ _____________________________________________________________________________________ _____________________________________________________________________________________ _____________________________________________________________________________________ _____________________________________________________________________________________ Page 3A-4 Rev. B Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-04 CPI Canada Inc. Setup Information 3A 3A.3.0 X-RAY TUBE AND GENERATOR PARAMETER WORKSHEET Note: The information in this table is to be derived from the GEN CONFIGURATION menu. Generator Model: ______________ TUBE SELECTION Serial No: _____________ TUBE 1 DEFAULT SELECTED TUBE 2 DEFAULT SELECTED TUBE SELECTED TUBE SPEED MAX SF KW LS MAX LF KW LS MAX SF KW HS MAX LF KW HS MAX KV MAX SF MA ANODE HU WARNING ANODE HU LIMIT SF STANDBY LF STANDBY SF MAX LF MAX FIL BOOST FIL PREHEAT GENERATOR LIMITS MAX KW MAX MA MIN MA MAX MAS Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual DEFAULT SELECTED Ch # 740904-04 Rev. B Page 3A-5 3A Setup Information CPI Canada Inc. 3A.4.0 IMAGE RECEPTOR PROGRAMMING WORKSHEET IMAGE RECEPTOR PROGRAMMING WORKSHEET DATE:___________ SERIAL #:_____________ FUNCTION RECEPTOR RECEPTOR RECEPTOR RECEPTOR RECEPTOR RECEPTOR 1 2 3 4 5 6 RECEPTOR NAME TUBE TOMO FLUORO SERIAL INTERFACE OPTS FUNCTIONAL OPTS RECEPTOR SYM FLUORO HANG RAD HANG LAST IMAGE HOLD MEMORY REM TOMO BUT SF/LF SWITCH AEC BACKUP AEC BACKUP MAS AEC BACKUP MS AEC CHANNEL Page 3A-6 Rev. B Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-04 CPI Canada Inc. Setup Information 3A 3A.5.0 I/O CONFIGURATION WORKSHEET NOTE: BOXES WITH DOTTED LINES CANNOT HAVE THEIR STATE CHANGED! FUNCTIONS STANDBY PREP GEN RDY RAD EXP FLUORO EXP ***INPUTS*** REMOTE EXP ----- ----- REMOTE PREP ----- ----- ----- REMOTE FL. EXP ----- ----- ----- CONSOLE EXP ----- ----- CONSOLE PREP ----- ----- TOMO EXP ----- REM. TOMO SEL ----- ----- ----- ----- ----- I/I SAFETY ----- ----- COLL. ITLK ----- ----- BUCKY CONTACTS ----- ----- ----- THERMAL SW 1 ----- THERMAL SW 2 ----- DOOR ITLK --------- ----- --------- --------- ----- ----- SPARE MULTI SPOT EXP ----- ----- ----- ----- ----- ----- ***OUTPUTS*** BKY 1 SELECT BKY 2 SELECT BKY 3 SELECT TOMO/BKY 4 SEL TOMO/BKY STRT ALE COLL. BYPASS ROOM LIGHT SPARE Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-04 Rev. B Page 3A-7 3A Setup Information CPI Canada Inc. (This page intentionally left blank) Page 3A-8 Rev. B Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-04 CPI Canada Inc. System Interfacing 3B CHAPTER 3 SECTION 3B SYSTEM INTERFACING CONTENTS: 3B.1.0 INTRODUCTION..........................................................................................................................................3B-2 3B.2.0 LOCATIONS OF INPUTS AND OUTPUTS .................................................................................................3B-3 3B.2.1 Generator Pictorial Showing Connections ...............................................................................................3B-3 3B.2.2 Low Speed / Dual Speed Starter ..............................................................................................................3B-4 3B.2.3 High Tension Transformer........................................................................................................................3B-4 3B.2.4 Generator Interface Board........................................................................................................................3B-4 3B.2.5 Generator CPU Board ..............................................................................................................................3B-4 3B.2.6 AEC Board................................................................................................................................................3B-4 3B.2.7 Console CPU Board / Touch Screen........................................................................................................3B-4 3B.2.8 I/0 Expansion Board (optional) .................................................................................................................3B-4 3B.2.9 DAP Interface Board (optional) ................................................................................................................3B-4 3B.2.10 Room Interface Board ............................................................................................................................3B-5 3B.3.0 FEATURES OF THE ROOM INTERFACE BOARD ....................................................................................3B-5 3B.3.1 Inputs ........................................................................................................................................................3B-6 3B.3.2 Outputs .....................................................................................................................................................3B-7 3B.3.3 Selecting Output Voltages ........................................................................................................................3B-7 3B.3.4 Typical Examples .....................................................................................................................................3B-9 3B.3.5 Wiring The Room Interface Terminal Plugs ...........................................................................................3B-10 3B.4.0 GENERATOR INTERFACE BOARD PROGRAMMING FOR 110/220 VAC.............................................3B-11 3B.5.0 TYPICAL R&F ROOM CONNECTIONS ....................................................................................................3B-12 3B.6.0 TYPICAL ROOM CABLING AND INTERFACING .....................................................................................3B-13 Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-05 Rev. J Page 3B-1 3B System Interfacing CPI Canada Inc. 3B.1.0 INTRODUCTION The Indico 100 generator may be interfaced to various tables, imaging systems, tube stands, tomographic devices, AEC pickups, Buckys, ABS pickups, X-ray tubes and collimators. The generator interface may be programmed to supply a voltage, an isolated contact, receive a voltage, or an external isolated contact. All interfacing cables enter the generator at the rear of the generator cabinet. NOTE: The installer must provide the necessary interfacing cables. WARNING NOTE: Page 3B-2 THE GENERATOR INTERFACE BOARD HAS 110 AND 220 VAC PRESENT AT ALL TIMES THAT THE MAIN DISCONNECT IS SWITCHED ON. USE CAUTION WHEN SERVICING THIS BOARD. Rev. J Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-05 CPI Canada Inc. System Interfacing 3B 3B.2.0 LOCATIONS OF INPUTS AND OUTPUTS 3B.2.1 Generator Pictorial Showing Connections Figure 3B-1: Generator to room interface CAUTION: ENSURE THAT ALL X-RAY TUBE HOUSINGS ARE CONNECTED TO THE GROUND STUD ON THE HT TANK. USE A SEPARATE GROUND WIRE FOR EACH TUBE, #10 AWG (6 mm2) OR GREATER. Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-05 Rev. J Page 3B-3 3B System Interfacing CPI Canada Inc. 3B.2.2 Low Speed / Dual Speed Starter Refer to chapter 2 (installation) for instructions on wiring to the low speed or dual speed starter terminal blocks. Note that the X-ray tube thermal switches may be connected at the starter terminal blocks, or at the room interface board. Both sets of terminals are connected in parallel, and either may be used. 3B.2.3 High Tension Transformer Accepts the high tension cables from either one or two x-ray tubes. 3B.2.4 Generator Interface Board The generator interface board accepts the following (ABS only on R&F generators): • • ABS - composite video (J8). ABS - proportional DC (J7). (Jumpers must be configured for different ABS types, refer to chapter 3E). • Control console as per chapter 2. 3B.2.5 Generator CPU Board The generator CPU board accepts the following (all are optional): • Remote fluoro controller (J11). • RS 232 Port (J1). • RS 232 Port (J2). 3B.2.6 AEC Board Depending on the Indico 100 generator’s configuration, different AEC boards may be fitted. Refer to chapter 3D: 3B.2.7 Console CPU Board / Touch Screen The optional hand switch connects to the console CPU board or to a connector on the rear of the console; refer to chapter 2 for details. If it is desired to connect a remote fluoro footswitch (normally customer supplied), connect to TB6 pins 5 & 6 on the room interface board, or to terminals “F” and “COM” on TB1 on the console CPU board (23 X 56 cm consoles), or to J13 on the 31 X 42 cm console. Refer to chapter 2 for details. 3B.2.8 I/0 Expansion Board (optional) The optional I/0 expansion board is used when the Indico 100 generator is interfaced with digital systems, film changers and various dedicated products. 3B.2.9 DAP Interface Board (optional) The optional DAP interface board is used to interface with DAP chambers, used to measure dose-areaproduct. The generator will interface with two DAP devices, one for each X-ray tube, when fitted with this option. Page 3B-4 Rev. J Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-05 CPI Canada Inc. System Interfacing 3B 3B.2.10 Room Interface Board All the necessary inputs and outputs for the external room equipment are located on this board. • • • • • • TB1 - Bucky 3 and tomo Bucky select, table stepper input, TB2 - Bucky 1 and 2 select, collimator and Bucky inputs. TB3 - Tomographic inputs and outputs, collimator bypass. TB4 - Room light, thermal switches, door interlock, tube indicators. TB5 - Multiple spot input, I.I. mag. select. TB6 - Remote prep, exposure and fluoro inputs, I.I. safety input, ALE output, spare output. 3B.3.0 FEATURES OF THE ROOM INTERFACE BOARD Refer to the following schematics and figures. • • Figure 3B-2, room interface board layout. Room interface functional drawing, MD-0763. TB1-TB6 LIVE CONTACT JW1-JW5 LIVE CONTACT 24VDC 110AC 220AC DRY CONTACT JW6-JW8 24 VDC DRY CONTACT DRY CONTACT LIVE CONTACT DRY CONTACT Figure 3B-2: Room interface board Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-05 Rev. J Page 3B-5 3B System Interfacing CPI Canada Inc. 3B.3.1 Inputs • • NOTE: All inputs are opto coupled, select inputs may be configured to use an external +/- 24 VDC source or may be configured to accept a closed dry contact. Note the following inputs and jumper configurations per the table below: The Indico 100 generator is shipped from the factory with all inputs configured for dry contact inputs. JUMPER CONFIGURATION (INPUTS): ROOM INTERFACE BOARD TB1 PINS 4 & 5 (TABLE STEPPER) TB2 PINS 6 & 7 (COLLIMATOR) TB2 PINS 4 & 5 (BUCKY CONTACTS) TB3 PINS 6 & 7 (TOMO EXPOSURE) TB3 PINS 4 & 5 (REMOTE TOMO SELECT) TB4 PINS 8 & 9 (THERMAL SWITCH 1) TB4 PINS 6 & 7 (THERMAL SWITCH 2) TB4 PINS 4 & 5 (ROOM DOOR INTLK) TB5 PINS 11 & 12 (MULT. SPOT EXPOSURE) TB6 PINS 9 & 10 (REMOTE EXPOSURE) TB6 PINS 7 & 8 (REMOTE PREP) TB6 PINS 3 & 4 (I.I. SAFETY) TB6 PINS 5 & 6 (REMOTE FLUORO EXP) Page 3B-6 Rev. J GENERATOR INTERFACE BOARD JUMPER CONFIGURATION JW7 PINS 1-2, 3-4 = DRY CONTACT INPUT JW7 PINS 2-3 = 24 VDC EXTERNAL INPUT JW9 PINS 1-2, 3-4 = DRY CONTACT INPUT JW9 PINS 2-3 = 24 VDC EXTERNAL INPUT JW10.PINS 1-2, 3-4 = DRY CONTACT INPUT JW10 PINS 2-3 = 24 VDC EXTERNAL INPUT JW3 PINS 1-2, 3-4 = DRY CONTACT INPUT JW3 PINS 2-3 = 24 VDC EXTERNAL INPUT JW2 PINS 1-2, 3-4 = DRY CONTACT INPUT JW2 PINS 2-3 = 24 VDC EXTERNAL INPUT DRY CONTACT INPUT ONLY DRY CONTACT INPUT ONLY DRY CONTACT INPUT ONLY JW6 PINS 1-2, 3-4 = DRY CONTACT INPUT JW6 PINS 2-3 = 24 VDC EXTERNAL INPUT JW15 PINS 1-2, 3-4 = DRY CONTACT INPUT JW15 PINS 2-3 = 24 VDC EXTERNAL INPUT JW14 PINS 1-2, 3-4 = DRY CONTACT INPUT JW14 PINS 2-3 = 24 VDC EXTERNAL INPUT JW8 PINS 1-2, 3-4 = DRY CONTACT INPUT JW8 PINS 2-3 = 24 VDC EXTERNAL INPUT DRY CONTACT INPUT ONLY Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-05 CPI Canada Inc. System Interfacing 3B 3B.3.2 Outputs • • • NOTE: Outputs are via relay contacts, some of which may be configured to supply a dry contact closure or to supply 24 VDC, 110 VAC, or 220 VAC upon closure. Note the following outputs and jumper configurations per the table below: To supply power to a grounded load, use TB1 pin 12 (for example) and jumper on “dry contacts”. This applies also to TB1 pin 1, TB2 pin 12, TB2 pin 1 and TB3 pin 12. The Indico 100 generator is shipped from the factory with JW1 to JW5 configured for dry contacts, and JW6 to JW8 configured for 24 VDC output on relay closure. JUMPER CONFIGURATION (OUTPUTS): ROOM INTERFACE BOARD TB1 PINS 11 & 12 (BUCKY 3 SELECT) TB1 PINS 1 & 2 (TOMO BUCKY SELECT) TB2 PINS 11 & 12 (BUCKY 1 SELECT) TB2 PINS 1 & 2 (BUCKY 2 SELECT) TB3 PINS 11 & 12 (TOMO/BUCKY START) TB3 PINS 1 & 2 (COLLIMATOR BYPASS) TB4 PINS 11 & 12 (ROOM LIGHT) TB4 PINS 1 & 2 TUBE 2 INDICATOR TB4 PINS 1 & 3 TUBE 1 INDICATOR TB5 PINS 8 & 9 (I.I. MAG 1) TB5 PINS 5 & 6 (I.I. MAG 2) TB5 PINS 2 & 3 (I.I. MAG 3) TB6 PINS 1 & 2 (ALE OUTPUT) TB6 PINS 11 & 12 (SPARE OUTPUT) ROOM INTERFACE BOARD JUMPER CONFIGURATION JW2 DRY CONTACTS OUTPUT JW2 LIVE CONTACTS OUTPUT JW1 DRY CONTACTS OUTPUT JW1 LIVE CONTACTS OUTPUT JW4 DRY CONTACTS OUTPUT JW4 LIVE CONTACTS OUTPUT JW3 DRY CONTACTS OUTPUT JW3 LIVE CONTACTS OUTPUT JW5 DRY CONTACTS OUTPUT JW5 LIVE CONTACTS OUTPUT DRY CONTACT OUTPUT ONLY DRY CONTACT OUTPUT ONLY JW6 PINS 1-2, 3-4 = 24VDC OUTPUT JW6 PINS 2-3 = DRY CONTACT OUTPUT DRY CONTACT OUTPUT ONLY DRY CONTACT OUTPUT ONLY DRY CONTACT OUTPUT ONLY JW7 PINS 1-2, 3-4 = 24VDC OUTPUT JW7 PINS 2-3 = DRY CONTACT OUTPUT JW8 PINS 1-2, 3-4 = 24VDC OUTPUT JW8 PINS 2-3 = DRY CONTACT OUTPUT 3B.3.3 Selecting Output Voltages Five outputs (K1, K2, K3, K4 and K6 for Bucky selects and Bucky start) may be jumper configured for a choice of the following voltages: • • • NOTE: 24 VDC 4 AMPS total. 110 VAC 2.5 AMPS total. 220 VAC 1.5 AMPS total. 2.5 AMPS IS AVAILABLE AT 110 VAC OR 1.5 AMPS IS AVAILABLE AT 220 VAC, BUT BOTH ARE NOT AVAILABLE SIMULTANEOUSLY. TOTAL POWER CONSUMPTION MUST NOT EXCEED 350 VA. Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-05 Rev. J Page 3B-7 3B System Interfacing CPI Canada Inc. 3B.3.3 Selecting Output Voltages (Cont) The above voltage sources are not compatible with: • • • Collimator lamps (24 VDC 150 watts). These exceed the 4 Amp rating of the 24 VDC supply. Contact your generator supplier regarding the optional 24VAC / 30VDC room power kit, which may be used for collimators and other room electromechanical devices. Fluorescent lamps. These have high starting currents and generate transients when the tube strikes. Some inductive loads may cause difficulties (for example some motors, under table tube fans, and solenoids). IT IS STRONGLY RECOMMENDED THAT CLAMPING / RECOVERY DIODES BE USED ON INDUCTIVE DEVICES SUCH AS RELAYS ETC WHICH ARE CONNECTED TO THE ROOM INTERFACE BOARD. Voltage selections are made by adding jumper wires from TB11 to TB8, TB9, or TB10, and placing the jumpers on JW1, JW2, JW3, JW4, or JW5 in the live contact position. Review figure 3B-3 for typical examples. Figure 3B-3: Typical jumper arrangement on the room interface board SOME INSTALLATIONS REQUIRE THAT THE OUTPUTS OF RELAYS K1, K2, K3, K4, K6 OR K8 DRIVE THE INPUTS OF OPTO COUPLERS. IN INSTALLATIONS WHERE THESE RELAYS SOURCE 110 OR 220 VAC, THE LEAKAGE CURRENT THROUGH THE R-C SNUBBER ACROSS THE RELAY CONTACTS MAY BE SUFFICIENT TO ENERGIZE THE OPTO COUPLERS WHEN THE RELAYS ARE OPEN. IF THIS IS EXPERIENCED, THE R-C SNUBBER SHOULD BE DISCONNECTED FROM THE CIRCUIT. CUTTING AND REMOVING THE JUMPER WIRES PER THE TABLE ON THE NEXT PAGE WILL DISABLE THE R-C SNUBBER CIRCUIT. THE JUMPER WIRES SHOULD BE CUT AS NEAR AS POSSIBLE TO THE PADS ON THE BOARD, THEN AS MUCH AS IS POSSIBLE OF THE WIRE JUMPER SHOULD BE REMOVED. THIS IS NECESSARY TO WITHSTAND THE OPEN CIRCUIT VOLTAGE ACROSS THE RELAY CONTACTS. Page 3B-8 Rev. J Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-05 CPI Canada Inc. System Interfacing 3B 3B.3.3 Selecting Output Voltages (Cont) IT IS THE RESPONSIBILITY OF THE INSTALLER TO PROVIDE THE PROPER INTERFACING CIRCUITS TO THE OPTO COUPLER(S) IN THESE TYPES OF INSTALLATIONS. For reference, the jumper wire links associated with each of the subject relays is listed below: RELAY K1 K2 K3 K4 K6 K8 JUMPER WIRE JW12 JW9 JW11 JW10 JW14 JW13 3B.3.4 Typical Examples Selected Output Relay Plug and Jumper Wire Jumper K2 (24 VDC) K1 (110 VAC) K4 (24 VDC) K3 (220 VAC) K6 (dry contacts) K12 (24 VDC) K13 (dry contacts) K7 (24 VDC) JW2: Live Contact JW1: Live Contact JW4: Live Contact JW3: Live Contact JW5: Dry Contact JW7: Live Contact 24VDC JW8: Dry Contact JW6: Live Contact 24VDC (K2) TB11 - 5 to TB8 (K1) TB11 - 4 to TB9 (K4) TB11 - 3 to TB8 (K3) TB11 - 2 to TB10 (K6) TB11 - no connection N/A N/A N/A The previous examples will configure the outputs as shown below: • • • • • • • • K2 when selected will provide 24 VDC to a load at TB1 pins 11 and 12. K1 when selected will supply 110 VAC to a load at TB1 pins 1 and 2. K4 when selected will supply 24 VDC to a load at TB2 pins 11 and 12. K3 when selected will supply 220 VAC to a load at TB2 pins 1 and 2. K6 when selected will supply closed contacts at TB3 pins 11 and 12. K12 when selected will supply 24 VDC at TB6 pins 1 and 2. K13 when selected will supply closed contacts at TB6 pins 11 and 12. K7 will supply 24 VDC at TB4 pin 3 for tube 1, or 24 VDC at TB4 pin 2 for tube 2. Ground reference will be at TB4 pin 1. Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-05 Rev. J Page 3B-9 3B System Interfacing CPI Canada Inc. 3B.3.5 Wiring The Room Interface Terminal Plugs Figure 3B-4: Terminal plug • • • • • • • • • • Page 3B-10 Remove the required mating connectors from TB1 to TB6 on the room interface board. Back out the wire retaining screws as required. Dress the interface cable with a minimum of 5 inch (130 mm) flying leads. Strip each wire .25 inches (6 mm). Insert the wire into the plug and tighten the terminal screw. Several wires may be inserted into a single terminal connection. Be sure the plug numbering matches the input/output signals. Insert the plug into the room interface plug as shown in Figure 3B-4. Leave sufficient cable to allow interface access. To eliminate confusion, label each plug. Cover plates are located on the rear access panels to provide strain relief for the interface cables. Holes are provided on the shelf at the back of the cabinet, below the room interface board, for attaching additional strain relief hardware such as “C” or “P” clamps as desired by the installer. Rev. J Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-05 CPI Canada Inc. System Interfacing 3B 3B.4.0 GENERATOR INTERFACE BOARD PROGRAMMING FOR 110/220 VAC The 110/220 VAC supplies available at TB9 and TB10 of the room interface board may be programmed such that: • 110/220 VAC is present at TB9 and TB10 at all times that the generator main disconnect is switched ON. • 110/220 VAC is present at TB9 and TB10 only when the generator itself is switched ON. The desired selection is made using JW1 on the generator interface board. Setting the jumper to JW1 pins 1-2 selects the condition where 110/220 VAC is present at TB9 and TB10 only when the generator is switched ON. Setting the jumper to JW1 pins 2-3 selects 110/220 VAC to be present at TB9 and TB10 at all times that the generator main disconnect is switched ON. Refer to figure 3B-5, this shows the jumper position JW1 pins 1-2 which only provides for 110/220 VAC when the generator is switched ON. Figure 3B-5: 110/220 VAC programming Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-05 Rev. J Page 3B-11 3B System Interfacing CPI Canada Inc. 3B.5.0 TYPICAL R&F ROOM CONNECTIONS Figure 3B-6: Typical R&F room Page 3B-12 Rev. J Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-05 CPI Canada Inc. System Interfacing 3B 3B.6.0 TYPICAL ROOM CABLING AND INTERFACING The following is for reference only and represents a typical R&F procedure room. • Cable assembly #1 1. Bucky 3 select (image receptor). 2. Table stepper input, indicates to the generator that a stepping table has moved to the next step. 3. Tomo Bucky select, usually used to select a tomographic device. • Cable assembly #2 1. Bucky 1 select (image receptor), usually used to select the R&F table Bucky. 2. Collimator interlock, will prevent an exposure if the collimator inputs are not satisfied. 3. Bucky contacts, all Bucky contacts are paralleled at this connector. Diode isolation may be required. 4. Bucky 2 select (image receptor), usually used to select vertical wall Bucky. • Cable assembly #3 1. Collimator bypass. Usually used with the collimator associated with the tomographic device, to allow non-PBL operation in the tomographic mode. 2. Remote tomo select, used for selecting tomography operation from a remote R&F table. 3. Tomo start, will issue a start to sweep signal to a tomographic device. 4. Tomographic exposure; the generator waits for a switch closure during the tomographic sweep. • Cable assembly #4 1. Room light. Provides a closed contact to energize the X-ray room warning light. Maximum 250 watts. 2. Door interlock. Requires a closed dry contact to interlock the generator exposure with the X-ray room’s entrance door. 3. Tube select indicator (source select indicator). Indicates which X-ray tube has been selected. 4. Optional thermal switch inputs. • Cable assembly #5 1. Mag. select. Interfaces with the image intensifier to select the magnification modes. 2. Multiple-spot exposure. When multi-spot operation is selected at the spot film device, (example: 4 on 1) and this input receives a closed dry contact, the AEC calibration will be offset to compensate for the small fields. • Cable assembly #6 1. Interfaces to the table (conventional or remote R&F), the X-ray prep, expose and fluoro footswitch. 2. The I.I. safety position interlock switch, used if the I.I. may be removed from the spot film device. 3. ALE - required if an SFC or a serial changer is used. 4. Spare output. Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-05 Rev. J Page 3B-13 3B System Interfacing CPI Canada Inc. 3B.6.0 TYPICAL ROOM CABLING AND INTERFACING (CONT) Page 3B-14 • Cable assembly #7 1. Must be a #10 AWG (6 mm2) wire or greater, connected from the housing of both X-ray tubes to ground at the high tension transformer. • Cable assemblies #8 1. Pair of H.T. cables from the over table (tube-1) X-ray tube to the HT Transformer. 2. Pair of H.T. cables from the under table (tube-2) X-ray tube to the HT transformer. • Cable assembly #9. 1. Interfaces the ABS signal from the TV camera as either DC proportional or composite video. 2. Interfaces the PMT’s high voltage and signal to the generator, if used. Refer to chapter 3E for details. • Cable assembly #10 1. These cables are usually supplied by the AEC vendor. Be sure these cables are placed away from any electrical noise areas. When interfacing AEC cables be careful not to cause ground loops. Grounding should only be at the AEC board. Refer to chapter 3D for details. • Cable assembly #11 1. This cable is supplied by CPI for the remote fluoro controller interface. • Cable assembly #12 1. This cable is supplied by CPI for the control console interface. • Cable assembly #13 1. Supplied with the optional laptop computer interconnect box. • Cable assembly #14 1. AC mains cable. • Cable assembly #15 1. Cable(s) for digital imaging system. • Cable assembly #16 1. Cable(s) for DAP (Dose Area Product). Rev. J Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-05 CPI Canada Inc. Programming the Generator 3C CHAPTER 3 SECTION 3C PROGRAMMING THE GENERATOR CONTENTS: 3C.1.0 INTRODUCTION ...................................................................................................................................... 3C-2 3C.1.1 Entering Into Programming Mode......................................................................................................... 3C-2 3C.2.0 GENERATOR SETUP MENU .................................................................................................................. 3C-3 3C.3.0 UTILITY MENU......................................................................................................................................... 3C-4 3C.3.1 Setting Time And Date.......................................................................................................................... 3C-4 3C.3.2 Error Log ............................................................................................................................................... 3C-4 3C.3.3 Statistics................................................................................................................................................ 3C-5 3C.3.4 Console................................................................................................................................................. 3C-5 3C.4.0 APR EDITOR............................................................................................................................................ 3C-7 3C.5.0 GENERATOR CONFIGURATION ........................................................................................................... 3C-8 3C.5.1 Tube Selection ...................................................................................................................................... 3C-9 3C.5.2 Generator Limits ................................................................................................................................. 3C-13 3C.5.3 Receptor Setup ................................................................................................................................... 3C-14 3C.5.4 I/O Configuration3C-........................................................................................................................... 3C-19 3C.5.5 AEC Setup .......................................................................................................................................... 3C-22 3C.5.6 AEC Calibration .................................................................................................................................. 3C-23 3C.5.7 Fluoro Setup ....................................................................................................................................... 3C-23 3C.5.8 Tube Calibration ................................................................................................................................. 3C-23 3C.6.0 DAP SETUP ........................................................................................................................................... 3C-23 3C.7.0 DATA LINK ............................................................................................................................................. 3C-23 3C.8.0 CONSOLE TEST MODE........................................................................................................................ 3C-24 Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-05 Rev. H Page 3C-1 3C Programming the Generator CPI Canada Inc. 3C.1.0 INTRODUCTION The generator is programmed using the operator control console (except touch screen, as noted below). All programming menus are displayed on the LCD display window on the console. The ten “soft key” buttons (1 to 10 in the figure below) are used to navigate through the programming screens and to select and enter values in this section. In this section, SELECT means to press the button adjacent to the desired function shown in the LCD display window. When using the touch screen console, the generator must be programmed and calibrated via GenWare®. This requires the GenWare® utility software, a laptop computer (or equivalent), and a null modem cable. The touch screen console setup is performed via the console SYSTEM UTILITIES function. Refer to section 7 of the touch screen operator’s manual for the procedure to access the SYSTEM UTILITIES menu for console setup and the DATA LINK mode in order to communicate with GenWare®. 3C.1.1 Entering Into Programming Mode To enter into the programming mode for the generator follow the steps below. Refer to figure 3C-1 for the button locations referenced in this section. This figure depicts both the 23 X 56 (cm) console, and the 31 X 42 (cm) console. 1 5 2 6 3 7 4 8 9 10 RESET Figure 3C-1: Programming/calibration mode reference Page 3C-2 Rev. H Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-05 CPI Canada Inc. Programming the Generator 3C 3C.1.1 Entering Into Programming Mode (Cont) Step 1. 2. 3. Action Start with the generator switched OFF. While pressing and holding the RESET button, press the generator POWER ON button on the console. Enter the password by pressing the button sequence: [1] - [8] - [4] - [5]. Result The generator will go through its start-up sequence, then display the message ENTER PASSWORD. The GENERATOR SETUP menu will now be displayed as shown in the next section. 3C.2.0 GENERATOR SETUP MENU The GENERATOR SETUP menu presents the user with 5 main options. * GENERATOR SETUP * UTILITY APR EDITOR: DISABLED GEN CONFIGURATION DATA LINK EXIT SETUP The table below shows the functions available within each of the options in the GENERATOR SETUP menu. Select one of these options to access the corresponding function. UTILITY • Set time & date • Error log • Statistics • Console APR EDITOR • Enables / disables changes to APR techniques GEN CONFIGURATION • Tube selection • Generator limits • Receptor setup • I/O configuration • AEC setup • AEC calibration • Fluoro setup • Tube calibration • DAP Setup DATA LINK • Download / upload software via a laptop computer EXIT SETUP • Returns to normal operating mode (non setup / programming mode) Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-05 Rev. H Page 3C-3 3C Programming the Generator CPI Canada Inc. 3C.3.0 UTILITY MENU The UTILITY menu presents the user with 5 options as shown below. * UTILITY * SET TIME & DATE ERROR LOG STATISTICS CONSOLE EXIT 3C.3.1 Setting Time And Date The SET TIME & DATE menu allows changing or setting of the time and date. * SET TIME & DATE * YEAR: 2000 HOUR: 18 MONTH: 9 MIN: 29 DAY: 15 + EXIT Use these steps to set the time and date. Step 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. Action From the UTILITY menu, select SET TIME & DATE. Select YEAR and press the + or - buttons to set the year. Select MONTH and press the + or - buttons to set the month. Select DAY and press the + or - buttons to set the date. Select HOUR and press the + or - buttons to set the hour (in 24 hour format). Select MIN and press the + or - buttons to set the minutes. Select EXIT to return to the UTILITY menu. 3C.3.2 Error Log The ERROR LOG menu allows the display of error messages stored in the generator’s error log. Parameters such as kV, mA, time, receptor, focus, technique selection, field, film screen and fluoro parameters will be displayed simultaneously on the console LED displays. * ERROR LOG * ERROR # 1 OF 18 DATE: 8-19-2000 TIME: 13:09 ERROR CODE: 200 + ERROR MESSAGE: ANODE HEAT WARN EXIT Page 3C-4 Rev. H Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-05 CPI Canada Inc. Programming the Generator 3C 3C.3.2 Error Log (Cont) Use these steps to access the error log. Step 1. 2. 3. Action From the UTILITY menu select ERROR LOG. Select ERROR # and press the + or buttons to scroll through the error log. Result The error code, error message, date and time of the error will be displayed in the LCD window, and the associated parameters will be displayed on the console displays. Select EXIT to return to the UTILITY menu. 3C.3.3 Statistics The STATISTICS menu shows the tube exposure count, accumulated fluoro hours if applicable, and the accumulated generator exposure count. This also allows resetting of select counters. * STATISTICS * TUBE 1 EXP: 500 RESET TUBE 1 EXP TUBE 2 EXP: 600 RESET TUBE 2 EXP FLUORO HOURS: 100 RESET FLUORO HOURS TOTAL EXP: 1100 EXIT Use these steps to access the statistics menu. RAD only or 1 tube generators will show a subset of the above menu items. Step 1. 2. 3. Action From the UTILITY menu select STATISTICS. To reset the tube exposure counter, select RESET TUBE 1 EXP or RESET TUBE 2 EXP. Select RESET FLUORO HOURS to reset the fluoro exposure counter. Select EXIT to return to the UTILITY menu. 3C.3.4 Console The CONSOLE menus allow setting of specific console operating features to suit operator preferences, and also for resetting of the console parameters to the factory defaults (some models). Console utilities screen 2, which includes LOGO, LANGUAGE, and LOAD CONSOLE DEFAULTS selections is only available when running the console software from flash memory on 31 X 42 cm consoles. Otherwise, these selections are made via SW1 on the console as described in chapter 2. CONSOLE utilities screen 1 * CONSOLE * SLOW KEY REPEAT: 200MS MED. KEY REPEAT: 150MS FAST KEY REPEAT: 75MS SPEAKER VOLUME: 15 EXIT Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-05 LCD SCREEN APR MODE: NO + >> Rev. H Page 3C-5 3C Programming the Generator CPI Canada Inc. 3C.3.4 Console (Cont) CONSOLE utilities screen 2 * CONSOLE * LOGO: YES LANGUAGE: ENGLISH LOAD CONSOLE DEFAULTS: NO << Definition of console parameters as used in this section. • SLOW KEY REPEAT Determines the speed at which displays change while the selected key is pressed for the first 5 counts. • MED. KEY REPEAT Determines the speed at which displays change while the selected key is pressed for the next 5 counts. • FAST KEY REPEAT Determines the speed at which displays change while the selected key is pressed after 10 counts. • SPEAKER VOLUME: Sets the speaker volume for the control console in the range 1 to 15. • LCD SCREEN Toggles between normal and reverse video for the LCD display. • APR MODE: NO allows the operator to select an APR view, and still have the ability to manually select receptors, focus, technique, film screen, AEC fields, etc. YES allows the operator to select all of the above EXCEPT the technique selection (AEC, mAs, mA/ms) i.e. this disables the ability to select AEC, mAs, mA/ms in APR mode. AEC, mAs, mA/ms changes can only be made by selecting an APR technique that has been programmed to the desired technique. • YES: The predefined logo is displayed briefly after the generator is switched on. LOGO NO: The logo is not displayed. • LANGUAGE Selects the language for status and error messages (the APR text must be changed via the CPI GenWare® utility software). • LOAD CONSOLE DEFAULTS YES: Initializes the console CPU’s NVRAM to the factory default settings when the generator is switched ON. This restores the factory defaults for the APR and the CONSOLE settings. NO: The NVRAM is not reset when the generator is switched on. The normal setting for this function is NO. Do not set to YES unless you intend to restore the console factory defaults. Page 3C-6 Rev. H Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-05 CPI Canada Inc. Programming the Generator 3C 3C.3.4 Console (Cont) Use these steps to access the CONSOLE menu. Step Action From the UTILITY menu select CONSOLE. This accesses CONSOLE utilities screen 1. Select the desired parameter to change. SLOW, MED, FAST KEY REPEAT and SPEAKER VOLUME are adjusted by pressing the + or - buttons. LCD SCREEN and APR MODE are toggled by pressing the adjacent selection button. Press >> to select CONSOLE utilities screen 2. This is only available on 31 X 42 cm Indico 100 consoles running the console software from flash memory. Refer to the section Console software / EPROM in chapter 6 for details. Select the parameter to be changed. Refer to the previous definitions. Press the selection button for that parameter to toggle the available selections. Select << to return to CONSOLE utilities screen 1. Select EXIT to return to the UTILITY menu. Select EXIT again to return to the GENERATOR SETUP menu. If the console defaults are to be reset, the generator must be switched OFF and then ON again. The console will prompt for a YES or NO to loading defaults when it is powered on again. Select YES to both prompts to reset the console and APR defaults. Selecting NO will not update the defaults. The LOAD CONSOLE DEFAULTS setting automatically resets to NO the next time the generator is switched on. 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 3C.4.0 APR EDITOR The APR EDITOR enables / disables the ability of the operator to make and then save changes to APR techniques. * GENERATOR SETUP * UTILITY APR EDITOR: DISABLED GEN CONFIGURATION DATA LINK EXIT SETUP Two modes of operation are available for the APR EDITOR: • ENABLED Allows the operator to change the default APR technique(s), and then save the changes to memory. The APR will subsequently default to the changed technique. • DISABLED Allows temporary editing of APR technique(s), but does not allow the changes to be saved to memory. The APR will always default to the original technique when the generator is switched OFF and then ON again. The generator stores the last APR editor setting prior to being switched OFF. If the APR editor was previously ENABLED, APR changes may subsequently be made and then saved in normal operating mode without the need to manually set the APR editor to ENABLED. To disable APR technique changes, the APR editor must be set to DISABLED. Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-05 Rev. H Page 3C-7 3C Programming the Generator CPI Canada Inc. 3C.4.0 APR EDITOR (Cont) Use these steps to set the APR EDITOR. Step Action 1. From the GENERATOR SETUP menu select APR EDITOR. 2. Press the APR EDITOR button again to toggle to the desired selection. APR TEXT MAY BE ALTERED BY USING A COMPUTER RUNNING THE CPI GenWare™ UTILITY SOFTWARE. FURTHER DOCUMENTATION REGARDING THIS FUNCTION IS INCLUDED WITH THE SOFTWARE PACKAGE IN THE FORM OF AN MS WORD DOCUMENT. NOTE: 3C.5.0 GENERATOR CONFIGURATION The GEN CONFIGURATION menu presents the user with 9 options as shown below. Select one of these options to access the corresponding menu. * GEN CONFIGURATION * TUBE SELECTION AEC SETUP GENERATOR LIMITS AEC CALIBRATION RECEPTOR SETUP FLUORO SETUP I/O CONFIGURATION TUBE CALIBRATION EXIT >> * * The >> function is only available on generators with the DAP (Dose-Area Product) option. Refer to section 3F for details. Page 3C-8 Rev. H Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-05 CPI Canada Inc. Programming the Generator 3C 3C.5.1 Tube Selection The TUBE SELECTION menus allow the desired tube type to be selected and assigned to TUBE 1 and to TUBE 2 (two tube generators only), and allow setting of the default limits for that tube. This menu will not be displayed on one-tube generators. *TUBE SELECTION * TUBE 1 TUBE 2 EXIT The next menus show the default tube selections. The screens, and the actual tube selections, may not be exactly as shown. A192B 0.6/1.2 A256 0.6/1.0 A292 0.6/1.2 A272 0.3/0.6 EXIT RAD14 RAD21 RAD56 RAD60 0.6/1.2 0.6/1.2 0.6/1.2 0.6/1.2 << DX93HS 0.6/1.5 DX101HS 0.6/1.3 MX75 1.0/2.0 MX100 0.6/1.25 << number of tube selection * TUBE 1 SELECTION * G256 0.6/1.0 G292 0.6/1.2 G1082 0.3/1.0 RAD8 1.0/2.0 >> * TUBE 1 SELECTION * RAD74 0.6/1.5 RAD92 0.6/1.2 DX10HS 0.6/1.0 DX92HS 0.6/1.2 >> * TUBE 1 SELECTION * RO1750 0.6/1.3 >> The following menu is only available if additional tubes have been downloaded via a computer running CPI GenWare™ software. * TUBE 1 SELECTION * ***USER DOWNLOADED TUBES DISPLAYED HERE** << Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual RETURN Ch # 740904-05 Rev. H Page 3C-9 3C Programming the Generator CPI Canada Inc. 3C.5.1 Tube Selection (cont) Use these steps to access the TUBE SELECTION menus. Step 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. Action From the GEN CONFIGURATION menu select TUBE SELECTION. Select TUBE 1 or TUBE 2. This step is not available on one tube generators; go directly to step 3. Select the X-ray tube type to be assigned to that tube location by pressing the button adjacent to the desired selection. Use the >> and << buttons to navigate through the tube selection menus if the desired tube is not displayed on the current screen. Once the desired tube has been selected, parameters for that tube are displayed showing the default values. DO NOT adjust the default values at this time. Additional tube types may be downloaded using the CPI GenWare™ utility software. Refer to section 3C.7.0 DATA LINK. Result The available tubes to choose from will display. This will assign the selected X-ray tube to the desired tube location. See next page for further details. Do not press RETURN or >> until this is requested in a later step. When the desired tube is selected, the default limits are displayed. Please consult the X-ray tube data sheet(s) before making any changes. The dual speed starter operates at 60 or 180 Hz (50 or 150 Hz for some tube types) independent of line frequency. The low speed starter operates at 50 Hz for 50 Hz mains, or 60 Hz for 60 Hz mains. Therefore for generators equipped with the low speed starter, the 60 Hz tube ratings are automatically derated for 50 Hz operation if required. PLEASE DO NOT CHANGE ANY DEFAULTS UNLESS THE IMPACT OF THOSE CHANGES IS CLEARLY UNDERSTOOD. INITIAL CALIBRATION SHOULD BE PERFORMED USING THE DEFAULT VALUES. NOTE: Page 3C-10 BEFORE CHANGING X-RAY TUBE DEFAULT PARAMETERS, PLEASE FILL IN THE X-RAY TUBE AND GENERATOR PARAMETER WORKSHEET. A BLANK FORM THAT SHOULD BE PHOTOCOPIED IS LOCATED IN SECTION 3A 3.0. THIS ALLOWS RECORDING OF THE DEFAULT VALUES AND THE NEW (CHANGED) VALUES. Rev. H Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-05 CPI Canada Inc. Programming the Generator 3C 3C.5.1 Tube Selection (cont) The next three menus show the default tube limits. tube has been selected in the previous steps. *TUBE 1: RAD60 0.6/1.2 12º REV 1.4* TUBE SPEED: DUAL MAX SF KW LS: 21.3 MAX LF KW LS: 58.9 MAX KV: 150 menus appear after a MAX SF KW HS: 35.2 MAX LF KW HS: 99.0 + - RETURN *TUBE 1: RAD60 These >> 0.6/1.2 12º REV 1.4* MAX SF MA: 320 ANODE HU WARNING: 80% ANODE HU LIMIT: 90% + - << >> *TUBE 1: RAD60 SF STANDBY: 2.5A LF STANDBY: 2.5A SF MAX: 5.2A LF MAX: 5.5A << 0.6/1.2 12º REV 1.4* FIL BOOST: 200MS FIL PREHEAT: 800MS + RETURN Definitions of tube limits as used in this section. These settings are tube specific, i.e. tube 1 and tube 2 each have their own tube limit settings. • TUBE SPEED May be altered on dual speed generators. DUAL means that the generator determines whether to use low speed or high speed operation. • MAX SF KW LS Sets the maximum small focus low speed kW limit. • MAX LF KW LS Sets the maximum large focus low speed kW limit. • MAX KV: Sets the maximum kV allowed for that tube. • MAX SF KW HS Sets the maximum small focus high speed kW limit. • MAX LF KW HS: Sets the maximum large focus high speed kW limit. • MAX SF MA Sets the maximum mA in small focus. This should be set as low as possible to preserve the focal spot track wear and focal spot blooming. • ANODE HU WARNING Sets the limit at which the anode heat warning message is displayed. • ANODE HU LIMIT Sets the limit at which exposures will be inhibited. If the present anode heating is under the threshold, the exposure will be inhibited if the next exposure is calculated to exceed the anode HU limit. Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-05 Rev. H Page 3C-11 3C Programming the Generator CPI Canada Inc. 3C.5.1 Tube Selection (cont) • SF STANDBY Sets the small focus standby filament current. The required value should be obtained from the X-ray tube data sheets. • LF STANDBY As above but for large focus. • SF MAX Sets the small focus maximum filament current. • LF MAX As above but for large focus. • FIL BOOST Sets the filament rapid boost duration in order to quickly raise the filament temperature. In installations where a spot film or equivalent device is used, default boost and preheat values may be increased if needed to allow for one second R/F change over time. • FIL PREHEAT The time that the filament is held at the required emission level before an exposure is permitted Typically, the boost time should be between 200 and 250 msec, and the preheat time should be in the range of 700 - 800 ms. If in doubt, monitor the filament feedback and be sure the filament is not being over or under driven during an exposure. Standby current must be below the emission point. If the standby current is too high, the lower fluoro mA values may not calibrate properly resulting in a high mA fault error during fluoro operation. If the maximum filament current is increased, be careful not to exceed the tube manufacturer’s specifications. Use these steps to modify the tube defaults. Step Action 1. Use the >>, <<, and RETURN buttons to navigate through the TUBE DEFAULTS screens. 2. Select the appropriate default value to change. Refer to the definitions on the previous page. 3. Use the + and - buttons to change the selected values. Pressing the TUBE SPEED button toggles the selection between LOW, HIGH and DUAL speed (generators with dual speed starter only). 4. When finished altering the tube default values, press the <<, RETURN or EXIT button(s) as required to return to the TUBE SELECTION menu (two tube generators) or GEN CONFIGURATION menu (one tube generators). 5. Select the second X-ray tube if desired by repeating the previous steps (two tube generators only). PLEASE ENSURE THAT THE SELECTED X-RAY TUBE STATOR(S) ARE COMPATIBLE WITH THE LOW SPEED OR DUAL SPEED STARTER IN YOUR GENERATOR. 6. Select EXIT to return to the GEN CONFIGURATION menu (two tube generators only). Page 3C-12 Rev. H Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-05 CPI Canada Inc. Programming the Generator 3C 3C.5.2 Generator Limits The GENERATOR LIMITS menu allows the setting of generator limits as defined below. * GENERATOR LIMITS* MAX KW: 80 MAX MA: 1000 MIN MA: 10 + MAX MAS 630 EXIT Definitions of generator limits as used in this section. • MAX KW Sets the maximum generator kW limit. • MAX MA Sets the maximum generator mA limit. • MIN MA Sets the minimum generator mA limit. • MAX MAS Sets the maximum generator mAs limit. BEFORE MAKING ANY CHANGES IN THIS SECTION, PLEASE CONSULT THE X-RAY TUBE DATA SHEETS TO ENSURE THAT THE PROPOSED CHANGES DO NOT EXCEED THE MANUFACTURERS RECOMMENDED LIMITS. BEFORE CHANGING GENERATOR LIMITS, PLEASE FILL IN THE X-RAY TUBE AND GENERATOR PARAMETER WORKSHEET. A BLANK FORM THAT SHOULD BE PHOTOCOPIED IS LOCATED IN SECTION 3A 3.0. THIS ALLOWS RECORDING OF THE DEFAULT VALUES AND THE NEW (CHANGED) VALUES. NOTE: Use these steps to set the generator limits. Step 1. 2. 3. 4. Action From the GEN CONFIGURATION menu select GENERATOR LIMITS. Select a limit to be changed. Refer to the previous definitions. Use the + and - buttons to change the selected values. When finished altering the generator default values, press EXIT to return to the GEN CONFIGURATION menu. Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-05 Rev. H Page 3C-13 3C Programming the Generator CPI Canada Inc. 3C.5.3 Receptor Setup The RECEPTOR SETUP menus allow each of the image receptors to be programmed as defined in the table following the example menu screens. Refer to the configuration A or configuration B menu screens, depending on the generator model. MENU 1 (Configuration A) * RECEPTOR SETUP [sym] * TUBE: 1 AEC CHANNEL: 1 TOMO: NO INTERFACE OPTS: 0 FLUORO: NO + SERIAL: NO EXIT >> OR MENU 1 (Configuration B) * RECEPTOR SETUP [sym] * TUBE: 1 INTERFACE OPTS: 0 TOMO: NO FUNCTIONAL OPTS: 0 FLUORO: NO + SERIAL: NO EXIT >> MENU 2 (Configuration A and configuration B) * RECEPTOR SETUP [sym]* RECEPTOR SYM: [sym] MEMORY: DEF FLUORO HANG: 30 SEC REM TOMO BUT: 2000 MS RAD HANG: 0 SEC + LAST IMAGE HOLD: 40 MS << >> MENU 3 (Configuration A) * RECEPTOR SETUP [sym]* SF/LF SWITCH: MAN AEC BACKUP: FIXED AEC BACKUP MAS: 500 AEC BACKUP MS: 3200 DEFAULTS + - << OR MENU 3 (Configuration B) * RECEPTOR SETUP [sym]* SF/LF SWITCH: MAN AEC BACKUP: FIXED AEC BACKUP MAS: 500 AEC BACKUP MS: 3200 DEFAULTS AEC CHANNEL: 1 + - << Page 3C-14 Rev. H Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-05 CPI Canada Inc. Programming the Generator 3C 3C.5.3 Receptor Setup (cont) NOTE: THE DEFAULTS SELECTION IN MENU 3 IS ONLY AVAILABLE IF MEMORY IN MENU 2 WAS SET TO DEF. RECEPTOR MENUS 4 AND 5 BELOW ARE ONLY ACCESSIBLE IF DEFAULTS IS ENABLED. MENU 4 (Configuration A and configuration B) * RECEPTOR SETUP [sym] DEFAULTS* TECHNIQUE: AEC LEFT FIELD: YES FOCUS: SMALL CENTER FIELD: YES FILM SCREEN: 1 RIGHT FIELD: YES << >> MENU 5 (Configuration A and configuration B) * RECEPTOR SETUP [sym] DEFAULTS* KV: 75 MA: 320 MS: 50 DENSITY: 0 + - << Definitions of receptor setup programming as used in this section follow. The selections made when programming a receptor apply to that receptor only. Some of the functions listed are optional. • TUBE Selects the tube assigned to that receptor. Selecting NONE disables that receptor. • TOMO Enables or disables tomographic operation (NO is disabled). • FLUORO Enables or disables fluoroscopic operation (NO is disabled). • SERIAL Allows repeated (serial) X-ray exposures without the need to re-prep after each exposure. Normally used with serial film changers (NO is disabled). • INTERFACE OPTS Selects pre-defined digital interface options: 0 = None. 1 = InfiMed GoldOne. 2 = ATS ESI. 3 = Gilardoni digital pulsed RAD. 4 = Gilardoni digital HCF. 5 = Reserved. 6 = Syracuse Fluorecord. 7 = Camtronics Video plus / Imacom DigiStar. 8 = CMT SmartSpot. 9 = Apelem Paladio. Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-05 Rev. H Page 3C-15 3C Programming the Generator CPI Canada Inc. 3C.5.3 Receptor Setup (cont) • FUNCTIONAL OPTS Selects pre-defined special functional options: 0 = None. 1 = Table stepper function. • RECEPTOR SYM Allows one of the predefined receptor symbols [sym] to be associated with the selected receptor. • FLUORO HANG Sets the time that the rotor will continue spinning after a fluoro exposure has terminated. • RAD HANG Sets the time that the rotor will continue spinning after a rad exposure has terminated. • LAST IMAGE HOLD Sets the time that the exposure will continue after the fluoro footswitch has been released. This enables a frame store device to complete the last image. • MEMORY Defines the techniques that will be defaulted to when a receptor is selected: YES: The selected receptor will remember it’s last techniques such that those techniques are displayed when that receptor is re-selected. NO: The selected receptor will not remember the last techniques used on that receptor. The techniques used will be the same as last used on the previous receptor. DEF: The techniques used for that receptor will be as programmed. See receptor setup menu 4 and 5. • REM TOMO BUT Sets the default tomo backup time when tomo is selected via the REMOTE TOMO SELECT input. • SF/LF SWITCH AUTO: Small or large focus will automatically be selected by the generator, depending on the tube current. MAN: The operator must manually select small/large focus. • AEC BACKUP Defines the AEC backup mode to be used: FIXED: The generator will determine the maximum AEC backup time, not to exceed preset AEC backup mAs/ms values or system limits. The characters AEC will be displayed in the time window of the LED display during AEC operation. MAS: Allows the operator to adjust the AEC backup mAs, not to exceed preset AEC backup mAs/ms values or system limits. The mAs value will be displayed in the time window of the LED display during AEC operation. MS: Allows the operator to adjust the AEC backup ms, not to exceed preset AEC backup mAs/ms values or system limits. The ms value will be displayed in the time window of the LED display during AEC operation. Page 3C-16 • AEC BACKUP MAS Sets the maximum backup mAs, to a limit of 500 mAs (600 mAs for some generator models). • AEC BACKUP MS Sets the maximum back-up ms. Rev. H Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-05 CPI Canada Inc. Programming the Generator 3C 3C.5.3 Receptor Setup (cont) • DEFAULTS This selection is available only if MEMORY was set to DEF in RECEPTOR SETUP menu 2. • AEC CHANNEL Defines which AEC channel will be used by the receptor. This must be set to a valid AEC input channel number, or to 0 as noted below. For example, if using an AEC board with only 3 input channels (channels 1 to 3) then selecting AEC channel 4 will cause an error. Selecting 0 disables AEC operation on that receptor. THE FOLLOWING SELECTIONS ARE ONLY AVAILABLE IF DEFAULTS WAS ENABLED AS PREVIOUSLY DESCRIBED. NOTE: • TECHNIQUE Defines which technique will be defaulted to when a receptor is selected. Options are AEC, MA, MAS. • FOCUS Defines which focus will be defaulted to when a receptor is selected. Options are LARGE or SMALL. • FILM SCREEN Defines which film screen will be defaulted to when a receptor is selected and AEC enabled. Options are film screen 1, 2, or 3. • LEFT FIELD Selects the left field on the AEC device when AEC is selected. • CENTER FIELD As above, but for center field. • RIGHT FIELD As above, but for right field. • KV Selects the default kV value. • MA Selects the default mA value. • MS Selects the default time value. • DENSITY Selects the default density value. IT IS RECOMMENDED THAT THE IMAGE RECEPTOR PROGRAMMING WORKSHEET BE FILLED IN FOR EACH RECEPTOR THAT IS PROGRAMMED. A BLANK FORM THAT SHOULD BE PHOTOCOPIED IS LOCATED IN SECTION 3A 4.0. THIS WILL PROVIDE A RECORD OF THE RECEPTOR SETUP FOR FUTURE REFERENCE. Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-05 Rev. H Page 3C-17 3C Programming the Generator CPI Canada Inc. 3C.5.3 Receptor Setup (cont) If the image receptor defaults are changed, please record the original defaults in a copy of the following table: IMAGE RECEPTOR DEFAULT SETTINGS FUNCTION RECEPTOR 1 RECEPTOR 2 RECEPTOR 3 RECEPTOR 4 RECEPTOR 5 RECEPTOR 6 TECHNIQUE FOCUS FILM SCREEN LEFT FIELD CENTER FIELD RIGHT FIELD KV MA MS DENSITY DO NOT SWITCH OFF THE GENERATOR WHILE IN *RECEPTOR SETUP DEFAULTS* MENUS 4 AND 5. DOING SO WILL CAUSE THE UPDATED RECEPTOR NOTE: SETUP PARAMETERS NOT TO BE SAVED. IT IS RECOMMENDED THAT THE FIRST RECEPTOR PROGRAMMING BE COMPLETED, THE RECEPTOR SETUP MENUS BE EXITED TO THE GEN CONFIGURATION MENU, THEN THE RECEPTOR SETUP MENU BE RESELECTED TO PROGRAM THE NEXT RECEPTOR. THE ABOVE SHOULD BE REPEATED UNTIL ALL RECEPTORS ARE PROGRAMMED. THIS WILL ENSURE THAT THE UPDATED PARAMETERS ARE SAVED. Use these steps to set up the receptor parameters. Step 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. Page 3C-18 Action From the GEN CONFIGURATION menu select RECEPTOR SETUP. Select the desired image receptor to be programmed. Use the << and >> buttons to navigate through the screens. As noted earlier, the RECEPTOR SETUP DEFAULTS menus (if enabled) are accessed by selecting DEFAULTS in screen 3. Select the appropriate parameter to change. Refer to the definitions on the previous pages in this section. Certain selections are toggled (press the selection button again to change the value), other parameters must be selected via the adjacent selection button. The values are then changed using the + and - buttons. When finished setting the parameters and/or defaults for the current receptor, press the << or EXIT button(s) as required to return to the GEN CONFIGURATION menu. Reselect RECEPTOR SETUP, then select the next receptor to be programmed. When finished programming all receptors, return to the GEN CONFIGURATION menu as per step 6. Rev. H Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-05 CPI Canada Inc. Programming the Generator 3C 3C.5.4 I/O Configuration The I/O CONFIGURATION menus allow programming the states of exposure for the inputs and the outputs on the room interface board. * INPUTS [sym] * REMOTE EXP : ...---...---... STANDBY STATE REMOTE PREP: ...---........... REMOTE FL. EXP: .............--CONSOLE EXP: ...---...---... EXIT CONSOLE PREP: TOMO EXP: REM. TOMO SEL.: I/I SAFETY: << COLL. ITLK: BUCKY CONTACTS: SPARE: THERMAL SW 1: << THERMAL SW 2: DOOR ITLK: MULTI SPOT EXP: << BKY 1 SELECT: BKY 2 SELECT: BKY 3 SELECT: TOMO/BKY 4 SEL: << ⇑ >> * INPUTS [sym] * ...---......... ........ ---... ---............ ...---...-----⇑ >> * INPUTS [sym] * ...---...-----.........---... ------...-----------...-----⇑ ⇑ STANDBY STATE >> * OUTPUTS [sym] * --------------------------------------------------------- Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual STANDBY STATE >> * INPUTS [sym] * -----...--------- ...-------............ ⇑ STANDBY STATE STANDBY STATE >> Ch # 740904-05 Rev. H Page 3C-19 3C Programming the Generator CPI Canada Inc. 3C.5.4 I/O Configuration (cont) * OUTPUTS [sym] * ------------------------------------------- TOMO/BKY STRT: ALE: COLL. BYPASS: ⇑ << >> * OUTPUTS [sym] * ----------------------------- ROOM LIGHT: SPARE: ⇑ << STANDBY STATE STANDBY STATE RETURN The STATE button on the upper right hand side of the menu selects the current state. The word STATE will be preceded by the description of the state: for example, STANDBY. The arrow in the lower middle area points to one of the five states described below. Moving to the next state is accomplished by pressing the STATE button. The states are as follows: • STANDBY Sets the state of the I/O when the generator is in standby or idle mode. Standby mode also defines the state when the generator is in fluoroscopic hangover. • PREP Sets the state of the I/O when the generator first enters PREP mode. • GEN RDY Sets the state of the I/O when the generator has completed PREP mode and is ready to expose. • RAD EXP Sets the state of the I/O when the generator starts a radiographic exposure. • FLUORO EXP Sets the state of the I/O when the generator starts a fluoroscopic exposure. Pressing one of the buttons next to the selected function on the left of the display selects that function. The logic level of the selected state is then changed by pressing the selection button again (low = off / inactive, high = on / active). For inputs, a logic “low” means that the input is ignored during that state. A Logic “high” requires that the input be satisfied before the generator will advance to the next state. If multiple inputs are programmed “high”, for example if REMOTE PREP and CONSOLE PREP are both high in the prep state, then both inputs will need to be active before the generator will enter the prep state. Setting an output to logic “low” causes the relay associated with that output to be de-energized during the selected state. Logic “high” will cause the associated relay to be energized during the selected state. Certain functions have states indicated by a dotted line. The dotted line indicates invalid states, which cannot be altered. Only states shown by a solid line can be changed. Refer to figure 3C-2 for examples of a TYPICAL input configuration. Page 3C-20 Rev. H Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-05 CPI Canada Inc. Programming the Generator 3C 3C.5.4 I/O Configuration (cont) 1 2 3 4 5 REMOTE EXP: ... ... ... 1 = STANDBY STATE (cannot be changed) 2 = PREP STATE (shown low/inactive) 3 = GEN RDY STATE (cannot be changed) 4 = RAD EXP STATE (shown high/active) 5 = FLUORO EXP STATE (cannot be changed) FILE: ML_IOSTE.CDR Figure 3C-2: Example of input states IT IS RECOMMENDED THAT THE I/O CONFIGURATION WORKSHEET BE FILLED IN FOR EACH INPUT OR OUTPUT THAT IS PROGRAMMED. A BLANK FORM THAT SHOULD BE PHOTOCOPIED IS LOCATED IN SECTION 3A.5.0. THIS WILL PROVIDE A RECORD OF THE I/O CONFIGURATION FOR FUTURE REFERENCE. NOTE: Use these steps for programming the I/O functions Step 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. 10. Action From the GEN CONFIGURATION menu, select I/O CONFIGURATION. Select the desired receptor to be programmed. Select the desired input(s) or output(s) to program. Use the >>, <<, and RETURN buttons to navigate through the screens. Press the STATE button to cycle through and select the desired state to program. Select the function to be programmed (example REMOTE EXP). Press the selection button again to change the logic level for that state. States with dashed lines (...) CANNOT BE CHANGED. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for each state in the selected I/O function. Repeat steps 3 to 6 for each input or output to be programmed. When finished the I/O programming for the current receptor, press the << or EXIT button(s) as required to return to the GEN CONFIGURATION menu. Reselect I/O CONFIGURATION, then select the next receptor to be programmed. When finished programming all receptors, return to the GEN CONFIGURATION menu as per step 8. Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-05 Rev. H Page 3C-21 3C Programming the Generator CPI Canada Inc. 3C.5.5 AEC Setup The AEC SETUP menu(s) allows the setting of AEC parameters for each AEC channel. MENU 1 (All models) * AEC SETUP* CHANNEL: 1 LEFT FIELD: CENTER FIELD: RIGHT FIELD: EXIT YES YES YES CHAMBER TYPE: FILM SCREEN 1 : FILM SCREEN 2 : FILM SCREEN 3 : >> ION YES YES YES MENU 2 (Some models only). Do not adjust these values at this time. * AEC SETUP* C FIELD COMP: L FIELD COMP: R FIELD COMP: << 0 0 0 + - Definitions of AEC SETUP parameters as used in this section. Some of the functions listed are optional. Page 3C-22 • CHANNEL Selects the AEC channel to be programmed. • LEFT FIELD Enables or disables the left field for the selected AEC channel (NO is disabled). • CENTER FIELD As above but for center field. • RIGHT FIELD As above but for right field. • CHAMBER TYPE Selects ION CHAMBER, S/S (Solid State), or APL (Apelem) chamber for the selected AEC channel. • FILM SCREEN 1 Enables or disables the selection of FILM SCREEN 1 for that AEC channel (NO is disabled). • FILM SCREEN 2 As above, but for film screen 2. • FILM SCREEN 3 As above, but for film screen 2. • R FIELD COMP Allows AEC field matching by setting the output compensation for the right AEC field. • C FIELD COMP As above, but for the center AEC field. • L FIELD COMP As above, but for the left AEC field. Rev. H Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-05 CPI Canada Inc. Programming the Generator 3C 3C.5.5 AEC Setup (Cont) Use these steps to perform the AEC SETUP. Step 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. Action From the GEN CONFIGURATION menu select AEC SETUP. Select the AEC channel to be setup. Pressing the CHANNEL button will scroll through the available AEC channels. Select the desired parameter to change for that AEC channel. DO NOT adjust the R, C, or L field compensation settings at this time (if available); these are part of the AEC calibration procedure. Press the selection button for that parameter to toggle the available selections. Repeat steps 2 to 4 to program each AEC channel. When finished the AEC SETUP, press EXIT to return to the GEN CONFIGURATION menu. 3C.5.6 AEC Calibration For AEC calibration, refer to chapter 3D, AEC CALIBRATION. 3C.5.7 Fluoro Setup For fluoro setup and calibration, refer to chapter 3E, ABS CALIBRATION. 3C.5.8 Tube Calibration Refer to chapter 2, the section TUBE AUTO CALIBRATION. 3C.6.0 DAP SETUP For setup and calibration of the optional DAP (Dose-Area Product) meter, refer to chapter 3F, DAP SETUP AND CALIBRATION. 3C.7.0 DATA LINK Used with the CPI GenWare® utility software. This allows for data communication with a computer in order to download additional tube types, transfer APR data, edit APR text, run the A2EC2 ™ utility, perform setup and calibration functions, and for other minor functions. Further documentation is included with GenWare®. A computer (i.e. laptop) and a 9 pin null modem cable with socket connectors (female) on both ends are required to run this software and interface to the generator. NOTE: The GenWare® program should be closed before exiting the DATA LINK function on the console. Failure to do so may require that the console be switched off and then on again in order to reinitialize communication with the generator. Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-05 Rev. H Page 3C-23 3C Programming the Generator CPI Canada Inc. 3C.8.0 CONSOLE TEST MODE A console diagnostics mode is available in the 31 X 42 (cm) console for Indico 100. This tests the CPU and associated components, the LED’s and display drivers, and the selector buttons and input buffers. This mode is only available with 31 X 42 cm consoles when running the console software from flash memory. Refer to the section Console Software / EPROM in chapter 6 for details. If the console software has been updated and is running from EPROM, the console diagnostics mode will be available by temporarily selecting the FLASH BOOT position as described in chapter 6. If doing so, please ensure that the EPROM BOOT position is selected when finished. • To enter this special mode, press and hold button 5 (figure 3C-1) while pressing the generator POWER ON button. The part number and revision of the boot loader software will be displayed for approximately 5 seconds after power-up. A special utility menu will be entered next, with the following options. • • • CONSOLE TEST This is a basic console diagnostic test, which tests the functions described above. • FLASH LOAD This utility is used to load the operating software into flash memory. DO NOT SELECT THIS OPTION UNLESS YOU INTEND TO REPROGRAM THE FLASH MEMORY. YOU MUST HAVE THE REQUIRED EQUIPMENT AVAILABLE TO DO SO, ALONG WITH UPGRADED CONSOLE SOFTWARE. CONTINUING WILL ERASE THE FLASH MEMORY, DISABLING THE CONSOLE. • MAIN APPLICATION Returns to the normal operating mode (non setup / programming mode). Use these steps to perform the CONSOLE TEST. Step 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. Page 3C-24 Action From the special UTILITY MENU, select CONSOLE TEST. The logo will be displayed for several seconds in normal video, and then in reverse video. The LCD contrast may be adjusted at this time. After the logo display is finished, a prompt is displayed asking if you wish to test the RAM. Press YES or NO to proceed with the RAM test. Testing the RAM by pressing YES will erase the contents of the RAM. If the RAM is erased, you will need to restore the console defaults, and use GenWare® to restore the APR data. At the prompt ARE YOU DOING ESS?, press NO. A serial loop back test is performed next. Pressing START to test ch. A will test serial channel A (the port connected to J5, the generator interface). Testing serial channel B (the port connected to J2, the data link) requires a special loop back connector. This may be made by simply connecting a wire jumper from pin 2 to pin 3 of a 9 pin female “D” connector. Plug this “loop back” connector into J2 on the console for this test. Press START if using a loop back connector. Press SKIP to omit this test if a loop back connector is not available. The 7 segment LEDs in the radiographic and fluoroscopic display window are tested next. The individual segments of the first LED will be lit in sequence. Confirm that only one segment lights at one time on the LED being tested. If all segments plus the decimal point light sequentially on the first LED being tested, press PASSED to test the next LED. Repeat step 7 to test all 7 segment LEDs. Rev. H Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-05 CPI Canada Inc. Programming the Generator 3C 3C.8.0 CONSOLE TEST MODE (Cont) 9. 10. 11. 12. 13. 14. 15. 16. 17. 18. 19. 20. 21. 22. The backlight LEDs for the radiographic kV, mAs, mA, etc indicators are lit next. The term “EYE” on the LCD display refers to the X-ray exposure indicator, which should light during this sequence. Press PASSED when finished this test. The backlight LEDs for the fluoroscopic ABS, kV, mA, etc indicators are lit next. The term “REMOTE” on the LCD display refers to the optional remote fluoro control, which is also tested at this time, if fitted. Press PASSED when finished this test. The image receptor LEDs and the prep LED are tested next. Press PASSED when finished this test. The technique selector LEDs, focus, and film screen LEDs are tested next. Press PASSED when finished this test. The fluoro magnification, dose, ABS, pulsed fluoro, fluoro exposure, and AEC field select LEDs are tested next. Press PASSED when finished this test. All LEDs and displays are lit next. Press YES or NO when finished this test. All LEDs and displays are turned off next. Press YES or NO when finished this test. The buttons on the console are tested next. Press each button as prompted. The external prep and external X-ray buttons (hand switch) are tested next. Press the hand switch as requested. If no hand switch is used, the console prep and X-ray button may be pressed at the “external” prep and exposure prompt. The fluoro foot switch is tested next. Press the foot switch if applicable, press SKIP if a foot switch is not used. The console prep and X-ray buttons are tested next. Press each button as prompted. Speaker 1 is tested next. The speaker volume will continuously be ramped from 1 (low) to 8 (maximum). Press PASSED when finished this test. Speaker 2 is tested next. The speaker volume will continuously be ramped from 1 (low) to 8 (maximum). Press PASSED when finished this test. This completes the console self test. Note any tests that failed, and discontinue use of the suspected faulty equipment until repairs are made. Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-05 Rev. H Page 3C-25 3C Programming the Generator CPI Canada Inc. (This page intentionally left blank) Page 3C-26 Rev. H Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-05 CPI Canada Inc. AEC Calibration 3D CHAPTER 3 SECTION 3D AEC CALIBRATION CONTENTS: 3D.1.0 INTRODUCTION..............................................................................................................................................3D-2 3D.1.1 AEC Limitations: Minimum Response Time ................................................................................................3D-3 3D.1.2 AEC Limitations: Maximum Exposure Times ..............................................................................................3D-4 3D.1.3 Film/Screen Response vs. kVp....................................................................................................................3D-5 3D.1.4 AEC Calibration Range ................................................................................................................................3D-6 3D.1.5 Multiple Spot Compensation ........................................................................................................................3D-7 3D.2.0 PRECALIBRATION SETUP ............................................................................................................................3D-8 3D.2.1 AEC Setup Worksheet .................................................................................................................................3D-8 3D.2.2 AEC Precalibration Checks........................................................................................................................3D-10 3D.2.3 AEC Chamber Installation ..........................................................................................................................3D-10 3D.2.4 AEC Pickup Connections (Overview) ........................................................................................................3D-12 3D.2.5 AEC Board (Solid State Chambers)...........................................................................................................3D-13 3D.2.6 AEC Board (Ion Chambers) .......................................................................................................................3D-15 3D.2.7 AEC Board (Universal AEC Board) ...........................................................................................................3D-17 3D.2.8 AEC Board (Universal AEC Board With Short AEC Time Compensation) ..............................................3D-19 3D.3.0 PRECALIBRATION NOTES: .........................................................................................................................3D-21 3D.4.0 AEC USING A PMT........................................................................................................................................3D-22 3D.5.0 AEC FIELD BALANCE...................................................................................................................................3D-23 3D.6.0 AEC CALIBRATION (TABLE BUCKY)..........................................................................................................3D-23 3D.6.1 Break point calibration worksheet ..............................................................................................................3D-28 3D.7.0 SHORT AEC TIME COMPENSATION (IF APPLICABLE) ...........................................................................3D-30 3D.8.0 AEC DENSITY CALIBRATION......................................................................................................................3D-31 3D.9.0 RLF COMPENSATION ..................................................................................................................................3D-35 3D.10.0 MULTIPLE SPOT COMPENSATION..........................................................................................................3D-38 3D.11.0 AEC CALIBRATION (WALL BUCKY) .........................................................................................................3D-40 3D.12.0 AEC CALIBRATION (AUX, SFD, ETC).......................................................................................................3D-43 Millenia / Indico 100 / CMP 200 Service Manual Ch # 740904-06 Rev. J Page 3D-1 3D AEC Calibration CPI Canada Inc. 3D.1.0 INTRODUCTION This section covers interfacing and calibration of the various AEC board assemblies that are used in Millenia and Indico 100 X-ray generators for ion chambers, solid state chambers, or PMT pickups; and in CMP 200 X-ray generators for ion and solid state chambers. THE GENERATOR IS FACTORY CONFIGURED FOR SPECIFIC AEC DEVICE(S). REFER TO THE COMPATIBILITY STATEMENT / PRODUCT DESCRIPTION IN CHAPTER 1D (MILLENIA AND INDICO 100), OR CHAPTER 1 (CMP 200) FOR THE FACTORY CONFIGURED AEC COMPATIBILITY OF THIS GENERATOR. The introduction in this section contains background information relevant to AEC operation. It is strongly suggested that this be read and understood prior to beginning AEC calibration. AEC calibration requires that a calibration curve be established which relates optical density to various kV breakpoints. The 75 kV knee breakpoint is calibrated at the slowest film screen combination. The remaining kV breakpoints are calibrated next, then the breakpoint calibration is repeated at the next highest film speed, with the highest film speed being calibrated last. After breakpoint calibration, ± density setup is done at the slowest film speed, and then RLF compensation and multiple spot compensation are done if desired. Page 3D-2 Rev. J Millenia / Indico 100 / CMP 200 Service Manual Ch # 740904-06 CPI Canada Inc. AEC Calibration 3D 3D.1.1 AEC Limitations: Minimum Response Time The X-ray generator (including the AEC pickup chamber) has a minimum response time from start of the exposure command to a kV value sufficient to start X-rays. There is a further delay to the start of current flow from the AEC device. Likewise, there is a minimum response time from when the AEC stop command is issued to when the kV has actually decreased to the point that X-rays are no longer produced. Figure 3D-1 depicts this graphically. Figure 3D-1: Relative timing of AEC ramp vs exposure command and kVp • 1 to 2 is the time from the exposure start command to kVp start. Time = 1 to 3 ms. • 2 to 3 is the reaction time of the solid state / ion chamber to start a current flow. Time = 1 to 3 ms. • 3 to 4 is the required exposure time. • 4 is the AEC stop command from the generator AEC circuits. • 4 to 5 is the generator shut down time including cable discharge time etc. Time = 1.5 to 3.0 ms. • 1 to 6 is the total time the exposure switch is activated. • FOR AEC BOARDS WITH SHORT AEC TIME COMPENSATION (FIGURE 3D-9 AND 3D-11) AEC TECHNIQUES SHOULD HAVE MINIMUM EXPOSURE TIMES GREATER THAN 5 MS. FOR ALL OTHER AEC BOARDS MINIMUM EXPOSURE TIMES SHOULD BE GREATER THAN 15 MS. Millenia / Indico 100 / CMP 200 Service Manual Ch # 740904-06 Rev. J Page 3D-3 3D AEC Calibration CPI Canada Inc. 3D.1.2 AEC Limitations: Maximum Exposure Times AEC exposures should normally be kept well under one second. When X-ray techniques are used that result in longer exposures, the film density will not be correct due to failure of reciprocity of the film. RLF (reciprocity law failure) compensation is provided to compensate for longer AEC exposure times. An offset may be added to each AEC calibration set (each film screen combination) to increase the AEC ON time as exposure time increases. RLF compensation is applied to the following range of times: • • • 50 ms to 500 ms. 500 ms to 1000 ms. 1000 ms and above. Care must be exercised when using table buckys with low kV values because most tabletops and grids absorb considerable radiation in the range of 60 - 65 kVp. This will adversely affect AEC operation. Figure 3D-2 shows the effect of kVp, optical density, and radiation. Note particularly the nonlinear change in density at 85-90 kVp. Figure 3D-2: kVp vs. optical density vs. dose Page 3D-4 Rev. J Millenia / Indico 100 / CMP 200 Service Manual Ch # 740904-06 CPI Canada Inc. AEC Calibration 3D 3D.1.3 Film/Screen Response vs. kVp Film screen response to kVp is not linear; therefore compensation must be provided in order to maintain constant film density as kVp is changed for different anatomical studies. By selecting and calibrating various kV breakpoints, the overall system response will be compensated such as to yield a constant film density. Up to eight breakpoints per film screen combination are available. The eight breakpoints are spread over three kV ranges as shown below: • • • Low kV: Knee kV: High kV: 50, 55, 65 kV 75 kV 85, 95, 110, 130 kV. Refer to figure 3D-3. Figure 3D-3: kV breakpoints vs relative density Millenia / Indico 100 / CMP 200 Service Manual Ch # 740904-06 Rev. J Page 3D-5 3D AEC Calibration CPI Canada Inc. 3D.1.4 AEC Calibration Range Since the Millenia and Indico 100 family of generators allow for up to three separate film screen combinations to be calibrated, the following points must be considered: • The AEC board allows for a 0 to a maximum of 10 volt ramp at the comparator input. All AEC signals must fit within this range (for all film / screens, densities, and techniques). • Most X-ray applications require the use of two or more different film screen combinations, all of which will require different exposure doses. • Using the slowest film screen combination, the required film input dose will be determined. • Once this value is determined (during AEC calibration), the density calibration is performed to allow 100% (double the dose) and 50% (half the dose) values. These are typical values, and will determine the maximum required range of the AEC reference voltage (the output from the D/A converter). • Figure 3D-4 illustrates the different windows required for various film screen combinations. Figure 3D-4: Film/screen speed vs. D/A output Page 3D-6 Rev. J Millenia / Indico 100 / CMP 200 Service Manual Ch # 740904-06 CPI Canada Inc. AEC Calibration 3D 3D.1.5 Multiple Spot Compensation Separate density compensation is provided when a SFD (Spot Film Device) is used for multiple film splits. This allows compensation when the SFD diaphragm is in the X-ray field. An external output from the SFD must be provided when multiple spots are requested to enable this function. 3D.1.6 A Typical R&F Room Figure 3D-5 shows source-image distances and image receptors as used in a typical R&F installation. Figure 3D-5: Typical R&F installation Millenia / Indico 100 / CMP 200 Service Manual Ch # 740904-06 Rev. J Page 3D-7 3D AEC Calibration CPI Canada Inc. 3D.2.0 PRECALIBRATION SETUP 3D.2.1 AEC Setup Worksheet Before continuing, it is suggested that a copy of the table below be filled in with all required information. Refer to the example AEC setup worksheet on the next page. FUNCTION Film/Screen RECEPTOR 1 RECEPTOR 2 RECEPTOR 3 RECEPTOR 4 1. 2. 3. Nominal optical density: Grid ratio/SID: Min - max kVp range: ± Density steps Density dose change (per step) +%: -%: Chamber type: Regulatory AEC dose requirements? Is film processing maintained? Assigned receptor name: Are all cassettes similar? Additional notes: Additional notes: Table 3D-1: AEC setup worksheet ALL RECEPTORS MUST HAVE THE SAME NUMBER OF DENSITY STEPS AND THE SAME DENSITY DOSE CHANGE PER STEP (DENSITY SETTINGS ARE COMMON TO ALL FILM SCREENS AND RECEPTORS). Page 3D-8 Rev. J Millenia / Indico 100 / CMP 200 Service Manual Ch # 740904-06 CPI Canada Inc. AEC Calibration 3D 3D.2.1 AEC Setup Worksheet (Cont) Note: The example below is supplied for reference only. It does not represent an actual installation. FUNCTION Film/Screen RECEPTOR 1 RECEPTOR 2 RECEPTOR 3 Lanex/reg RECEPTOR 4 1. Lanex/reg Lanex/reg PMT/I.I. 2. Lanex/med Lanex/chest Nominal optical density: 1.2 1.1 1.4 Grid ratio/SID: 12:1 8:1 10:1 10:1 Min - max kVp range: 60 - 120 65 - 140 80 - 110 70 - 120 ± Density steps ±8 ±8 ±8 ±8 +%: 12.5 12.5 12.5 12.5 -%: 6.25 6.25 6.25 6.25 Chamber type: Ion Solid state Ion PMT Regulatory AEC dose requirements? Yes Yes Yes Yes Is film processing maintained? Yes Yes Yes Yes Assigned receptor name: Table Wall SFD Digital Are all cassettes similar? Yes Yes Yes N/A 3. Density dose change (per step) Additional notes: Additional notes: Table 3D-2: Sample AEC setup worksheet Millenia / Indico 100 / CMP 200 Service Manual Ch # 740904-06 Rev. J Page 3D-9 3D AEC Calibration CPI Canada Inc. 3D.2.2 AEC Precalibration Checks It is recommended that a copy of the form below be filled in with the required information before attempting AEC calibration. 1. Verify that the AEC chambers are mounted correctly in the Bucky or spot film device. Note that some chamber types must be physically isolated from equipment ground, refer to figure 3D-6 as an example. CHECK: 2. Verify that each AEC chamber / pickup is properly connected to its intended input channel on the AEC board. CHECK: Refer to AEC board pictorials, figure 3D-8 to 3D11 for input channel designations 3. Make and type of AEC chamber/pickup: AEC Ch 1_____________________________ AEC Ch 2_____________________________ AEC Ch 3_____________________________ AEC Ch 4_____________________________ 4. Verify signal grounding for the AEC chamber. The only electrical ground should be at the AEC board in the generator. This applies to the ground braid (shield) for the AEC signal cable and to the ground return conductor(s) in the AEC signal cable. CHECK: 5. Verify that the AEC board is fully inserted into the mating edge connector (if applicable), that all connections to the AEC board are secure, and that the AEC board is securely fastened. CHECK: 6. Before calibrating, verify that the AEC system is functioning. This includes the AEC chambers / devices and the AEC circuits in the generator. Each of the fields on the AEC device must be able to terminate the exposure. CHECK: 7. Radiographic techniques to be performed with the equipment (high kV chest, G.I. studies etc)? 8. Normal exposure factors used by the customer (typical mAs / kV range)? Table 3D-3: Precalibration checklist 3D.2.3 AEC Chamber Installation Figure 3D-6 shows an installed AEC chamber. Note particularly the use of a suitable insulating material to isolate the body of the chamber from the receptor ground. This is required for non-insulated AEC chambers. Page 3D-10 Rev. J Millenia / Indico 100 / CMP 200 Service Manual Ch # 740904-06 CPI Canada Inc. AEC Calibration 3D 3D.2.3 AEC Chamber Installation (Cont) Figure 3D-6: AEC chamber installation Millenia / Indico 100 / CMP 200 Service Manual Ch # 740904-06 Rev. J Page 3D-11 3D AEC Calibration CPI Canada Inc. 3D.2.4 AEC Pickup Connections (Overview) Review the applicable sections of chapter 3 section B and C for interfacing AEC devices and programming the image receptors to select the correct AEC device (or no AEC if desired). It should be ensured that each receptor used for AEC has a Bucky or equivalent. A typical R&F room configuration will consist of the following: • • • • Table Bucky Wall Bucky Spot film Bucky Aux - digital acquisition Refer to Figure 3D-7 for typical AEC connections. This is a simplified view only, refer to figures 3D-8 to 3D11 for AEC board layouts used in Millenia and Indico 100 generators. Refer to chapter 1E for the AEC board location in your generator. Figure 3D-7: AEC pickup connections Page 3D-12 Rev. J Millenia / Indico 100 / CMP 200 Service Manual Ch # 740904-06 CPI Canada Inc. AEC Calibration 3D 3D.2.5 AEC Board (Solid State Chambers) The AEC board shown below is compatible with various makes / models of solid state chambers (i.e. Comet, Ziehm, Gilardoni). This AEC board is used in various models of generators requiring those AEC chamber types. This board will be fitted with 6 pin circular connectors (J1 to J4) or with 5 pin in-line connectors (J11 to J14), depending on the application. Figure 3D-8: Dedicated solid state AEC board AEC board input assignment: • • • • Ch 1 = J1 / J11 - Table Radiographic Bucky. Ch 2 = J2 / J12 - Vertical Wall Bucky. Ch 3 = J3 / J13 - Spot Film Device Ch 4 = J4 / J14 - Aux. (Extra Bucky, Digital Acquisition, etc.) The following potentiometers are used for AEC gain adjustment: • • • • R1 is used for channel 1 gain adjustment. R2 is used for channel 2 gain adjustment. R3 is used for channel 3 gain adjustment. R4 is used for channel 4 gain adjustment. Millenia / Indico 100 / CMP 200 Service Manual Ch # 740904-06 Rev. J Page 3D-13 3D AEC Calibration CPI Canada Inc. 3D.2.5 AEC Board (Solid State Chambers) Cont The following tables show the pin outs for both the 6 pin circular connectors and for the 5 pin in-line connectors on the AEC board in figure 3D-8. FUNCTION Anode Anode Anode Cathode, left Cathode, right Cathode, middle Ground PIN 1 NOTE: PINS 1, 2, AND 3 ON THE 2 CIRCULAR CONNECTOR ARE 3 ALL CONNECTED IN PARALLEL. 4 5 6 Connector shell Table 3D-4: Pin outs for 6 pin circular connector FUNCTION Anode Cathode, left Cathode, right Cathode, middle Ground PIN 2 3 5 4 1 Table 3D-5: Pin outs for 5 pin in-line connector If the AEC input signal has excessive electrical noise superimposed on the signal, it is suggested that jumpers JW1 to JW4 as appropriate be temporarily installed. If this improves the signal to noise ratio, the jumper(s) should be left in. Excessive signal to noise ratio generally shows up as inconsistent AEC exposure times at low mAs values. It is the responsibility of the installer to determine the need for these jumper(s). Page 3D-14 Rev. J Millenia / Indico 100 / CMP 200 Service Manual Ch # 740904-06 CPI Canada Inc. AEC Calibration 3D 3D.2.6 AEC Board (Ion Chambers) The AEC board shown below is compatible with various makes / models of ion chambers (i.e. AID, GE, Vacutec, Philips Amplimat, etc). This AEC board is used in various models of generators requiring those AEC chamber types. This board will be fitted with 9 pin D connectors (J11 to J14), or with 12 pin in-line connectors (J1 to J4), depending on the application. CPI CANADA INC Made in Canada AEC DEDICATED ION CHAMBER R79 J14 J5 JW2 JW1 J4 J13 JW4 JW3 J3 J12 JW6 JW5 J2 J11 R11 R12 R13 R14 JW8 JW7 R1 J1 R2 R3 R4 ML_IONBD.CDR Figure 3D-9: Dedicated ion chamber AEC board AEC board input assignment: • • • • Ch 1 = J1 / J11 - Table Radiographic Bucky. Ch 2 = J2 / J12 - Vertical Wall Bucky. Ch 3 = J3 / J13 - Spot Film Device Ch 4 = J4 / J14 - Aux. (Extra Bucky, Digital Acquisition, etc.) The following potentiometers are used for AEC gain adjustment: • • • • R1 is used for channel 1 gain adjustment. R2 is used for channel 2 gain adjustment. R3 is used for channel 3 gain adjustment. R4 is used for channel 4 gain adjustment. Millenia / Indico 100 / CMP 200 Service Manual Ch # 740904-06 Rev. J Page 3D-15 3D AEC Calibration CPI Canada Inc. 3D.2.6 AEC Board (Ion Chambers) Cont The following potentiometers are used for short AEC exposure time compensation: • • • • R11 is used for channel 1 short exposure time compensation. R12 is used for channel 2 short exposure time compensation. R13 is used for channel 3 short exposure time compensation. R14 is used for channel 4 short exposure time compensation. R79 adjusts the output of the high voltage bias supply. This is only fitted on versions of this board intended for use with ion chambers that require a separate high voltage bias supply. R79 adjusts the value of the +300 / +500 VDC, and the +45 VDC outputs, and should be set as per the ion chamber manufacturer specifications. The following tables show the pin outs for both the 9 pin D connectors and for the 12 pin in-line connectors on the AEC board in figure 3D-9. The 9 pin connectors are compatible with most models of AID ionization chambers. However, the installer should verify compatibility of the pin outs with the chamber(s) being used. FUNCTION +300 VDC output PIN 1 Left / right field select Middle field select Start command output Signal input Right / left field select -12 VDC output +12 VDC output Ground 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 NOTE Only provided on configurations of this board that require the +300 VDC output. See note below. See note below. Table 3D-6: Pin outs for 9 pin D connector NOTE: Jumpers JW1 to JW8 swap the left and right fields on J11 to J14. Jumpering pins 2-3 of the field selector jumpers (JW7 / JW8 for channel 1, JW5 / JW6 for channel 2, JW3 / JW4 for channel 3, JW1 / JW2 for channel 4) connects the right field select signal to pin 6 and the left field select signal to pin 2. Jumpering pins 1-2 of the field selector jumpers connects the right field select signal to pin 2 and the left field select signal to pin 6. FUNCTION +500 VDC output + or - 300 VDC output +45 VDC output +12 VDC output -12 VDC output -24 VDC output Ground Start command output Left field select Middle field select Right field select Signal input PIN 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 NOTE The +500, + or -300, and +45 VDC outputs are only provided on configurations of this board designed to interface to ion chambers requiring these voltage outputs. +12, -12, -24 VDC outputs are typically used as the DC supply for a pre-amplifier, often part of the ion chamber. -24 VDC is not available on CMP 200. Table 3D-7: Pin outs for 12 pin in-line connector Page 3D-16 Rev. J Millenia / Indico 100 / CMP 200 Service Manual Ch # 740904-06 CPI Canada Inc. AEC Calibration 3D 3D.2.7 AEC Board (Universal AEC Board) The AEC board shown below is factory configured to be compatible with most makes / models of AEC chambers (ion and solid state) on the market. This assembly also contains a low current, high voltage supply for a photo multiplier tube (PMT). The PMT supply is located on the upper board, which also contains the connectors to interface to the AEC pickup device(s). Figure 3D-10: Universal AEC board AEC board input / output assignment: • • • • • Ch 1 = J1 - Table Radiographic Bucky. Ch 2 = J2 - Vertical Wall Bucky. Ch 3 = J3 - Spot Film Device. Ch 4 = J4 - Aux. (Extra Bucky, Digital Acquisition, etc.). J7 = High voltage output for the PMT (if used) The following potentiometers are used for AEC gain adjustment: • • • • R1 is used for channel 1 gain adjustment. R26 is used for channel 2 gain adjustment. R27 is used for channel 3 gain adjustment. R28 is used for channel 4 gain adjustment. Refer to the end of subsection 3D.2.7 for the procedure for adjusting R10, R19, and R24. Millenia / Indico 100 / CMP 200 Service Manual Ch # 740904-06 Rev. J Page 3D-17 3D AEC Calibration CPI Canada Inc. 3D.2.7 AEC Board (Universal AEC Board) Cont The following table shows the pin outs for the 12 pin connectors J1 to J4 on the AEC board in figure 3D-10 and 3D-11. The pins on J7 are all connected in parallel, thus the PMT high voltage may be taken from any of the pins on that connector. The connections to the AEC pickup chamber vary considerably between ion chambers and solid state chambers. For clarity two tables are shown below, the first for ion chambers and the second for solid state chambers. FUNCTION +500 VDC output +300 VDC output +50 VDC output +12 VDC output -12 VDC output -24 VDC output Ground Start command output Left field select Middle field select Right field select Signal input PIN 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 NOTE +500, +300, +50 VDC outputs are provided for ion chamber use if required. +12, -12, -24 VDC outputs are typically used as the DC supply for a pre-amplifier, often part of the ion chamber. The start command, and left, middle, right field select outputs are jumper configured to be active high or active low as per the AEC chamber requirements. The signal input is jumper configured to accept a positive going or negative going ramp or DC signal as per the AEC chamber output. Table 3D-8: Ion chamber connections FUNCTION +500 VDC output +300 VDC output +50 VDC output +12 VDC output -12 VDC output -24 VDC output Ground Start Left Middle Right Signal input PIN 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 NOTE Not used for solid state AEC chambers Not used for solid state AEC chambers Not used for solid state AEC chambers Not used for solid state AEC chambers Not used for solid state AEC chambers Not used for solid state AEC chambers Connect pin 8 to pin 7 (ground). Connect the common anodes for left, middle, right to pin 8. Connect cathode (left) to LEFT, cathode middle to MIDDLE, and cathode right to RIGHT. Cable shield (if used) connects to pin 8. Not used for solid state AEC chambers Table 3D-9: Solid state chamber connections Page 3D-18 Rev. J Millenia / Indico 100 / CMP 200 Service Manual Ch # 740904-06 CPI Canada Inc. AEC Calibration 3D 3D.2.7 AEC Board (Universal AEC Board) Cont R10, R19 and R24 adjust the output voltage from the high voltage power supply on the AEC interface board (the upper board on the universal AEC board assembly in figure 3D-10 and 3D-11). This high voltage supply generates the PMT high voltage, up to approximately -1000 VDC available at J7, and also the nominal +500, +300 and +50 VDC supplies noted in table 3D-8. The +500, +300 and +50 VDC supplies are available to bias ion chambers if needed and are adjustable as defined below. These potentiometers are switched into the circuit electronically by logic circuits connected to the AEC channel select commands. Only one potentiometer will be active at any given time, the condition under which each potentiometer is active is described below, along with the function of that potentiometer. • R10 adjusts the high voltage supply output for the PMT when ABS operation is selected. This is described in chapter 3E. • R24 adjusts the high voltage supply output when AEC channel 1, 2, or 3 is selected. AEC channels 1, 2, 3 are normally used with an AEC chamber. R24 will be used to adjust the +500, +300 and +50 VDC bias voltage outputs if required for ion chamber(s) connected to AEC channels 1, 2 or 3. Refer to the AEC chamber manufacturers recommendations to adjust this voltage. • R19 adjusts the high voltage supply output when AEC channel 4 is selected. AEC channel 4 is normally used for digital acquisition or spot film work using a PMT pickup for AEC control. This will typically be the same PMT used for ABS control during fluoroscopy operation. Refer to 3D.4.0 for further details if using a PMT for AEC control on AEC channel 4. 3D.2.8 AEC Board (Universal AEC Board With Short AEC Time Compensation) The AEC board shown below has short AEC time compensation, and is factory configured to be compatible with most makes / models of AEC chambers (ion and solid state) on the market. This assembly also contains a low current, high voltage supply for a photo multiplier tube (PMT). The PMT supply is located on the upper board, which also contains the connectors to interface to the AEC pickup device(s). Figure 3D-11: Universal AEC board with short AEC time compensation Millenia / Indico 100 / CMP 200 Service Manual Ch # 740904-06 Rev. J Page 3D-19 3D AEC Calibration CPI Canada Inc. 3D.2.8 AEC Board (Universal AEC Board With Short AEC Time Compensation) Cont In order to clearly show the adjustment pots on the lower (AEC) board, the upper board which contains the AEC and PMT interface connectors and the high voltage supply is shown shifted from its actual position. AEC board input / output assignment: • • • • • Ch 1 = J1 - Table Radiographic Bucky. Ch 2 = J2 - Vertical Wall Bucky. Ch 3 = J3 - Spot Film Device. Ch 4 = J4 - Aux. (Extra Bucky, Digital Acquisition, etc.). J7 = High voltage output for the PMT (if used) The following potentiometers are used for AEC gain adjustment: • • • • R1 is used for channel 1 gain adjustment. R2 is used for channel 2 gain adjustment. R3 is used for channel 3 gain adjustment. R4 is used for channel 4 gain adjustment. The following potentiometers are used for short AEC exposure time compensation: • • • • R91 is used for channel 1 short exposure time compensation. R92 is used for channel 2 short exposure time compensation. R93 is used for channel 3 short exposure time compensation. R94 is used for channel 4 short exposure time compensation. Refer to tables 3D-8 and 3D-9 for the connector pin outs. Refer to the end of subsection 3D.2.7 for the procedure for adjusting R10, R19, and R24. Page 3D-20 Rev. J Millenia / Indico 100 / CMP 200 Service Manual Ch # 740904-06 CPI Canada Inc. AEC Calibration 3D 3D.3.0 PRECALIBRATION NOTES: This section contains information that must be understood and confirmed prior to and / or during AEC calibration. CAUTION: THE PROCEDURES IN THESE SECTIONS REQUIRE X-RAY EXPOSURES. TAKE ALL SAFETY PRECAUTIONS TO PROTECT PERSONNEL FROM X-RADIATION. SHOULD AN IMPROPER TECHNIQUE BE SELECTED, OR AN AEC FAULT OCCUR CAUSING NO AEC FEEDBACK SIGNAL TO THE GENERATOR, THE EXPOSURE WILL TERMINATE IF THE RAMP VOLTAGE FAILS TO REACH 4% OF THE EXPECTED RAMP VOLTAGE WHEN THE EXPOSURE TIME REACHES 20% OF THE SELECTED BACK UP TIME. • When using PMTs or photo diodes for AEC from the output of an image intensifier, there is normally no need to iterate all the kV break points. It is usually sufficient to use the 75 kV breakpoint calibration value for that film screen at all kV breakpoints. If doing this, the calibration values should be confirmed at all kV breakpoints using the acquired digital images. • During AEC calibration, all AEC exposures should be done using mA values such that the exposures are in the 30 to 100 ms range UNLESS STATED OTHERWISE. • During AEC calibration, always ensure that the central ray is centered relative to the image receptor. • Prior to placing the absorbers, ensure that the collimator is opened sufficiently to irradiate ALL fields on the AEC pickup device. • The recommended absorber in table 3D-12 is water. This should be in a plastic container of uniform thickness. Lexan of a similar thickness is also a suitable absorber. • Ensure that the absorber is positioned to fully cover the X-ray field. The absorber must extend a minimum of 3/8 in. (10 mm) beyond the X-ray field. • All components and assemblies used during AEC calibration must be those that will be used during procedures, and must be positioned as they will be in actual use of the X-ray room. • The generator must be known to be calibrated before proceeding. • During AEC calibration, if exposure times do not change if the mA is varied, it may be that the input signal level to the AEC board may be too high. If this is experienced, check the ramp voltage at the output of the first gain stage (the first operational amplifier output) on the AEC board for the subject AEC channel. This voltage must never exceed 10 V. If this voltage does exceed 10 V, reduce the input signal level as required. Millenia / Indico 100 / CMP 200 Service Manual Ch # 740904-06 Rev. J Page 3D-21 3D AEC Calibration CPI Canada Inc. 3D.4.0 AEC USING A PMT This section applies if a PMT is to be used for AEC control on AEC channel 4. AEC channels 1, 2, and 3 (as applicable) should be calibrated first (sections 3D.6.0 to 3D.12.0), before calibrating AEC channel 4. WARNING: SWITCH OFF THE GENERATOR BEFORE CONNECTING A PMT, AND USE APPROPRIATE HIGH VOLTAGE PRECAUTIONS WHEN MEASURING THE PMT HIGH VOLTAGE. Figure 3D-12: Connections for PMT AEC Step 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. Page 3D-22 Action Connect the PMT output to J7 on the generator interface board (the ABS input) as shown in figure 3D-12. If the “PMT for AEC on channel 4” configuration was factory ordered, the generator will be pre-wired as shown above. The ABS input is at J7-12, and the signal will be divided for the AEC board via the resistor from J7-12 to J7-10. Appropriate high voltage shielded cable should be used for the PMT signal connections. Set the PMT voltage to approximately -650 VDC for AEC operation using R19 on the AEC interface board. AEC channel 4 must be selected in order for R19 to be active. USE ONLY TP5 ON THE AEC INTERFACE BOARD (FIGURE 3D-10, 3D-11) FOR THE HV METER GROUND WHEN MEASURING PMT HIGH VOLTAGE. CONNECT THE GROUND LEAD FIRST BEFORE MEASURING THE HIGH VOLTAGE. DO NOT ATTEMPT TO MEASURE THIS WITHOUT A SUITABLE METER. Configure AEC channel 4 as per 3D.6.0 steps 6 to 14, but use the following settings in the AEC SETUP menu: Select ION chamber, and enable FILM SCREEN 1 only, and CENTER FIELD only. If AEC SETUP menu screen 2 is available, set C FIELD COMP to 0 (this is model dependent, refer to AEC SETUP in chapter 3C). Enter the calibration value 45 into EACH of the kV breakpoints. The procedure for setting the 75 kV knee breakpoint is detailed in 3D.6.0, step 16. The remaining breakpoints are set in a similar manner (refer to the balance of 3D.6.0 for details on accessing those breakpoint settings). Adjust the channel 4 gain adjustment potentiometer on the AEC board to achieve the desired I.I. input dose at the 75 kV knee breakpoint, using absorber thickness per table 3D-12. The PMT voltage that was set in step 2 may need to be adjusted up or down if the gain adjustment potentiometer does not provide the desired adjustment range in step 5. Repeat the exposures at other kV breakpoints that cover the desired kV operating range, checking the I.I. input dose at each kV breakpoint. Use absorber thickness per table 3D-12. Readjust the breakpoint calibration values in step 7, if necessary, to achieve the desired I.I. input dose at those kV values. DO NOT READJUST THE AEC GAIN POT OR PMT VOLTAGE. Rev. J Millenia / Indico 100 / CMP 200 Service Manual Ch # 740904-06 CPI Canada Inc. AEC Calibration 3D 3D.5.0 AEC FIELD BALANCE If your generator does NOT have AEC SETUP menu 2 (see the section AEC SETUP in chapter 3C), follow the AEC chamber manufacturers recommendations for AEC field balancing. If your generator has AEC SETUP menu 2, follow the AEC chamber manufacturers recommendations for AEC field balancing if available. If the AEC chamber has no provision for AEC field balancing, follow the steps below. PERFORM THE FOLLOWING STEPS IMMEDIATELY BEFORE DOING AEC CALIBRATION AT THE 75 kV KNEE BREAKPOINT IN THE FOLLOWING SECTIONS: 1. Enter AEC SETUP menu 2, and ensure that each of the field compensation values is set to 0. 2. When set up to do dose measurements at the 75 kV knee breakpoint, evaluate the AEC field balance by measuring the dose at the film plane during an AEC exposure as each of the three AEC fields is individually selected. 3. If the AEC chamber field balance is not acceptable, go to AEC SETUP menu 2 and adjust the right or left compensation values up or down as required. Do not adjust the middle field (C) compensation value. 4. Repeat steps 2 and 3. The right and left AEC field compensations are adjusted to match the middle field. This process may need to be repeated several times until the three AEC fields are suitably balanced. 3D.6.0 AEC CALIBRATION (TABLE BUCKY) Figure 3D-13: Equipment setup for table Bucky AEC calibration Millenia / Indico 100 / CMP 200 Service Manual Ch # 740904-06 Rev. J Page 3D-23 3D AEC Calibration CPI Canada Inc. 3D.6.0 AEC CALIBRATION (TABLE BUCKY) Cont Step Action SETUP FOR AEC CALIBRATION IF THE AEC BOARD BEING CALIBRATED HAS SHORT AEC TIME COMPENSATION (FIGURE 3D-9 OR 3D-11), THE SHORT EXPOSURE TIME COMPENSATION MUST FIRST BE DISABLED. TO DO THIS, ADJUST ALL SHORT AEC EXPOSURE TIME COMPENSATION POTENTIOMETERS TO ZERO, I.E. SUCH THAT THE WIPERS ON EACH POT ARE GROUNDED. VERIFY THE CORRECT SETTINGS BY USING AN OHMMETER ON LOW OHMS RANGE AND ENSURING A NEAR ZERO OHMS READING FROM THE WIPER OF EACH SHORT AEC TIME COMPENSATION POT TO GROUND. REFER TO TABLE 3D-14 FOR THE SHORT AEC TIME COMPENSATION POTENTIOMETER DESIGNATIONS. FAILURE TO PRESET THESE POTS WILL RESULT IN DIFFICULTY IN PERFORMING AEC CALIBRATION. 1. Set up the X-ray tube stand as shown in figure 3D-13. 2. Align the tube stand and table Bucky such that the central ray is centered relative to the image receptor. 3. Open up the collimator to expose all three fields of the AEC pickup. Ensure that the central ray remains centered relative to the image receptor. 4. Place the R probe at the film plane, i.e. behind the grid. If this cannot be done, then place the probe on the table top. Ensure that the R-probe is located as close as possible to the central ray, but not blocking any pickup areas on the AEC device. The R meter must be set to measure in the micro-R range. 5. Place the absorber (with thickness selected for 75 kV per table 3D-12) in the X-ray field, ensuring that the radiation is COMPLETELY blocked by the absorber. 6. Place the generator into the programming mode. Refer to section 3C.1.1. 7. From the GENERATOR SETUP menu select GEN CONFIGURATION. 8. From the GEN CONFIGURATION menu select AEC SETUP. 9. Set up the AEC parameters in the AEC SETUP menu FOR EACH ACTIVE AEC CHANNEL. Refer to AEC SETUP in chapter 3C. 10. Set up the image receptors in the RECEPTOR SETUP menu such that each receptor has the desired AEC channel assigned to it. Refer to RECEPTOR SETUP in chapter 3C. 11. In the RECEPTOR SETUP menu, set MEMORY to NO for each image receptor. This will ensure that the next receptor being calibrated will not remember the techniques from the previous receptor. The MEMORY function may be reset as desired after AEC calibration is completed. 12. In the RECEPTOR SETUP menu, ensure that the AEC BACKUP MAS and AEC BACKUP MS are set sufficiently high that the generator backup timer will not terminate the exposure. 13. From the GEN CONFIGURATION menu select AEC CALIBRATION. 14. From the AEC CALIBRATION menu select FILM SCREEN 1 (the slowest film screen combination). CAUTION: DURING THE FOLLOWING CALIBRATION PROCEDURE, BE SURE THAT THE SELECTED TECHNIQUES WILL NOT OVERLOAD THE X-RAY TUBE. USE CAUTION WHEN REPEATING EXPOSURES AS THIS MAY QUICKLY OVERLOAD THE X-RAY TUBE. MOST X-RAY TUBE MANUFACTURERS RECOMMEND NO MORE THAN TWO HIGH SPEED STARTS PER MINUTE. NOTE: BE SURE TO USE THE SAME CASSETTE FOR EACH EXPOSURE AT THAT FILM SPEED. Page 3D-24 Rev. J Millenia / Indico 100 / CMP 200 Service Manual Ch # 740904-06 CPI Canada Inc. AEC Calibration 3D 3D.6.0 AEC CALIBRATION (TABLE BUCKY) Cont NOTE: FOR THE CMP 200 AND THE INDICO 100 RAD-ONLY CONSOLE, LCD SCREEN DETAILS NOT RELEVANT TO AEC CALIBRATION WILL DIFFER SLIGHTLY FROM THE EXAMPLES IN THIS SECTION. HOWEVER, THE AEC CALIBRATION MENUS WILL APPEAR AS SHOWN IN THIS SECTION. RLF COMPENSATION AND MULTI-SPOT COMPENSATION IS NOT AVAILABLE ON CMP200. The following screens are used for AEC calibration * AEC CALIBRATION * FILM SCREEN 1 FILM SCREEN 2 FILM SCREEN 3 DENSITY SETUP EXIT *TUBE? 0%HU 50KV: 84.0: 55KV: 78.0: 65KV: 66.0: 75KV: 54.0 3200MS << AEC CAL, F/S 1* *TUBE? 0%HU 110KV: 34.0: 130KV: 28.0: RLF COMPENSATION MULT. SPOT COMP: 3200MS << AEC CAL, F/S 1* Step 15. 16. 17. 18. 19. 20. 85KV: 42.8 95KV: 38.0 + >> + - 0% Action 75 KV KNEE BREAKPOINT CALIBRATION: Select the table Bucky image receptor. Select the 75 kV knee breakpoint and enter the value 45 using the + or - buttons adjacent to the LCD display. Select the appropriate mA for the first film speed being calibrated per table 3D-12, remembering that the slowest film screen used in that installation must be calibrated first (example 320 mA for 100 speed film). Select large focus, center field. Make an exposure and note the dose and mAs. Referring to table 3D-11, select the estimated dose required for the film speed being calibrated i.e. 1025 ± 25 µR (see note on next page regarding conversion of µR to µGy if desired) at the 75 kV knee breakpoint for 100 speed film. Note that the dose values in the table are based on the R-probe being located at the film plane. If the probe was placed in front of the grid the dose values shown in the tables must be increased accordingly. The dose in front of the grid will typically be approximately double the dose at the film plane. Adjust the required gain potentiometer on the AEC board (see note below) while taking exposures until the dose noted in the previous step is obtained. • CHANNEL 1 ON THE AEC BOARD IS TYPICALLY USED FOR THE TABLE BUCKY AEC CHAMBER. YOUR INSTALLATION MAY USE A DIFFERENT CHANNEL ON THE AEC BOARD. • REFER TO TABLE 3D-10 FOR THE AEC BOARD GAIN POTENTIOMETER (GAIN POT) DESIGNATIONS FOR THE VARIOUS AEC BOARDS. Millenia / Indico 100 / CMP 200 Service Manual Ch # 740904-06 Rev. J Page 3D-25 3D AEC Calibration CPI Canada Inc. 3D.6.0 AEC CALIBRATION (TABLE BUCKY) Cont AEC BOARD Solid State (Fig 3D-8) Ion Chamber (Fig 3D-9) Universal (Fig 3D-10) Universal (Fig 3D-11) CHANNEL 1 R1 R1 R1 R1 CHANNEL 2 R2 R2 R26 R2 CHANNEL 3 R3 R3 R27 R3 CHANNEL 4 R4 R4 R28 R4 Table 3D-10: AEC board gain pot designations FILM SPEED 100 200 400 800 FILM PLANE DOSE @ 75 kV 1025 ± 25 uR 550 ± 25 uR 260 ± 12 uR 135 ± 12 uR Table 3D-11: Film speed vs. approximate dose @ 75 kV These are APPROXIMATE dose inputs to the film cassette plane at an SID of 40 in. (100 cm), using a grid with a 12:1 ratio. NOTE: To convert from µR to µGy divide the value in µR by 114.5. This will give the value in µGy (for example 114.5 µR = 1 µGy). Step 21. Action Load a test cassette with fresh film and install it in the image receptor. Using the same technique as in the previous step, expose the film and develop it. 22. Measure the optical density. The desired value should have been previously recorded in a copy of table 3D-1. 23. If the measured O.D. is not within 5% of the desired value, adjust the gain pot (as per step 20) to increase or decrease the density, then repeat the previous two steps. 24. Once the desired film density is achieved, record the mAs, dose, calibration number and O.D. in a copy of table 3D-13. FOR EACH BREAKPOINT IN THE REMAINDER OF THIS SECTION, START WITH THE APPROXIMATE DOSE AS PER TABLE 3D-12. AFTER THAT DOSE IS ACHIEVED, A FILM MUST BE EXPOSED AND THE O.D. VERIFIED. FURTHER DOSE ITERATIONS MAY BE REQUIRED TO ACHIEVE THE DESIRED OPTICAL DENSITY. DO NOT READJUST THE AEC BOARD GAIN POT AFTER THE 75KV KNEE BREAKPOINT IS CALIBRATED. DOSE / DENSITY ADJUSTMENTS WILL ONLY BE DONE BY ADJUSTING THE CALIBRATION VALUES FOR THE OTHER KV BREAKPOINTS. 25. 26. 27. 28. Page 3D-26 55 KV BREAKPOINT CALIBRATION: Change the absorber thickness per table 3D-12. As before, ensure that the absorber fully blocks the X-ray field. Select the 55 kV breakpoint. Make an exposure and note the dose. Use mA values as per table 3D-12. Adjust the 55 kV calibration numbers using the + or - buttons such that the actual dose is equal to the target dose at 55 kV for the selected film speed per table 3D-12. DO NOT READJUST THE AEC BOARD GAIN POT. Rev. J Millenia / Indico 100 / CMP 200 Service Manual Ch # 740904-06 CPI Canada Inc. 3D AEC Calibration 3D.6.0 AEC CALIBRATION (TABLE BUCKY) Cont 100 speed film screen Break point 75 kV knee pt. 55 kV 50 kV 65 kV 110 kV 130 kV 85 kV 95 kV Absorber 15 cm H2O 10 cm H2O 10 cm H2O 10 cm H2O 20 cm H2O 25 cm H2O 20 cm H2O 20 cm H2O Dose 1025 µ/R 1808 µ/R 1832 µ/R 1436 µ/R 1088 µ/R 848 µ/R 1060 µ/R 1008 µ/R mAs 59.2 mAs 54 mAs 128 mAs 44 mAs 24 mAs 16 mAs 54 mAs 44 mAs Generator mA 320 mA 320 mA 320 mA 320 mA 200 mA 200 mA 320 mA 320 mA Generator BUT mAs 320 mAs (MAX) 320 mAs (MAX) 320 mAs (MAX) 320 mAs (MAX) 320 mAs (MAX) 320 mAs (MAX) 320 mAs (MAX) 320 mAs (MAX) 200 speed film screen Break point 75 kVp knee pt. 55 kVp 50 kVp 65 kVp 110 kVp 130 kVp 85 kVp 95 kVp Absorber 15 cm H2O 10 cm H2O 10 cm H2O 10 cm H2O 20 cm H2O 25 cm H2O 20 cm H2O 20 cm H2O Dose 518 µ/R 904 µ/R 916 µ/R 718 µ/R 544 µ/R 484 µ/R 530 µ/R 504 µ/R mAs 30 mAs 26 mAs 64 mAs 22 mAs 12 mAs 8 mAs 27 mAs 22 mAs Generator mA 250 mA 250 mA 250 mA 250 mA 250 mA 250 mA 250 mA 250 mA Generator BUT mAs 250 mAs (MAX) 250 mAs (MAX) 250 mAs (MAX) 250 mAs (MAX) 250 mAs (MAX) 250 mAs (MAX) 250 mAs (MAX) 250 mAs (MAX) 400 speed film screen Break Point 75 kVp knee pt. 55 kVp 50 kVp 65 kVp 110 kVp 130 kVp 85 kVp 95 kVp Absorber 15 cm H2O 10 cm H2O 10 cm H2O 10 cm H2O 20 cm H2O 25 cm H2O 20 cm H2O 20 cm H2O Dose 259 µ/R 452 µ/R 458 µ/R 359 µ/R 272 µ/R 424 µ/R 265 µ/R 252 µ/R mAs 14.8 mAs 13 mAs 32 mAs 11 mAs 6 mAs 4 mAs 13.5 mAs 11 mAs Generator mA 200 mA 200 mA 200 mA 200 mA 200 mA 200 mA 200 mA 200 mA Generator BUT mAs 200 mAs (MAX) 200 mAs (MAX) 200 mAs (MAX) 200 mAs (MAX) 200 mAs (MAX) 200 mAs (MAX) 200 mAs (MAX) 200 mAs (MAX) 800 speed film screen Break Point 75 kVp knee pt. 55 kVp 50 kVp 65 kVp 110 kVp 130 kVp 85 kVp 95 kVp Absorber 15 cm H2O 10 cm H2O 10 cm H2O 10 cm H2O 20 cm H2O 25 cm H2O 20 cm H2O 20 cm H2O Dose 129 µ/R 226 µ/R 229µ/R 179 µ/R 136 µ/R 212 µ/R 132 µ/R 126 µ/R mAs 7.4 mAs 6.5 mAs 16 mAs 5.5 mAs 3 mAs 2 mAs 6.7 mAs 5.5 mAs Generator mA 100 mA 100 mA 100 mA 100 mA 100 mA 100 mA 100 mA 100 mA Generator BUT mAs 120 mAs (MAX) 120 mAs (MAX) 120 mAs (MAX) 120 mAs (MAX) 120 mAs (MAX) 120 mAs (MAX) 120 mAs (MAX) 120 mAs (MAX) Table 3D-12: Breakpoint calibration factors 2 For SID’s other than 40 in. (100 cm) multiply the dose by the factor [new SID / 40 in. (100 cm)] Millenia / Indico 100 / CMP 200 Service Manual Ch # 740904-06 Rev. J Page 3D-27 3D AEC Calibration CPI Canada Inc. 3D.6.0 AEC CALIBRATION (TABLE BUCKY) Cont 3D.6.1 Break point calibration worksheet Record the final measurements in a copy of the table below. The final measurements are those obtained AFTER films have been developed to verify the correct O.D. at each breakpoint. FILM SCREEN 1 SPEED = #1 BK. POINT = 75 kV #2 BK. POINT = 55 kV #3 BK. POINT = 50 kV #4 BK. POINT = 65 kV #5 BK. POINT = 110 kV #6 BK. POINT = 130 kV #7 BK. POINT = 85 kV #8 BK. POINT = 95 kV mAs mAs mAs mAs mAs mAs mAs mAs FILM SCREEN 2 SPEED = #1 BK. POINT = 75 kV #2 BK. POINT = 55 kV #3 BK. POINT = 50 kV #4 BK. POINT = 65 kV #5 BK. POINT = 110 kV #6 BK. POINT = 130 kV #7 BK. POINT = 85 kV #8 BK. POINT = 95 kV mAs mAs mAs mAs mAs mAs mAs mAs FILM SCREEN 3 SPEED = #1 BK. POINT = 75 kV #2 BK. POINT = 55 kV #3 BK. POINT = 50 kV #4 BK. POINT = 65 kV #5 BK. POINT = 110 kV #6 BK. POINT = 130 kV #7 BK. POINT = 85 kV #8 BK. POINT = 95 kV mAs mAs mAs mAs mAs mAs mAs mAs = = = = = = = = = = = = = = = = = = = = = = = = DOSE = DOSE = DOSE = DOSE = DOSE = DOSE = DOSE = DOSE = CAL. NO. = CAL. NO. = CAL. NO. = CAL. NO. = CAL. NO. = CAL. NO. = CAL. NO. = CAL. NO. = O.D. = O.D. = O.D. = O.D. = O.D. = O.D. = O.D. = O.D. = DOSE = DOSE = DOSE = DOSE = DOSE = DOSE = DOSE = DOSE = CAL. NO. = CAL. NO. = CAL. NO. = CAL. NO. = CAL. NO. = CAL. NO. = CAL. NO. = CAL. NO. = O.D. = O.D. = O.D. = O.D. = O.D. = O.D. = O.D. = O.D. = DOSE = DOSE = DOSE = DOSE = DOSE = DOSE = DOSE = DOSE = CAL. NO. = CAL. NO. = CAL. NO. = CAL. NO. = CAL. NO. = CAL. NO. = CAL. NO. = CAL. NO. = O.D. = O.D. = O.D. = O.D. = O.D. = O.D. = O.D. = O.D. = Table 3D-13: Breakpoint worksheet Page 3D-28 Rev. J Millenia / Indico 100 / CMP 200 Service Manual Ch # 740904-06 CPI Canada Inc. AEC Calibration 3D 3D.6.0 AEC CALIBRATION (TABLE BUCKY) Cont Step 29. 30. 31. 32. 33. 34. 35. 36. 37. 38. 39. 40. 41. 42. 43. 44. 45. Action Load the test cassette with fresh film and install it in the image receptor. Using the same technique, expose the film and develop it. Measure the optical density. The optical density should be as per step 22. If the measured O.D. is not within 5% of the desired value, adjust the 55 kV calibration number using the + or - buttons, then repeat the previous two steps. DO NOT READJUST THE AEC BOARD GAIN POT. Once the desired film density is achieved, record the required values in a copy of table 3D-13. 50 KV BREAKPOINT CALIBRATION: If special techniques are NOT used which require the 50 kV range, simply enter the 55 kV calibration number into the 50 kV breakpoint using the + and - buttons. Note that at approximately 55 kV and under, the film screen sensitivity becomes too low for practical AEC operation when used with a Bucky. If the 50 kV range IS used, the 50 kV breakpoint must be calibrated. To do this, select the 50 kV breakpoint. The 50 kV step will use the same absorber as used for the 55 kV step. Repeat steps 27 to 32 to calibrate the 50 kV breakpoint if desired, substituting 50 kV where applicable in place of 55 kV. 65 KV BREAKPOINT CALIBRATION: Select the 65 kV breakpoint. Use absorber thickness per table 3D-12 for the 65 kV breakpoint. Repeat steps 27 to 32 to calibrate the 65 kV breakpoint, substituting 65 kV where applicable in place of 55 kV. IN THE FOLLOWING STEPS, SELECT >> AND << AS REQUIRED TO NAVIGATE BETWEEN THE TWO BREAKPOINT SCREENS (SCREEN 1 LISTS BREAKPOINTS 50 KV TO 95 KV, SCREEN 2 SHOWS BREAKPOINTS 110 AND 130 KV). 110 KV BREAKPOINT CALIBRATION: Select the 110 kV breakpoint. Use absorber thickness per table 3D-12 for the 110 kV breakpoint. Use the appropriate mA for this breakpoint as per table 3D-12. Repeat steps 27 to 32 to calibrate the 110 kV breakpoint, substituting 110 kV where applicable in place of 55 kV. 130 KV BREAKPOINT CALIBRATION: If special high kV techniques are NOT used which require the 130 kV range, enter the 110 kV calibration number into the 130 kV breakpoint using the + and - buttons. If the 130 kV range IS used, the 130 kV breakpoint must be calibrated. To do this, select the 130 kV breakpoint. Use absorber thickness per table 3D-12 for the 130 kV breakpoint. Repeat steps 27 to 32 to calibrate the 130 kV breakpoint if desired, substituting 130 kV where applicable in place of 55 kV. 85 KV BREAKPOINT CALIBRATION: Select the 85 kV breakpoint. Use absorber thickness per table 3D-12 for the 85 kV breakpoint. Repeat steps 27 to 32 to calibrate the 85 kV breakpoint, substituting 85 kV where applicable in place of 55 kV. Millenia / Indico 100 / CMP 200 Service Manual Ch # 740904-06 Rev. J Page 3D-29 3D AEC Calibration CPI Canada Inc. 3D.6.0 AEC CALIBRATION (TABLE BUCKY) Cont Step 46. 47. 48. Step 49. 50. Action 95 KV BREAKPOINT CALIBRATION: Select the 95 kV breakpoint. Use absorber thickness per table 3D-12 for the 95 kV breakpoint. Repeat steps 27 to 32 to calibrate the 95 kV breakpoint, substituting 95 kV where applicable in place of 55 kV. Select << to return to the AEC CALIBRATION menu. Action FILM SCREEN 2 BREAKPOINT CALIBRATION: Select FILM SCREEN 2. Repeat steps 16 to 48 as described for film screen 1 except: WHEN CALIBRATING THE 75 KV KNEE BREAKPOINT FOR FILM SCREEN 2, DO NOT ADJUST THE AEC BOARD GAIN POT. DOSE ADJUSTMENTS MUST ONLY BE MADE BY VARYING THE BREAKPOINT CALIBRATION NUMBERS. FILM SCREEN 2 MUST BE THE NEXT HIGHEST FILM SPEED AFTER FILM SCREEN 1. Step 51. 52. Action FILM SCREEN 3 BREAKPOINT CALIBRATION: Select FILM SCREEN 3. Repeat steps 16 to 48 as described for film screen 1 except: WHEN CALIBRATING THE 75 KV KNEE BREAKPOINT FOR FILM SCREEN 3, DO NOT ADJUST THE AEC BOARD GAIN POT. DOSE ADJUSTMENTS MUST ONLY BE MADE BY VARYING THE BREAKPOINT CALIBRATION NUMBERS. FILM SCREEN 3 MUST BE THE HIGHEST FILM SPEED. 3D.7.0 SHORT AEC TIME COMPENSATION (IF APPLICABLE) Step 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. Page 3D-30 Action THIS SECTION ONLY APPLIES FOR AEC BOARDS WITH SHORT AEC EXPOSURE TIME COMPENSATION (FIGURE 3D-9 OR 3D-11) IF AEC EXPOSURES LESS THAN APPROXIMATELY 15 MS ARE REQUIRED. Select the image receptor to be short AEC time compensated, i.e. table Bucky. Select the highest film speed used on the selected receptor, and then select the 75 kV breakpoint. Set the mA per table 3D-12 for the film speed being used. Reinstall the absorber as per table 3D-12 for the 75 kV breakpoint. Make an exposure and confirm the dose (or mAs) readings as previously recorded in table 3D-13. Reduce the absorber thickness such as to decrease the AEC exposure time to approximately 10 ms. Adjust the short AEC time compensation pot for the AEC channel being calibrated such that the dose (or mAs) is approximately the same as previously recorded (step 4). The short AEC time compensation potentiometer designations are given in table 3D-14. Rev. J Millenia / Indico 100 / CMP 200 Service Manual Ch # 740904-06 CPI Canada Inc. AEC Calibration 3D 3D.7.0 SHORT AEC TIME COMPENSATION (IF APPLICABLE) Cont AEC BOARD Ion Chamber (Fig 3D-9) Universal (Fig 3D-11) CHANNEL 1 R11 R91 CHANNEL 2 R12 R92 CHANNEL 3 R13 R93 CHANNEL 4 R14 R94 Table 3D-14: Short AEC time compensation pot designations Step 7. 8. 9. 10. 11. Action Reduce the absorber thickness again such as to decrease the AEC exposure time to approximately 6 ms (but not less). Adjust the short AEC time compensation pot for the AEC channel being calibrated such that the dose (or mAs) is approximately the same as it was in step 6. The short AEC time compensation adjustments affect the AEC calibration at longer exposure times. Therefore, it may now be necessary to readjust the gain pot for the AEC channel being calibrated to restore the dose (or mAs) values to the values previously recorded in table 3D-13. Ensure that the absorber thickness and mA values are as per table 3D-12 when readjusting the AEC gain pot. Films should be exposed and developed, and the O.D. checked at the 75 kV breakpoint at AEC exposure times of approximately 6 ms and approximately 100 ms. If the film density is not acceptable at both short and long AEC exposure times, it will be necessary to iterate the adjustments of both the short AEC time compensation pot and the AEC gain pot by repeating steps 3 to 8. Repeat steps 1 to 10 for each image receptor (AEC channel) to be short AEC time compensated. 3D.8.0 AEC DENSITY CALIBRATION The following screens are used for density calibration * AEC CALIBRATION * FILM SCREEN 1 FILM SCREEN 2 FILM SCREEN 3 DENSITY SETUP EXIT *TUBE? 0%HU -8: -7: -6: -5: 62% 3200MS EXIT *DENS. SETUP* *TUBE? 0%HU -4: 50% -3: 37% -2: 25% -1: 12% 3200MS << *DENS. SETUP* + >> Millenia / Indico 100 / CMP 200 Service Manual + >> Ch # 740904-06 Rev. J Page 3D-31 3D AEC Calibration CPI Canada Inc. 3D.8.0 AEC DENSITY CALIBRATION (Cont) *TUBE? 0%HU +1: 12% +2: 25% +3: 37% +4: 50% 3200MS << *DENS. SETUP* *TUBE? 0%HU +5: 62% +6: +7: +8: 3200MS << *DENS. SETUP* + >> + RETURN Please note the following points regarding density calibration: • Up to eight density plus and eight density minus steps are available. If ± 8 density steps are not required, the unwanted density steps may be programmed out per the procedure below. For example, if only ± 5 density steps are desired, then density steps ± 6, 7, 8 may be deprogrammed. • Once the desired number of ± density steps are known, the relative minimum and maximum dose values must be determined. Typically the minimum density step will result in half (50%) of the nominal dose and the maximum density step will typically give double the nominal dose (100% increase). The nominal dose is the value that was recorded at 0 density in table 3D-13. • The relative dose change per density step must be determined next. To do this, note the relative minimum and maximum dose as determined above (i.e. 50% at min density and 100% increase at max density), then calculate the number of - density steps and the number of + density steps that will be required. The relative dose change between density steps will then be the minimum density (i.e. 50) divided by the number of density minus steps or the maximum density (i.e. 100) divided by the number of density plus steps. This will yield the required dose increment for each density minus step and for each density plus step respectively. For ± 8 density steps, this gives a dose decrease of 6.25% per density minus step (8 steps x 6.25% per step = 50% dose at -8 density) or a dose increase of 12.5% per density plus step (8 steps x 12.5% per step = 100% dose increase at +8 density). Refer to table 3D-15 for two typical examples of density steps vs. calibration numbers. For 8 minus density steps the dose decrease is 6.25% per step, and for 8 + density steps the dose increase is 12.5% per step as per the example calculation above. For 5 minus density steps the dose decrease is 10% per step, and for 5 + density steps the dose increase is 20% per step. Page 3D-32 Rev. J Millenia / Indico 100 / CMP 200 Service Manual Ch # 740904-06 CPI Canada Inc. AEC Calibration 3D 3D.8.0 AEC DENSITY CALIBRATION (Cont) DENSITY STEP -8 -7 -6 -5 -4 -3 -2 -1 +1 +2 +3 +4 +5 +6 +7 +8 CALIBRATION NUMBER (- 8 DENSITY CALIBRATION NUMBER (- 5 DENSITY = HALF THE DOSE, +8 STEP DENSITY = HALF THE DOSE, +5 DENSITY = DOUBLE THE DOSE) DENSITY = DOUBLE THE DOSE) 50 44 38 31 -5 50 25 -4 40 19 -3 30 13 -2 20 6 -1 10 0 DENSITY: SHOWN FOR REFERENCE ONLY. 13 +1 20 25 +2 40 38 +3 60 50 +4 80 63 +5 99 75 88 99 Table 3D-15: Example density values Step 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. 10. 11. Action Reselect FILM SCREEN 1. Use absorber thickness per table 3D-12 for the 75 kV breakpoint. Reselect the 75 kV knee breakpoint. Select << to return to the AEC CALIBRATION menu. Select DENSITY SETUP. Referring to table 3D-13, note the dose at 75 kV for film screen 1. This will be referred to as the 0 density dose. Select the highest density minus step desired i.e. - 8 from the density setup menu. If it is not intended to use this step, select the highest density minus step to be used i.e. - 5, then set the unused steps to - to disable those steps. To disable density steps, press the - button to scroll down until the - symbol is displayed. Set the calibration number for the highest density minus step to the desired relative density value (example 50, this will give approximately 1/2 the 0 density dose). Make an exposure and confirm that the measured dose is approximately the desired value. If the measured dose is not as expected, adjust the calibration number for that density step and repeat step 8. Select the next density step (i.e. - 7) and enter the appropriate calibration number for that step. Refer to table 3D-15 and the notes preceding table 3D-15. Repeat steps 8 and 9. Repeat the previous step for each remaining density minus step. Use the >> and << buttons to navigate through the DENS SETUP menu in order to access all the density steps in this procedure. Millenia / Indico 100 / CMP 200 Service Manual Ch # 740904-06 Rev. J Page 3D-33 3D AEC Calibration CPI Canada Inc. 3D.8.0 AEC DENSITY CALIBRATION (Cont) Step 12. 13. 14. 15. 16. Page 3D-34 Action Set the calibration number for the highest density plus step to the desired relative density value (example 100, this will result in approximately double the 0 density dose). Repeat step 8 and 9. Select the next lowest density step (i.e. 7) and enter the appropriate calibration number for that step. Refer to table 3D-15 and notes preceding table 3D-15. Repeat steps 8 and 9. Repeat the previous step for each remaining density plus step. Use the >> and << buttons to navigate through the DENS SETUP menu in order to access all the density steps. When the density setup is complete and verified via dose measurements, use the << and EXIT buttons to return to the AEC CALIBRATION menu. Rev. J Millenia / Indico 100 / CMP 200 Service Manual Ch # 740904-06 CPI Canada Inc. AEC Calibration 3D 3D.9.0 RLF COMPENSATION The following points should be noted regarding RLF compensation. RLF compensation is normally only needed if special techniques are used which result in AEC exposures greater than 100 ms. • If perfect, film would provide linear density changes with linearly increasing exposure times. In reality, at longer exposures, film effectively becomes slower. This effect is known as reciprocity law failure. To compensate, exposure times must be increased at longer exposures. This compensation is achieved by increasing the AEC reference voltage at longer exposure times. RLF compensation is applied to three ranges (50-500 ms, 500-1000 ms, and 1000- 1500 ms) as shown below. The examples below are not meant to represent actual RLF compensation percentages in your installation. Actual values will need to be determined per the procedure following. • Between 0 and 50 ms no RLF compensation is applied. Per figure 3D-14, the AEC reference voltage is constant at 1 unit between 0 and 50 ms. • At 50 ms, RLF compensation = 10% is applied. This means that the reference voltage will increase by 10% between 50 ms and 500 ms in a linear fashion. At 500 ms the reference voltage is then 1.0 X 1.10 = 1.10 units. • At 500 ms, RLF compensation = 20% is applied. This means that the reference voltage will increase by 20% between 500 ms and 1000 ms in a linear fashion. At 1000 ms the reference voltage is then 1.10 X 1.20 = 1.32 units. • At 1000 ms, RLF compensation = 30% is applied. This means that the reference voltage will increase by 30% between 1000 ms and 1500 ms in a linear fashion. At 1500 ms the reference voltage is then 1.32 X 1.30 = 1.72 units • The rate of increase of the reference voltage beyond 1500 ms will be constant, up to limit of the B.U.T. (backup timer). • The compensation curve resulting from the RLF values described above is depicted in the graph below. Figure 3D-14: Example RLF compensation curve Millenia / Indico 100 / CMP 200 Service Manual Ch # 740904-06 Rev. J Page 3D-35 3D AEC Calibration CPI Canada Inc. 3D.9.0 RLF COMPENSATION (Cont) The following screens are used for RLF compensation * AEC CALIBRATION * FILM SCREEN 1 FILM SCREEN 2 FILM SCREEN 3 DENSITY SETUP EXIT *TUBE? 0%HU 50KV: 84.0: 55KV: 78.0: 65KV: 66.0: 75KV: 54.0 3200MS << AEC CAL, F/S 1* *TUBE? 0%HU 110KV: 34.0: 130KV: 28.0: RLF COMPENSATION MULT. SPOT COMP: 3200MS << AEC CAL, F/S 1* *TUBE? 0%HU 50MSEC: 0% 500MSEC: 4% 1000MSEC: 0% RLF COMP, F/S 1* 3200MS Page 3D-36 85KV: 42.8 95KV: 38.0 + >> 0% + - + - << Rev. J Millenia / Indico 100 / CMP 200 Service Manual Ch # 740904-06 CPI Canada Inc. AEC Calibration 3D 3D.9.0 RLF COMPENSATION (Cont) Step 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. 10. 11. 12. 13. 14. 15. 16. 17. 18. 19. 20. 21. 22. 23. 24. 25. 26. 27. 28. 29. 30. 31. 32. Action Place the absorber (with thickness selected for 75 kV per table 3D-12) in the X-ray field, ensuring that the radiation is COMPLETELY blocked by the absorber. Select the slowest film screen combination to compensate. This will normally be FILM SCREEN 1. Select >>. Select RLF COMPENSATION. From the LF COMP menu, select 50MSEC and set the value to 0 using the + or buttons. Select mA appropriate to the film speed i.e. 100 mA for 100 speed film. Make an exposure and adjust the mA if necessary to give an exposure time of approximately 50 ms. Load a test cassette with fresh film and install it in the image receptor. Make an exposure using the same techniques. Record the mAs, then develop the film. Note the O.D. This should be within 10% of the O.D. that was noted during AEC calibration. Make an exposure and reduce the mA to give an exposure time of approximately 500 ms. Make an exposure using the same techniques. Record the mAs. Enter an RLF offset at 50MSEC to give a mAs increase of approximately 10%. Load a test cassette with fresh film and install it in the image receptor. Make an exposure and develop the film. If the measured O.D. is not within 5% of the value in step 10, adjust the 50 ms RLF offset value as appropriate using the + and - buttons. Repeat steps 14 and 15 until the required O.D. is achieved. Make an exposure and reduce the mA to give an exposure time of approximately 1000 ms. Select the 500MSEC RLF adjustment and set the value to 0 using the + or - buttons. Make an exposure using the same techniques. Record the mAs. Enter an RLF offset at 500MSEC to give a mAs increase of approximately 20%. Load the test cassette with fresh film and install it in the image receptor. Make an exposure and develop the film. If the measured O.D. is not within 5% of the value in step 10, adjust the 500 ms RLF offset value as appropriate using the + and - buttons. Repeat steps 21 and 22 until the desired density is achieved. THE FOLLOWING STEPS ONLY APPLY IF TECHNIQUES ARE USED RESULTING IN AEC EXPOSURE TIMES GREATER THAN APPROXIMATELY 1500 MS. Make an exposure and reduce the mA such as to give an exposure time of approximately 1500ms. Select the 1000MSEC RLF adjustment and set the value to 0 using the + or - buttons. Make an exposure using the same techniques. Record the mAs. Enter an RLF offset at 1000MSEC to give an mAs increase of approximately 30%. Load the test cassette with fresh film and install it in the image receptor. Make an exposure and develop the film. If the measured O.D. is not within 5% of the value in step 10, adjust the 1000 ms RLF offset value as appropriate using the + and - buttons. Repeat steps 28 and 29 until the desired density is achieved. Select << as required to return to the AEC CALIBRATION menu. Repeat steps 2 to 31 for FILM SCREEN 2 and FILM SCREEN 3 if required. Millenia / Indico 100 / CMP 200 Service Manual Ch # 740904-06 Rev. J Page 3D-37 3D AEC Calibration CPI Canada Inc. 3D.10.0 MULTIPLE SPOT COMPENSATION The following screens are used for multiple spot compensation * AEC CALIBRATION * FILM SCREEN 1 DENSITY SETUP FILM SCREEN 2 FILM SCREEN 3 EXIT *TUBE? 0%HU 50KV: 84.0: 55KV: 78.0: 65KV: 66.0: 75KV: 54.0 3200MS << AEC CAL, F/S 1* *TUBE? 0%HU 110KV: 34.0: 130KV: 28.0: RLF COMPENSATION MULT. SPOT COMP: 3200MS << AEC CAL, F/S 1* 85KV: 42.8 95KV: 38.0 + >> 0% + - • Multiple spot compensation may be required when doing multiple exposures on a single film. In this mode of serial recording, the X-ray field is usually coned down to a small area. Due to the lack of scatter and possible AEC field cutoff, an AEC density offset may be added if required. This offset is known as multiple spot compensation. • In order to activate the multiple spot compensation feature, the R & F table must supply a closed dry contact when the SFD is operated in multi-spot mode. The multi-spot input to the generator is at TB5 pins 11 and 12 on the room interface board. Page 3D-38 Rev. J Millenia / Indico 100 / CMP 200 Service Manual Ch # 740904-06 CPI Canada Inc. AEC Calibration 3D 3D.10.0 MULTIPLE SPOT COMPENSATION (Cont) Step 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. 10. 11. 12. 13. 14. 15. 16. 17. 18. Action Place the absorber (with thickness selected for 85 kV per table 3D-12) in the X-ray field, ensuring that the radiation is COMPLETELY blocked by the absorber. Select the slowest film screen combination to compensate. This will normally be FILM SCREEN 1. Select >>. Select MULT SPOT COMP. Enter the value 0% using the + and - buttons. Select 85 kV via the kV + or - buttons in the radiography section of the console. Select mA appropriate to the film speed per table 3D-13. Load the test cassette with fresh film and install it in the SFD. Make an exposure and record the mAs, then develop the film. Verify that the film is evenly exposed, and that the O.D. is the desired value Enable the SFD multi-spot function, then make several exposures and record the mAs. Develop the film and record the O.D. for each exposure. If the measured optical densities are not within 5% of the desired value, enter a multispot compensation offset percentage that increases or decreases the mAs as appropriate using the + and - buttons. Repeat steps 8 to 13 until the desired O.D. is achieved on all exposures. Select << as required to return to the AEC CALIBRATION menu. Repeat steps 2 to 15 for FILM SCREEN 2 and FILM SCREEN 3 if required. Select EXIT to return to the GEN CONFIGURATION menu. Select EXIT, then EXIT SETUP to return to the normal operating mode. Millenia / Indico 100 / CMP 200 Service Manual Ch # 740904-06 Rev. J Page 3D-39 3D AEC Calibration CPI Canada Inc. 3D.11.0 AEC CALIBRATION (WALL BUCKY) Figure 3D-15: Equipment setup for wall Bucky AEC calibration Please note the following points regarding wall Bucky calibration: • If the wall Bucky is dedicated to chest radiography, a focused grid with a 10:1 or 12:1 ratio should be used along with an SID of 72 in. (180 cm). • If the wall Bucky will be used for conventional as well as chest radiography, then two grids should ideally be used. See the note at the bottom of this page. A reasonable compromise if a single grid must be used is a 10:1 ratio, 60 in. (150 cm) grid. NOTE: Page 3D-40 SINCE MOST WALL BUCKYS ARE USED AT 40 AND 72 IN. (100 AND 180 CM) SID, THE GRID MUST BE CHOSEN WITH CARE WITH RESPECT TO CUT-OFF. A TYPICAL GRID WILL HAVE AN 8:1 RATIO, WITH 85 LINE PAIR / INCH OR 10:1 RATIO WITH 150 LINE PAIR / INCH (STATIONARY). TYPICALLY, 400 SPEED FILM SCREEN WILL BE USED WITH 90 SECOND PROCESSING. Rev. J Millenia / Indico 100 / CMP 200 Service Manual Ch # 740904-06 CPI Canada Inc. AEC Calibration 3D 3D.11.0 AEC CALIBRATION (WALL BUCKY) Cont Grid Absorption The following information may aid in selecting a grid and / or estimating doses in front of the Bucky if required: The percentages listed are approximate. NOTE: ∗ A 10:1 ratio 60 in. (150 cm) focused grid will exhibit the following absorption when measured 5 in. (13 cm) from center: At 72 in. (180 cm) absorption = 18% At 40 in. (100 cm) absorption = 40% ∗ A 12:1 ratio 60 in. (150 cm) focused grid will exhibit the following absorption when measured 5 in. (13 cm) from center: At 72 in. (180 cm) absorption = 20% At 40 in. (100 cm) absorption = 50% ∗ A 10:1 ratio 72 in. (180 cm) focused grid will exhibit the following absorption when measured 5 in. (13 cm) from center: At 40 in. (100 cm) absorption = 65% ∗ A 12:1 ratio 72 in. (180 cm) focused grid will exhibit the following absorption when measured 5 in. (13 cm) from center: At 40 in. (100 cm) absorption = 75% ∗ A 10:1 ratio 40 in. (100 cm) focused grid will exhibit the following absorption when measured 5 in. (13 cm) from center: At 72 in. (180 cm) absorption = 65% ∗ A 12:1 ratio 40 in. (100 cm) focused grid will exhibit the following absorption when measured 5 in. (13 cm) from center: At 72 in. (180 cm) absorption = 75% BREAKPOINT CALIBRATIONS MAY HAVE BEEN DONE FOR ALL THREE FILM SCREEN COMBINATIONS DURING TABLE BUCKY AEC CALIBRATION. IF SO, THE REMAINING IMAGE RECEPTORS MUST USE THE CALIBRATION CURVES PREVIOUSLY ESTABLISHED FOR THOSE FILM SCREENS. IF AN UNUSED FILM SCREEN COMBINATION IS AVAILABLE FOR WALL BUCKY USE, IT IS SUGGESTED THAT TWO RECEPTOR SELECTOR BUTTONS ON THE CONSOLE BE ASSIGNED TO SELECT THE WALL BUCKY. THE FIRST WALL BUCKY SELECTOR SHOULD BE USED FOR 40 IN. (100 CM) SID’S WITH THE APPROPRIATE PREVIOUSLY CALIBRATED FILM SCREEN. THE SECOND WALL BUCKY SELECTOR SHOULD THEN BE USED WITH THE PREVIOUSLY UNCALIBRATED FILM SCREEN AT 72 IN. (180 CM) SID’S. THIS METHOD WILL ALLOW THE GRID TO BE OPTIMIZED FOR EACH SID, AS A SEPARATE DEDICATED FILM SCREEN WITH ITS OWN CALIBRATION CURVE CAN BE ASSIGNED TO THE 72 IN. (180CM) SID. Millenia / Indico 100 / CMP 200 Service Manual Ch # 740904-06 Rev. J Page 3D-41 3D AEC Calibration CPI Canada Inc. 3D.10.0 AEC CALIBRATION (WALL BUCKY) Cont Step 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. 10. 11. 12. 13. 14. 14. 15. 16. Page 3D-42 Action USE OF ONE FILM SCREEN FOR BOTH SID’S USING PREVIOUSLY CALIBRATED FILM SCREENS Set up the X-ray tube stand as shown in figure 3D-15. Align the tube stand and wall Bucky such that the central ray is centered relative to the image receptor. Open up the collimator to expose all three fields of the AEC pickup. Ensure that the central ray remains centered relative to the image receptor. Place the R probe at the film plane, i.e. behind the grid. If this cannot be done, then attach the probe to the front of the Bucky. Ensure that the R-probe is located directly under the central ray. The R meter must be set to measure in the micro-R range. Place the absorber (with thickness selected for 75 kV per table 3D-12) in the X-ray field, ensuring that the radiation is COMPLETELY blocked by the absorber. Select the wall Bucky image receptor. Select the slowest film screen used for the wall Bucky, then select the appropriate mA for that film screen per table 3D-12 (example 320 mA for 100 speed film). Select 75 kV, large focus, center field. Make an exposure and note the dose and mAs. Referring to table 3D-13, select the previously established dose required at the 75 kV knee breakpoint for the film speed being calibrated. Note that the dose values in the table are based on a specific R-probe placement during table Bucky calibration (either at the film plane, or alternately in front of the Bucky). If the probe placement for wall Bucky calibration is not the same as it was for table Bucky calibration, use the estimated dose correction factor in this subsection under GRID ABSORPTION. Adjust the required gain potentiometer on the AEC board (see note below) while taking exposures until the dose noted in the previous step is obtained. • CHANNEL 2 ON THE AEC BOARD IS TYPICALLY USED FOR THE WALL BUCKY AEC CHAMBER. YOUR INSTALLATION MAY USE A DIFFERENT CHANNEL ON THE AEC BOARD. DO NOT READJUST THE GAIN POT FOR THE CHANNEL THAT WAS PREVIOUSLY CALIBRATED (FOR TABLE BUCKY). • REFER TO TABLE 3D-10 FOR THE AEC BOARD GAIN POTENTIOMETER (GAIN POT) DESIGNATIONS FOR THE VARIOUS AEC BOARDS. Load the test cassette with fresh film and install it in the image receptor. Using the same technique, expose the film and develop it. Measure the O.D. The desired value should have been previously recorded in a copy of table 3D-1. If the measured O.D. is not within 5% of the desired value, adjust the gain pot (as per step 10) to increase or decrease the density, then repeat the previous two steps. Change the SID to 40 in. (100 cm) and repeat steps 11 to 13. Adjust the gain pot if necessary to achieve an acceptable compromise between both SID’s. Verify the O.D. at a range of different kV’s. USE OF TWO FILM SCREENS (ONE FOR EACH SID) USING ONE PREVIOUSLY CALIBRATED FILM SCREEN AND ONE UNCALIBRATED FILM SCREEN Select the wall bucky image receptor via the selector configured for the 40 in. (100 cm) SID. Repeat steps 1 to 13 at the 40 in. (100 cm) SID position using the appropriate previously calibrated film screen. Rev. J Millenia / Indico 100 / CMP 200 Service Manual Ch # 740904-06 CPI Canada Inc. AEC Calibration 3D 3D.11.0 AEC CALIBRATION (WALL BUCKY) Cont Step 17. 18. 19. 20. 21. Action Verify the O.D. at a range of different kV’s. Switch the generator OFF. Re-enter the programming mode as detailed in the TABLE BUCKY AEC calibration section. Select the wall Bucky image receptor via the selector configured for the 72 in. (180 cm) SID. Calibrate the film screen assigned to this SID as per the table Bucky procedure. The calibration pot is NOT to be adjusted during this procedure (this was calibrated in the preceding procedure). All breakpoints, including the 75 kV knee breakpoint, are to be calibrated by adjusting the calibration numbers ONLY. When complete, exit the AEC CALIBRATION and GEN CONFIGURATION menu. 3D.12.0 AEC CALIBRATION (AUX, SFD, ETC) The remaining image receptors are calibrated in a similar manner to the table Bucky receptor. Only the gain pot for that channel is to be adjusted at the slowest film screen used on that receptor. DO NOT READJUST THE GAIN POT FOR PREVIOUSLY CALIBRATED RECEPTORS, AND DO NOT READJUST THE CALIBRATION VALUES IN THE AEC CALIBRATION MENU FOR PREVIOUSLY CALIBRATED FILM SCREENS. Refer to 3D.4.0 if a PMT is to be used for AEC during digital acquisition or spot film work. THE MEMORY FUNCTION THAT WAS TEMPORARILY CHANGED TO OFF EARLIER IN THIS CHAPTER MAY NOW BE RESET TO THE DESIRED VALUE. Millenia / Indico 100 / CMP 200 Service Manual Ch # 740904-06 Rev. J Page 3D-43 3D AEC Calibration CPI Canada Inc. (This page intentionally left blank) Page 3D-44 Rev. J Millenia / Indico 100 / CMP 200 Service Manual Ch # 740904-06 CPI Canada Inc. ABS Calibration 3E CHAPTER 3 SECTION 3E ABS CALIBRATION CONTENTS: 3E.1.0 INTRODUCTION .......................................................................................................................................3E-2 3E.1.1 Overview of ABS Operation ...................................................................................................................3E-2 3E.1.2 Image Intensifier Light Output................................................................................................................3E-3 3E.1.3 ABS Pickup Devices ..............................................................................................................................3E-4 3E.1.4 Required Test Equipment ......................................................................................................................3E-5 3E.2.0 ABS PICKUP INSTALLATION / WIRING ..................................................................................................3E-5 3E.2.1 Overview ................................................................................................................................................3E-5 3E.2.2 ABS Jumper Matrix. ...............................................................................................................................3E-6 3E.2.3 PMT (Photo Multiplier Tube) ..................................................................................................................3E-7 3E.2.4 Photo Diode ...........................................................................................................................................3E-7 3E.2.5 DC Proportional .....................................................................................................................................3E-8 3E.2.6 Composite Video....................................................................................................................................3E-8 3E.3.0 FLUORO SETUP AND CALIBRATION.....................................................................................................3E-8 3E.3.1 Fluoro Setup Menu Structure.................................................................................................................3E-9 3E.3.2 High Level Fluoro (HLF).......................................................................................................................3E-11 3E.3.3 Dose Limits / PF Setup ........................................................................................................................3E-14 3E.3.4 ABS Defaults........................................................................................................................................3E-20 3E.3.5 I.I. Input Dose Calibration ....................................................................................................................3E-24 Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-07 Rev. H Page 3E-1 3E ABS Calibration CPI Canada Inc. 3E.1.0 INTRODUCTION 3E.1.1 Overview of ABS Operation Refer to figure 3E-1, this is a block diagram of the ABS system. X-rays pass through the patient and excite the input cesium phosphor of the image intensifier (I.I.). This will cause the output of the I.I. to fluoresce and project the image to the TV camera via the collimating lens. A sample of the light output is then sensed by a photodiode or photomultiplier tube (PMT), or composite or proportional video will be fed back from the camera. The feedback signal is processed by the ABS circuits on the generator interface board. The result, regardless of the type of ABS sensor used, will be a DC voltage proportional to the brightness of the image. This DC signal is then processed by the generator CPU board. The CPU compares the feedback voltage with a reference value determined by dose rate, mA, kVp, and mA ranges set during ABS calibration. The CPU will attempt to maintain constant image brightness by varying the kVp and / or mA output of the power supply according to a predetermined algorithm. Figure 3E-1: ABS block diagram Page 3E-2 Rev. H Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-07 CPI Canada Inc. ABS Calibration 3E 3E.1.2 Image Intensifier Light Output The following variables affect the transmitted light output of an I.I. tube. • • • • Image Intensifier gain. Field size - input to output. System components. Choice of X-ray techniques. Image Intensifier Gain. Image tube gain is affected by two different factors, the ratio of the input to output phosphor area and the electron gain due to the electron acceleration from the cathode to anode. A third effect that slowly reduces the I.I. tube’s gain is age. The emissivity of the cesium cathode decays with time and usage. Gain = Area of input divided by the area of the output multiplied by the energy of a photon (E = hc/λ [where h = Plank’s constant, c = speed of light and λ is the light wavelength]) Example: Consider the difference of I.I. tube gain when a 12 inch I.I. tube is switched between 6 inches and 12 inches. Gain with tube in NORMAL mode: Gain =(6 X 6 X π)/(.5 X .5 x π) = 144 X E Gain with tube in the MAG mode: Gain =(3 X 3 X π)/(.5 X .5 x π) = 36 X E Field Size - Input to Output. Most modern I.I. tubes are the multi-mode type where the effective input area may be changed per the nature of the procedure. To change the field size of an I.I. tube when a MAG mode is selected, the electron beam over-scans the output target. This in effect reduces the ratio of input size to output size and reduces the gain or light output of the I.I. tube. Figure 3E-2: I.I. input and output area Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-07 Rev. H Page 3E-3 3E ABS Calibration CPI Canada Inc. 3E.1.3 ABS Pickup Devices Shown below are pictorial representations of the three basic types of light sensors that generate the DC reference signal used by the generator. These are simplified schematics only; refer to section 3E.2.0 for actual wiring of the ABS pickup device. Photo-multiplier tube HIGH VOLTAGE TO J7 PIN 1 OF UNIVERSAL AEC INTERFACE BOARD TO J7 PIN-12 TO J7 PIN-7 GENERATOR INTERFACE BOARD NOTE: MINIMUM DYNODE LOAD 1 MEG OHM OR GREATER Photo Diode Composite Video or Proportional DC Figure 3E-3: ABS Pickup Devices Page 3E-4 Rev. H Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-07 CPI Canada Inc. ABS Calibration 3E 3E.1.4 Required Test Equipment The following test equipment is required for ABS calibration. • • • • • Resolution test pattern for imaging focusing. Central ray alignment fixture. Collimator centering test pattern. A selection of Al filters for HVL determination. Water or lexan (or equivalent) absorbers in various thickness. Water should be in a plastic container of uniform thickness. 3E.2.0 ABS PICKUP INSTALLATION / WIRING Sections 3E.1.3 and 3E.2.1 present an overview of the various ABS pickup types that may be used with the Millenia and Indico 100 family of generators. The generator must be specifically configured to accept each pickup type as per table 3E-2 and sections 3E.2.3, 3E.2.4, 3E.2.5 and 3E.2.6. NOTE THAT THE GENERATOR IS FACTORY CONFIGURED FOR ONE SPECIFIC TYPE OF ABS PICKUP ONLY. REFER TO THE COMPATIBILITY STATEMENT / CUSTOMER PRODUCT DESCRIPTION FORM IN CHAPTER 1D FOR THE FACTORY CONFIGURED ABS COMPATIBILITY OF THIS GENERATOR. 3E.2.1 Overview The generator has been factory configured to be compatible with one of the following ABS pickup types. Field reconfiguration to accept other ABS pickup types, listed below, is possible if required. • • • • PMT (photo multiplier tube). Light sensitive optical diode. The output may be 0 to +5 VDC, 0 to -5 VDC, or +/- VDC centered at 0 VDC. A proportional (to the brightness of the I.I.) DC voltage. The output polarity may be 0 to +5 VDC or 0 to -5 VDC. A terminated or non - terminated composite video signal. Refer to chapter 1E for the AEC board and generator interface board location in your generator. Figure 3E-4: ABS interface to the generator (overview) Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-07 Rev. H Page 3E-5 3E ABS Calibration CPI Canada Inc. 3E.2.2 ABS Jumper Matrix. The table below details the generator interface board jumper positions as required to be compatible with the listed ABS pickups. Refer to the generator interface board schematic, or to the ABS functional drawing in conjunction with this table. This table should be used in conjunction with sections 3E.2.3, 3E.2.4 3E.2.5, and 3E.2.6. ABS PICKUP TYPE GENERATOR INTERFACE BOARD INPUTS & JUMPER CONFIGURATIONS INPUT JW4 JW5 JW11 JW12 JW13 JW19 JW20 JW21 Photo Multiplier Tube J7 OUT Photo Multiplier Tube J8 OUT Photo Diode (negative output) Photo Diode (positive output) Photo Diode 0-5 VDC neg/pos Proportional DC 0-5 VDC positive Proportional DC 0-5 VDC positive Proportional DC 0-5 VDC negative Proportional DC 0-5 VDC negative Composite video terminated 75 Ω Composite video high impedance Via optional expansion board in digital system J7 OUT J7 OUT J7 OUT J7 OUT J8 OUT J7 OUT J8 OUT J8 OUT IN J8 IN OUT Via J13 OUT * * * * * * * * * * PINS 1-2 PINS 1-2 PINS 1-2 PINS 2-3 PINS 2-3 PINS 2-3 PINS 2-3 PINS 1-2 PINS 1-2 PINS 3-4 PINS 3-4 OUT OUT * * OUT OUT PINS 1-2 IN OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT * * * * * * * * OUT OUT PINS 1-2 OUT OUT OUT * * OUT OUT OUT OUT IN OUT IN PINS 1-2 PINS 2-3 PINS 2-3 * * * * * IN IN PINS 2-3 PINS 2-3 PINS 2-3 PINS 2-3 PINS 2-3 PINS 2-3 PINS 2-3 PINS 2-3 PINS 2-3 PINS 2-3 PINS 2-3 PINS 1-2 * = Don’t care i.e. jumper may be in any position Table 3E-1: ABS jumper matrix THE TABLE ABOVE SHOWS THE OPTION OF CONNECTING THE OUTPUTS FROM A PMT OR PROPORTIONAL DC TO J8 INSTEAD OF J7. THIS ALTERNATE CONNECTION IS NOT SHOWN IN THE SIMPLIFIED PICTORIAL DIAGRAMS, FIGURES 3E-3 OR 3E-4. Page 3E-6 Rev. H Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-07 CPI Canada Inc. ABS Calibration WARNING: CAPACITORS SWITCH OFF THE GENERATOR AND ENSURE THAT ALL DISCHARGED BEFORE CONNECTING ANY ABS PICKUP DEVICES. 3E ARE 3E.2.3 PMT (Photo Multiplier Tube) The generator must be fitted with the “Universal AEC Board” assembly if using a PMT. The high voltage supply for the PMT is located on this assembly. 1. Dress the PMT cable from the imaging system such as to allow the dynode high voltage lead to plug into the “universal AEC interface board” at J7. Refer to figure 3E-4. J7 is the high voltage output for the PMT; all pins on this connector are connected in parallel and thus any of the 4 pins on J7 may be used. Ensure that the high voltage lead is rated at 1000 VDC minimum. NOTE: The total resistive load of all dynodes must be greater than 1 megohm to prevent excess PMT power supply loading. 2. Dress the signal (coax) cable from the PMT to allow it to connect to J7 on the generator interface board. Wire to J7 as per figure 3E-3. Alternately, the PMT output may be connected to BNC connector J8 on the generator interface board. 3. Ensure that there is sufficient slack in the cables such that the cabinet door (Millenia generators) does not strain these cables when opening and closing. Secure the cables in place such as to prevent mechanical stress on the connections. 4. The signal ground must be at the generator interface board only to avoid ground loops. 5. Position the jumpers on the generator interface board as per table 3E-1 for Photo Multiplier Tube, selecting the correct configuration depending on whether the input is at J7 or J8. 6. The PMT high voltage calibration will be done at a later step. 3E.2.4 Photo Diode 1. Dress the signal cable from the photo diode circuit to allow it to connect to J7 on the generator interface board. Connect the photodiode to J7 as follows: Output signal to pin 12, ground to pin 7, +12 VDC to pin 4, and -12 VDC if used to pin 5. 2. Ensure that there is sufficient slack in the cable such that the cabinet door (Millenia generators) does not strain this cable when opening and closing. Secure the cables in place such as to prevent mechanical stress on the connections. 3. Note that there are three types of photo diodes for this application with outputs as listed below: • a zero to positive DC voltage for increasing light flux • a zero to negative DC voltage for increasing light flux • a negative DC voltage to positive DC voltage for increasing light flux. The required dose is set for 0 volts. The output will be negative for reduced light due to increased patient absorption, then swinging positive for increased light due to reduced patient absorption. 4. Position the jumpers on the generator interface board as per table 3E-1 for Photo Diode. Please ensure that the correct configuration is selected per your photo diode type as detailed above. Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-07 Rev. H Page 3E-7 3E ABS Calibration CPI Canada Inc. 3E.2.5 DC Proportional 1. Dress the signal cable from the camera to allow it to connect to J7 on the generator interface board. Wire to J7 as per figure 3E-3. Alternately, the DC proportional signal output may be connected to BNC connector J8 on the generator interface board. 2. Ensure that there is sufficient slack in the cable such that the cabinet door (Millenia generators) does not strain this cable when opening and closing. Secure the cable in place such as to prevent mechanical stress on the connections. 3. Position the jumpers on the generator interface board as per table 3E-1 for Proportional DC, selecting the correct configuration depending on whether the input is at J7 or J8 and whether the polarity is negative or positive. 3E.2.6 Composite Video 1. Dress the composite video output from the camera to allow it to connect to J8 on the generator interface board. 2. Ensure that there is sufficient slack in the cable such that the cabinet door (Millenia generators) does not strain this cable when opening and closing. Secure the cable in place such as to prevent mechanical stress on the terminations. 3. Position the jumpers on the generator interface board as per table 3E-1 for Composite Video, selecting the correct configuration depending on whether the video is 75 ohm-terminated or high impedance (it must be determined beforehand whether the 75 ohm termination must be made at the generator). Composite video ABS is not recommended with pulsed fluoro applications. 3E.3.0 FLUORO SETUP AND CALIBRATION Before the ABS system can be calibrated, the imaging system must be functional and properly set up. Please verify the following: • • • • • • • • • • • • • • Page 3E-8 Image intensifier and its power supply are functional. TV camera is calibrated for this application. All beam attenuating devices are in place. Table top is in position. Fluoro grid is in path of X-ray beam. Imaging system is in the operational position. Imaging collimator functional. Collimator opening varies as S.I.D. is changed. (S.I.D. = source-image distance). Collimator opening varies as the image intensifier’s MAG mode switch is changed. The ABS pickup device (as per the previous section) must be installed and functional. Sufficient filters are added to the X-ray tube to provide the required HVL. The fluoro imaging and receptor devices have been programmed. Refer to chapter 3C. kVp and mA must be in calibration. Refer to chapter 4. Ensure that JW22 on the generator interface board is set properly for the application: Jumper JW22 pins 1-2 to provide line frequency sync pulses (for conventional imaging systems), or jumper JW22 pins 2-3 for external sync input (for digital imaging systems). Rev. H Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-07 CPI Canada Inc. ABS Calibration 3E 3E.3.1 Fluoro Setup Menu Structure Figures 3E-5 and 3E-6 show the fluoro setup menu structure. Figure 3E-5 is used for generators without optional pulsed fluoro, and figure 3E-6 is used on generators with pulsed fluoro. Information on the top and bottom lines of the LCD display, such as tube number, I.I. magnification, dose setting, etc is omitted on these figures for clarity. *FLUORO SETUP* DOSE LIMITS ABS SETUP MIN FLUORO KV: I/I MODES: FL-RAD KV XFER: 50 2 6 + - >> EXIT *FLUORO SETUP* ABS DEFAULT: OFF FL TIMER MODE: 10MIN << LOOP GAIN: 60 NOMINAL DOSE: DOSE 1: 100 DOSE 2: 100 << *ABS SETUP* AUTO MA/KV CURVE: 1 ABS CHANNEL: 5 80 + - *DOSE LIM - ABS* 1.0MA: 2.0MA: 3.0MA: 4.0MA: 5.0MA: 6.0MA: 125KV 125KV 125KV 125KV << 125KV 125KV >> *DOSE LIM - MAN* 1.0MA: 2.0MA: 3.0MA: 4.0MA: 5.0MA: 6.0MA: 125KV 125KV 125KV 125KV << 125KV 125KV RETURN FILE: V_A_ABS.CDR Figure 3E-5: Fluoro setup menus, non - pulsed fluoro generators Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-07 Rev. H Page 3E-9 Page 3E-10 Rev. H 125KV 125KV 125KV 125KV << 125KV 125KV 125KV 125KV << 1.0MA: 2.0MA: 3.0MA: 4.0MA: 1.0MA: 2.0MA: 3.0MA: 4.0MA: LOOP GAIN: 60 NOMINAL DOSE: DOSE 1: 100 DOSE 2: 100 << << PF MA: PF MS: >> 20 6 + - 2 6 + - *DOSE LIM - MAN* *DOSE LIM - ABS* 125KV 125KV + - 125KV 125KV + - 3 PPS: 7.5 PPS: 15 PPS: 30 PPS: << << 125 125 125 125 KV KV KV KV *DOSE LIM - PF* *ABS SETUP* FL SIGNAL GAIN: 20 PF SIGNAL GAIN: 20 Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual + FILE: V_B_ABS.CDR RETURN RETURN *HLF SETUP* HLF ABS DEF. : NONE HLF: OFF 20 HLF MAX MA: HLF DEFAULT: OFF + HLF ABS RANGE: HIGH HLF MA/KV CURVE: 0 << << *FLUORO SETUP* ABS DEFAULT: OFF FL TIMER MODE: 10MIN HIGH LEVEL FLUORO ABS Calibration >> 5.0MA: 6.0MA: >> 5.0MA: 6.0MA: *ABS SETUP* AUTO MA/KV CURVE: 1 ABS CHANNEL: 5 80 + >> *PF SETUP* 50 I/I MODES: FL-RAD KV XFER: *FLUORO SETUP* PF: ON PF DEFAULT: ON PPS DEFAULT: NONE DOSE LIMITS ABS SETUP PULSED FLUORO MIN FLUORO KV: EXIT 3E CPI Canada Inc. 3E.3.1 Fluoro Setup Menu Structure (Cont) Figure 3E-6: Fluoro setup menus, pulsed fluoro generators Ch # 740904-07 CPI Canada Inc. ABS Calibration 3E 3E.3.2 High Level Fluoro (HLF) High level fluoro (HLF) is optional, and is intended for use with therapy simulators only. High level fluoro operates at mA levels up to 20 mA, resulting in higher than normal patient dose. Please observe the note below. WARNING: HIGH LEVEL FLUOROSCOPY IS COMPATIBLE WITH THERAPY SIMULATORS ONLY. HIGH LEVEL FLUORO MUST NOT BE ENABLED FOR OTHER APPLICATIONS WARNING: USE OF HIGH LEVEL FLUORO MAY CAUSE INCREASED TUBE HEATING. PLEASE ENSURE THAT THE X-RAY TUBE THERMAL SWITCH IS FUNCTIONING PROPERLY, THAT THE THERMAL SWITCH IS PROPERLY CONNECTED TO THE GENERATOR, AND THAT THE GENERATOR THERMAL INTERLOCK CIRCUITS ARE FUNCTIONING NORMALLY. Definitions of HLF SETUP menu items. • HLF Selects or deselects HLF mode. OFF: HLF mode is disabled. ON: HLF mode is enabled. • HLF DEFAULT Determines the HLF mode when a fluoroscopic receptor is selected. OFF: HLF defaults to OFF when a fluoro receptor is selected. ON: HLF defaults to ON when a fluoro receptor is selected. • HLF ABS RANGE Determines the HLF mode of operation for ABS. OFF: ABS mode is disabled when HLF is on. HIGH: ABS will operate between 5.0 mA and the HLF MAX MA value, a maximum of 20 mA. FULL: ABS will operate between 0.5 mA and the HLF MAX MA value, a maximum of 20 mA. • HLF MA/KV CURVE This allows selection of one-of-three mA / kV curves for HLF ABS operation. 0 deselects this function. The ABS will only vary the fluoro kV during HLF operation, holding the mA constant. 1, 2, or 3 selects one of the mA / kV curves on page 3E-13. The ABS will vary the mA and the kV as per the selected curve during HLF operation. Note that there are two sets of curves, one for the HIGH ABS range, and one for the FULL ABS range. • HLF ABS DEF Determines whether ABS will default to ON or OFF when a fluoroscopic receptor is selected. NONE: ABS will remain at its previous setting when HLF mode is selected. OFF: ABS will default to OFF when HLF mode is selected. ABS: ABS will default to ON when HLF mode is selected. • HLF MAX MA Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Sets the maximum allowed HLF mA. The maximum HLF mA range is 10 to 20 mA. This may be used to set the maximum HLF dose limit. Ch # 740904-07 Rev. H Page 3E-11 3E ABS Calibration CPI Canada Inc. 3E.3.2 High Level Fluoro (HLF) Cont Use these steps to set the HLF SETUP menu items. Step 1. 2. Page 3E-12 Action From the FLUORO SETUP menu, select HIGH LEVEL FLUORO. In the HLF SETUP menu, set the HLF parameters described on the previous page as required. The parameters HLF, HLF DEFAULT, HLF ABS RANGE, and HLF ABS DEF are set by toggling the buttons adjacent to these functions. HLF MA/KV CURVE and HLF MAX MA are set by pressing the adjacent button to select these functions, then by using the + or - buttons to select the desired value. Rev. H Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-07 CPI Canada Inc. ABS Calibration 3E 3E.3.2 High Level Fluoro (HLF) Cont Curve 1 - HLF ABS Range = High 20 18 16 14 12 10 8 6 M 4 A 2 0 Curve 1 - HLF ABS Range = Full 20 18 16 14 12 10 8 6 M 4 A 2 0 F L U O R O F L U O R O 40 50 60 70 80 90 100 110 120 125 40 50 60 FLUORO kV 70 80 90 100 110 120 125 FLUORO kV Curve 2 - HLF ABS Range = High Curve 2 - HLF ABS Range = Full 20 18 16 14 12 10 8 6 M 4 A 2 0 20 18 16 14 12 10 8 6 M 4 A 2 0 F L U O R O F L U O R O 40 50 60 70 80 90 100 110 120 130 40 50 60 FLUORO kV 80 90 100 110 120 125 FLUORO kV Curve 3 - HLF ABS Range = High 20 18 16 14 12 10 8 6 M 4 A 2 0 70 Curve 3 - HLF ABS Range = Full 20 18 16 14 12 10 8 6 M 4 A 2 0 F L U O R O F L U O R O 40 50 60 70 80 90 100 110 120 125 40 50 FLUORO kV Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual 60 70 80 90 100 110 120 125 FLUORO kV Ch # 740904-07 Rev. H Page 3E-13 3E ABS Calibration CPI Canada Inc. 3E.3.3 Dose Limits / PF Setup Figure 3E-7: Dose limits test setup Page 3E-14 Rev. H Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-07 CPI Canada Inc. ABS Calibration 3E 3E.3.3 Dose Limits / PF Setup (Cont) This procedure sets the maximum kV allowed for each mA step in both manual and ABS mode of operation, and sets the maximum kV allowed for each PPS rate (for optional pulsed fluoro). CAUTION: MAXIMUM INPUT DOSE VALUE IS USUALLY GOVERNED BY LOCAL, STATE OR COUNTRY REGULATIONS. THESE LIMITS MUST BE DETERMINED IN ADVANCE OF ATTEMPTING DOSE LIMITS SETUP, AND ADHERED TO DURING GENERATOR CALIBRATION. NOTE: REFER TO LOCAL REGULATIONS TO DETERMINE THE REQUIRED DISTANCE BETWEEN THE FOCAL SPOT AND RADIATION DETECTOR. THIS FOCAL SPOT TO DETECTOR DISTANCE MUST BE USED WHEN SETTING UP THE RADIATION DETECTOR FOR DOSE LIMITS CALIBRATION. CAUTION: PROCEDURES IN THE FOLLOWING SECTIONS REQUIRE THE PRODUCTION OF X-RAYS. IT IS THE RESPONSIBILITY OF THE INSTALLER TO FOLLOW ESTABLISHED GUIDELINES TO PROTECT ALL PERSONNEL FROM RADIATION EXPOSURE. Use these steps to set the DOSE LIMITS. Step 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 6. 7. 8. Action Set up the radiation probe as per figure 3E-7 in the position indicated Max. Patient Input Dose. Refer to the note above re focal spot to radiation probe distance. No absorber is required at this point in the setup. Temporarily unplug the ABS pickup at J7 or J8 of the generator interface board. Temporarily de-energize the I.I. power supply, or cover the I.I. with approximately 1/16 in. (1.6 mm) lead. Enter into the generator programming mode. Refer to chapter 3C, section 3C.1.1. From the GENERATOR SETUP menu select GEN CONFIGURATION. From the GEN CONFIGURATION menu select FLUORO SETUP. Select a fluoroscopic image receptor. Select ABS SETUP. Select AUTO MA/KV CURVE, then use the + or - buttons to select auto mA/kV curve 1. Select << to return to the FLUORO SETUP menu. Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-07 Rev. H Page 3E-15 3E ABS Calibration CPI Canada Inc. 3E.3.3 Dose Limits / PF Setup (Cont) IT IS RECOMMENDED THAT COPIES BE MADE OF ALL PAGES WHERE RESULTS ARE TO BE RECORDED. THE RESULTS SHOULD THEN BE RECORDED ON THE COPIES, LEAVING THE ORIGINALS BLANK. Step 9. Action Record the maximum permissible input dose values for ABS, non-ABS (manual), and PF (optional) modes of fluoroscopy as per local regulations. Result Maximum permitted input dose: ABS mode:______________ R/Min. Non ABS mode:__________ R/Min. PF mode:_______________ R/Min. 10. 11. 12. 13. 14. 15. 16. Page 3E-16 From the FLUORO SETUP menu, select DOSE LIMITS. From the DOSE LIM - ABS menu, select >>. Ensure that ABS is switched OFF via the console. Also, ensure that PF is switched OFF via the console (if applicable). Set the default kV for each mA station in the DOSE LIM - MAN menu to the maximum permissible value (110 or 125 kV) as per local regulations. To do this, select the desired mA in the LCD display, then use the + or - buttons adjacent to the LCD display to set the maximum kV. Enter the value 6.0 mA in the fluoro control section of the console. While observing the dosimeter, make a fluoroscopy exposure. Adjust the kV via the fluoro section of the console such that the maximum permitted dose as recorded in step 9 for ABS mode is not exceeded. Record the kV value as determined in the previous step for the 6.0 mA setting. 17. Repeat steps 14 to 16 for 5.0 mA. 18. Repeat steps 14 to 16 for 4.0 mA. 19. Repeat steps 14 to 16 for 3.0 mA. 20. Repeat steps 14 to 16 for 2.0 mA. 21. Repeat steps 14 to 16 for 1.0 mA. 22. Re-enter the value 6.0 mA in the fluoro control section of the console. Rev. H The DOSE LIM. - ABS menu will be displayed. The DOSE LIM. - MAN menu will be displayed. Max kV limit for 6.0 mA = ______(ABS) Max kV limit for 5.0 mA = ______(ABS) Max kV limit for 4.0 mA = ______(ABS) Max kV limit for 3.0 mA = ______(ABS) Max kV limit for 2.0 mA = ______(ABS) Max kV limit for 1.0 mA = ______(ABS) Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-07 CPI Canada Inc. ABS Calibration 3E 3E.3.3 Dose Limits / PF Setup (Cont) Step 23. 24. Action While observing the dosimeter, make a fluoroscopy exposure. Adjust the kV via the fluoro section of the console such that the maximum permitted dose as recorded in step 9 for non-ABS mode is not exceeded. Record the kV value as determined in the previous step for the 6.0 mA setting. 25. Repeat steps 22 to 24 for 5.0 mA. 26. Repeat steps 22 to 24 for 4.0 mA. 27. Repeat steps 22 to 24 for 3.0 mA. 28. Repeat steps 22 to 24 for 2.0 mA. 29. Repeat steps 22 to 24 for 1.0 mA. 30. Enter the kV limit for non-ABS mode as recorded in step 24 for the 6.0 mA station into the 6.0 mA dose limit step in the LCD display by selecting the 6.0 mA step in the DOSE LIM - MAN menu, then entering the required kV value using the + or - buttons adjacent to the LCD display. Repeat the previous step for the 5.0 mA to 1.0 mA stations (non-ABS kV limits). Select << to return to the DOSE LIM-ABS menu. Enter the kV limit for ABS mode as recorded in step 16 for the 6.0 mA station into the 6.0 mA dose limit step in the LCD display by selecting the 6.0 mA step in the DOSE LIM - ABS menu, then entering the required kV value using the + or - buttons adjacent to the LCD display. Repeat the previous step for the 5.0 to 1.0 mA stations (ABS kV limits). Select << to return to the FLUORO SETUP menu. If PF is not available, go to section 3E.3.4. If the PF option is available, continue with the next step. From the FLUORO SETUP menu, select PULSED FLUORO. 31. 32. 33. 34. 35. 36. Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-07 Result Max kV limit for 6.0 mA = ______(MAN) Max kV limit for 5.0 mA = ______(MAN Max kV limit for 4.0 mA = ______(MAN Max kV limit for 3.0 mA = ______(MAN Max kV limit for 2.0 mA = ______(MAN Max kV limit for 1.0 mA = ______(MAN) The PF SETUP menu will be displayed. Rev. H Page 3E-17 3E ABS Calibration CPI Canada Inc. 3E.3.3 Dose Limits / PF Setup (Cont) Definitions of PF SETUP menu items. • OFF disables pulsed fluoro operation. PF ON allows pulsed fluoro to be selected via the console. • Determines the fluoro mode when a fluoroscopic receptor is selected. PF DEFAULT NONE defaults fluoroscopy to the previously selected mode. If PF was ON when fluoro was last used, PF will default to ON when fluoro is re-selected. OFF defaults to continuous fluoro mode when a fluoro receptor is selected. ON defaults to pulsed fluoro mode when a fluoro receptor is selected. • Determines the PPS rate when pulsed fluoroscopy mode is selected. PPS DEFAULT NONE defaults the PPS rate to the last selected value. If the last used PPS was 15, the PPS will default to 15 when PF is reselected. Selecting one of the available PPS rates (3, 7.5, 15, or 30 PPS) will default the PPS to that value when PF is selected. The PF SETUP menu displays 60 Hz based PPS rates only. For systems with 50 Hz based sync input, select the PPS rate nearest to the desired PPS (2.5, 6.25, 12.5, or 25 PPS). • PF MA Sets the pulsed fluoro mA. Typical pulsed fluoro mA is 15 to 20 mA. • PF MS Sets the PF pulse width in milliseconds. Typical pulse widths are 5 to 8 ms. Step 37. 38. 39. 40. 41. 42. Page 3E-18 Action Set PF, PF DEFAULT, and PPS DEFAULT as appropriate. These items are set by selecting the button adjacent to the desired parameter, then toggling the button to make the desired selection. Set the PF MA and PF MS by pressing the button adjacent to the desired selection, then setting the desired value using the + or - buttons adjacent to the LCD display. Select << to return to the FLUORO SETUP menu. From the FLUORO SETUP menu, select DOSE LIMITS. From the DOSE LIM - ABS menu, press >> two times. Select a fluoroscopic image receptor. Ensure that pulsed fluoro is ON. Rev. H Result Use care in choosing these parameters. High mA and / or high ms settings may require that the kV be limited to an unsuitably low value. The DOSE LIM - ABS menu will be displayed. The DOSE LIM - PF menu will be displayed. Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-07 CPI Canada Inc. ABS Calibration 3E 3E.3.3 Dose Limits / PF Setup (Cont) Step 43. 44. 45. 46. 47. Action Set the default kV for each PPS station in the DOSE LIM - PF menu to the maximum permissible value as per local regulations. To do this, select the desired PPS in the LCD display, then use the + or - buttons adjacent to the LCD display to set the maximum kV. Select 3 PPS in the fluoro control section of the console. While observing the dosimeter, make a pulsed fluoroscopy exposure. Adjust the kV via the fluoro section of the console such that the maximum permitted dose as recorded in step 9 for PF mode is not exceeded. Record the kV value as determined in the previous step for the 3 PPS setting. Max kV limit for 3 PPS = ________(PF) Repeat steps 44 to 46 for the 7.5 PPS step. Max kV limit for 7.5 PPS = _______(PF) 48. Repeat steps 44 to 46 for the 15 PPS step. 49. Repeat steps 44 to 46 for the 30 PPS step. Result Max kV limit for 15 PPS = _______(PF) Max kV limit for 30 PPS = _______(PF) 50. Enter the kV limit as recorded in step 46 for 3 PPS into the 3 PPS dose limit step in the LCD display by selecting the 3 PPS step in the DOSE LIM - PF menu, then entering the required kV value using the + or - buttons adjacent to the LCD display. 51. Repeat the previous step for the 7.5 to 30 PPS settings. IF PF MA OR PF MS ARE CHANGED AS PER STEP 38, THE PULSED FLUORO DOSE LIMITS MUST BE RECALIBRATED, AS THESE WILL INFLUENCE THE MAXIMUM PERMISSIBLE KV. 52. Select << as required to return to the The FLUORO SETUP menu will be displayed. FLUORO SETUP menu. Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-07 Rev. H Page 3E-19 3E ABS Calibration CPI Canada Inc. 3E.3.4 ABS Defaults Step 1. 2. 3. Page 3E-20 Action From the FLUORO SETUP menu, select MIN FLUORO KV. Press the + or - buttons to select the minimum kV to be allowed in fluoro. Select I/I MODES. Press the + or - buttons to select the number of magnification modes in the I.I. (2 corresponds to 2 mag modes plus normal mode). If this is set to 0, the console and remote fluoro control will not display the mag status. This may be desired if an external mag mode control and display are used. Select FL-RAD KV XFER. Press the + or - buttons to select the desired fluoro - rad kV transfer curve. This allows selection of one-of-seven fluoro to rad kV transfer curves (Millenia) or oneof-ten fluoro to rad kV transfer curves (Indico 100). When in fluoro operation with ABS on, the fluoro kV value is transferred to the RADIOGRAPHY section of the console at the end of the fluoro exposure. This presets the rad kV in preparation for a rapid follow-on radiographic exposure for digital acquisition or spot film work. Selecting 0 disables this function. Graphs of the fluoro kV to rad kV transfer function are shown on the next two pages. Rev. H Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-07 CPI Canada Inc. ABS Calibration 3E 3E.3.4 ABS Defaults (Cont) CURVE 1 150 140 130 R 120 A 110 D 100 90 80 k V 70 60 50 40 40 50 60 70 80 90 CURVE 2 100 110 120 130 150 140 130 R 120 A 110 D 100 90 80 k V 70 60 50 40 40 50 60 70 FLUORO kV 50 60 70 80 90 100 110 120 130 50 60 70 60 70 80 90 80 90 100 110 120 130 FLUORO kV CURVE 5 50 100 110 120 130 CURVE 4 150 140 130 R 120 A 110 D 100 90 80 k V 70 60 50 40 40 FLUORO kV 150 140 130 R 120 A 110 D 100 90 80 k V 70 60 50 40 40 90 FLUORO kV CURVE 3 150 140 130 R 120 A 110 D 100 90 80 k V 70 60 50 40 40 80 CURVE 6 100 110 120 130 150 140 130 R 120 A 110 D 100 90 80 k V 70 60 50 40 40 50 60 70 FLUORO kV 80 90 100 110 120 130 FLUORO kV FILE: ABS_CURVES1.CDR Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-07 Rev. H Page 3E-21 3E ABS Calibration CPI Canada Inc. 3E.3.4 ABS Defaults (Cont) CURVE 8 * CURVE 7 150 140 130 R 120 A 110 D 100 90 80 k V 70 60 50 40 40 50 60 70 80 90 100 110 120 130 150 140 130 R 120 A 110 D 100 90 80 k V 70 60 50 40 40 50 60 70 FLUORO kV 50 60 70 80 100 110 120 130 CURVE 10 * 90 100 110 120 130 FLUORO kV 90 FLUORO kV CURVE 9 * 150 140 130 R 120 A 110 D 100 90 80 k V 70 60 50 40 40 80 150 140 130 R 120 A 110 D 100 90 80 k V 70 60 50 40 40 50 60 70 80 90 100 110 120 130 FLUORO kV * Fluoro - Rad kV curves 8 to 10 only apply to Indico 100 FILE: ABS_CURVES2.CDR Page 3E-22 Rev. H Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-07 CPI Canada Inc. ABS Calibration 3E 3E.3.4 ABS Defaults (Cont) Step 4. 5. Action From the FLUORO SETUP menu select >>. The above menu will display. Select ABS DEFAULT. Toggle to select NONE, OFF, or ABS. 6. NONE: No default selected, ABS remains at its last setting. OFF: Defaults to ABS OFF. ABS: Defaults to ABS ON. Select FL TIMER MODE. Toggle to select 5MIN or 10MIN. 5MIN: Alarms at 5.0 minutes, and stops incrementing the timer. Fluoro exposures will continue. 10MIN: Alarms at 5.0 minutes, stops incrementing the timer at 9.6 minutes. Fluoro exposures will be inhibited at 9.6 minutes. Select << to return to the FLUORO SETUP menu. Select ABS SETUP. The ABS SETUP menu will display as shown below. Select ABS CHANNEL. This selects the hardware ABS input. This must be set to 5. Select AUTO MA/KV CURVE. Press the + or - buttons to select the desired fluoro mA / kV curve. This sets how the kV and mA change during ABS operation. 7. 8. 9. 10. 0: Changes kV only (mA set manually). 1: kV linear mA. 2: mA leading kV. 3: kV leading mA #1. 4: kV leading mA #2 (reduced dose). Refer to the graph of these curves as shown below. ABS mA/kV CURVES M A 4.5 4 3.5 3 2.5 2 1.5 1 0.5 0 kV linear mA mA leading kV kV leading mA #1 kV leading mA #2 40 50 60 70 80 90 100 110 120 130 KV Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-07 Rev. H Page 3E-23 3E ABS Calibration CPI Canada Inc. 3E.3.5 I.I. Input Dose Calibration This procedure sets the actual operating input dose to the I.I. Please note the following: • • • Ensure that the collimator is adjusted to only expose the I.I. input. The central ray from the X-ray tube must coincide with the center of the I.I. The required I.I. input dose must be known before proceeding. Figure 3E-8: PMT high voltage adjustment (AEC interface board) • • Page 3E-24 R10 adjusts the PMT high voltage during ABS operation. R19 and R24 adjust the ion chamber bias voltage and PMT high voltage during AEC operation. Refer to chapter 3D for details. Rev. H Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-07 CPI Canada Inc. ABS Calibration 3E 3E.3.5 I.I. Input Dose Calibration (Cont) Step 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. 10. 11. 12. 13. Action Reconnect the ABS pickup plug that was temporarily disconnected from J7 or J8 of the generator interface board in an earlier step. Re-energize the I.I. power supply or remove the lead that was temporarily installed in an earlier step. Set up the radiation probe as per figure 3E-7 in the position indicated I.I. Input Dose. This must be able to read dose values as low as 2 to 3 mR / min. Set up the absorber as shown in figure 3E-7. 1 1/2” (40 mm) of aluminum or 20 cm of water is recommended. Ensure that the absorber covers the full input field of the I.I. Ensure that the ABS is switched off. Select 75 kV and 1.5 mA. Ensure that the I.I. is in the NORMAL mode (MAG = 0). Ensure that an anti-scatter grid, if used, is properly installed. Make a fluoro exposure and measure the I.I. input dose. Adjust the fluoro kV to achieve the desired input dose. Connect a DVM or ‘scope to TP8 and ground of the generator interface board. FOR GENERATOR INTERFACE BOARDS WITH ABS GAIN ADJUST POTENTIOMETER R48 (no pulsed fluoro option): Adjust R48 on the generator interface board to achieve 1.50 VDC at the test points connected to in the previous step. FOR GENERATOR INTERFACE BOARDS WITH DIGITAL ABS GAIN ADJUST POT (units with pulsed fluoro option): • From the ABS SETUP menu, select >>. • Select FL SIGNAL GAIN, then use the + or - buttons to adjust the digital gain pot to achieve 1.50 VDC at the test points connected to in the previous step. • Select PF SIGNAL GAIN, then use the + or - buttons to adjust the I.I. input dose to achieve the desired frame rate dose. Setting the PF signal gain to 0 causes the generator to use the FL SIGNAL GAIN setting with PF. This may be used when a conditioned ABS signal is provided to the generator where the continuous and PF signal levels are scaled to be equal. • Select << to return to the ABS SETUP menu. From the ABS SETUP menu, select LOOP GAIN. Press the + or - buttons to select the initial value of 100. ENSURE THAT THE DOSE IS SET TO 0 ON THE CONSOLE. From the ABS SETUP menu, select NOMINAL DOSE. Press the + or - buttons to select a value of 200. Switch the ABS on. The LED adjacent to the ABS switch will light. NOTE: STEPS 14 TO 16 APPLY ONLY IF USING A PMT. IGNORE THESE STEPS FOR OTHER ABS PICKUP DEVICES WARNING: SWITCH OFF THE GENERATOR AND ENSURE THAT ALL CAPACITORS ARE DISCHARGED BEFORE MAKING AND REMOVING THE PMT CURRENT MEASURING EQUIPMENT Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-07 Rev. H Page 3E-25 3E ABS Calibration CPI Canada Inc. 3E.3.5 Dose1/Dose2 Calibration (Cont) Step 14. 15. 16. 17. 18. 19. 20. 21. 22. Page 3E-26 Action Connect a micro ammeter in series with the PMT signal output. Alternately, if a micro ammeter is not available, follow this procedure: • Temporarily connect a resistor of known value (100K is suggested) from either end of R61 on the generator interface board to ground. A DVM can then be used to measure the voltage developed by the PMT current across this resistor. However, this is not the preferred method of measurement. Adjust the PMT high voltage using R10 (refer to figure 3E-6) on the AEC interface board while pressing the fluoro footswitch such that the PMT current is 20 ± 5 uA at the desired I.I. input dose. This corresponds to a voltage of 2.00 ± 0.50 VDC for a 100K resistor if using the voltmeter method in the above step. The high voltage should be approximately -750 VDC at this point. The PMT high voltage is adjusted to yield the PMT current noted in this step. The approximate value of PMT voltage is stated for reference only. The PMT voltage does not normally need to be measured in this step, however, if it is desired to do so for troubleshooting purposes please note the following: USE TP5 ONLY ON THE AEC INTERFACE BOARD FOR THE HV METER GROUND WHEN MEASURING PMT HIGH VOLTAGE. CONNECT THE GROUND FIRST BEFORE MEASURING THE HIGH VOLTAGE. DO NOT ATTEMPT TO MEASURE THIS WITHOUT A SUITABLE METER. Disconnect the meter (and resistor if applicable) that was connected in step 3. Reconnect the PMT signal lead if required. Verify stability of the ABS system with continuous fluoroscopy. Check stability with and without the absorber. The ABS should quickly stabilize without hunting or settling on the wrong kV value. If the ABS is unstable, try reducing the sensitivity of the ABS pickup device first. If this does not work, try reducing the LOOP GAIN. However, be aware that reducing the loop gain increases the hysterisis (“deadband”), consequently the kV may stabilize on any value within the deadband range. Initiate fluoro operation and measure the input dose to the I.I. If this value is not as desired adjust the NOMINAL DOSE using the + or - buttons as required. Record the nominal dose calibration value as indicated in the LCD display in the next step. Record the NOMINAL DOSE calibration value as determined in the previous step. Nominal Dose (cal value): _______ Record the desired dose 1 and dose 2 Desired dose values: input values. Dose 1:______________ mR / Min Dose 2:______________ mR / Min To disable the ability to make incremental dose changes, set the DOSE 1 and DOSE 2 calibration values the same as the nominal dose value. If doing so, skip steps 21 to 25. Initiate fluoro operation and measure the input dose to the I.I. Adjust to the desired dose 1 value by altering the NOMINAL DOSE calibration value as required using the + or - buttons. When the desired dose 1 value has been achieved, enter the new NOMINAL DOSE value in the DOSE 1 location using the + or - buttons. Rev. H Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-07 CPI Canada Inc. ABS Calibration 3E 3E.3.5 Dose1/Dose2 Calibration (Cont) Step 23. 24. 25. 26. 27. Action Initiate fluoro operation and measure the input dose to the I.I. Adjust to the desired dose 2 value by altering the NOMINAL DOSE calibration value as required using the + or - buttons. When the desired dose 2 value has been achieved, enter the new NOMINAL DOSE value in the DOSE 2 location using the + or - buttons. Reset the original NOMINAL DOSE value by entering the value recorded in step 19 of this table into the NOMINAL DOSE location using the + or - buttons. Verify each dose (nominal, dose 1, and dose 2) by initiating fluoro operation and measuring the I.I. input dose. Press <<, then EXIT to exit out of FLUORO SETUP mode. Press EXIT, then EXIT SETUP to return to the normal operating mode. This completes the fluoro calibration. Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-07 Rev. H Page 3E-27 3E ABS Calibration CPI Canada Inc. (This page intentionally left blank) Page 3E-28 Rev. H Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-07 CPI Canada Inc. DAP Setup 3F CHAPTER 3 SECTION 3F DAP SETUP AND CALIBRATION CONTENTS: 3F.1.0 INTRODUCTION .......................................................................................................................................3F-2 3F.2.0 DAP INTERFACING ..................................................................................................................................3F-2 3F.2.1 DAP Compatibility ..................................................................................................................................3F-2 3F.2.2 DAP Installation......................................................................................................................................3F-2 3F.3.0 DAP SETUP...............................................................................................................................................3F-3 3F.3.1 DAP Setup Menu ...................................................................................................................................3F-3 3F.3.2 DAP SETUP Menu Items .......................................................................................................................3F-4 3F.4.0 DAP CALIBRATION ..................................................................................................................................3F-6 3F.4.1 Equipment Required ..............................................................................................................................3F-6 3F.4.2 DAP calibration overview .......................................................................................................................3F-7 3F.4.3 DAP Calibration Procedure ....................................................................................................................3F-7 3F.4.4 DAP Calculation Worksheet.................................................................................................................3F-10 Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-09 Rev. C Page 3F-1 3F DAP Setup CPI Canada Inc. 3F.1.0 INTRODUCTION This section details setup and programming of the DAP (Dose-Area Product) meter, optional on Indico 100 X-ray generators. Any references made to tube 2 or the ability to switch tubes in this section apply to two tube generators only. 3F.2.0 DAP INTERFACING 3F.2.1 DAP Compatibility The Indico 100 generator, when equipped with the DAP option, is compatible with the DAP devices listed in section 3F.3.2. The correct DAP device must be selected in the DAP SETUP menu as described in 3F.3.2 in order to ensure device compatibility. The DAP chamber, when fitted with the proper interconnect cable, plugs directly into the DAP interface board in the generator. When ordering the DAP chamber from the DAP manufacturer, specify the CPI compatible interconnect cable, if available. This is a special cable terminated with a 9 pin male “D” connector that is designed to plug directly into the DAP interface board in the generator. If this cable is not available from the DAP device manufacturer, consult CPI product support for the required cable to connect the DAP chamber to the generator. Refer to the table below for the CPI cable assembly part numbers. DAP DEVICE PTW PX-T11020 Gammex-RMI 841S VacuTEC VacuDAP 2004 Scanditronix 120-131 INTERCONNECT CABLE 736145-00 736146-00 Contact VacuTEC for this cable assembly. 736148-00 3F.2.2 DAP Installation 1. Switch OFF the AC line voltage to the generator at the main disconnect switch. Allow sufficient time for all capacitors in the generator to discharge. 2. Install the DAP chamber as per the manufacturers instructions. The interconnect cable to the generator must be as per 3F.2.1. 3. Route the DAP interconnect cable(s) through the access covers in the upper part of the generator cabinet, then route the cables toward the DAP interface board. 4. Plug the cable from DAP device 1 (for tube 1) into J2, and the cable from DAP device 2 (for tube 2) into J3 of the DAP interface board. Tighten the screw locks on the connectors to secure the cables. 5. Proceed with DAP setup and calibration as per the remainder of this procedure. Page 3F-2 Rev. C Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-09 CPI Canada Inc. DAP Setup 3F 3F.3.0 DAP SETUP 3F.3.1 DAP Setup Menu NOTE: GEN CONFIGURATION MENUS 1 AND 2, SHOWN BELOW, APPLY TO R&F CONSOLES ONLY. THE GEN CONFIGURATION MENU APPLIES TO THE INDICO 100 RAD-ONLY CONSOLE. FOR THE INDICO 100 RAD-ONLY CONSOLE, LCD SCREEN DETAILS NOT RELEVANT TO DAP SETUP DIFFER SOMEWHAT FROM THE EXAMPLES SHOWN IN THE REMAINDER OF THIS SECTION. HOWEVER, THE ACTUAL DAP SETUP PORTION OF THE MENUS IS SIMILAR TO THAT SHOWN (MINOR DIFFERENCES, WHERE APPLICABLE, ARE NOTED). To access the DAP SETUP menu, press the >> button when the GEN CONFIGURATION menu is displayed (R&F consoles). For Rad-only consoles, the DAP SETUP function may be accessed directly from the GEN CONFIGURATION menu. Refer to chapter 3C, section 3C.1.1, 3C.2.0, and 3C.5.0 to access the GEN CONFIGURATION menu. MENU 1 (GEN CONFIGURATION) R&F Consoles * GEN CONFIGURATION * TUBE SELECTION AEC SETUP GENERATOR LIMITS AEC CALIBRATION RECEPTOR SETUP FLUORO SETUP I/O CONFIGURATION TUBE CALIBRATION EXIT >> MENU 2 (GEN CONFIGURATION) R&F Consoles * GEN CONFIGURATION * DAP SETUP << GEN CONFIGURATION menu (Rad-only consoles) * GEN CONFIGURATION * TUBE SELECTION AEC SETUP GENERATOR LIMITS AEC CALIBRATION RECEPTOR SETUP TUBE CALIBRATION I/O CONFIGURATION DAP SETUP EXIT Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-09 Rev. C Page 3F-3 3F DAP Setup CPI Canada Inc. 3F.3.1 DAP Setup Menu (Cont) The DAP SETUP menus shown below allow setup and calibration of the DAP meter(s). MENU 1 (DAP SETUP) TUBE 1 0%HU DAP: ON DAP MODE: IND DEVICE TYPE 1: 0 CAL. VALUE 1: 10 4mAs << MAG:0 * DAP SETUP * DAP 0mGycm2 TEST VALUE 1: 1000 DEVICE TYPE 2: 0 + >> On the Indico 100 Rad-only console, the DAP function is located under the MENU button. MENU 2 (DAP SETUP) TUBE 1 0%HU * DAP SETUP * 0mGycm2 CAL. VALUE 2: 10 DAP RATE DISPLAY: ON TEST VALUE 2: 1000 ACC ALARM (mGycm2): 100000 + 2 RATE ALARM (mGycm /S): 1000 4mAs << DAP >> MAG:0 RATE ALARM and DAP RATE DISPLAY are not used on Indico 100 Rad-only units. MENU 3 (DAP RESET AND TEST) DAP = 0mGycm2 DAP TEST: OK [ 200 PULSES ] RESET EXIT TEST On the Indico 100 Rad-only console, the EXIT function is located under the MENU button. 3F.3.2 DAP SETUP Menu Items Definitions of the DAP SETUP parameters per the previous menus follow. • Enables or disables the DAP device. The setting of ON or OFF applies to both DAP devices, if two DAP devices are used. DAP ON: The DAP meter is enabled. OFF: The DAP meter is disabled. Page 3F-4 Rev. C Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-09 CPI Canada Inc. DAP Setup 3F 3F.3.2 DAP SETUP Menu Items (Cont) • Selects the DAP mode of operation as defined below. DAP MODE IND: The generator makes and displays individual DAP measurements for each tube. SUM: The generator sums the DAP measurement from both tubes, and displays the single summed measurement when either tube is selected. • Selects the DAP device. DEVICE TYPE 0 = PTW PX-T11020. 1 = Gammex RMI 841S. 2 = VacuTec VacuDAP 2004. 3 = Scanditronix 120-131. • CAL. VALUE Allows the DAP reading to be calibrated by adjusting this parameter. • TEST VALUE A numeric value, supplied by the DAP device manufacturer, that represents the number of pulses generated by the DAP device during TEST mode. The generator counts the number of pulses generated by the DAP device during TEST mode, and reports a DAP failure error message if the actual number of test pulses are not the same as the manufacturer - supplied test count, within an allowable margin of error. • ACC ALARM (mGycm2) Sets the alarm level for accumulated DAP. The console will present an audible alarm, and a visual warning via the LCD display when the accumulated dose exceeds this limit. • RATE ALARM (mGycm2/S) Sets the alarm level for the maximum DAP rate. The console will present an audible alarm, and a visual warning via the LCD display when the current dose rate exceeds this limit. • DAP RATE DISPLAY Enables or disables the display of the DAP rate during fluoro operation. ON: DAP rate is displayed during fluoroscopic operation. When the fluoro run is finished, the accumulated DAP will be displayed. OFF: Displays the accumulated DAP only during fluoroscopic operation. • DAP Allows access to a submenu used to reset the DAP display, and test the DAP device. This submenu is accessed by selecting DAP when menu 1 or menu 2 in 3F.3.1 is displayed. • RESET Resets the DAP display to zero. • TEST Tests the DAP by counting the number of test pulses (refer to TEST VALUE, above). The message “DAP TEST: OK” will be presented if the DAP has passed its test, and the actual number of test pulses counted will be displayed. Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-09 Rev. C Page 3F-5 3F DAP Setup CPI Canada Inc. 3F.3.2 DAP SETUP Menu Items (Cont) Use these steps to set up the DAP device. DAP calibration is done after DAP setup; refer to 3F.4.0. Step Action 1. Select DAP SETUP. Refer to 3F.3.1 to access the DAP SETUP menu. Use the << or >> buttons to select DAP SETUP menu 1 or menu 2 as required in the following steps. 2. Press the DAP button to select ON or OFF. This will enable or disable both DAP devices, if two DAP devices are used. 3. Press the DAP MODE button to select IND for individual, or SUM for summed DAP readings. 4. Select DEVICE TYPE 1. Use the + or - buttons to select the DAP device for tube 1. Refer to the table on the previous page for compatible DAP device manufacturers. 5. Repeat step 4 for DEVICE TYPE 2, this sets up the DAP device for tube 2 if applicable. 6. Select TEST VALUE 1. Use the + or - buttons to enter the test-pulse count supplied by the DAP device manufacturer for DAP device 1. Typical terms used by DAP device manufacturers for this function are “Test Pulses”, “Test Value”, or “Test Count”, but other names may be used. 7. Repeat step 6 for TEST VALUE 2. This enters the test-pulse count for DAP device 2, if applicable. 8. Select ACC ALARM (mGycm2). Use the + or - buttons to select the maximum permissible accumulated DAP. 9. Select RATE ALARM (mGycm2/S). Use the + or - buttons to select the maximum permissible DAP rate for fluoro operation. 10. Press the DAP RATE DISPLAY button to select ON or OFF. This enables or disables the display of the DAP rate during fluoro operation. 3F.4.0 DAP CALIBRATION The DAP device must be calibrated before use, and the calibration must be periodically checked as per the DAP device manufacturers requirements, or as per local regulations. 3F.4.1 Equipment Required The following equipment is required for DAP calibration. • An X-ray cassette and film. The speed of the film / screen is not relevant, as the film is only used to determine the area that is irradiated at the dose measurement plane. An X-ray cassette and film is the preferred method to measure the irradiated area, but if this is not readily available, for example if this is a digital only system, a procedure is given to determine the required area using the imaging system. • A film processor to develop the film, if required. • A calibrated dosimeter. • A ruler or tape measure with centimeter markings. This will be needed to measure the exposed area of the film. If measuring in inches, use a calculator and multiply inches by 2.54 to obtain the measurement in centimeters. Page 3F-6 Rev. C Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-09 CPI Canada Inc. DAP Setup 3F 3F.4.2 DAP calibration overview The first step involved in calibrating the DAP meter in the generator is to carefully make a dose measurement at a given distance from the X-ray source. The next step is to expose a test film at the same distance from the X-ray source as the dose measurement that was just made. The dose-area product is calculated by multiplying the measured dose, in mGy, by the exposed area of the film, in cm2. This gives the actual dose-area product, in mGycm2. After the reference dose-area product is determined as described above, it is compared to the DAP reading as measured by the generator. Adjustments are made to the CAL. VALUE parameter in the DAP SETUP menu such that the consoles DAP display corresponds to the calculated dose-area product. This procedure may need to be repeated several times until the required accuracy is obtained. The reason the DAP device (a specialized ion chamber) is able to accurately measure the dosearea product at its location at the bottom of the collimator is that although the radiation level falls off at a rate inversely proportional to the square of the distance from the source, the irradiated area increases as the square of the distance from the source. For example, by doubling the distance, the dose falls to (½)2 = ¼ of the previous dose BUT the area increases to 22 = 4 times the area. Therefore, the dose-area product will remain constant at a given distance from the source. This is also the reason that care must be taken to ensure that the area measurement is done at the same distance from the X-ray source as the dose measurement. 3F.4.3 DAP Calibration Procedure CTM TUBE 1 DAP chamber 1 70 cm Dosimeter plane and film plane 20 cm DAP chamber 2 TUBE 2 TYPICAL SETUP FOR DAP CALIBRATION FILE: DAP.CDR Figure 3F-1: DAP setup Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-09 Rev. C Page 3F-7 3F DAP Setup CPI Canada Inc. 3F.4.3 DAP Calibration Procedure (Cont) Use these steps to calibrate the DAP meter(s) in the generator. Step 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. 10. 11. 12. 13. 14. 15. 16. Page 3F-8 Action Set up the dosimeter as per figure 3F-1.The probe should be centered relative to the central ray from the X-ray tube, and sufficiently far off the table top to minimize scatter radiation. Do not use any absorber during this procedure. Open the collimator such that the field size at the location of the probe is approximately 12 cm X 12 cm. Ensure that the probe is fully irradiated. Temporarily set the DAP MODE to IND. Refer to section 3F.3.2. Enter DAP SETUP menu 1 or menu 2 as required to display the CAL. VALUE 1 parameter for DAP device 1, or the CAL. VALUE 2 parameter for DAP device 2. Select the desired DAP device to calibrate by selecting tube 1 or tube 2 via an appropriate image receptor. Start with the over-table tube. Set the generator to 70 kV, 100 mA, 20 ms. Press DAP to access the RESET / TEST menu, then press RESET to reset the DAP display to zero. Press EXIT to return to DAP SETUP menu 1 or menu 2. Make an X-ray exposure and note the dose per the dosimeter. Record the mR or mGy value in a copy of table 3F-1. Convert the mR value to mGy, if necessary. Note the DAP value as displayed on the console, and record the value in a copy of table 3F-1. Replace the dosimeter with an X-ray cassette and film if available. The film plane must be at the same location as the dosimeter was in step 8. If using an image sensor such as an I.I., or flat panel, or other non-film image sensor, the image pickup plane must be at the same location as the dosimeter was in step 8. THE IMPORTANCE OF THIS STEP CANNOT BE OVERSTATED: THE IRRADIATED AREA MEASUREMENT MUST BE MADE AT A POINT THAT IS THE SAME DISTANCE FROM THE X-RAY SOURCE AS THE DOSE WAS MEASURED AT. Ensure that the collimator field at the measurement plane is smaller than the active area of the image pick-up device (film, I.I., or other). Refer to figure 3F-2. Do not readjust the collimator from the setting that was used in step 8. Make another exposure using the same settings as in step 6. Develop the film (if used). Measure the irradiated image area. For film, measure the length and width of the exposed area, and record the results in table 3F-1. Refer to figure 3F-2. If using a digital imaging system, some systems have a cursor available that allows measurement of the length and width of the area in question. If the digital imaging system does not allow image size measurement, it is suggested that an X-ray opaque item of known dimensions be placed at the image plane. (A collimator test tool would be useful in this application). The length and width of the irradiated area can then be extrapolated by comparison to the size of the reference object. Record the length and width of the irradiated area at the measurement plane in table 3F-1. Calculate the irradiated image area, in cm2. Use the length and width recorded in table 3F-1. Calculate the dose-area product by multiplying the area from table 3F-1 X the dose in mGy from table 3F-1. Record the resulting value at step 3 in table 3F-1. Rev. C Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-09 CPI Canada Inc. DAP Setup 3F 3F.4.3 DAP Calibration Procedure (Cont) 17. 18. 19. 20. 21. Calculate the percentage error between the manually calculated DAP measurement (table 3F-1, step 3) and the measured DAP value (table 3F-1, step 4). Record the percentage error in step 5 of the table. If the consoles DAP reading does not meet the required accuracy, increase or decrease CAL. VALUE 1 or CAL. VALUE 2 by the same percentage as the percentage error. Repeat steps 7 to 18 until the required accuracy is obtained. Make as many copies of table 3F-1 as required to record the results from all required iterations. Repeat the above procedure for the second DAP device (tube 2). Reset the DAP MODE as desired. This was temporarily set to IND in step 3. X-RAY CASSETTE 13.2 EXPOSED AREA ILLUMINATED COLLIMATOR FIELD 13.6 DEVELOPED FILM Figure 3F-2: Irradiated area vs. available image area Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-09 Rev. C Page 3F-9 3F DAP Setup CPI Canada Inc. 3F.4.4 DAP Calculation Worksheet STEP 1. 2. ACTION RESULT Measured dose: _____________ mR Convert mR to mGy if necessary by multiplying mR X 0.00873. Example 23.3 mR X 0.00873 = 0.203 mGy. _____________ mGy Measure and record the exposed area of the film (Length X Width). _____________ Length (cm) _____________ Width (cm) Calculate the exposed area in cm2 (length X width). 3. Multiply the dose in mGy (step 1) X the area in cm2 (step 2). This will yield the actual dose-area product, in mGycm2. _____________ Area (cm2) _____________ (mGycm2) DAP DAP 4. Record the DAP, in mGycm2, as displayed on the console. _____________ (mGycm2) 5. Calculate the percentage error: Refer to the example at the end of this section. _____________ % error THIS TABLE IS REPEATED BELOW FOR THE SECOND ITERATION OF THE DAP CALIBRATION. STEP 1. 2. ACTION RESULT Measured dose: _____________ mR Convert mR to mGy if necessary by multiplying mR X 0.00873. Example 23.3 mR X 0.00873 = 0.203 mGy. _____________ mGy Measure and record the exposed area of the film (Length X Width). _____________ Length (cm) _____________ Width (cm) Calculate the exposed area in cm2 (length X width). 3. Multiply the dose in mGy (step 1) X the area in cm2 (step 2). This will yield the actual dose-area product, in mGycm2. _____________ Area (cm2) _____________ (mGycm2) DAP DAP 4. Record the DAP, in mGycm2, as displayed on the console. _____________ (mGycm2) 5. Calculate the percentage error: Refer to the example at the end of this section. _____________ % error Table 3F-1: DAP worksheets Page 3F-10 Rev. C Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-09 CPI Canada Inc. DAP Setup 3F 3F.4.4 DAP Calculation Worksheet (Cont) Refer to the sample DAP worksheet below: STEP 1. 2. ACTION RESULT Measured dose: ____23.3_____ mR Convert mR to mGy if necessary by multiplying mR X 0.00873. Example 23.3 mR X 0.00873 = 0.203 mGy. ____0.203____ mGy Measure and record the exposed area of the film (Length X Width). ____13.6_____ Length (cm) ____13.2_____ Width (cm) Calculate the exposed area in cm2 (length X width). ___179.52____ Area (cm2) 3. Multiply the dose in mGy (step 1) X the area in cm2 (step 2). This will yield the actual dose-area product, in mGycm2. 4. Record the DAP, in mGycm2, as displayed on the console. ____40_______ DAP (mGycm2) 5. Calculate the percentage error: Refer to the example at the end of this section. ____-8.9______ % error ____36.44____ DAP (mGycm2) Sample percentage error calculation (step 5): (36.44 - 40) -3.56 X 100 = X 100 = -8.9 % 40 40 Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-09 Rev. C Page 3F-11 3F DAP Setup CPI Canada Inc. (This page intentionally left blank) Page 3F-12 Rev. C Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-09 CPI Canada Inc. Acceptance Testing 4 CHAPTER 4 ACCEPTANCE TESTING CONTENTS: 4.1.0 INTRODUCTION ........................................................................................................................................... 4-1 4.2.0 REQUIRED TEST EQUIPMENT FOR GENERATOR VERIFICATION. ....................................................... 4-2 4.3.0 ACCEPTANCE TESTS (BASIC FUNCTIONS) ............................................................................................. 4-3 4.3.1 Console Rad Tests..................................................................................................................................... 4-3 4.3.2 Console Fluoro Tests ................................................................................................................................. 4-4 4.3.3 Generator Preliminary Tests ...................................................................................................................... 4-5 4.3.4 Low Speed Starter Verification................................................................................................................... 4-7 4.3.5 Dual Speed Starter Verification .................................................................................................................. 4-8 4.4.0 ACCEPTANCE TESTS (KVP, TIME, MA AND MAS).................................................................................... 4-9 4.4.1 Generator Rad Tests.................................................................................................................................. 4-9 4.4.2 Generator Fluoro Tests ............................................................................................................................ 4-13 4.5.0 ACCEPTANCE TESTS (OPTIONAL INTERFACES) .................................................................................. 4-15 4.6.0 ACCEPTANCE TESTS (AEC) ..................................................................................................................... 4-15 4.7.0 ACCEPTANCE TESTS (ABS) ..................................................................................................................... 4-15 4.8.0 ACCEPTANCE TESTS (DAP) ..................................................................................................................... 4-15 4.9.0 ACCEPTANCE TESTS (HVL, LINEARITY AND REPRODUCIBILITY) ...................................................... 4-16 4.1.0 INTRODUCTION This section details acceptance testing, which verifies that the generator is performing within limits. It is recommended that this be done whenever the generator is reconfigured, or component(s) are replaced which may affect the X-ray output. Examples of such components are the X-ray tube, HT tank, generator CPU board, generator interface board, AEC board, control board 1 and control board 2 in the HF power supply (Millenia) or the control board (Indico 100), and the filament supply board(s). Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-08 Rev. J Page 4-1 4 Acceptance Testing CPI Canada Inc. WARNING: 1. USE EXTREME CARE IN MEASURING HIGH VOLTAGES. ACCIDENTAL CONTACT MAY CAUSE INJURY OR DEATH. 2. EVEN WITH THE GENERATOR SWITCHED OFF AT THE CONSOLE, (OR THE LOCKOUT SWITCH INSIDE THE MAIN CABINET LOCKED OUT), MAINS VOLTAGE IS STILL PRESENT INSIDE THE GENERATOR CABINET. THIS VOLTAGE IS EXTREMELY DANGEROUS; USE EXTREME CAUTION. 3. THE ELECTROLYTIC CAPACITORS, LOCATED ON THE BASE OF THE HF POWER SUPPLY, PRESENT A HAZARD FOR A MINIMUM OF 5 MINUTES AFTER THE POWER HAS BEEN SWITCHED OFF. VERIFY THAT THESE CAPACITORS ARE DISCHARGED BEFORE SERVICING OR TOUCHING ANY PARTS. WARNING: THE PROCEDURES IN THIS CHAPTER REQUIRE THE PRODUCTION OF X-RAYS. TAKE ALL SAFETY PRECAUTIONS TO PROTECT PERSONNEL FROM X-RADIATION. WARNING: 1. ALWAYS ENSURE THAT THE EQUIPMENT UNDER TEST AND ALL ASSOCIATED TEST EQUIPMENT IS PROPERLY GROUNDED. 2. ENSURE THAT THE HIGH VOLTAGE CABLES ARE INTACT / UNDAMAGED AND PROPERLY CONNECTED BEFORE ATTEMPTING EXPOSURES. ENSURE THAT THE FOLLOWING ITEMS ARE COMPLETED PRIOR TO PERFORMING THE ACCEPTANCE TESTING: • • • • • • 4.2.0 The generator is interfaced to room equipment noted in the product description / compatibility statement. The tube auto calibration has been done as per chapter 2 of this manual. The receptors have been programmed as per chapter 3C of this manual. If the installation has AEC, verify that all receptors have been calibrated as per chapter 3D of this manual. If the installation has ABS, verify that the imaging system has been calibrated as per chapter 3E of this manual. Acceptance testing shall only be started after the installation is complete i.e.; generator in final position and installed as per the previous chapters of this manual. REQUIRED TEST EQUIPMENT FOR GENERATOR VERIFICATION. • • • • • • • • • • Page 4-2 kV measuring device such as a Dynalyzer (or equivalent). This will be required for verifying kV and mA calibration during preventative maintenance or if recalibration is necessary, for example after replacing the generator CPU board or control board 1 in the HF power supply. See note on page 11 regarding use of a Dynalyzer on Indico 100 generators. Storage oscilloscope. mA / mAs meter. Radiation meter 0-1000 mR and 1-15 R/min. Lead diaphragm or equivalent to collimate the beam. General purpose DVM. Strobe or reed tachometer. Current probe 0 to 20 amps AC. A set of HVL filters. Calculator. Rev. J Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-08 CPI Canada Inc. Acceptance Testing 4.3.0 ACCEPTANCE TESTS (BASIC FUNCTIONS) 4.3.1 Console Rad Tests 4 For the touch screen console, check the console functionality by pressing the equivalent switch position on the touch screen for the functions described in section 4.3.1 and 4.3.2. Verify the correct response on the touch screen console for each function that is tested. Step 1. Action Press the power ON then power OFF buttons on the console. Press power ON again to switch the unit on. Press each of the receptor buttons that are active (those that have been enabled during generator configuration). Result Check Unit switches on and off. Unit switches on. Verify that the adjacent LED lights for each receptor. For receptor 6 on the 23 X 56 cm console (adjacent to the power ON button) only the top LED will light. Note: The TECHNIQUE / MODE SELECT button used to select AEC / mAs / mA/ms in steps 4, 5, 6 will only be functional if APR mode has been disabled during generator configuration (the TECHNIQUE SELECT function is disabled if APR mode is enabled). 4. Select an active radiographic receptor that has A: The AEC LED lights. AEC programmed. B: kV value is displayed. Press the technique select button to select C: mA value is displayed. AEC. D: “AEC”, mAs value or ms Verify the following displays: value is displayed depending on the AEC backup mode selected. E: Density value is displayed. 5. Press the technique select button to select A: The mAs LED lights. mAs. B: kV value is displayed. Verify the following displays: C: mAs value is displayed. 6. Press the technique select button to select A: The mA/ms LED lights. mA/ms. B: kV value is displayed. Verify the following displays: C: mA value is displayed. D: ms value is displayed. 7. kV increases if kV + is pressed. Press the kV +/- buttons. kV decreases if kV - is pressed. 8. Ensure that three-point operation is selected (mA/ms). mA increases if mA + is pressed. Press the mA +/- buttons. mA decreases if mA - is pressed. 9. Ensure that three-point operation is selected (mA/ms). ms increases if ms + is pressed. Press the ms +/- buttons. ms decreases if ms - is pressed. 10. Ensure that AEC is selected. Density increases if density + is pressed. Press the DENSITY +/- buttons. Density decreases if density - is pressed. 11. Press the focus select button. The large and small focal spot LED’s alternately light as the switch is toggled. 12. Ensure that AEC is selected. The three film-screen LED’s (I, II, Press the film-screen select button. III) alternately light as the switch is toggled. 2. 3. Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-08 Rev. J Page 4-3 4 Acceptance Testing 4.3.1 Console Rad Tests (Cont) Step 13. 14. 4.3.2 CPI Canada Inc. Action Select 60 kV, 50 mA, 100 ms. Press the PREP button. Press the X-ray button. 15. Ensure that AEC is selected. Press the FIELD select button (23 X 56 cm console) or press the individual AEC field select buttons in sequence (all other consoles). 16. Press the power OFF button on the console. Result The adjacent LED lights. Check The X-ray warning indicator lights during an X-ray exposure, and an audible tone is heard from the console. The three field indicator LED’s light to indicate field selection [L+C+R], [R], [C], [R+C], [L], [L+R], [L+C] as the switch is toggled (23 X 56 cm console). For other consoles, the LEFT, CENTER, and RIGHT field selection LED’s should light as each field is selected. The unit switches off. Console Fluoro Tests This section applies only to R&F units. BEFORE CONTINUING, ENSURE THAT THE REMOTE FLUORO CONTROL IS CONNECTED (IF USED WITH THIS INSTALLATION). Page 4-4 Step 1. 2. Action Press the power ON button on the console. Select an active fluoro receptor. 3. Press the DOSE button. 4. Press the MAG button on the console. Press the MAG +/- buttons on the remote fluoro control if used. Rev. J Result Unit switches on. A: The fluoro display area of the console lights. B: The remote fluoro control panel lights (if used). The dose display on the LCD display changes as the switch is toggled. A: The MAG display on the console LCD and remote fluoro display changes (IF I/I MODES IS ENABLED DURING GENERATOR CONFIGURATION) as the MAG button is toggled. B: The Mag display on the console LCD and remote fluoro display increases if MAG + button is pressed, decreases if MAG - button on the remote fluoro control is pressed (IF I/I MODES IS ENABLED DURING GENERATOR CONFIGURATION. Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Check Ch # 740904-08 CPI Canada Inc. 4.3.2 4.3.3 Acceptance Testing 4 Console Fluoro Tests (Cont) Step 5. Action Press the ABS button on the console to enter ABS mode. 6. Press the ABS button on the remote fluoro control if used, else press the ABS button on the console. 7. Press the fluoro kV +/- buttons on the console and remote fluoro control if used. 8. Press the fluoro mA +/- buttons on the console and remote fluoro control if used. 9. Press the ACCUMULATED TIME button on the console. 10. Press the ACCUMULATED TIME button on the remote fluoro control if used. 11. Press the pulse fluoro button on the console (if the pulse fluoro option is fitted). 12. Press the power OFF button on the console. Result A: The LED adjacent to the button lights. B: The LED adjacent to the ABS button on the remote fluoro control (if used) lights. The ABS indicator LED’s adjacent to the ABS buttons on the console and the remote fluoro control (if used) switch off. kV increases if kV + is pressed. kV decreases if kV - is pressed. Confirm tracking of the kV displays on the console and the remote fluoro control. mA increases if mA + is pressed. mA decreases if mA - is pressed. Confirm tracking of the mA displays on the console and the remote fluoro control. The accumulated time indicator will light, then extinguish on the console as the switch is toggled. The ACC indicator will light, then extinguish on the remote fluoro control as the switch is toggled. The pulse fluoro indicator will light, then extinguish as the switch is toggled. Unit switches off. Check Generator Preliminary Tests WARNING: NOTE: USE EXTREME CAUTION WHEN MEASURING HIGH VOLTAGES. VERIFY THE POSITION OF EACH OF THE SWITCHES OF SW1 ON THE GENERATOR CPU BOARD FOR THE GENERATOR UNDER TEST AS PER THE FOLLOWING TABLE. THESE SWITCHES MUST BE SET CORRECTLY PRIOR TO CONTINUING. REFER TO THE COMPATIBILITY STATEMENT / PRODUCT DESCRIPTION (SECTION 1D) AS NECESSARY FOR THE PRODUCT DEFINITION. Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-08 Rev. J Page 4-5 4 Acceptance Testing 4.3.3 CPI Canada Inc. Generator Preliminary Tests (Cont) For GENERATOR POWER, refer to copy of the compatibility statement / product description (PD) form in Chapter 1D GENERATOR POWER SW1-3 SW1-2 SW1-1 30 kW (350 Series) ON ON OFF Millenia only ON ON OFF 32 kW (Indico 100 only) ON OFF ON 40 kW (Indico 100 only) 50 kW (650 Series) OFF ON ON 65 kW (850 Series) OFF ON OFF 80 kW (1050 Series) OFF OFF ON OFF OFF 100 kW (Indico 100 only) OFF SW1-4: OFF for two filament boards, ON for one filament board. SW1-5: OFF for 150 max kV, ON for 125 max kV. SW1-6: OFF for dual speed, ON for low speed. SW1-7: OFF for 2 tube, ON for 1 tube. SW1-8: ON. Do not inadvertently switch this to OFF! Setting to OFF resets to the factory defaults (calibration, configuration, etc). Step 1. Action Ensure unit is switched OFF. 2. Press the power ON button on the console. 3. Switch OFF the console. Switch the NORMAL/LOCKOUT switch on the generator interface board to LOCKOUT. Switch the console ON. Switch the NORMAL/LOCKOUT switch to the NORMAL position. Switch the console ON. Verify that each active receptor (those that have been enabled during generator configuration) displays the desired X-ray tube on the LCD display. 4. 5. Page 4-6 Rev. J Result DS1 on generator interface board is lit. One or more LED’s on the driver/auxiliary board in HF power supply are lit. Millenia generators only. Check The generator will not switch on with the switch in the lockout position. The unit switches on. Receptor 1 Tube # _____ Receptor 2 Tube # _____ Receptor 3 Tube # _____ Receptor 4 Tube # _____ Receptor 5 Tube # _____ Receptor 6 Tube # _____ Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-08 CPI Canada Inc. 4.3.3 Acceptance Testing 4 Generator Preliminary Tests (Cont) 6. 7. Verify that each active receptor selects the desired AEC channel. This must be done by measuring the voltage at specified pins on the AEC board edge connector. Logic low (approx. 1 VDC) means CHANNEL ENABLED, logic high (approx. 11.5 VDC) means CHANNEL DISABLED. Refer to figure 4-1 for pin assignments on the AEC board: CHANNEL 1 = PIN 8 CHANNEL 2 = PIN 7 CHANNEL 3 = PIN 6 CHANNEL 4 = PIN 5 Switch OFF the console. Receptor 1 Ch # _______ Receptor 2 Ch # _______ Receptor 3 Ch # _______ Receptor 4 Ch # _______ Receptor 5 Ch # _______ Receptor 6 Ch # _______ N/A Figure 4-1: AEC board pin assignments THE MILLENIA AND INDICO 100 FAMILY OF GENERATORS ARE FITTED WITH A LOW SPEED STARTER, OR OPTIONAL DUAL SPEED STARTER. USE SECTION 4.3.4 OR 4.3.5, AS APPLICABLE, FOR YOUR GENERATOR. 4.3.4 Low Speed Starter Verification Step 1. 2. 3. Action Result Connect a current probe to the common lead of tube 1. A 60 Hz waveform dropping to Switch ON the console. less than half amplitude after Press and hold the PREP button. prep complete. Measure the rotor boost time. Should be approximately 1.5 sec. Use a strobe or reed tachometer and verify that the tube(s) reach operating speed at the end of boost. Speed ≥ 3300 RPM. FOLLOW STEPS 4 TO 6 IF TUBE 2 IS USED (LOW SPEED STARTER) Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-08 Rev. J Check Page 4-7 4 Acceptance Testing 4.3.4 Low Speed Starter Verification (Cont) 4. 5. 6. 7. 4.3.5 CPI Canada Inc. Connect a current probe to the common lead of tube 2. Press and hold the PREP button. Measure the rotor boost time. Use a strobe or reed tachometer and verify that the tube(s) reach operating speed at the end of boost. Switch OFF the console. A 60 Hz waveform dropping to less than half amplitude after prep complete. Should be approximately 1.5 sec. Speed ≥ 3300 RPM. N/A Dual Speed Starter Verification From the product description, be sure the actual tube being used is correctly selected at the dual speed starter. Refer to the dual speed starter table in chapter 2. Tube 1 selection verified _______ Tube 2 selection verified _______ THE GENERATOR MUST BE PROGRAMMED FOR DUAL SPEED STARTER OPERATION IN ORDER TO BE ABLE TO VERIFY BOTH MODES OF OPERATION IN THIS SECTION. ***** PLEASE OBSERVE A MAXIMUM OF 2 HIGH SPEED BOOSTS PER MINUTE ***** Step 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. Page 4-8 Action Connect a current probe to the common lead of tube 1. Switch ON the console. Select 70 kVp, minimum mA, 50 ms. Press and hold the PREP button. Measure the rotor boost time. Select 100 kVp, maximum mA, 50 ms, small focus. Press and hold the PREP button. Measure the rotor boost time. Result Check A 60 Hz waveform dropping to less than half amplitude after prep complete. Should agree with the value in the dual speed starter table in chapter 2. A 180 Hz waveform dropping to less than half amplitude after prep complete. Should agree with the value in the dual speed starter table in chapter 2. Use a strobe or reed tachometer and verify that the tube(s) reach operating speed at end of boost. Use the techniques in steps 1 and 3 to select low and high-speed modes Low Speed ≥ 3300 RPM. respectively. High Speed ≥ 9500 RPM. After a high-speed prep, verify that the Will hear the X-ray tube slow dynamic brake is applied. down to 60 Hz. FOLLOW STEPS 7 TO 12 IF TUBE 2 IS USED (DUAL SPEED STARTER) Connect a current probe to the common lead of tube 2. A 60 Hz waveform dropping to Select 70 kVp, minimum mA, 50 ms. less than half amplitude after Press and hold the PREP button. prep complete. Measure the rotor boost time. Should agree with the value in the dual speed starter table in chapter 2. Rev. J Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-08 CPI Canada Inc. 4.3.5 Acceptance Testing 4 Dual Speed Starter Verification (Cont) Step 9. 10. 11. 12. 13. Action Select 100 kVp, maximum mA, 50 ms, small focus. Press and hold the PREP button. Measure the rotor boost time. Use a strobe or reed tachometer and verify that the tube(s) reach operating speed at end of boost. Use the techniques in steps 7 and 9 to select low and high-speed modes respectively. After a high-speed prep, verify that the dynamic brake is applied. Switch OFF the console 4.4.0 ACCEPTANCE TESTS (KVP, TIME, MA AND MAS) 4.4.1 Generator Rad Tests Result A 180 Hz waveform dropping to less than half amplitude after prep complete. Should agree with the value in the dual speed starter table in chapter 2. Check Low Speed ≥ 3300 RPM. High Speed ≥ 9500 RPM. Will hear the X-ray tube slow down to 60 Hz. N/A Measurement of kVp, mA, and time may be done via test points at the generator CPU board as per figure 4-2. These are direct feedback voltages and are scaled to represent the actual kVp and X-ray tube current AS LONG AS THE GENERATOR IS CALIBRATED. REFER TO NOTES ON PAGE 11. NOTE: TEST EQUIPMENT TOLERANCES MUST BE ALLOWED FOR IN THE MEASUREMENTS IN THE FOLLOWING SECTIONS. LIMITS STATED ARE THE MAXIMUM ALLOWED LIMITS, INCLUDING EQUIPMENT TOLERANCES AND MEASUREMENT ERROR. Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-08 Rev. J Page 4-9 4 Acceptance Testing 4.4.1 CPI Canada Inc. Generator Rad Tests (Cont) GENERATOR CPU BOARD TP8 TP6 TP7 TP9 TP11 TP13 TP10 TP12 TP14 TP15 TP24 TP25 TP22 TP23 TP16 TP17 TP18 TP19 TP20 TP21 FILE: ML_CPU1.CDR KVP - + TP8 1VOLT = 20 KV TP10 1 VOLT = 100 mA TP6 RAD mA AEC RAMP - + - + TP7 TP12 TP9 FLUORO mA TP11 - + TP13 + ABS TP14 1 VOLT = 2.5 mA TP15 THE SCALING FACTORS LISTED ABOVE ARE NOMINAL VALUES. NOTE: THIS DIAGRAM IS TYPICAL, ACTUAL GENERATOR CPU BOARDS MAY DIFFER IN DETAIL Figure 4-2: Test point locations Page 4-10 Rev. J Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-08 CPI Canada Inc. 4.4.1 Acceptance Testing 4 Generator Rad Tests (Cont) CAUTION: THE FOLLOWING TESTS REQUIRE THE PRODUCTION OF APPROPRIATE SAFETY PRECAUTIONS TO PROTECT PERSONNEL. X-RADIATION. USE NOTE: IF USING TEST POINTS TP6 & 8, TP7 & 10, TP11 & 14 IN FIGURE 4-2 FOR ACCEPTANCE TESTING, THE SCALING FACTORS SHOWN MUST BE VERIFIED USING AN APPROPRIATE CALIBRATED REFERENCE STANDARD. THE ACTUAL MEASURED SCALING VALUES SHOULD THEN BE USED IN THIS PROCEDURE. NOTE: A DYNALYZER IS NOT RECOMMENDED FOR MA MEASUREMENTS WITH INDICO 100 GENERATORS. BANDWIDTH LIMITATIONS OF THE DYNALYZER WILL RESULT IN INACCURATE MA MEASUREMENTS AT MA VALUES LESS THAN APPROXIMATELY 100 MA. MA MEASUREMENTS SHOULD BE MADE WITH AN MA / MAS METER CONNECTED TO THE MA TEST JACKS ON THE HT TANK. EXPOSURE TIMES MUST BE GREATER THAN 100 MS TO ENSURE ACCURATE MEASUREMENTS. Refer to figure 4-2 for test point locations referenced in the following section(s). Step 1. 2. 3. 4. Action SEE NOTE ABOVE RE USE OF TEST POINTS FOR VERIFYING CALIBRATION Connect ‘scope probe channel 1 input to TP6 and TP8 (kVp) Connect ‘scope probe channel 2 input to TP7 and TP10 (Rad mA). Adjust ‘scope gains as required. Use the KV signal to trigger the ‘scope. Switch ON the generator and after initialization select the following radiographic technique: kVp = 100, mA = 100, Time = 50 ms Select an off-table receptor. Make an exposure and measure the kVp at TP6 and TP8 and the Rad mA at TP7 and TP10. Using scaling factors in figure 4-2, verify the following results: Repeat step 3 but set the values to kVp = 65, mA = 200. Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Result Check N/A N/A kVp = 100 KV ± 3%. mA = 100 mA ± 4% (Millenia). mA = 100 mA ± 5% (Indico 100). Time = 50 ms ± 2 ms. kVp = 65 KV ± 3%. mA = 200 mA ± 4% (Millenia). mA = 200 mA ± 5% (Indico 100). Time = 50 ms ± 2 ms. Ch # 740904-08 Rev. J Page 4-11 4 Acceptance Testing 4.4.1 CPI Canada Inc. Generator Rad Tests (Cont) Step 5. Action Repeat step 3 but set the values to kVp = 125, mA = 200. 6. Select 75 kVp, 200 mA. Select the exposure times shown below (3 point operation). Result kVp = 125 KV ± 3%. mA = 200 mA ± 4% (Millenia). mA = 200 mA ± 4% (Indico 100). Time = 50 ms ± 2 ms. Check (Measure time and mA on the ‘scope and check that their product is as per the RESULT column). Measure time at 75% of the peak kVp waveform. 7. A: 10 ms (2 mAs) B: 20 ms (4 mAs) C: 63 ms (12 mAs) D: 100 ms (20 mAs) Select 75 kVp. Select the mAs shown below (2 point operation). Measure time at 75% of the peak kVp waveform. 8. A: 2 mAs (time per LCD display) B: 8 mAs (time per LCD display) C: 25 mAs (time per LCD display) D: 63 mAs (time per LCD display) Select 200 mA, 50 ms (3 point operation). A: 2 mAs ± 5%. B: 4 mAs ± 5%. C: 12 mAs ± 5%. D: 20 mAs ± 5%. NOTE: The time associated with each mAs setting will vary depending on generator configuration. Use the time displayed in the LCD window as the reference for the measurements below. time per LCD disp ± (2% + 1ms). time per LCD disp ± (2% + 1ms). time per LCD disp ± (2% + 1ms). time per LCD disp ± (2% + 1ms). Select the kVp values shown below. The measurements may be done noninvasively or from TP6 and TP8 using the ‘scope. A: B: C: D: E: Page 4-12 50 kVp 60 kVp 80 kVp 100 kVp 125 kVp A: B: C: D: E: Rev. J 50 kVp ± (3% + 1 kVp). 60 kVp ± (3% + 1 kVp). 80 kVp ± (3% + 1 kVp). 100 kVp ± (3% + 1 kVp). 125 kVp ± (3% + 1 kVp). Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-08 CPI Canada Inc. 4.4.1 Acceptance Testing 4 Generator Rad Tests (Cont) Step 9. Action Select 75 kVp, 50 ms (3 point operation). Result Check Select the mA values shown below. Measure mA at 75% of the peak kVp waveform. A: B: C: D: E: 50 mA 100 mA 200 mA 400 mA 800 mA A: B: C: D: E: 50 mA ± (5% + 1 mA). 100 mA ± (5% + 1 mA). 200 mA ± (5% + 1 mA). 400 mA ± (5% + 1 mA). 800 mA ± (5% + 1 mA). Note: The higher mA values will not be available on all generator models and / or programmed tube types. 4.4.2 Generator Fluoro Tests This section applies only to R&F units. Step 1. 2. 3. Action Place the generator into the fluoro mode of operation. Connect ‘scope probe channel 1 input to TP6 and TP8 (kVp). Connect ‘scope probe channel 2 input to TP11 and TP14 (fluoro mA). Use the kV signal to trigger the ‘scope. Place imaging system into non-ABS mode or cover the I.I. input with lead. Set 3 mA fluoro. Select the kV values shown below using the remote fluoro control if fitted, or the fluoro section of the console. A: B: C: D: E: 50 KV 65 KV 80 KV 100 KV 110 KV Result Check N/A N/A A: B: C: D: E: 50 kVp ± (10% + 1 kVp). 65 kVp ± (5% + 1 kVp). 80 kVp ± (5% + 1 kVp). 100 kVp ± (5% + 1 kVp). 110 kVp ± (5% + 1 kVp). Measure the kVp at TP6 and TP8. Using scaling factors in figure 4-2 verify kV values per the RESULTS column: Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-08 Rev. J Page 4-13 4 Acceptance Testing 4.4.2 CPI Canada Inc. Generator Fluoro Tests (Cont) Step 4. Action Select 70 kVp fluoro. Select the fluoro mA values shown below: A: B: C: D: 5. 6. Page 4-14 1.0 mA 2.0 mA 4.0 mA 6.0 mA Result A: B: C: D: Measure the fluoro mA at TP11 and TP14. Using scaling factors in figure 4-2 verify mA values per the RESULTS column: Press the PPS + and - buttons (if the pulse fluoro option is fitted). Run a sufficiently long fluoro exposure to accumulate some time on the console fluoro display, and on the remote fluoro control if used Press the ZERO button on the console and on the remote fluoro control if applicable. Rev. J Check 1.0 mA ± 20%. 2.0 mA ± 20%. 4.0 mA ± 15%. 6.0 mA ± 15%. Verify that the pulsed fluoro rate increases and decreases. Verify that the accumulated time is reset to zero after pressing each of the ZERO buttons. Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-08 CPI Canada Inc. 4.5.0 Acceptance Testing 4 ACCEPTANCE TESTS (OPTIONAL INTERFACES) Refer to separate supplements in this manual for further information IF APPLICABLE. 4.6.0 ACCEPTANCE TESTS (AEC) This section applies only to generators with AEC. • • 4.7.0 Review Section 3D: AEC Calibration. Recheck the mAs, Dose, and O.D. as recorded during initial installation. Follow the appropriate steps in section 3D to verify the AEC calibration. ACCEPTANCE TESTS (ABS) This section applies only to non-digital R&F generators with ABS. • • 4.8.0 Review section 3E: ABS calibration. Recheck the dose limits and input dose as described in the procedure. ACCEPTANCE TESTS (DAP) This section applies only to Indico 100 X-ray generators with DAP. • • Review Section 3F: DAP SETUP AND CALIBRATION. Follow the appropriate steps in section 3F to verify the DAP calibration. Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-08 Rev. J Page 4-15 4 Acceptance Testing 4.9.0 CPI Canada Inc. ACCEPTANCE TESTS (HVL, LINEARITY AND REPRODUCIBILITY) The procedure for performing reproducibility, linearity and HVL testing is contained in a separate document, part number 740917 that immediately follows this page. Page 4-16 Rev. J Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-08 CPI Canada Inc Reproducibility, Linearity, & HVL Testing SUPPLEMENT REPRODUCIBILTY, LINEARITY, & HVL TESTING CONTENTS: 1.0 INTRODUCTION.................................................................................................................................................. 2 2.0 EQUIPMENT SETUP........................................................................................................................................... 3 3.0 REPRODUCIBILITY............................................................................................................................................. 3 4.0 LINEARITY........................................................................................................................................................... 7 5.0 H.V.L. EVALUATION ........................................................................................................................................... 9 X-Ray Generator Service Manual Supplement 740917-00 Rev. A Page 1 Reproducibility, Linearity, & HVL Testing 1.0 CPI Canada Inc INTRODUCTION This supplement describes reproducibility, linearity, and half - value layer (HVL) tests which may be used to verify performance of medical X-ray generators. Page 2 NOTE: THIS SUPPLEMENT DETAILS TYPICAL REPRODUCIBILITY, LINEARITY, AND HVL TESTS. LOCAL REGULATIONS SHOULD ALWAYS BE CONSULTED PRIOR TO PERFORMING THESE TESTS, AS DETAILS MAY VARY IN SOME JURISDICTIONS, OR ADDITIONAL TESTS MAY NEED TO BE PERFORMED. WARNING: SOME EXPOSURES IN GENERATOR KVP. THE OPERATION AT THAT SEASONED TO ENSURE PROBLEMATIC. Rev. A THIS SECTION MUST BE TAKEN AT THE MAXIMUM X-RAY TUBE MUST BE KNOWN TO BE CAPABLE OF KVP VALUE, AND THE TUBE SHOULD FIRST BE THAT OPERATION AT HIGH KVP VALUES WILL NOT BE X-Ray Generator Service Manual Supplement 740917-00 CPI Canada Inc 2.0 Reproducibility, Linearity, & HVL Testing EQUIPMENT SETUP 1. Place the radiation probe above the table approximately 25 cm (10”). Select an SID of approximately 100 cm (40”). 2. Place a lead diaphragm over the detector and adjust its height so that the X-ray beam covers the detector but does not over radiate the sides of the ‘R’ probe. Refer to figure 1. Figure 1: mR measurement setup 3.0 REPRODUCIBILITY Calculate reproducibility as follows: 1. Using kV and mA/ms or mAs values per tables 1 to 4, make a series of 5 exposures. 2. Record each of the measured mR values in the appropriate table. Refer to step 3 before beginning step 2. 3. Record the preselected mAs for each series of exposures in the header of each table. For 3 point generators, this is the calculated mAs value where mAs = mA X time in seconds (example for 160 mA and 125 ms, mAs = 160 X 0.125 = 20 mAs). X-Ray Generator Service Manual Supplement 740917-00 Rev. A Page 3 Reproducibility, Linearity, & HVL Testing 3.0 CPI Canada Inc REPRODUCIBILITY (Cont) 4. Calculate and record the average dose mR. 5. Calculate the difference mR - mR for each exposure. 6. Square each difference from the previous step. 7. Calculate the sum of the differences squared. 8. Calculate the standard deviation (S) by using the formula. 9. Calculate reproducibility by dividing S by mR. 10. Table 5 shows example reproducibility calculations. 11. If linearity is to be measured, it is suggested that dose measurements be taken at this time for entry into tables 6 and 7. Refer to 4.0 LINEARITY for details. IN TABLES 1 TO 4, 3 POINT MEANS THAT FOR GENERATORS WHERE KV, MA, AND TIME SELECTION IS AVAILABLE, THE KV, MA AND MS VALUES SHOWN SHOULD BE USED. FOR GENERATORS WHERE 2 POINT OPERATION ONLY IS AVAILABLE, THE KV AND MAS VALUES SHOWN SHOULD BE USED. 3 point = Minimum kV, maximum mA, 100 ms. 2 point = Minimum kV, maximum mAs. EXP No. DOSE (mR) mAs = __________ DIFFERENCE2 DIFFERENCE 1 2 3 4 5 mR = ________ Calculate each of the differences ie: DIFF1 = mR1 - mR. Repeat for each remaining mR value. Square each difference. Then calculate the sum of the difference2. Sum of difference2 = _________ Calculate standard deviation (S) using formula at beginning of this section: Calculate reproducibility = S = __________ S = _________ (not to exceed 0.045) mR Table 1: Reproducibility Page 4 Rev. A X-Ray Generator Service Manual Supplement 740917-00 CPI Canada Inc 3.0 Reproducibility, Linearity, & HVL Testing REPRODUCIBILITY (Cont) 3 point = Maximum kV, minimum mA, 100 ms. 2 point = Maximum kV, minimum mAs. EXP No. DOSE (mR) mAs = __________ DIFFERENCE2 DIFFERENCE 1 2 3 4 5 mR = ________ Calculate each of the differences ie: DIFF1 = mR1 - mR. Repeat for each remaining mR value. Square each difference. Then calculate the sum of the difference2. Sum of difference2 = _________ Calculate standard deviation (S) using formula at beginning of this section: Calculate reproducibility = S = __________ S = _________ (not to exceed 0.045) mR Table 2: Reproducibility 3 point = 50% of maximum kV, 250 ms, mA to give 100 - 500 µR (1 - 5 µGy) dose. 2 point = 50% of maximum kV, mAs to give 100 - 500 µR (1 - 5 µGy) dose. EXP No. DOSE (mR) mAs = __________ DIFFERENCE2 DIFFERENCE 1 2 3 4 5 mR = ________ Calculate each of the differences ie: DIFF1 = mR1 - mR. Repeat for each remaining mR value. Square each difference. Then calculate the sum of the difference2. Sum of difference2 = _________ Calculate standard deviation (S) using formula at beginning of this section: Calculate reproducibility = S = __________ S = _________ (not to exceed 0.045) mR Table 3: Reproducibility X-Ray Generator Service Manual Supplement 740917-00 Rev. A Page 5 Reproducibility, Linearity, & HVL Testing 3.0 CPI Canada Inc REPRODUCIBILITY (Cont) 3 point = 80% of maximum kV, 250 ms, mA to give 100 - 500 µR (1 - 5 µGy) dose. 2 point = 80% of maximum kV, mAs to give 100 - 500 µR (1 - 5 µGy) dose. EXP No. DOSE (mR) MAS = __________ DIFFERENCE2 DIFFERENCE 1 2 3 4 5 mR = ________ Calculate each of the differences ie: DIFF1 = mR1 - mR. Repeat for each remaining mR value. Square each difference. Then calculate the sum of the difference2. Sum of difference2 = _________ Calculate standard deviation (S) using formula at beginning of this section: Calculate reproducibility = S = __________ S = _________ (not to exceed 0.045) mR Table 4: Reproducibility EXAMPLE mAs = _20_ EXP No. DOSE (mR) DIFFERENCE DIFFERENCE2 1 249.0 4.4 19.36 2 245.0 0.4 0.16 3 244.0 0.6 0.36 4 242.0 2.6 6.76 5 243.0 1.6 2.56 Calculate each of the differences ie: DIFF1 = mR1 - mR. Repeat for each remaining mR value. mR = _244.6_ Square each difference. Then calculate the sum of the difference2. Sum of difference2 = _29.2_ Calculate standard deviation (s) using formula at beginning of this section: Calculate reproducibility = S = _2.70_ S = _0.011_ (not to exceed 0.045) mR Table 5: Reproducibility Page 6 Rev. A X-Ray Generator Service Manual Supplement 740917-00 CPI Canada Inc 4.0 Reproducibility, Linearity, & HVL Testing LINEARITY 1. Record two additional series of dose measurements for entry into tables 6 and 7: • For table 6, use settings per table 3 EXCEPT use an mA (or mAs) value adjacent to the mA (or mAs) setting used in table 3. • For table 7, use settings per table 4 EXCEPT use an mA (or mAs) value adjacent to the mA (or mAs) setting used in table 4. • Record the mAs in the header of tables 6 and 7 as per 3.0 step 3. 1. Calculate and record the average dose mR for table 6 and 7. 2. Record the preselected mAs and the average dose values taken from tables 3 and 4, and from tables 6 and 7, at the top of the next page. 3. Using the appropriate mAs and mR values, calculate X3, X4, X6, and X7 in tables 8 and 9. 4. Calculate the coefficient of linearity, L, as per tables 8 and 9. mAs = __________ EXP No. DOSE (mR) 1 2 3 4 5 mR = ________ Table 6: Linearity mAs = __________ EXP No. DOSE (mR) 1 2 3 4 5 mR = ________ Table 7: Linearity X-Ray Generator Service Manual Supplement 740917-00 Rev. A Page 7 Reproducibility, Linearity, & HVL Testing 4.0 CPI Canada Inc LINEARITY (Cont) Record the mAs and mR values taken from tables 3, 4, 6, and 7 below. Table 3 mAs3 = _____ mR3 = _____ Table 4 mAs4 = _____ mR4 = _____ Table 6 mAs6 = _____ mR6 = _____ Table 7 mAs7 = _____ mR7 = _____ mR3 X3 = = ________ mAs3 mR6 X6 = = ________ mAs6 X3 - X6 L = = ________ (not to exceed 0.095) X3 + X6 In the numerator of the above equation, use the absolute value of X3 - X6 (disregard the minus sign). Table 8: Linearity mR4 X4 = = ________ mAs4 mR7 X7 = = ________ mAs7 X4 - X7 L = = ________ (not to exceed 0.095) X4 + X7 In the numerator of the above equation, use the absolute value of X4 - X7 (disregard the minus sign). Table 9: Linearity Page 8 Rev. A X-Ray Generator Service Manual Supplement 740917-00 CPI Canada Inc 5.0 Reproducibility, Linearity, & HVL Testing H.V.L. EVALUATION 1. Be sure the X-ray source assembly (X-ray tube and beam limiting device) is fully assembled and functional. 2. Use the test setup as per figure 1. 3. Set the generator as follows: 3 point generators, 80 kV, 200 mA, 50 ms, large focus. For 2 point generators use 80 kV, 200 mA if this can be set, and 10 mAs. 4. Take a series of three exposures and record the mR values in table 10. Calculate and record the average of the three exposures. 5. Place 2 mm of Al on top of the lead diaphragm (total of 2 mm added), repeat the exposure and record the mR value in table 10. 6. Place an additional 1 mm of Al on top of the lead diaphragm (total of 3 mm added), repeat the exposure; and record the mR value in table 10. 7. Place an additional 3 mm of Al on top of the lead diaphragm (total of 6 mm added), repeat the exposure; and record the mR value in table 10. 8. The relative transmission for the average of the three mR values where no Al was added is assigned a value of 1.00. Using that base, assign relative transmission values to the remaining mR values. For example, if the average mR value was 247 and has a relative transmission factor of 1.00, then 162 mR will have a relative transmission of 162 / 247 = 0.66. 9. Plot the relative transmission values in figure 1. This should produce a straight line on the graph since the X-axis is logarithmic. 10. Interpolate to determine the HVL. The Al thickness at a relative transmission of 0.5 will be the required HVL value. 11. Repeat steps 4 to 10: 3 point generators, 100 kV, 200 mA, 50 ms, large focus. For 2 point generators use 100 kV, 200 mA if this can be set, and 10 mAs. Use table 11 to record the values and figure 2 to plot the results 12. Table 12 and figure 3 show example HVL determination. X-Ray Generator Service Manual Supplement 740917-00 Rev. A Page 9 Reproducibility, Linearity, & HVL Testing 5.0 CPI Canada Inc H.V.L. EVALUATION (Cont) ADDED ALUMINUM FILTER DOSE (mR) RELATIVE TRANSMISSION 0 0 0 0 (Average of three readings) 1.00 2 1 3 Table 10: HVL dose values 80 kVp Figure 1: HVL plot 80 kVp For 80 kVp, the HVL must be ≥ 2.3 mm Al. Page 10 Rev. A X-Ray Generator Service Manual Supplement 740917-00 CPI Canada Inc 5.0 Reproducibility, Linearity, & HVL Testing H.V.L. EVALUATION (Cont) ADDED ALUMINUM FILTER DOSE (mR) RELATIVE TRANSMISSION 0 0 0 0 (Average of three readings) 1.00 2 1 3 Table 11: HVL dose values 100 kVp Figure 2: HVL plot 100 kVp For 100 kVp, the HVL must be ≥ 2.7 mm Al. X-Ray Generator Service Manual Supplement 740917-00 Rev. A Page 11 Reproducibility, Linearity, & HVL Testing 5.0 CPI Canada Inc H.V.L. EVALUATION (Cont) ADDED ALUMINUM FILTER DOSE (mR) RELATIVE TRANSMISSION 0 249 0 244 0 247 0 (Average of above three readings) 247 1.00 2 162 .66 1 131 .53 3 70 .28 Table 12: HVL dose values (example) Figure 3: HVL plot (example) By interpolating the thickness of Al at a relative transmission value of 0.5, it can be seen that the HVL is approximately 3.3. Page 12 Rev. A X-Ray Generator Service Manual Supplement 740917-00 CPI Canada Inc. Troubleshooting 5 CHAPTER 5 TROUBLESHOOTING CONTENTS: SECTION TITLE 5.1.0 INTRODUCTION.................................................................................................................................................... 5-1 5.2.0 STATUS AND ERROR CODES (NON-TOUCH SCREEN)................................................................................... 5-2 5.2.1 Operator Messages (Non-Touch Screen) .......................................................................................................... 5-2 5.2.2 Limit Messages (Non-Touch Screen)................................................................................................................. 5-2 5.2.3 Error Messages (Non-Touch Screen) ................................................................................................................ 5-3 5.3.0 STATUS AND ERROR CODES (TOUCH SCREEN) .......................................................................................... 5-10 5.3.1 Operator Messages (Touch Screen)................................................................................................................ 5-10 5.3.2 Limit Messages (Touch Screen)....................................................................................................................... 5-10 5.3.3 Error Messages (Touch Screen) ...................................................................................................................... 5-11 5.4.0 MISCELLANEOUS FAULTS................................................................................................................................ 5-18 5.4.1 Erratic Console Faults ...................................................................................................................................... 5-18 5.1.0 INTRODUCTION The Millenia and Indico 100 console will display status messages on the LCD display during normal and abnormal operation of the generator. This chapter contains tables of those messages and suggests actions to be taken by service personnel to correct any malfunctions that may occur. Section 5.2.0 details status and error messages for generators with the “standard” (non-touch screen console). Refer to section 5.3 for status and error messages for the touch screen console. Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-09 Rev. G Page 5-1 5 Troubleshooting CPI Canada Inc. 5.2.0 STATUS AND ERROR CODES (NON-TOUCH SCREEN) 5.2.1 Operator Messages (Non-Touch Screen) These messages indicate the status of the generator. No action is required. MESSAGE INITIALIZATION SPINNING ROTOR X-RAY READY X-RAY ON DAP NOT READY 5.2.2 DESCRIPTION Displayed during power up sequence. Displayed when prep state is active. Displayed when generator is ready to expose Displayed during both a rad and fluoro exposure. The optional DAP (Indico 100 only) is in its “warm up” state, and not ready to make DAP measurements. Limit Messages (Non-Touch Screen) These messages indicate that an exposure has been requested that exceeds one or more limits. MESSAGE TUBE KV LIMIT CAL LIMIT PROBLEM Requested kV not allowed as tube kV limit has been reached. Requested kV not allowed as generator kV limit has been reached. Requested mA not allowed as tube mA limit has been reached. Requested mA not allowed as generator mA limit has been reached. Requested parameter not allowed as tube kW limit has been reached. Requested parameter not allowed as generator kW limit has been reached. Requested mAs not allowed as tube mAs limit has been reached. Requested mAs not allowed as generator mAs limit has been reached. Requested ms not allowed as generator ms limit has been reached. Requested parameter not calibrated. AEC DENSITY LIM Requested density not programmed. ANODE HEAT WARN Anode has exceeded programmed warning level. FL TIMER WARN Fluoro interval timer ≥ 5.0 mins. Generator detected invalid parameter within received message, message ignored. GEN KV LIMIT TUBE MA LIMIT GEN MA LIMIT TUBE KW LIMIT GEN KW LIMIT TUBE MAS LIMIT GEN MAS LIMIT GEN MS LIMIT INVALID PARAM Page 5-2 Rev. G ACTION None. None. None. None. None. None. None. None. None. Recalibrate X-ray tube or select a calibrated parameter. Select another density or program requested density step. Wait for anode to cool. Reset fluoro timer. Select valid parameter. Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-09 CPI Canada Inc. 5.2.2 Troubleshooting Limit Messages (Cont) HOUSE HEAT WARN GEN DUTY WARNING DAP ACCUM WARN DAP RATE WARN 5.2.3 5 X-ray tube housing heat has exceeded housing warning limit. The generator has reached its duty cycle warning limit. The accumulated DAP value has reached the programmed DAP limit. The current DAP rate exceeds the programmed DAP rate limit. Wait for housing to cool. Re-evaluate technique factors. Allow generator to cool if possible. If exposures are continued, serious generator damage may result due to overheating. Reset the DAP. Reduce the dose. Error Messages (Non-Touch Screen) These messages indicate that an error has occurred. The errors are logged in the error log, previous errors should be reviewed by service personnel before taking further action. ERROR CODE MESSAGE APR MEMORY ERROR PROBLEM APR data has been corrupted. Generator CPU EPROM has been corrupted. E001 GEN EPROM ERR E003 GEN NVRAM ERR Generator CPU NVRAM data has been corrupted. E004 GEN RTC ERROR E005 PS CONTACT ERR E006 ROTOR FAULT Generator CPU real time clock is not functioning. Main contactor in HF power supply did not energize. 1. Rotor starter may have detected a current fault in the stator. E007 FILAMENT FAULT 2. Power supply was not ready to start rotor. Power supply has detected filament current <2 amps. Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-09 Rev. G ACTION See note 1 near end of this section. Call product support for new generator CPU EPROM. Re-initialize generator CPU NVRAM using generator factory defaults. Reset time and date. Call product support. Power unit off and retry rotor start. 1. Check for open filament in X-ray tube. 2. Check for poor connections in the cathode cable. 3. Check fuses on filament board(s). Page 5-3 5 Troubleshooting 5.2.3 CPI Canada Inc. Error Messages (Cont) Page 5-4 ERROR CODE E008 MESSAGE KV/MA FAULT PROBLEM Power supply has detected a fault in the kV or mA output during an exposure and immediately terminated the exposure. This may be caused by arcing in the Xray tube, arcing of the HV cables, or HT tank. E009 PS NOT READY E011 HIGH MA FAULT E012 LOW MA FAULT E013 MANUAL TERMIN Power supply is not ready to make an exposure. Generator CPU detected mA greater than allowed tolerance. Generator CPU detected mA less than allowed tolerance. Operator released exposure switch during exposure. E014 AEC BUT ERROR AEC exposure exceeded allowed back up time. E015 AEC BU MAS ERR AEC exposure exceeded allowed back up mAs. E016 TOMO BUT ERROR Tomo exposure exceeded back up time. Rev. G ACTION 1. If arcing of the Xray tube is suspected, check condition of tube. The X-ray tube may be damaged or simply require “seasoning”. Refer to chapter 6 for tube seasoning procedure. 2. If failure of HT tank is suspected, contact product support. Retry exposure. Recalibrate X-ray tube. * Recalibrate X-ray tube. * 1. Re-take exposure if necessary. 2. Check for faulty switch contacts or wiring. 1. Check exposure technique settings. 2. Check that correct AEC chamber is energized. 1. Check exposure technique settings. 2. Check that correct AEC chamber is energized. 1. Check exposure technique settings. 2. Increase tomo back up time if necessary. Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-09 CPI Canada Inc. 5.2.3 Troubleshooting 5 Error Messages (Cont) ERROR CODE E017 MESSAGE NOT CALIBRATED PROBLEM Selected mA not calibrated for selected kV. Generator has been in prep state too long. Selected parameters will cause X-ray tube to exceed its programmed anode heat limit. X-ray tube # 1 too hot and its thermal switch has opened. X-ray tube # 2 too hot and its thermal switch has opened. Door is open. Collimator is not ready. Generator did not receive a Bucky contact closure in a reasonable time after start of Rad expose state. II safety is not ready. Spare input is not ready. Prep input active during power on initialization phase. X-ray input active during power on initialization phase. Fluoro input active during power on initialization phase. Communication error detected with remote fluoro control unit. E018 PREP TIMEOUT E019 ANODE HEAT LIMIT E020 THERMAL INT #1 E021 THERMAL INT #2 E022 E023 E024 DOOR INTERLOCK COLLIMATOR ERR CASSETTE ERROR E025 E026 E028 II SAFETY INT SPARE INT PREP SW CLOSED E029 X-RAY SW CLOSED E030 FLUORO SW CLOSED E031 REMOTE COMM ERR E032 CONSOLE COMM ERR Generator has detected error in communication to console. E033 GEN BATTERY LOW Generator detects lithium battery voltage is low. Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-09 Rev. G ACTION Recalibrate X-ray tube. Reduce length of time in prep state. Reduce parameters or wait for tube to cool. Wait for X-ray tube # 1 to cool. Wait for X-ray tube # 2 to cool. Close door. Check collimator. Check for grid movement and drive signal to Bucky. Check II safety. Check spare input. Check prep switch and input for short circuit. Check X-ray switch and input for short circuit. Check fluoro switch and input for short circuit. 1. Check remote fluoro control cable for damage and proper connection. 2. Turn power off and then on to Reset Generator. 1. Check console cable for damage and proper connection. 2. Turn power off and then on to reset generator. Replace lithium battery. Page 5-5 5 Troubleshooting 5.2.3 CPI Canada Inc. Error Messages (Cont) Page 5-6 ERROR CODE E034 MESSAGE +12VDC ERROR E035 -12VDC ERROR E036 +15VDC ERROR E037 -15VDC ERROR E038 CAL DATA ERROR E039 AEC DATA ERROR E040 FLUORO DATA ERROR Generator detects corrupt Fluoro data. E041 REC DATA ERROR Generator detects corrupt receptor data. E042 TUBE DATA ERR Generator detects corrupt tube data. E043 KV ERROR KV detected in non x-ray state. E044 COMM ERROR E045 NOT SUPPORTED E046 MODE INHIBITED E047 FL TIMER LIMIT E048 FOCUS MISMATCH Received communication message not valid and ignored. Received message valid, but not supported by this system. Received message valid, but not allowed during present state. Fluoro Timer has exceeded time limit. Focus selected does not match current focus enabled by power supply. E049 NOT ENABLED Rev. G PROBLEM +12VDC rail is out of tolerance. -12VDC rail is out of tolerance. +15VDC rail is out of tolerance. -15VDC rail is out of tolerance. Generator detects corrupt calibration data. Generator detects corrupt AEC data. Requested function not programmed to be enabled. ACTION Check +12VDC rail. Check -12VDC rail. Check +15VDC rail. Check -15VDC rail. Re-calibrate X-ray tube(s). Reprogram AEC data or set factory defaults. Reprogram fluoro data or set factory defaults. Reprogram receptor data or set factory defaults. Reprogram tube data or set factory defaults. Switch OFF generator. Prevent further use of generator. Call product support. Reset error. Reset error. Reset error. Reset Fluoro timer. Check power supply interface cables between power supply and generator CPU board. Reprogram to enable function. Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-09 CPI Canada Inc. 5.2.3 Troubleshooting 5 Error Messages (Cont) ERROR CODE E050 MESSAGE GEN DATA ERROR PROBLEM Generator detects corrupt generator limit data. E051 AEC DEVICE ERR Generator has detected no feedback signal from AEC device. E052 HIGH SF CURRENT E053 HIGH LF CURRENT E054 AEC OUT OF RANGE Generator detects small focus filament current greater than limits in standby mode. Generator detects large focus filament current greater than limits in standby mode. AEC reference has reached a maximum or minimum limit. E055 NO FIELDS ACTIVE E056 NO TUBE SELECTED E057 AEC STOP ERROR E058 CONSOLE BUT ERR E059 HOUSE HEAT LIMIT AEC enabled but no fields are selected. All Receptors have no X-ray tube programmed. AEC stop signal (P.T. stop signal) is active low indicating exposure is finished during prep state. Console has detected exposure exceeded backup time and terminated exposure. X-ray tube housing has exceeded limit. Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-09 Rev. G ACTION Reprogram generator limit data or set factory defaults. 1. Check that X-ray tube is pointing at correct AEC device. 2. Check AEC cable for damage and proper connection. Check small focus filament board. Check large focus filament board. Re-adjust AEC calibration including density to operate within AEC range (O to 1OVDC). Select AEC field(s). Program receptor(s) with tube number. 1. Check that P.T. ramp does not exceed P.T. reference during prep state. 2. Check AEC device for proper operation. Call product support. Wait for tube to cool. Page 5-7 5 Troubleshooting 5.2.3 CPI Canada Inc. Error Messages (Cont) Page 5-8 ERROR CODE E060 MESSAGE EXP KV HIGH PROBLEM KV exceeds high KV tolerance level. E061 EXP KV LOW KV exceeds low KV tolerance level. E062 EXP_ SW ERROR E063 FACTORY DEFAULTS The EXP_SW signal on the generator Interface and generator CPU board is enabled when it should be disabled. SW1 switch 8 on the generator CPU board is set to default the generator CPU NVRAM with factory defaults. E066 NO SYNC PULSE Pulsed fluoro has been requested, but no sync pulse is present. E070 SOFTWARE KEY ERR E071 DAP OVERFLOW Defective or missing GAL U29 on generator CPU board 734573. The accumulated DAP value exceeds the display limit. Rev. G ACTION 1. Check the output of the kV reference DAC on the generator CPU board. 2. Measure the output of the generator with a dynalyzer or a non-invasive kVp meter. 1. Check the output of the kV reference DAC on the generator CPU board. 2. Measure the output of the generator with a dynalyzer or a non-invasive kVp meter. Call product support. Set SW1 switch 8 to its non default position. The generator will not exit the initialization phase until this switch is set. 1. Check that the imaging system is active, and cables are connected properly. 2. Check JW22 on the generator interface board. Call product support for new GAL U29. Reset the DAP. Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-09 CPI Canada Inc. 5.2.3 Troubleshooting 5 Error Messages (Cont) ERROR CODE E072 MESSAGE DAP DEVICE ERROR PROBLEM The DAP device is not functional. E073 DAP DATA ERROR The DAP configuration data is corrupted. E100 CAL_MAX MA ERR Maximum mA has been exceeded during auto calibration. E101 CAL_DATA LIMIT Auto calibration has exceeded data table length due to an excessive number of exposures. E102 CAL_MAX FIL ERR Maximum filament current for the selected focus has been exceeded. E103 CAL_MAN TERM E104 CAL_NO MA Operator released exposure button during auto calibration. No mA feedback detected during auto calibration. E105 CAL_MIN MA ERR Minimum generator mA was exceeded at start of calibration. This is usually caused by too high a filament standby current on the primary and or secondary filament. (Primary is the current filament being calibrated, secondary is the other filament and applies only to generators with two independent filament supplies). Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-09 Rev. G ACTION 1. Check the DAP wiring. 2. Check the DAP interface board. Reset factory defaults. Repeat auto calibration and/or decrease standby current. 1. Check to see if the filament standby current is too low. 2. Retry auto calibration. 1. Check to see if the maximum filament current limit can be increased. 2. Retry auto calibration. Retry auto Calibration. Check power supply Interface cables between HF power supply and generator CPU board. Reduce filament standby current on primary and/or secondary filament. Page 5-9 5 Troubleshooting CPI Canada Inc. 5.3.0 STATUS AND ERROR CODES (TOUCH SCREEN) 5.3.1 Operator Messages (Touch Screen) These messages indicate the status of the generator. No action is required. MESSAGE Generator Ready Unable to establish generator communication. Communication with generator reestablished 5.3.2 DESCRIPTION Indicates that the generator is ready to make an exposure. Indicates that the console is unable to communicate with the generator. Ensure that the generator is switched on, and that the console cable is properly connected to J2 on the rear of the console. Indicates that the console has re-established communication with the generator. Limit Messages (Touch Screen) These messages indicate that an exposure has been requested that exceeds one or more limits. MESSAGE Anode warning level exceeded Calibration limit: selected parameter not calibrated. PROBLEM Anode has exceeded programmed warning level. Requested parameter not calibrated. Deselect tomo table Request operator to deselect tomo table. Fluoro timer warning level exceeded Generator AEC density limit Fluoro interval timer ≥ 5.0 mins. Generator duty cycle warning The X-ray generator has reached its duty cycle warning limit. Generator kV limit Requested kV not allowed as generator kV limit has been reached. Requested parameter not allowed as generator kW limit has been reached. Requested mA not allowed as generator mA limit has been reached. Requested mAs not allowed as generator mAs limit has been reached. Requested ms not allowed as generator ms limit has been reached. Generator kW limit Generator mA limit Generator mAs limit Generator ms limit Page 5-10 Requested density not programmed. Rev. G ACTION Wait for the anode to cool. Recalibrate X-ray tube or select a calibrated parameter. Deselect the tomo receptor. Reset fluoro timer. Select another density or program requested density step. Re-evaluate technique factors. Allow generator to cool if possible. If exposures are continued, serious generator damage may result due to overheating. None. None. None. None. None. Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-09 CPI Canada Inc. 5.3.2 Troubleshooting Limit Messages (Cont) MESSAGE Generator PPS limit Invalid communication parameter Select tomo table. PROBLEM Generator PPS limit has been reached. Generator detected invalid parameter within received message, message ignored. Request operator to select tomo table. Tube housing heat warning X-ray tube housing heat has exceeded housing warning limit. Requested kV not allowed as tube kV limit has been reached. Requested parameter not allowed as tube kW limit has been reached. Requested mA not allowed as tube mA limit has been reached. Requested mAs not allowed as tube mAs limit has been reached. Tube kV limit Tube kW limit Tube mA limit Tube mAs limit 5.3.3 5 ACTION None. Select valid parameter. Select the tomo receptor Wait for the tube housing to cool. None. None. None. None. Error Messages (Touch Screen) These messages indicate that an error has occurred. The errors are logged in the error log, previous errors should be reviewed by service personnel before taking further action. ERROR CODE E001 MESSAGE Generator CPU EPROM checksum error PROBLEM Generator CPU EPROM has been corrupted. E003 Generator CPU NVRAM error Generator CPU NVRAM data has been corrupted. E004 E005 Generator CPU Real Time Clock error. Main Contactor Error E006 Rotor Fault Generator CPU real time clock is not functioning. Main contactor in HF power supply did not energize. 1. Rotor starter may have detected a current fault in the stator. ACTION Call product support for new generator CPU EPROM. Re-initialize generator CPU NVRAM using generator factory defaults. Reset time and date. Call product support. Power unit off and retry rotor start. 2. Power supply was not ready to start rotor. Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-09 Rev. G Page 5-11 5 Troubleshooting 5.3.3 CPI Canada Inc. Error Messages (Cont) ERROR CODE E007 MESSAGE Filament Fault PROBLEM Power supply has detected filament current <2 amps. E008 mA Fault Power supply has detected a fault in the kV or mA output during an exposure and immediately terminated the exposure. This may be caused by arcing in the Xray tube, arcing of the HV cables, or HT tank. E009 Power Supply Not Ready E011 MA During Exposure Too High E012 MA During Exposure Too Low E013 Manually Terminated Exposure Power supply is not ready to make an exposure. Generator CPU detected mA greater than allowed tolerance. Generator CPU detected mA less than allowed tolerance. Operator released exposure switch during exposure. E014 AEC Back-up Timer Exposure Terminated AEC exposure exceeded allowed back up time. Page 5-12 Rev. G ACTION 1. Check for open filament in X-ray tube. 2. Check for poor connections in the cathode cable. 3. Check fuses on filament board(s). 1. If arcing of the Xray tube is suspected, check condition of tube. The X-ray tube may be damaged or simply require “seasoning”. Refer to chapter 6 for tube seasoning procedure. 2. If failure of HT tank is suspected, contact product support. Retry exposure. Recalibrate X-ray tube. * Recalibrate X-ray tube. * 1. Re-take exposure if necessary. 2. Check for faulty switch contacts or wiring. 1. Check exposure technique settings. 2. Check that correct AEC chamber is energized. Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-09 CPI Canada Inc. 5.3.3 Troubleshooting 5 Error Messages (Cont) ERROR CODE E015 MESSAGE AEC mAs Exceeded Exposure Terminated PROBLEM AEC exposure exceeded allowed back up mAs. E016 Tomo Back-up Timer Exposure Terminated Tomo exposure exceeded back up time. E017 E018 Uncalibrated Exposure Parameter Preparation Timeout E019 Anode Heat Limit E020 Thermal Switch Interlock #1 Error E021 Thermal Switch Interlock #2 Error E022 E023 E024 Door Interlock Collimator Interlock Error Cassette Interlock Error E025 Image Intensifier Safety Interlock Error Spare Input Interlock Error Receptor Timeout Error Receptor did not respond within the timeout period Prep Input Active During Initialization Phase Selected mA not calibrated for selected kV. Generator has been in prep state too long. Selected parameters will cause X-ray tube to exceed its programmed anode heat limit. X-ray tube # 1 too hot and its thermal switch has opened. X-ray tube # 2 too hot and its thermal switch has opened. Door is open. Collimator is not ready. Generator did not receive a Bucky contact closure in a reasonable time after start of Rad expose state. II safety is not ready. E026 E027 E028 E029 X-Ray Input Active During Initialization Phase E030 Fluoro Input Active During Initialization Phase Spare input is not ready. The receptor is not responding Prep input active during power on initialization phase. X-ray input active during power on initialization phase. Fluoro input active during power on initialization phase. Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-09 Rev. G ACTION 1. Check exposure technique settings. 2. Check that correct AEC chamber is energized. 1. Check exposure technique settings. 2. Increase tomo back up time if necessary. Recalibrate X-ray tube. Reduce length of time in prep state. Reduce parameters or wait for tube to cool. Wait for X-ray tube # 1 to cool. Wait for X-ray tube # 2 to cool. Close door. Check collimator. Check for grid movement and drive signal to Bucky. Check II safety. Check spare input. Wait for receptor to be ready, then retry exposure. Check prep switch and input for short circuit. Check X-ray switch and input for short circuit. Check fluoro switch and input for short circuit. Page 5-13 5 Troubleshooting 5.3.3 CPI Canada Inc. Error Messages (Cont) ERROR CODE E031 MESSAGE Remote Fluoro Communication Error PROBLEM Communication error detected with remote fluoro control unit. E032 Console Communication Error Generator has detected error in communication to console. E033 E034 Warning Lithium Battery Voltage Low +12VDC Error E035 -12VDC Error E036 +15VDC Error E037 -15VDC Error E038 E039 Calibration Data Corrupt Error AEC Data Corrupt Generator detects lithium battery voltage is low. +12VDC rail is out of tolerance. -12VDC rail is out of tolerance. +15VDC rail is out of tolerance. -15VDC rail is out of tolerance. Generator detects corrupt calibration data. Generator detects corrupt AEC data. E040 Fluoro Data Corrupt Generator detects corrupt Fluoro data. E041 Receptor Data Corrupt Generator detects corrupt receptor data. E042 Tube Data Corrupt Generator detects corrupt tube data. E043 High Voltage Error - kV detected in non X-ray state KV detected in non x-ray state. E044 Invalid Communication Message Received communication message not valid and ignored. Page 5-14 Rev. G ACTION 1. Check remote fluoro control cable for damage and proper connection. 2. Turn power off and then on to Reset Generator. 1. Check console cable for damage and proper connection. 2. Turn power off and then on to reset generator. Replace lithium battery. Check +12VDC rail. Check -12VDC rail. Check +15VDC rail. Check -15VDC rail. Re-calibrate X-ray tube(s). Reprogram AEC data or set factory defaults. Reprogram fluoro data or set factory defaults. Reprogram receptor data or set factory defaults. Reprogram tube data or set factory defaults. Switch OFF generator. Prevent further use of generator. Call product support. Reset error. Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-09 CPI Canada Inc. 5.3.3 Troubleshooting 5 Error Messages (Cont) ERROR CODE E045 MESSAGE Communication Message Not Supported PROBLEM Received message valid, but not supported by this system. Received message valid, but not allowed during present state. Fluoro Timer has exceeded time limit. Focus selected does not match current focus enabled by power supply. E046 Mode Inhibited E047 Fluoro Timer Limit E048 Focus mismatch error E049 Not Enabled E050 Generator Limit Data Corrupt E051 AEC Feedback Error (No Feedback Signal Detected) Generator has detected no feedback signal from AEC device. E052 High Small focus filament current error in standby E053 High Large focus filament current error in standby E054 AEC Reference out of range Generator detects small focus filament current greater than limits in standby mode. Generator detects large focus filament current greater than limits in standby mode. AEC reference has reached a maximum or minimum limit. E055 No fields selected in AEC E056 Receptor Disabled Requested function not programmed to be enabled. Generator detects corrupt generator limit data. AEC enabled but no fields are selected. All Receptors have no X-ray tube programmed. Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-09 Rev. G ACTION Reset error. Reset error. Reset Fluoro timer. Check power supply interface cables between power supply and generator CPU board. Reprogram to enable function. Reprogram generator limit data or set factory defaults. 1. Check that X-ray tube is pointing at correct AEC device. 2. Check AEC cable for damage and proper connection. Check small focus filament board. Check large focus filament board. Re-adjust AEC calibration including density to operate within AEC range (O to 1OVDC). Select AEC field(s). Program receptor(s) with tube number. Page 5-15 5 Troubleshooting 5.3.3 CPI Canada Inc. Error Messages (Cont) ERROR CODE E057 MESSAGE AEC Stop Signal In Wrong State PROBLEM AEC stop signal (P.T. stop signal) is active low indicating exposure is finished during prep state. E058 Console Back-up Timer E059 E060 Housing Heat Limit Exceeded High kV Error Console has detected exposure exceeded backup time and terminated exposure. X-ray tube housing has exceeded limit. KV exceeds high KV tolerance level. E061 Low kV Error KV exceeds low KV tolerance level. E062 EXP_SW Signal Active in Standby State E063 Factory Defaults Set The EXP_SW signal on the generator Interface and generator CPU board is enabled when it should be disabled. SW1 switch 8 on the generator CPU board is set to default the generator CPU NVRAM with factory defaults. Page 5-16 Rev. G ACTION 1. Check that P.T. ramp does not exceed P.T. reference during prep state. 2. Check AEC device for proper operation. Call product support. Wait for tube to cool. 1. Check the output of the kV reference DAC on the generator CPU board. 2. Measure the output of the generator with a dynalyzer or a non-invasive kVp meter. 1. Check the output of the kV reference DAC on the generator CPU board. 2. Measure the output of the generator with a dynalyzer or a non-invasive kVp meter. Call product support. Set SW1 switch 8 to its non default position. The generator will not exit the initialization phase until this switch is set. Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-09 CPI Canada Inc. 5.3.3 Troubleshooting 5 Error Messages (Cont) ERROR CODE E066 MESSAGE No Sync Signal PROBLEM Pulsed fluoro has been requested, but no sync pulse is present. E067 Power Supply Duty Cycle Limit Power supply duty cycle limit exceeded. E070 Generator software key error E071 DAP overflow error E072 DAP device error Defective or missing GAL U29 on generator CPU board 734573. The accumulated DAP value exceeds the display limit. The DAP device is not functional. E073 DAP data error The DAP configuration data is corrupted. E100 Calibration Error - Maximum mA Exceeded Maximum mA has been exceed during auto calibration. E101 Calibration Error Calibration Data Table Exceeded Auto calibration has exceeded data table length due to an excessive number of exposures. E102 Calibration Error - Maximum Filament Current Exceeded Maximum filament current for the selected focus has been exceeded. E103 Calibration Error - Manually Terminated Operator released exposure button during auto calibration. Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-09 Rev. G ACTION 1. Check that the imaging system is active, and cables are connected properly. 2. Check JW22 on the generator interface board. Re-evaluate technique factors. Allow generator to cool if possible. If exposures are continued, serious generator damage may result due to overheating. Call product support for new GAL U29. Reset the DAP. 1. Check the DAP wiring. 2. Check the DAP interface board. Reset factory defaults. Repeat auto calibration and/or decrease standby current. 1. Check to see if the filament standby current is too low. 2. Retry auto calibration. 1. Check to see if the maximum filament current limit can be increased. 2. Retry auto calibration. Retry auto Calibration. Page 5-17 5 Troubleshooting 5.3.3 CPI Canada Inc. Error Messages (Cont) ERROR CODE E104 MESSAGE Calibration Error - No mA PROBLEM No mA feedback detected during auto calibration. E105 Calibration Error - Minimum mA Not Calibrated Minimum generator mA was exceeded at start of calibration. This is usually caused by too high a filament standby current on the primary and or secondary filament. (Primary is the current filament being calibrated, secondary is the other filament and applies only to generators with two independent filament supplies). ACTION Check power supply Interface cables between HF power supply and generator CPU board. Reduce filament standby current on primary and/or secondary filament. * The generator purges the existing X-ray tube auto calibration data before starting the auto calibration routine and saving new calibration data. Therefore, auto calibration should be a last resort during general troubleshooting, and should only be done to recalibrate the tube. For example, if a low mA fault is presented, you should ensure that the generator is fully functional, and actually needs recalibration. If calibration is attempted on a partially functional generator, the auto calibration routine may be aborted before any calibration is done, and the generator will inhibit further exposures until the selected mA is calibrated for the selected kV. 1. For an APR MEMORY ERROR fault, the console factory defaults must be restored or the APR must be restored via GenWare®. The procedure for resetting console factory defaults is described in chapter 6. 5.4.0 MISCELLANEOUS FAULTS 5.4.1 Erratic Console Faults SYMPTOM: In some environments that are “electrically noisy”, the console may exhibit erratic faults i.e. RAM data error, intermittent loss of communication, or random fault messages may be displayed. SOLUTION: Connect a separate ground wire, #14 AWG (2.3 mm2) or larger from the ground stud on the rear of the console (marked CONSOLE GROUND in the figure “rear of control console” in chapter 2) to the ground stud located to the left of the main input fuse block. This is marked GROUND in the figure “generator mains connection” in chapter 2. Page 5-18 Rev. G Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-09 CPI Canada Inc Regular Maintenance 6 CHAPTER 6 REGULAR MAINTENANCE CONTENTS: Section Title 6.1.0 INTRODUCTION.................................................................................................................................................... 6-2 6.2.0 X-RAY GENERATOR UPDATE/SERVICE RECORD ........................................................................................... 6-2 6.3.0 MAINTENANCE SCHEDULE ................................................................................................................................ 6-2 6.4.0 OIL FILL/LEVEL CHECK (HT TANK) .................................................................................................................... 6-4 6.4.1 Millenia Oil Fill/Level Check ............................................................................................................................... 6-4 6.4.2 Indico 100 Oil Fill/Level Check ........................................................................................................................... 6-5 6.5.0 CLEANING ............................................................................................................................................................. 6-6 6.6.0 EPROM REPLACEMENT / SOFTWARE UPGRADE ........................................................................................... 6-6 6.6.1 Console Software / EPROM............................................................................................................................... 6-6 6.6.2 Power EPROM ................................................................................................................................................... 6-7 6.6.3 Dual Speed Starter EPROM (If fitted) ................................................................................................................ 6-7 6.6.4 Resetting Factory Defaults ................................................................................................................................. 6-7 6.7.0 SOFTWARE KEY INSTALLATION / REPLACEMENT.......................................................................................... 6-9 6.8.0 BATTERY REPLACEMENT................................................................................................................................. 6-10 6.9.0 TUBE CONDITIONING / SEASONING ............................................................................................................... 6-10 6.9.1 Tube Conditioning (Overview).......................................................................................................................... 6-10 6.9.2 Tube Conditioning (Procedure) ........................................................................................................................ 6-11 6.10.0 END OF PRODUCT LIFE .................................................................................................................................. 6-12 Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-10 Rev. L Page 6-1 6 Regular Maintenance 6.1.0 CPI Canada Inc INTRODUCTION This chapter of the manual provides a recommended schedule for periodic maintenance of the Millenia and Indico 100 family of generators. NOTE: 6.2.0 REFERENCES IN THIS SECTION TO CONSOLE SERVICING (CONSOLE EPROM REPLACEMENT, SETTING CONSOLE CPU FACTORY DEFAULTS, CONSOLE BATTERY REPLACEMENT, ETC) DO NOT APPLY TO THE TOUCH SCREEN CONSOLE. THE TOUCH SCREEN CONSOLE IS NOT FIELD SERVICEABLE, PLEASE CONTACT THE FACTORY FOR SERVICE. X-RAY GENERATOR UPDATE/SERVICE RECORD The X-ray generator update / service record is stored in the upper cabinet of the generator (Millenia) or on the back of the panel which accesses the control boards in the lower cabinet (Indico 100). The installation date and location should be recorded on this form at the time of the original site installation. Service and repairs must be recorded in the update / service record. The record should be as thorough as possible, detailing the scope and type of work that was performed (all service and a record of all replacement parts that were installed). Additionally, the person performing the work should date and sign the record. This information will be invaluable in the future for traceability and to ensure continued compatibility of the generator. 6.3.0 MAINTENANCE SCHEDULE WARNING: MAINTENANCE IS TO BE PERFORMED ONLY BY COMPETENT, TRAINED PERSONNEL WHO ARE FAMILIAR WITH THE POTENTIAL HAZARDS ASSOCIATED WITH THIS EQUIPMENT. NOTE: MAINTENANCE SCHEDULE FREQUENCY MAY BE DETERMINED BY CERTAIN REGULATORY REQUIREMENTS OF THE COUNTRY OR STATE IN WHICH THE INSTALLATION IS LOCATED. ALWAYS CHECK THE LOCAL CODES AND REGULATIONS WHEN DETERMINING A MAINTENANCE SCHEDULE. WARNING: ALWAYS SWITCH OFF MAINS POWER TO THE GENERATOR AND WAIT A MINIMUM OF 5 MINUTES FOR CAPACITORS TO DISCHARGE BEFORE BEGINNING ANY PREVENTATIVE MAINTENANCE, INCLUDING CLEANING. WARNING: OBSERVE ESD PRECAUTIONS. KEEP ALL STATIC - SENSITIVE COMPONENTS AND CIRCUIT BOARDS IN THEIR STATIC - SHIELDING PACKAGING UNTIL READY TO INSTALL. ENSURE THAT YOU ARE GROUNDED AT ALL TIMES WHEN HANDLING STATIC - SENSITIVE COMPONENTS AND CIRCUIT BOARDS. Page 6-2 Rev. L Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-10 CPI Canada Inc 6.3.0 Regular Maintenance 6 MAINTENANCE SCHEDULE (Cont) Maintenance Frequency As governed by local regulations. Every 6 Months AND whenever a related certifiable X-ray component is replaced: Every 12 months: Every 5 years: Description of Preventative Maintenance Check and recalibrate the DAP meter in the generator. 1. Clean and re-grease all HV connections using vapour proof compound. 2. Clean the control console, remote fluoro control (if used) and main cabinet as needed. REFER TO 6.5.0 CLEANING BEFORE PROCEEDING 3. Perform the X-ray tube auto calibration routine, refer to chapter 2. 4. Verify the calibration of the generator; refer to chapter 4 of this manual. 5. Test the X-ray tube thermal switch circuits in the generator. Disconnect the tube thermal switch(s) and verify the correct error message, and that X-ray exposures are inhibited. 6. For fan cooled Indico 100 generators in particular, remove accumulated dust from the cooling vents. Vacuuming is recommended. 7. Perform any additional tests required by laws governing this installation. 1. Examine the following for any visible damage and replace any damaged components: • The exterior of the control console and remote fluoro control if used, including the membrane switch assembly. • The cable between the control console and the generator main cabinet and between the remote fluoro control (if used) and generator main cabinet. • The hand switch and fluoro footswitch (if used) and the cables connecting these to the console. 2. Open the generator cabinet and examine the unit for any visible damage: missing or loose ground connections, oil leaks, damaged cables etc. 3. Ensure that there are no obstructions blocking any of the ventilation holes or louvers on the generator cabinet. Replace the lithium battery on the CPU board in the control console and on the generator CPU board in the main cabinet. Refer to the spares list in chapter 8 for the required part number. Refer to subsection 6.7.0 for battery replacement procedure. Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-10 Rev. L Page 6-3 6 Regular Maintenance 6.4.0 CPI Canada Inc OIL FILL/LEVEL CHECK (HT TANK) The insulating oil level in the HT transformer does NOT require periodic checking under normal conditions. However, if there is evidence of possible oil loss, the procedure for checking the correct oil level follows. Refer to 6.4.1 for Millenia generators, and to 6.4.2 for Indico 100 generators. 6.4.1 Millenia Oil Fill/Level Check 1. Using a suitable wrench, remove the oil fill cap on top of the HT transformer. 2. Measure the oil level from the TOP surface of the oil fill flange using a clean ruler. The oil level should be in the range of 7/8” (22 mm) to 1 3/8” (35 mm) from the top of the flange. Add oil if the oil level is low, that is greater than 1 3/8” (35 mm) from the top. 3. Use only fresh oil, type Shell DIALA AX or equivalent. Take care not to damage delicate components inside the tank if using a funnel for oil fill. 4. Replace the oil filler cap and tighten when finished. Wipe up any oil spills. Dispose of soiled absorber in compliance with government requirements and ensure conformity to local disposal regulations. Figure 6-1: Millenia HT tank oil fill Page 6-4 Rev. L Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-10 CPI Canada Inc 6.4.2 Regular Maintenance 6 Indico 100 Oil Fill/Level Check 1. Loosen the oil fill plug screw on the Indico 100 tank lid. 2. With the screw sufficiently loosened, remove the rubber (neoprene) plug. 3. Use a clean ruler, strip of cardboard, or other equivalent material to determine the oil level -measured always from the TOP surface of the HT tank’s lid. • Normally the oil level should be between 0.88 - 1.25 inches (22 - 32 mm) from the top of the tank lid. • If the oil level is between 1.25 - 1.6 inches (32 - 41 mm) from the top of the tank lid, then clean oil should be added as needed. • If the oil level is greater than 1.6 inches (41 mm) below the top of the tank lid, please consult the factory. Figure 6-2: HT tank oil level 4. 5. Use only fresh oil, type Shell DIALA AX or equivalent. It is critical that air is not added when topping up the oil. The following procedure is strongly recommended when adding oil. • Use a new clean syringe to remove oil from the container. A 60 cc catheter tip syringe is recommended. Approximately 60 cc of oil is required to raise the oil level by one millimeter. • Turn the syringe upright and expel any trapped air. • Place the tip of the syringe through the oil-fill plug and into the oil, ensuring that it is below the surface of the oil. • Gently eject the oil from the syringe into the HT tank, while making sure that the tip of the syringe remains below the surface of the oil until all of the oil is emptied from the syringe. • Repeat the previous steps until the required amount of oil has been added. Replace the oil fill plug. Once the plug is installed and the screw properly seated, tighten the screw 4 turns. This will secure the oil fill plug. Wipe up any oil spills. Dispose of soiled absorber in compliance with government requirements and ensure conformity to local disposal regulations. THE OIL DOES NOT CONTAIN PCBs. Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-10 Rev. L Page 6-5 6 Regular Maintenance 6.5.0 CLEANING • • • • • • • 6.6.0 Never use anything other than soap and water to clean plastic surfaces. Other cleaners may damage the plastic. Never use any corrosive, solvent or abrasive detergents or polishes. Ensure that no water or other liquid can enter any equipment. This precaution prevents short circuits and corrosion forming on components. Methods of disinfection used must conform to legal regulations and guidelines regarding disinfection and explosion protection. If disinfectants are used which form explosive mixtures of gases, these gases must have dissipated before switching on the equipment again. Disinfection by spraying is not recommended because the disinfectant may enter the X-ray equipment. If room disinfection is done with an atomizer, it is recommended that the equipment be switched OFF, allowed to cool down and covered with a plastic sheet. When the disinfectant mist has subsided, the plastic sheet may be removed and the equipment be disinfected by wiping. EPROM REPLACEMENT / SOFTWARE UPGRADE WARNING: 6.6.1 CPI Canada Inc PLEASE TAKE APPROPRIATE ELECTROSTATIC PRECAUTIONS AT ALL TIMES WHEN HANDLING THE EPROM’s. Console Software / EPROM 1. Console software for the 23 X 56 cm console and for the Rad-only console resides in an EPROM. When the software for these consoles needs to be field upgraded, a replacement EPROM will be supplied. 2. Console software for the 31 X 42 cm console initially resides in flash memory on the console board. The console software will be field upgraded by one of the following methods: • The flash memory may be reprogrammed in the field if the required hardware is available (a suitable computer, a flash loader, and the proper cables). For details, please consult the factory. • Alternatively, an EPROM may be supplied containing the updated software. Continue with the following steps if upgrading the software via an EPROM. 3. With the generator mains power switched OFF, open the console to gain access to the console EPROM. Refer to chapter 2, the section CHECKING THE RAM BACKUP BATTERY VOLTAGE, for the procedure to access the console CPU board. 4. Locate and carefully remove the existing EPROM on the console CPU board (refer to figure 1E-4). This does not apply if the console software currently resides in flash memory as described in step 2. 5. Carefully insert the replacement EPROM into the socket observing the orientation per figure 1E-4. 6. For Indico 100 with the 31 X 42 cm console: • Ensure that JW1 on the console board is set to the EPROM BOOT position in order to run the updated software on EPROM. Refer to figure 1E-4. This jumper is initially set to the FLASH BOOT position in order to boot from flash memory. • JW1 on the console board must be set to the FLASH BOOT position in order to run existing or upgraded console software from flash memory. 7. Re-assemble the console as per the procedure in chapter 2. 8. Refer to 6.6.4 before re-energizing the generator. Page 6-6 Rev. L Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-10 CPI Canada Inc 6.6.2 6.6.3 Regular Maintenance 6 Power EPROM 1. With the generator mains power switched OFF, locate and carefully remove the existing power EPROM on the generator CPU board (U38 or U41, refer to figure 1E-1). 2. Carefully insert the replacement EPROM into the socket observing the orientation per figure 1E-1. NOTE THAT THE REPLACEMENT EPROM MAY HAVE FOUR LESS PINS THAN THE SOCKET IT IS TO BE INSERTED INTO. IF THIS IS SO, THE EMPTY PINS MUST BE ON THE PIN 1 SIDE OF THE EPROM AS SHOWN IN FIGURE 1E-1. 3. Refer to 6.6.4 before re-energizing the generator. Dual Speed Starter EPROM (If fitted) 1. Switch the generator mains power OFF, AND WAIT 5 MINUTES FOR THE DC BUS CAPACITORS TO FULLY DISCHARGE. STEPS 2 AND 3 APPLY TO MILLENIA GENERATORS ONLY. IN INDICO 100 GENERATORS, THE DUAL SPEED STARTER BOARD IS FULLY ACCESSIBLE WITH THE APPROPRIATE GENERATOR SIDE PANEL(S) REMOVED. 6.6.4 2. Loosen the two nuts securing the clamping bracket at the top of the dual speed starter. Slide the bracket up and gently remove the dual speed starter assembly. The cables connected to the dual speed starter do not need to be removed in order to change the EPROM. 3. Carefully rotate the dual speed starter chassis to fully expose the dual speed starter board inside the unit. 4. Locate and carefully remove the existing EPROM on the dual speed starter board (U26, refer to figure 1E-6). 5. Carefully insert the replacement EPROM into the socket observing the orientation per figure 1E-6. 6. Reinstall the dual speed starter assembly by reversing steps 2 and 3 (Millenia). Resetting Factory Defaults If the part number (not revision) of the replacement EPROM is different from the EPROM being replaced, then the FACTORY DEFAULT procedure(s) must be performed as detailed below. This will initialize the CPU’s NVRAM as required by the new software and sets the data to its factory-configured state. Note that there are separate procedures for the console CPU board and for the generator CPU board. For Indico 100 with the 31 X 42 cm console, the console software is initially programmed into flash memory on the console board. If the console software needs to be field-upgraded, an EPROM may be supplied containing the updated software. As noted above, if the part number (not revision) of the replacement firmware is different from that being replaced, then the FACTORY DEFAULT procedure(s) must be performed as detailed below. The part number and revision of the software in flash memory is displayed at the password screen, below the message ENTER PASSWORD: _____, when initially entering into programming mode. This is only displayed if running the software from flash memory. Refer to the section EPROM REPLACEMENT, Console EPROM for details regarding the use of flash memory vs. EPROM. Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-10 Rev. L Page 6-7 6 Regular Maintenance 6.6.4 CPI Canada Inc Resetting Factory Defaults (Cont) CONSOLE CPU FACTORY DEFAULTS: 31 X 42 CM CONSOLE USING AN EPROM AND 23 X 56 CM CONSOLE: 1. With the power OFF, set switch 8 of SW1 on the console CPU board to its ON position. 2. Power ON the generator. The console will prompt for a YES or NO to loading defaults for two conditions (console settings and APR memory). Select YES to both. 3. Power OFF the console. Reset switch 8 of SW1 on the console CPU board to its OFF position. This will initialize both the CONSOLE settings (refer to CONSOLE settings in chapter 3C) and the APR to the factory default settings. 31 X 42 CM CONSOLE USING FLASH MEMORY AND RAD-ONLY CONSOLE: 1. In chapter 3C, refer to LOAD CONSOLE DEFAULTS. This is in the UTILITY menu, under the CONSOLE submenu. Set LOAD CONSOLE DEFAULTS to YES. 2. Select << and EXIT to return to the UTILITY menu. 3. Select EXIT again to return to the GENERATOR SETUP menu. 4. Briefly switch the generator OFF, and then ON again. The console will prompt for a YES or NO to loading defaults when it is powered on again. Select YES to both prompts to reset the console and APR defaults. 5. This will initialize both the CONSOLE settings (refer to CONSOLE settings in chapter 3C) and the APR to the factory default settings. The LOAD CONSOLE DEFAULTS setting automatically resets to NO the next time the generator is switched on. GENERATOR CPU FACTORY DEFAULTS: 1. With the power OFF, set switch 8 of SW1 on the generator CPU board to its OFF position. 2. Power ON the generator. After the initialization is complete, the console will display the message FACTORY DEFAULTS. 3. Power OFF the generator. Reset switch 8 of SW1 on the generator CPU board to its ON position. This will initialize all generator data to the factory defaults (tube selection, generator limits, receptor setup, I/O configuration, AEC setup, AEC calibration, fluoro setup, tube calibration, time & date, error log and statistics). Page 6-8 Rev. L Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-10 CPI Canada Inc 6.7.0 Regular Maintenance 6 SOFTWARE KEY INSTALLATION / REPLACEMENT WARNING: PLEASE TAKE APPROPRIATE ELECTROSTATIC PRECAUTIONS AT ALL TIMES WHEN HANDLING THE “SOFTWARE KEY” I.C. This feature is available on Indico 100 generators only. The “software key” activates specific options in the Indico 100 X-ray generator, and may need to be installed to add certain options, or may need to be replaced if it is desired to alter the current configuration of the generator. To install or replace the software key follow the procedure below. 1. With the generator mains power switched OFF, locate the socket for the “software key”, U29, on the generator CPU board. Refer to figure 6-3. 2. Remove the existing I.C. U29, if fitted. The original I.C. should be placed in anti-static packaging, and may be set aside for future use in a generator that requires the options that are activated by that I.C. 3. Carefully insert the replacement “software key” into the U29 socket observing the orientation per figure 6-3. 4. Perform setup and calibration, if required, of the new features that have been activated by the new software key. Refer to the applicable sections of the service manual. GENERATOR CPU BOARD U29 EPROM U41 FILE: ML_CPU2.CDR Figure 6-3: Software key location and orientation Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-10 Rev. L Page 6-9 6 Regular Maintenance 6.8.0 CPI Canada Inc BATTERY REPLACEMENT To replace the battery on the console CPU board or on the generator CPU board, follow the procedure below. Refer to the figure showing the location of these batteries in chapter 2, in the section “CHECKING THE RAM BACKUP BATTERY VOLTAGE”. Refer to that section in chapter 2 for console disassembly instructions to gain access to the console CPU board if required. THE CONSOLE BATTERY SHOULD BE REPLACED WITH THE GENERATOR POWERED UP. THIS WILL PREVENT THE CONSOLE DATA FROM BEING LOST WHEN THE BATTERIES ARE REMOVED. NOTE: THIS IS THE ONLY EXCEPTION TO THE RULE OF NOT SERVICING THE GENERATOR WHILE THE POWER IS ON. FAMILIARIZE YOURSELF WITH THE HIGH VOLTAGE LOCATIONS AND HAZARDS BEFORE REPLACING THIS BATTERY. 6.9.0 1. Remove the battery from the holder by gently prying under the battery at the access slot in the battery holder using a small screwdriver. Slide the battery over the edge of the holder and remove it when it is free. 2. Check the voltage of the new battery prior to inserting it. This should be nominally 3.0V, do not use if it is under 2.80 V. 3. Wipe the replacement battery with a clean cloth, and ensure that the holder is clean and free of debris before inserting the battery. 4. Gently lift the spring contact on the holder and insert the replacement battery positive (+) side up TUBE CONDITIONING / SEASONING Tube conditioning or “seasoning” is particularly important for new tubes or tubes that have not been used for several days. This should be performed on each X-ray tube before attempting auto calibration, as an unseasoned tube may not operate properly at higher kV values without arcing. Refer to the X-ray tube manufacturer’s instructions, if available, for the tube conditioning or “seasoning” procedure. If the X-ray tube manufacturers instructions are not available, the following procedure may be used: 6.9.1 Tube Conditioning (Overview) The generator does X-ray tube auto calibration at 50 kV, 60 kV, 70 kV, 80 kV, 100 kV and 120 kV. The tube normally needs to be seasoned before it can be operated at the higher voltages encountered during auto calibration. Tube seasoning is started by auto calibrating the kV stations up to and including part of the 70 kV station. The tube is then seasoned at 70 kV. Progressively higher kV stations are then auto calibrated and seasoned. Finally the entire kV and mA range is auto calibrated, then the tube is seasoned at the remaining high kV values. Manually releasing the exposure button during auto calibration of a particular kV station in the following procedure prevents the generator from attempting operation beyond that kV/mA value. NOTE: Page 6-10 THE TUBE MANUFACTURER’S RECOMMENDED SEASONING PROCEDURE, IF AVAILABLE, MUST ALWAYS BE USED IN PLACE OF THE FOLLOWING PROCEDURE. Rev. L Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-10 CPI Canada Inc 6.9.1 Regular Maintenance 6 Tube Conditioning (Overview) Cont NOTE: LOW SPEED ONLY EXPOSURES ARE RECOMMENDED FOR THE SEASONING EXPOSURES, TO PREVENT EXCESSIVE HEAT BUILD-UP IN THE HOUSING FROM THE STATOR WINDINGS OR THE ROTOR BEARINGS. X-ray tubes that have not been used for more than 8 hours may suffer thermal shock if operated at high mA and kV without a warm-up procedure. A cold anode (Molybdenum) is very brittle and when suddenly heated over a small area may experience thermal cracking of the anode surface, eventually leading to permanent tube damage. 6.9.2 Tube Conditioning (Procedure) X-ray tube seasoning should be done on LARGE focus in order to minimize tube wear. The procedure below is intended for seasoning an X-ray tube prior to attempting tube auto calibration. To season a tube that does not need to be calibrated, simply follow steps 2, 4, 6, 8, and 9. 1. Start the tube auto calibration sequence, and manually terminate the exposure at 70 kV and 250 mA. 2. Season the tube at 70 kV by taking approximately 10 exposures of 200 mA and 100 ms. These exposures should be taken at the rate of approximately one every 15 seconds. 3. Restart the auto calibration sequence and manually terminate the exposure at 100 kV and 250 mA. 4. Season the tube at 100 kV by taking approximately 5 exposures of 200 mA and 100 ms. These exposures should be taken at the rate of approximately one every 15 seconds. 5. Restart the auto calibration sequence and manually terminate the exposure at 120 kV and 160 mA. 6. Season the tube at 120 kV by taking approximately 5 exposures of 160 mA and 100 ms. These exposures should be taken at the rate of approximately one every 15 seconds. 7. Restart the auto calibration sequence and allow the auto calibration sequence to complete. 8. Season the tube at 130 kV by taking approximately 5 exposures of 100 mA and 50 ms. These exposures should be taken at the rate of approximately one every 15 seconds. 9. Repeat step 8 at 140 kV, and then at 145 kV. Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-10 Rev. L Page 6-11 6 Regular Maintenance CPI Canada Inc 6.10.0 END OF PRODUCT LIFE If the generator has completed its useful service life, local environmental regulations must be complied with in regard to disposal of possible hazardous materials used in the construction of the generator. In order to assist with this determination, the noteworthy materials used in the construction of this generator are itemized below: ITEM • Electrical insulating oil in HT tank. This is a mineral oil with trace additives (60 Litre (17 U.S. gal) for Millenia, 25 Litre (6.5 U.S. gal) for Indico 100). • Solder (lead/tin). • Epoxy fiberglass circuit board materials, tracks are solder on copper. • Wire, tinned copper. Insulated with PVC, tefzel, or silicone. • Steel and / or aluminum (generator cabinet and console chassis). • Plastic (console enclosure and console membrane). • Electrical and electronic components: IC’s, transistors, diodes, resistors, capacitors, etc. WARNING: DO NOT DISASSEMBLE, INCINERATE, OR SHORT-CIRCUIT THE BATTERY(S) IN THIS PRODUCT. DO NOT PUT IT IN TRASH THAT IS DISPOSED OF IN LANDFILLS; DISPOSE OF IT AS REQUIRED BY LOCAL ORDINANCES. THE FLUORESCENT LAMP IN THE LCD DISPLAY CONTAINS MERCURY. DO NOT PUT IT IN TRASH THAT IS DISPOSED OF IN LANDFILLS; DISPOSE OF IT AS REQUIRED BY LOCAL ORDINANCES. THE LCD IS MADE OF GLASS. IF THE LCD BREAKS DUE TO ROUGH HANDLING OR DROPPING, AND THE INTERNAL FLUID GETS IN YOUR EYES OR ON YOUR HANDS, IMMEDIATELY WASH THE AFFECTED AREAS WITH WATER FOR AT LEAST 15 MINUTES. SEEK MEDICAL ATTENTION IF ANY SYMPTOMS ARE PRESENT AFTER WASHING. Page 6-12 Rev. L Millenia / Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740904-10 CPI Canada Inc Theory of Operation 7 CHAPTER 7 THEORY OF OPERATION CONTENTS: 7.1.0 INTRODUCTION .......................................................................................................................................... 7-2 7.2.0 FUNCTIONAL THEORY OF OPERATION................................................................................................... 7-2 7.2.1 System ON (MD-0762).............................................................................................................................. 7-2 7.2.2 DC bus & power distribution (MD-0788) ................................................................................................... 7-3 7.2.3 Room interface (MD-0763)........................................................................................................................ 7-6 7.2.4 X-ray exposure Rad / fluoro (MD-0761) .................................................................................................... 7-8 7.2.5 kV control and feedback (MD-0759) ....................................................................................................... 7-10 7.2.6 Filament drive and mA control (MD-0760) .............................................................................................. 7-11 7.2.7 Low speed starter (MD-0764) ................................................................................................................. 7-14 7.2.8 Dual speed starter (MD-0765)................................................................................................................. 7-15 7.2.8 Dual speed starter (Cont) ........................................................................................................................ 7-16 7.2.9 Rad / fluoro and power mode select (MD-0786) ..................................................................................... 7-16 7.2.10 Interlocks & tube 1 / tube 2 tellback (MD-0787).................................................................................... 7-16 7.2.11 AEC (MD-0757)..................................................................................................................................... 7-17 7.2.12 ABS (MD-0758) ..................................................................................................................................... 7-20 7.2.13 Remote fluoro control (MD-0766).......................................................................................................... 7-21 7.2.14 Digital interface (MD-0767) ................................................................................................................... 7-21 7.2.15 DAP (MD-0828)..................................................................................................................................... 7-25 7.2.16 Serial communications (MD-0829)........................................................................................................ 7-25 Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-06 Rev. L Page 7-1 7 Theory of Operation 7.1.0 CPI Canada Inc INTRODUCTION This chapter contains the theory of operation for the Indico 100 series of X-ray generators. The theory of operation is organized by functional blocks as depicted in the functional drawings in chapter 9. 7.2.0 FUNCTIONAL THEORY OF OPERATION Refer to the appropriate functional block diagram in chapter 9 in conjunction with the theory of operation in this chapter. Waveforms and voltages at the pertinent test points are shown on the last page of each functional drawing. 7.2.1 System ON (MD-0762) The left side of this drawing shows the wiring from the ON and OFF switches on the console “keyboard assemblies” to J4-10, J4-11 and J4-12 on the generator interface board for the various Indico 100 consoles (J16-3, J16-6, J16-7 for the Rad-only console). The generator interface board on the Indico 100 X-ray generator includes power ON and OFF switches S2 and S1 that may be used to switch the generator on and off locally while working on the equipment. These switches are connected in parallel with the main generator power ON and OFF switches that are located on the console. Pressing either of the power ON switches described above turns on Q2 on the generator interface board. This turns on Q3, holding the collector of Q3 low. This latches Q2 on by holding the base of Q2 low when the ON button is released. The collector of Q3 is connected to K2 and K3 via D16. These relays will energize if S3 is in the NORMAL position when the generator is switched on. If S3 is in the LOCKOUT position, the generator cannot be inadvertently switched on. When K2 and K3 are energized, the DC rails (+5 V, +12 V, +15 V, +24 V, -12 V, -15 V, and -24 V) on the generator interface board are established, and +24 V is supplied to the console via K3 (see MD-0788, sheet 4). The generator CPU will issue a P/S ON (power supply ON) command after the +5 V rail is detected as described in 7.2.2. JW1 on the generator interface board may be jumpered such that K1 is energized only when the generator is switched on, or such that K1 is energized at all times that the AC mains to the generator is on. K1 switches the 110 and 220 VAC supplies for the room interface board, as shown on sheet 4 of MD0788. Pressing either of the OFF switches turns on Q1 on the generator interface board. This turns off Q2, turning off Q3. This will de-energize K2, K3, and / or K1 on the generator interface board, removing the DC rails from the generator interface board and removing the +24 V supply from the console. Deenergizing K1 (if applicable) will disconnect the 110 / 220 VAC supplies to the room interface board. In normal operation, J17-1 and J17-2 are joined via a wire jumper. An emergency-off switch may be connected to the generator by removing the jumper between J17-1 and J17-2, and then wiring the emergency-off switch to J17-1 and J17-2. Page 7-2 Rev. L Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-06 CPI Canada Inc 7.2.2 Theory of Operation 7 DC bus & power distribution (MD-0788) Refer to MD-0788, sheet 1: Sheet 1 of MD-0788 applies to three phase units. Portions of sheet 1 are common to single phase and three phase units. Sheet 2 details the circuits that are different between single and three phase generators. Assuming that the AC mains is connected and switched on, line voltage is applied to the primary of room interface transformer T2 via F1 and F2. This will establish the 24 VDC supply via F5 and D3 on the generator interface board, as shown on sheet 4. Several seconds after the generator has been switched on as per 7.2.1, the generator CPU will issue a P/S ON (power supply ON) command, resulting in 24 VDC being applied to J5-3 and J5-4 on the auxiliary board as described under MD-0788, sheet 3. This will energize K1 and K2 on the power input board via relay K1 on the auxiliary board (K1 is shown in the normal, i.e. no soft-start fault position). With K2 on the power input board energized, line voltage is applied to power supply auxiliary transformer T1. The primary of T1, an autotransformer, supplies 120 VAC for the fans and for the tube 1 / tube 2 solenoid in the HT tank, 120 or 240 VAC for rotor boost, and 52 / 73 / 94 VAC for rotor-run as described later in this section. The secondary of T1 supplies low voltage AC to the auxiliary board as per sheet 3. When K1 on the power input board is energized, line voltage is applied to the input of D1 via soft-start current limit resistors R10 and R11, thus pre-charging the DC bus capacitors. Normal charging of the DC bus is sensed by U1 via R5 to R8, D3, R18 / R19 and R16 / R17. The emitter of U1 will rise toward +6 V as the DC bus charges. The emitter is connected to the soft-start protection circuit on the auxiliary board. If the DC bus capacitors charge normally, K1 on the auxiliary board will remain de-energized, D3 will be lit, and the soft start driver circuit (U3B, Q6, etc) will issue a contactor-closed signal after approximately 20 seconds. This will light D2 on the auxiliary board, output a logic low signal to the CPU via J5-7 of the auxiliary board to indicate that the main contactor is closed, and close the main power contactor K5 on the power input board. The line voltage will then be directly rectified by D1 to produce approximately 560 VDC for 400 V units, or approximately 670 VDC for 480 V units. This DC bus voltage is switched by the inverter board(s) to produce the drive for the primary of the HT transformers as described in 7.2.5. If U1 on the power input board does not indicate normal bus charging, the soft start protection circuit will energize K1 on the auxiliary board. This will open K1 on the power input board, but leave K2 energized via R1 / R2. De-energizing K1 on the power input board opens the soft-start charging path via R10 and R11. With K1 on the auxiliary board energized, Q6 on the auxiliary board cannot turn on. This keeps K5 on the power input board de-energized, and holds J5-7 of the auxiliary board high to indicate to the generator CPU that the main contactor is open. For R&F generators, a logic circuit (U11, Q9, etc) on the auxiliary board controls the cooling fans in the generator. During fluoroscopic operation, and for approximately 20 minutes after switching from fluoro to Rad operation, the output of the fluoro fan timer / driver circuit will be low, lighting D37 on the auxiliary board and energizing K4 on the power input board. This will supply 120 VAC to the cooling fans from T1 via F4 and K4 on the power input board. When tube 2 is selected (two tube units only), J1-6 on the auxiliary board is pulled low via the control board. This will close K3 on the power input board, supplying 120 VAC to energize the tube 1 / tube 2 solenoid in the HT tank. The tube 1 / tube 2 select signal is also taken to J2-9 on the low speed starter board as described in 7.2.7. When the generator is switched off, the loss of the DC rails on the generator interface board (which supplies the generator CPU board) will remove the drive for K1 and K2 on the power input board, causing these relays to open. Line voltage will then be removed from the power supply auxiliary transformer T1, causing loss of the DC rails on the auxiliary board. When the 12 V rail has collapsed, U2 on the power input board will turn off. This allows the DC bus discharge circuit to be biased on by R20, rapidly discharging the DC bus capacitors through R16 / R17 and R18 / R19. Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-06 Rev. L Page 7-3 7 Theory of Operation 7.2.2 CPI Canada Inc DC bus & power distribution (Cont) Depending on the tap settings on T1, the low speed starter boost voltage will be 120 or 240 VAC, and the run-voltage will be 52, 73, or 94 VAC. Refer to chapter 2 of the service manual for the procedure for setting these taps. Refer to MD-0788, sheet 2: Sheet 2 of MD-0788 applies to single-phase units. The circuits that are common to single phase and three phase units are described on sheet 1. Assuming that the AC mains is connected and switched on, line voltage is applied to the primary of room interface transformer T2 via F1 and F2. This will establish the 24 VDC supply via F5 and D3 on the generator interface board, as shown on sheet 4. Several seconds after the generator has been switched on as per 7.2.1, the generator CPU will issue a generator-ON command, resulting in 24 VDC being applied to J5-3 and J5-4 on the auxiliary board as described under MD-0788, sheet 3. This will energize K1 and K2 on the power input board. With K2 on the power input board energized, line voltage is applied to power supply auxiliary transformer T1. The primary of T1, an autotransformer, supplies 120 VAC for the fans and for the tube 1 / tube 2 solenoid in the HT tank, 120 or 240 VAC for rotor boost, and 52 / 73 / 94 VAC for rotor-run as described later in this section. The secondary of T1 supplies low voltage AC to the auxiliary board as per sheet 3. When K1 on the power input board energizes, line voltage is applied to the voltage doubler circuit via soft-start current limit resistors R10 and R11, thus pre-charging the DC bus capacitors. Normal charging of the DC bus is sensed by U1 via R6 to R8, R16 to R21, D3, etc. D2 will light to indicate that U1 is energized (indicating that the DC bus is charged). The emitter of U1 will rise toward +6 V as the DC bus charges. The emitter is connected to the soft-start protection circuit on the auxiliary board, and is described on sheet 1. If the DC bus capacitors charge normally, the main contactor K5 on the power input board will close, applying the line voltage directly to the voltage doubler circuit where it is rectified and doubled to produce approximately 650 VDC. This DC bus voltage is switched by the inverter board(s) to produce the drive for the primary of the HT transformers as described in 7.2.5. If U1 on the power input board does not indicate normal bus charging, the soft start protection circuit will energize K1 on the auxiliary board, and K5 will remain de-energized as described previously The operation of the cooling fans via K4 on the power input board and the operation of the tube 1 / tube 2 solenoid via K3 is described on the previous page. The power down sequence is similar to that described on the previous page, except that single phase units do not have a rapid discharge circuit. The DC bus capacitors will discharge through bleeder resistors connected across the bus capacitors, with a time constant ≤ 5 minutes. Depending on the tap settings on T1, the low speed starter boost voltage will be 120 or 240 VAC, and the run-voltage will be 52, 73, or 94 VAC. Refer to chapter 2 of the service manual for the procedure for setting these taps. Page 7-4 Rev. L Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-06 CPI Canada Inc 7.2.2 Theory of Operation 7 DC bus & power distribution (Cont) Refer to MD-0788, sheet 3: Line voltage is connected to the primary of power supply auxiliary transformer T1 when the generator is switched ON, i.e. when K2 on the power input board is energized. The DC rails on the auxiliary board will then be established (+/- 35 V via F3, F4 and D32, and +/- 12 V via F1, F2, D33, U5 and U6 which are connected in parallel, and U4). The required DC rails are then distributed to the filament supply board(s) and to the control and dual speed starter boards as shown on sheet 3. Regulators on the control board and dual speed starter board supply +5 V for those boards as shown. When the main contactor K5 on the power input board closes, J5-7 of the auxiliary board is taken low. This logic low signal is taken to the control board, where it enables the prep signal to the dual speed starter board as described in 7.2.8, and also turns on Q16 on the control board, turning on opto-coupler U9 on the generator CPU board. The output of U9, which indicates the contactor-closed status, is monitored by the CPU via U24. U9 also drives contactor-closed status LEDs DS9 / DS10, where DS9 lights to indicate that the contactor is closed. When the +5 V rail on the generator interface board is established, the generator CPU will start to function. The CPU will perform its start-up diagnostics, and then output data (bit 0) via U27, U19, and U16 to energize opto coupler U17 on the generator CPU board. This will turn on Q4, applying ±15 V to J5-3 and J5-4 on the auxiliary board via current limit resistors R27 / R32 and the control board, resulting in approximately 24 VDC to close K1 and K2 on the power input board, as described earlier. DS34 / DS35 indicate the P/S ON status, where DS34 lights to indicate that the power supply is on. The tube 1 / tube 2 select signal (bit 2) is generated by the CPU, then latched and buffered by U27 and U19 on the generator CPU board. The tube 1 / tube 2 select signal is then applied to U16 and to the tube 1 / tube 2 tellback logic circuit as per 7.2.10. The output of U16 drives U7 on the control board, which inturn drives Q1. Q1 turns on when tube 2 is selected, pulling J1-6 on the auxiliary board low. This energizes K3 on the power input board as described earlier. The tube 1 / tube 2 select signal is also fed to the dual speed starter as described in 7.2.8. For continuous fluoro mode, the CPU sends data (bit 7) to data latch U27 on the generator CPU board. This is then applied to driver U16, and to DS22 / DS23 which indicate continuous fluoro (FLUORO) or Rad / pulsed fluoro (FLUORO bar) operation. The output of U16 drives opto coupler U40 on the control board, which pulls J1-5 on the auxiliary board high for Rad / pulsed fluoro operation and low for continuous fluoro operation. This high / low signal is applied to the fluoro fan timer / driver circuit (sheet 1), and to the Rad / fluoro and power mode select circuits as described in 7.2.9. When pulsed fluoro or low power Rad operation is selected, the CPU sends data (bit 3) to data latch U49. The data latch drives Q1 and DS2 / DS4 on the generator CPU board. DS2 lights to indicate low power / pulsed fluoro operation, while DS4 indicates high power Rad operation. Q1 on the generator CPU board drives opto coupler U41 on the control board, which pulls J1-3 on the auxiliary board high for PF / low power operation, and low for high power Rad mode. This signal is then applied to the fluoro fan timer / driver circuit (sheet 1), and to the Rad / fluoro and power mode select circuits as described in 7.2.9. U3C and U3D on the auxiliary board monitor the + and -12 V supplies on that board. The outputs of U3C and U3D will switch low if either of these supplies drops below predefined limits, lighting DS1 and sending a fault signal to the control board and to the driver for K1 on the low speed starter board. A soft-start fault signal is generated if the DC bus capacitors do not charge normally (SOFT START FAULT SIGNAL from the soft start driver circuit on page 1). This signal is fed to U3A on the auxiliary board, whose output will switch low if a soft-start fault exists. This is OR’ed together with the outputs of U3C and U3D, and has the same effect as described above for a +/-12 V fault. Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-06 Rev. L Page 7-5 7 Theory of Operation 7.2.2 CPI Canada Inc DC bus & power distribution (Cont) Refer to MD-0788, sheet 4: Line voltage is connected to the primary of room interface transformer T2 whenever the AC mains is connected and switched on. With the generator switched on, K2 on the generator interface board will close, establishing the DC rails on the generator interface board via F3 / F4 and D1 (+/- 24 V, + 15 V via U5, +5 V via F6 and the +5 V / +16 V power supply circuit, + 12 V via U3, -12 V via U2, and -15 V via U4). The required DC rails are then distributed to the digital I/O board, to the AEC board, to the room interface board, and to the generator CPU board, where DS33 and DS36-DS39 indicate the presence of the associated DC rails. The 24 VDC supply that is derived from D3 / C10 is used by the on / off circuit on the generator interface board (MD-0762), and is also fed to the console when the on / off circuit closes K3. Power supplies and / or voltage regulators on the console produce the required DC rails for the console circuits. Additionally, the console includes a 300 VAC power supply that drives the cold-cathode fluorescent lamp that backlights the LCD display. 110 and 220 VAC is supplied to the room interface board. The 110 / 220 VAC supplies are only present when K1 on the generator interface board is closed. K1 may be configured to be closed at all times that AC mains is supplied to the generator, or K1 may be configured to close only when the generator is switched on. Refer to 7.2.1, SYSTEM ON, for details. 24 VDC is available at J17-3 and J17-4 to drive the coil of a power distribution relay in installations with installer supplied power distribution circuits. The maximum current available from this source is 100 mA. Refer to MD-0788, sheet 5: Sheet 5 shows the power distribution (DC rails) to the remote fluoro control, and to the Indico 100 consoles other than those shown on page 4. 7.2.3 Room interface (MD-0763) Refer to MD-0763, sheet 1: Sheet 1 shows the room interface inputs. These are shown on the left side of the drawing. Nine of the inputs energize opto couplers via 4-pin jumpers; the remaining inputs energize the associated opto coupler directly. The inputs that have a connector (JW7, JW10, JW15, etc) in series with the opto coupler(s) may be configured such that shorting the input turns on the opto coupler, or may be configured such that applying 24 VDC across the input energizes the opto coupler. The remaining inputs are only active when the inputs are shorted. For inputs with a 4-pin jumper in series with the opto coupler, the jumper must be across pins 2 and 3 of the connector if the input is a 24 VDC source. If using this configuration, observe the polarity of the 24 VDC source to ensure that the opto coupler is correctly driven. Jumper across pins 1 and 2 and pins 3 and 4 of the connector if it is desired to activate the opto coupler by shorting across that input. For the REMOTE FLUORO EXPOSURE input and the REMOTE EXPOSURE input, two or three opto couplers are connected in series. MD-0763 shows the opto coupler relevant to the room interface function. The second and / or third opto coupler is shown on MD-0761 and described in 7.2.4. One set of thermal switch inputs is available on the room interface board as shown. A second set of thermal switch inputs is available on the stator terminal block. The thermal switch inputs on the stator terminal block are routed to T1 and T2 (at R33 and R34 respectively) on the generator interface board. The generator CPU monitors the output of each opto coupler via logic circuits on the generator interface board. Page 7-6 Rev. L Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-06 CPI Canada Inc 7.2.3 Theory of Operation 7 Room interface (Cont) Refer to MD-0763, sheet 2: Sheet 2 shows the room interface outputs. These are shown on the right side of the drawing. Five of the outputs may be configured to supply +24 VDC, 110 VAC, or 220 VAC or to provide a dry contact closure when the output is active. Three of the outputs may be configured to supply +24 VDC or to provide a dry contact closure when the output is active, and the remaining three outputs are permanently configured to provide a dry contact closure when the output is active. When any of the outputs on the room interface board are to be made active, the generator CPU will send data to address decoders, latches, and driver circuits on the generator interface board. These circuits decode the data, and drive relays K1 to K13 on the room interface board. The contacts of each of these relays drive the room interface outputs. JW1 to JW5 may be configured such that the corresponding output is a dry relay contact by placing the jumper in the DRY position. Placing the jumper in the LIVE position will cause +24 VDC, 110 VAC, or 220 VAC to be output, depending on the voltage source selected at TB11. To select the desired voltage source, a wire jumper must be connected from TB11 pins 1-5 to TB10 to select 220 VAC, to TB9 to select 110 VAC, or to TB8 to select 24 VDC. For example, if it is intended that the TOMO / BUCKY 4 SELECT output should provide 110 VAC when that output is active, JW1 must be jumpered in the LIVE position and a wire jumper must be connected from TB11-4 to one of the available positions on TB9. With JW1 to JW5 in the LIVE position, relays K1 - K4 and K6 switch the return side of the circuit. If multiple switched voltage outputs are required, jumper the desired voltage to TB11, select the DRY position on JW1 to JW5, connect the switched output to the relay output (example TB1-1 for JW1), and connect the common return directly to TB7. Relays K1 to K4 and K6 have R-C snubbers connected across the contacts to quench contact arcing when the relay opens while driving inductive loads. If the output is configured to supply 110 or 220 VAC, and the load is an opto coupler or other low-current device, sufficient AC current may flow through the snubber to energize the load when the relay is open. If this is the case, the jumper that is in series with the snubber may need to be removed. Further details on this may be found in chapter 3B. JW6 to JW8 may be configured such that the corresponding output is a dry relay contact by placing the jumper in the DRY position. Placing the jumper in the LIVE 24 VDC position will cause +24 VDC to be output. The remaining outputs (collimator bypass, room light, and mag 1 to mag 3) are permanently configured to provide dry contact closures when the output is active. Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-06 Rev. L Page 7-7 7 Theory of Operation 7.2.4 CPI Canada Inc X-ray exposure Rad / fluoro (MD-0761) Refer to MD-0761, sheet 1: The keyboard assembly and console board shown on sheet 1 is used on the 31 X 42 cm console. The console portion of these circuits for the other Indico 100 console types is shown on sheet 3 and 4. Pressing PREP pulls J4-7 on the generator interface board low via U25 on the console board. This turns on U15 on the generator interface board. The generator CPU monitors the output of U15 via U18 and U25, with a valid prep command being recognized when the output of U15 is low. Pressing X-ray will pull J4-8 on the generator interface board low via U26 on the console board. This will turn on U37 and U38 on the generator interface board. The generator CPU monitors the output of U37 via U18 and U25. The software will recognize a logic low at the output of U37 as a hardware X-ray request (X-ray switch pressed), and consequently will pull the emitter of U38 low via U25, U12, and U7. With the emitter of U38 held low and U38 energized, the collector of U38 will be held low. This energizes U22 on the generator interface board, turning on U46 on the generator CPU board. The generator CPU monitors the output of U46, recognizing a valid X-ray request when the output of U46 is low. DS42 on the generator CPU board will light to indicate that an X-ray request is being made. An input via the REMOTE TOMO SELECT input will energize U8 and U10 on the generator interface board (refer also to 7.2.3). The generator CPU monitors the output of U10 via U18 and U25, and recognizes a logic low at the output of U10 as a remote tomo X-ray request. When a remote tomo exposure request is received, the CPU will pull the emitter of U8 low via U25, U12, and U7. With the emitter of U8 held low and U8 energized, the collector of U8 will be held low. This turns on U22 and U46 as described above, indicating to the CPU that a valid remote tomo request is being made. A remote X-ray exposure request via the REMOTE EXPOSURE input will energize U41and U43 on the generator interface board (refer also to 7.2.3). The generator CPU monitors the output of U41 via U18 and U25, and recognizes a logic low at the output of U41 as a remote exposure request. When a remote exposure request is received, the CPU will pull the emitter of U43 low via U25, U12, and U7. With the emitter of U43 held low and U43 energized, the collector of U43 will be held low. This turns on U22 and U46 as described above, indicating to the CPU that a valid X-ray request is being made. Pressing the fluoro foot switch (if connected to the console) will pull J4-6 on the generator interface board low via U24 on the console board. This will turn on U30, U42, and U44 on the generator interface board. These same opto couplers will be energized if the fluoro foot switch is connected to the room interface board (refer to 7.2.3), and the fluoro foot switch is pressed. The generator CPU monitors the output of U30 via U18 and U25. The software will recognize a logic low at the output of U30 as a fluoroscopic X-ray request, and consequently will pull the emitter of U42 low via U25, U12, and U7. With the emitter of U42 held low and U42 energized, the collector of U42 will be held low. This turns on U22 and U46 as described above, indicating to the CPU that a valid X-ray request is being made. The generator interface board contains a last image hold circuit consisting of U44, U32, U39, C30, etc. The last image hold circuit will keep U32 energized for approximately 100 milliseconds after the fluoro foot switch has been released. The emitter of U32 will be held low by the generator CPU for the time of the “last image hold” setting (up to 99 ms) in the receptor setup menu (chapter 3C). This will hold the collector of U32 low, keeping U22 and U46 energized as previously described, and allowing the frame store device to complete the last image. The console CPU (U18) monitors the output of U24, U25, and U26 on the console board, recognizing a console fluoroscopic X-ray request when the output of U24 is low, a prep request when the output of U25 is low, and a console X-ray request when the output of U26 is low. Page 7-8 Rev. L Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-06 CPI Canada Inc 7.2.4 Theory of Operation 7 X-ray exposure Rad / fluoro (Cont) Refer to MD-0761, sheet 2: When a prep request has been made as described on page 1, the CPU will write data to the kV enable and prep latches within U27 on the generator CPU board. The kV enable and prep commands light DS30 and DS27 on the generator CPU board when active, and drive U4 and U2 respectively on the control board via U19 and U16 on the generator CPU board. The emitter of U4 on the control board is held low when the HT tank is properly connected. If the output of U4 is high (HT tank not connected, or kV enable command not present), the ENABLE line (TP10) will be held low by the comparator circuit consisting of U11A, RN8, etc. This will hold the output of the “PREP ENABLED” and “X-RAY REQUEST” comparator circuits low via D21 and D24, inhibiting the prep and Xray functions. If the kV ENABLE command is present, the output of U4 will be low, and the kV enable line (TP10) will be high. This will reverse bias D21 and D24, allowing the PREP and X-RAY lines to be pulled high when requested. The RESET command resets kV and mA faults that are latched by circuits on the control board. Pressing the MENU / RESET button on the console toggles the kV enabled circuit, resetting the fault latches. The output of U2 on the control board will be low when PREP is active, causing the prep line (TP18) to be pulled high by the comparator circuit consisting of U11B, U10C, etc. The prep command is taken to the “GENERATOR READY” detector circuit and the logic “OR / NOR” circuits via D25. If the prep command is present, and no faults exist, the base of Q12 will be pulled low, turning on Q12, thus indicating a generator-ready condition. The prep command also initiates the boost cycle on the low speed or dual speed starter (refer to 7.2.7 and 7.2.8). When the generator CPU has received a valid X-ray request, the CPU will send an X-ray command to data latch U27 on the generator CPU board. This will light DS26 on the generator CPU board, and will pull the anodes of U5 and U3 on the control board high. The cathodes of U5 and U3 are held low by the EXPOSURE ENABLE command from U22 (the line connected to the cathode of U46 on the generator CPU board, page 1) during an X-ray request. Therefore, opto couplers U5 and U3 will only be energized if both the hardware and software X-ray commands are present. Because these opto couplers and the comparator circuits (U11D, RN7, U10D, etc) are connected in parallel, both opto couplers must be turned on for TP12 to be pulled high. The X-ray request line is taken to the “OR / NOR” circuits consisting of Q4, Q13, D91, etc. If the prep request is present, and no faults exist at the time of the X-ray request, the line at TP14 will be pulled high. This enables the output of the VCO as described in 7.2.5. The “GENERATOR READY” detector and the logic “OR / NOR” circuits are shown as a functional block with six inputs as shown (PREP input, X-RAY input, and four fault inputs), and three outputs (GENERATOR READY, DRIVE ENABLE, and HV / MA FAULT). The generator-ready and drive enable signals are inhibited if any of the fault inputs are active (+/- 12V/SS FAULT, FILAMENT FAULT, STATOR FAULT, HIGH KV / INVERTER FAULT, or HIGH MA FAULT). This will disable the inverter drive, preventing any kV output. Refer to MD-0761, sheet 3: Opto coupler U6 on the generator CPU board will be turned on when the power supply ready signal that originates on page 2 is present. The generator CPU monitors the output of U6 via U24, and DS17 on the generator CPU board will light to indicate the generator-ready status. For the Rad-only console, pressing PREP and X-RAY energizes U9 and U10 respectively. The inputs to the generator interface board at J16-4 and J16-5 are pulled low via the LED portion of U9 / U10 and the closed prep or X-ray exposure switch. For the 23 X 56 cm console, the operation is similar to that for the 31 X 42 cm console as described on sheet 1, except that the component reference designations are different. Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-06 Rev. L Page 7-9 7 Theory of Operation 7.2.4 CPI Canada Inc X-ray exposure Rad / fluoro (Cont) Refer to MD-0761, sheet 4: Sheet 4 shows the console prep and X-ray exposure circuits for the touch screen console. Pressing prep or X-ray on the console directly pulls J4-7 and J4-8 on the generator interface board low, initiating the appropriate action in the generator as described earlier. 7.2.5 kV control and feedback (MD-0759) Refer to MD-0759, sheet 1: When the CPU is satisfied that all requirements have been met to allow an X-ray exposure as described in 7.2.4, the kV reference voltage will be produced by D/A converter U22 on the generator CPU board. This is buffered by U14A, inverted by U13A on the control board, and then summed with the positive going kV feedback signal from U16B at the input of error amplifier U13B. Error amplifier U13B will regulate the kV by producing a DC output that is proportional to the difference between the kV reference voltage and the kV feedback voltage. The HT primary current is sampled by T1, and rectified by D27 to D30 to produce a current limit signal (a negative voltage proportional to the primary current). This is applied to the input of U21A, where it will limit the kV demand if the primary current exceeds normal limits. This current limit signal is also fed to comparator U15, which generates a fault pulse if excessive primary current is sensed. The fault pulse is detected by latch U32D and inverted by U33D. A primary (resonant) over current fault will light D70 and pull the input of U33E low via D66. This will force the output of U33E high. The output of U33E is one of the inputs to the “GENERATOR READY” detector and logic “OR / NOR” circuits described in 7.2.4. The presence of a fault will immediately remove the generator-ready and drive enable signals, inhibiting the inverter gate drive, thus preventing inverter damage due to the over-current condition. The output of U21A will swing increasingly negative for increased kV demand. This kV demand voltage is buffered and inverted by U21B, and then applied to the VCO (voltage controlled oscillator). The VCO generates complementary output pulses that vary in frequency. The frequency of these pulses is inversely proportional to demanded generator output power. The current sense feedback from T2 synchronizes the start of the pulses. The output pulses from the VCO are applied to AND gates U24A and U24B. The drive enable signal from MD-0761 is applied to the control inputs of U24, holding these inputs high if all logic conditions to allow an X-ray exposure are satisfied. The pulses are inverted and level shifted by U26A and U26B, and then applied to the gate-drive circuit as described on page 2. The differential kV feedback voltage from the HT tank is brought to J9 on the generator control board. This is applied to the inputs of U12A and U12B, where the kV feedback scaling is precisely set by R215. The differential feedback signals are then summed by U16B. The output of U16B supplies a kV feedback signal to error amplifier U13B as described earlier. The kV feedback signal is also fed to the CPU via U16A on the control board, and U15A, U15B, and A/D converter U37 on the generator CPU board where it is used to monitor the output voltage during an exposure. The kV feedback signal is also routed to the high kV detector and latch, which drives D69 and U33E. The output of U33E, when high, will inhibit the inverter gate drive as described previously. The outputs of U14A and U15A on the generator CPU board are summed and compared by the HV ON DETECTOR CIRCUIT, consisting of U30D, Q6, etc. This produces a HV ON signal when the actual kV is greater than approximately 75% of the demanded kV. The HV ON signal is brought to the digital interface board, where it is made available to those digital imaging systems that require this signal to synchronize the exposure. Page 7-10 Rev. L Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-06 CPI Canada Inc 7.2.5 Theory of Operation 7 kV control and feedback (Cont) The generator control board contains circuits that protect against an inverter “shoot-through” fault. If a shoot through fault is sensed, current sense transformers on the inverter board(s) will supply a current pulse that is fed to the control board at J14-1 & J14-3, J15-1 & J15-3, and / or J16-1 & J16-3. An inverter fault is then detected by comparator circuits on the control board, latched, and inverted (a logic low at the outputs of the INVERTER 1, INVERTER 2, or INVERTER 3 FAULT LATCH & LOGIC INVERTER circuits indicates a fault). An inverter fault will light D80, D81, or D82, and will pull the output of the logic OR circuit (D87-D89, U35C) low. This will take the input of U33E low, forcing the output of U33E high, thus inhibiting the inverter gate drive as per high primary current and high kV faults described earlier. The fault latches that drive the input of U33E are reset by the RESET command, which originates on MD0761. Refer to MD-0759, sheet 2: The drive pulses from page 1 are applied to the input of the gate-drive circuit on the control board. The gate-drive circuit utilizes MOSFETs that form a full bridge inverter circuit. This circuit provides current gain for the gate pulses. The high frequency gate pulses are then applied to the power MOSFETS on the inverter board(s) via J10 and / or J11 and / or J12 on the control board. The inverter board(s) produce the high power drive for the HT transformers (Indico 100 X-ray generators use one, two, or three inverter boards, depending on output power). The output of the inverter board(s) drive the primaries of the HT transformers via the resonant capacitor and the fluoro / EMC / sharing inductors. During radiographic operation, contactor K1 shorts out the fluoro inductor. This inductor is in-circuit during fluoroscopy, and optimizes the output tuning during fluoroscopic operation. The drive circuit for K1 is detailed in 7.2.9. For 65, 80, and 100 kW units, the drive to inverter board #3 is disabled by a relay on the power mode select board during low power operation. Refer to 7.2.9 for details. Refer to MD-0759, sheet 3: The HT tank has similar anode and cathode sections. The cathode and anode sections each have their own high voltage transformer and high voltage multiplier board. The anode section generates the anode voltage, 0 to 75 kV, and the cathode section generates the cathode voltage, 0 to -75 kV. The anode and cathode sections contain voltage dividers that supply kV anode and cathode feedback voltages. The kV feedback from the HT tank is brought to J9 on the control board as described earlier in this section. The HT tank is not field-repairable. Defective HT tanks must be exchanged with equivalent units. 7.2.6 Filament drive and mA control (MD-0760) Refer to MD-0760, sheet 1: When the CPU receives a prep request, D/A converter U18 or U22 on the generator CPU board will output the filament reference voltage (1 volt = 1 amp of filament current). For units with two filament supplies, U18 outputs the small filament drive and U22 outputs the large filament drive. For units with a single filament board, U22 supplies the filament drive. The filament drives are buffered by U14D and U14B, and then routed to the filament supply board via J3 and J10 of the generator CPU board. The filament reference voltage is applied to U1B on the filament supply board. The output of U1B is summed with the output of current limit clamp U1A. The filament current limit is set at 5.5 or 6.5 amps via JW1. Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-06 Rev. L Page 7-11 7 Theory of Operation 7.2.6 CPI Canada Inc Filament drive and mA control (Cont) The filament reference voltage may be measured at the cathode of D6 on the filament board (at the output of U1B). Attempting to measure the filament reference at the input to U1B will provide erroneous results. The filament reference voltage is then summed with the filament feedback voltage at the input of error amplifier U4B. When the filament reference is greater than the feedback, the output of U4B rises, causing the pulse width at the output of U3 to increase. The filament supply blocks are shown in very limited detail on sheet 1 of MD-0760. Refer to sheet 3 for a more detailed functional diagram of the filament supply board. PWM (pulse width modulator) U3 drives MOSFETS Q6, Q7, Q12, and Q13, which form a full bridge inverter. The MOSFETS convert the + and - 35 V supplies to high frequency AC to drive the primary of the filament transformers at the filament switching frequency, approximately 40 kHz, via C22, the primary of T1, J4 / J8 / K1, J5 on the filament supply board, and J4 on the tank lid board. The output of filament current sense transformer T1 on the filament supply board is rectified by D12, D13, D27, and D28, and fed to the RMS converter circuit consisting of U7 and associated components. The output of the RMS converter drives U4A, which is a variable gain amplifier. The filament current feedback is calibrated such that 1 volt = 1 amp of filament current. The calibrated filament feedback voltage (representing actual filament current) appears at the input of buffer U2B and at the summing input of error amplifier U4B as previously described. The output of U2B is brought to J2-2 or J2-4 on the filament supply board, depending on configuration. This filament current feedback signal is then fed to the CPU as shown on sheet 2 and 3. The filament feedback signal from the output of U2B is compared with a 1.7 volt reference by U2A. The output of U2A will swing low if the filament current drops below approximately 1.7 amps, indicating a filament fault. This will turn off Q1 on the filament supply board, taking J2-10 on the filament board and J3-10 on the control board high. The FILAMENT FAULT signal is taken to one of the inputs on the “GENERATOR READY” detector and logic “OR / NOR” circuits described in 7.2.4, where a fault will inhibit inverter drive by removing the generator-ready and drive enable signals. A filament fault condition will also turn off Q15 on the control board, turning off opto coupler U7 on the generator CPU board. The output of U7 drives filament fault status LEDs DS13 /DS14 and the input of U24, which is monitored by the generator CPU. The HIGH KV / INVERTER FAULT and the HIGH MA FAULT signals from MD-0759 and MD-0760 respectively are OR’ed together, and designated as the HV / MA FAULT signal. This is fed to the base of Q14 on the control board, and will be high for a fault. During a HV / mA fault, Q14 will be turned off, turning off opto coupler U8 on the generator CPU board. The output of U8 is monitored by the CPU via U24. U8 also drives DS11 / DS12, with DS12 being lit for a HV / mA fault condition. For generators with a single filament board, U27 on the generator CPU board outputs the large / small filament select command. The output of U27 will be low for large focus, lighting DS24. U19 and U16 invert the large / small focus signal and drive U1 on the control board. The output of U1 will be low for large focus, causing the large / small select line, J3-11 on the control board, to be pulled high by the comparator circuit consisting of U11C, Q2 etc. This de-energizes K1 on the filament board, selecting large focus. The logic high signal at J3-11 drives the base of Q3 on the control board, holding Q3 off when large focus is selected. Q3 drives opto coupler U10 on the generator CPU board, turning off U10 for large focus. The output of U10 is monitored by the CPU via U24. Page 7-12 Rev. L Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-06 CPI Canada Inc 7.2.6 Theory of Operation 7 Filament drive and mA control (Cont) Refer to MD-0760, sheet 2: The filament drive from page 1 is applied to the secondaries of the filament transformers, which provide high voltage isolation and drive the X-ray tube filaments via the HV cathode board and the cathode high voltage connector as shown. When an exposure is being made, X-ray tube current flows through series resistors on the HV anode and cathode boards. The voltage developed across these resistors, which is proportional to the X-ray tube current, is taken to J9 of the control board. Transient protectors on the high voltage boards clamp the voltage across the series resistors during high voltage arcs. The “ground” side of the high voltage boards in the HT tank is connected to the mA test jacks E17 / E18 on the tank lid board. Transient protectors on the tank lid board clamp the voltage across the mA measuring device during high voltage arcs, and prevent the voltage at E17 and E18 from rising above approximately 15 volts if the mA test jack shorting strap is removed. The anode mA feedback that appears at J9-1 and J9-2 of the generator control board is scaled approximately 0.4 volts = 100 mA of anode current, and is applied to the input of differential amplifier U6B. The output of U6B is taken to the anode over current detector, whose output is applied to the high anode current latch and inverter circuit. The output of U33C will be low for a high anode current condition. This will light D72 and pull the input of U33E low via D65, forcing the output of U33E high. The output of U33E is one of the inputs to the “GENERATOR READY” detector and logic “OR / NOR” circuits described in 7.2.4. An over current condition will immediately remove the generator-ready and drive enable signals, preventing possible damage due to the over-current condition. The ANODE OVERVOLTAGE signal from MD-0759 is also fed into the anode over current detector circuit. Therefore, an anode over voltage condition will disable the inverter gate drive as described above. The output of U6B is also applied to the input of U9 and U30B. U30B provides a scaled mA feedback voltage, calibrated by R216, such that 1 volt = 100 mA at the output of U30B. The output of U30B is fed to the generator CPU board as shown on sheet 3. U9 is a high gain amplifier, and provides a scaled mA feedback voltage 1 volt = 2.5 mA. R212 calibrates the mA feedback, and R213 provides offset voltage adjustment. The output of U9 is fed to the generator CPU board as shown on sheet 3. The cathode mA feedback at J9-4 and J9-3 of the generator control board is used for cathode overcurrent detection only. The cathode mA feedback is applied to the input of differential amplifier U6A. The output of U6A is taken to the cathode over current detector, whose output is applied to the high cathode current latch and inverter circuit. The output of U33B will be low for a high cathode current condition. This will light D71 and pull the input of U33E low via D64, inhibiting the inverter drive as described above for an anode over voltage fault. The CATHODE OVERVOLTAGE signal from MD-0759 is also fed into the cathode over current detector circuit. Therefore, a cathode over voltage condition will disable the inverter gate drive as described above. The high anode and high cathode current fault latches are reset by the RESET command, which originates on MD-0761. The large and small filament current feedback signals from page 1 are brought to J3 on the control board, and then routed to J2 and J1 on the control board. From there, these signals are taken to the generator CPU board as shown on sheet 3. Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-06 Rev. L Page 7-13 7 Theory of Operation 7.2.6 CPI Canada Inc Filament drive and mA control (Cont) Refer to MD-0760, sheet 3: The large and small filament current feedback signals from page 2 are fed to differential amplifiers U30A and U30B respectively on the generator CPU board. The CPU monitors the outputs of U30A and U30B via A/D converter U37. The Rad mA feedback voltage (1 volt = 100 mA) is applied to U15C on the generator CPU board, and the fluoro mA feedback signal (1 volt = 2.5 mA) is applied to U23A. The outputs of U15C and U23A are fed to A/D converter U37, which supplies the mA feedback values to the CPU. The CPU uses the Rad and fluoro mA feedback information to regulate the X-ray tube mA and to perform mA monitoring functions during exposures. The figure on the right of sheet 3 is an expanded functional schematic of the Indico 100 filament supplies, showing more detail than the figures on page 1. 7.2.7 Low speed starter (MD-0764) Refer to MD-0764, sheet 1: The 120 / 240 VAC and the 52 / 73 / 94 VAC supplies originate on MD-0788. The boost voltage (120 or 240 VAC) and the run-voltage (52, 73, or 94 VAC) is supplied by the power supply auxiliary transformer T1. These voltages must be properly selected via taps on T1 as described in chapter 2 of the service manual. When the CPU receives a prep request, the ENABLE command is generated as described in 7.2.4. This command originates on the control board, and is brought to the cathode of D17 on the auxiliary board. This is OR’ed with the TUBE 1 / TUBE 2 MISMATCH & THERMOSTAT OPEN and 12 VDC / SOFT START FAULT signal in the base circuit of Q15. If all three of these lines are high, i.e. if the ENABLE command is present and no tube 1 / tube 2 mismatch & thermostat open or 12 VDC / soft start faults exist, the base of Q15 will be pulled high, turning on Q15. This will energize K1 on the low speed starter board. K1 is a protection relay that is closed during normal operation, and open-circuits the stator drive if any of the above faults are present. Also when a prep request is made, the PREP command will be applied to the boost and run logic circuit on the auxiliary board. This will pull J4-11 on the control board low, energizing U2 on the low speed starter board, initiating the boost cycle. The boost duration is 1.5 seconds or 2.5 seconds, and is determined by the setting of JW1 on the auxiliary board. At the completion of the boost cycle, the boost and run logic circuit will pull J4-11 high, turning U2 on the low speed starter off. Approximately 100 milliseconds after U2 turns off, J4-12 will be pulled low, turning on U1 on the low speed starter board, initiating the rotor-run cycle. Q2 and Q1 are triacs that are triggered on the zero crossing points of the AC waveform when U2 or U1 is energized. These act as low resistance switches when triggered, with Q2 switching the stator boost voltage, and Q1 switching the stator run-voltage. The output of the triacs is OR’ed together; therefore their common output will carry the boost voltage or run-voltage, depending on which triac is energized. The COMMON line (AC return), connects to the “common” terminal on the stator terminal blocks via K1. The boost / run voltages that are controlled by Q2 and Q1 are brought to protection relay K1, and then applied to the main winding via K3 and K4, and to the shift winding via K2, shift capacitor C3, and K4. K4 switches the main and shift currents to tube 1 or tube 2. The TUBE SELECT signal that drives K4 is described in 7.2.2. K3 and K2 are current sense relays that are energized when the stator current is above preset limits. With K3 and K2 closed, Q3 on the auxiliary board is supplied with base current. This will turn on Q3, turning on Q18 on the control board. Page 7-14 Rev. L Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-06 CPI Canada Inc 7.2.7 Theory of Operation 7 Low speed starter (Cont) The STATOR FAULT line (J6-10) on the control board will be low if there is no stator fault, and high for a fault. This is one of the inputs to the “GENERATOR READY” detector and logic “OR / NOR” circuits described in 7.2.4. A stator fault condition will immediately remove the generator-ready and drive enable signals, inhibiting kV output. When the CPU detects a stator fault condition (via the circuits depicted on sheet 2), the kV enable and prep signals are immediately removed, opening relay K1 on the low speed starter board. Refer to MD-0764, sheet 2: When Q18 on the control board is turned on as described on sheet 1, indicating no stator fault, U5 on the generator CPU board will be turned on. The CPU monitors the output of U5 via U24, and DS20 / DS21 indicate the stator fault status (DS20 indicates no stator fault, and DS21 indicates a stator fault). 7.2.8 Dual speed starter (MD-0765) Refer to MD-0765, sheet 1: The CPU will determine whether the pending exposure should be made at low speed or high-speed operation. Based on this determination, the CPU will output the high speed / low speed command via U27 on the generator CPU board. The output of U27 drives DS8 and DS7 on the generator CPU board, and energizes U12 on the dual speed starter board via U19 and U16. The dual speed starter CPU monitors the output of U12, and sets low or high-speed operation based on the state of U12. The CONTACTOR CLOSED signal that originates on the auxiliary board and closes the main contactor K5, is also brought to the emitter of Q7 on the control board via R94. This signal is low when the contactor is closed, turning on U13 on the dual speed starter board if the prep command is present. The PREP COMMAND is brought to the cathode of D47 on the control board. This is low when prep is not requested, turning on Q7. With Q7 on, the cathode of U13 on the dual speed starter will be held high, keeping U13 off. During prep, the prep command will be high. This turns off Q7, allowing U13 to turn on. The dual speed starter CPU monitors the output of U13, and starts the boost cycle when the output of this opto coupler is low. The TUBE 1 / TUBE 2 select signal from MD-0788 is applied to J4-16 of the control board. This will be low when tube 2 has been selected, energizing U14 on the dual speed starter board. The dual speed starter CPU monitors the output of U14, and selects tube 1 or tube 2 based on the state of U14. K1 on the dual speed starter board will close to select tube 1, and K2 will close to select tube 2, all at the start of prep. K4 is energized only when K1 or K2 is energized, thus isolating the high voltage from the stator terminals at all times except during normal operation of the dual speed starter. The dual speed starter contains an inverter (Q1 to Q4) that produces the required stator current at 50, 60, 150, or 180 Hz by precisely switching the 560 / 650 volt DC bus. The dual speed starter CPU controls the switching of the inverter via the driver circuit consisting of U1-U10 and T1-T4, etc. The setting of DIP switches SW1 and SW2 determines all stator drive parameters (boost voltage and boost time, run voltage, brake voltage and brake time, etc). The modulated output from the inverter is applied to the common stator terminal via one leg of the inverter. The shift and main currents are taken from the other leg of the inverter via K5 and K6. K1-A and K2-A switch the main current, and K1-A and K1-B switch the shift current. K3 is open for high-speed operation. Therefore, only the high-speed phase shift capacitor will be in the circuit. K3 will close for low-speed operation, connecting the low-speed phase shift capacitor in parallel with the high-speed phase shift capacitor. Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-06 Rev. L Page 7-15 7 Theory of Operation 7.2.8 CPI Canada Inc Dual speed starter (Cont) The contacts of current sense relays K5 and K6 will be closed when the stator current is above preset limits. With K5 and K6 closed, Q5 on the dual speed starter board is supplied with base current. This will turn on Q5, whose output is monitored by the dual speed starter CPU. If a stator fault is detected, the CPU will output a high at J1-10 on the dual speed starter board. This signal is fed to the “GENERATOR READY” detector and logic “OR / NOR” circuits described in 7.2.4. A fault condition will immediately remove the generator-ready and drive enable signals, inhibiting kV output. Also, the dual speed starter CPU will open K1 or K2 and K4 on the dual speed starter board, removing the stator drive. The stator fault signal is also applied to the base of Q18 on the control board. The base of Q18 will be low if there is no stator fault, turning on Q18. This will turn on U5 on the generator CPU board. The generator CPU monitors the output of U5 via U24, and DS20 / DS21 indicate the stator fault status. 7.2.9 Rad / fluoro and power mode select (MD-0786) The circuits shown on MD-0786 control the Rad / fluoro contactor on the resonant board, and the relay on the power mode select board, both described in 7.2.5. The Rad / fluoro select signal from J1-5 of MD-0788 is applied to the base of Q5 on the auxiliary board via R79. This is high for Rad / pulsed fluoro mode, and low for continuous fluoro mode. When in Rad / pulsed fluoro mode, Q5 will be turned on, lighting D36 and energizing K1 on the resonant board. K1 shorts out the fluoro inductor as described in 7.2.5. In continuous fluoro mode, Q5 is off, de-energizing K1. Inverter # 3 on 65, 80, and 100 kW generators is disabled during low power operation (pulsed fluoro, continuous fluoro, or low power Rad exposures). This is accomplished as described below. When in continuous fluoro mode, and the collector of Q5 is high, the base of Q4 will be pulled high via D38. This will turn on Q4, energizing K1 on the power mode select board. This removes gate drive from inverter #3. The low / high power select signal from J1-3 of MD-0788 is applied to the base of Q4 on the auxiliary board via D44. This is low for high power Rad exposures, and high for pulsed fluoro / low power Rad operation. Q4 will be turned on during pulsed fluoro / low power operation, energizing K1 on the power mode select board, removing gate drive from inverter #3. 7.2.10 Interlocks & tube 1 / tube 2 tellback (MD-0787) For R&F generators, JW4 on the auxiliary board is jumpered in the ON position, and a thermal switch is mounted on the inverter heat sink. This switch will open if an inverter over temperature is detected. This pulls J2-4 on the auxiliary board high, turning on Q10 and lighting D42. With J2-10 pulled high, Q8 is turned on via D26 and R7. The output of Q8, low for a fault, holds the base of Q15 on the auxiliary board low as described in 7.2.7. The output of Q8 is also OR’ed with the kV ENABLE signal on MD-0761, inhibiting the prep and X-ray functions when the output of Q8 is low. The tube 1 / tube 2 tellback portion of MD-0787 ensures that the actual tube selection matches the requested tube selection. Logic circuits compare the tube 1 / tube 2 request signal to the feedback from a contact closure in the HT tank. The TUBE 1 / TUBE 2 SELECT command from MD-0788 is low when tube 2 is selected, and high for tube 1. This is applied to one input of the tube 1 / tube 2 tellback logic circuit. The output of U7 is connected to the other input of this logic circuit. Page 7-16 Rev. L Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-06 CPI Canada Inc Theory of Operation 7 7.2.10 Interlocks & tube 1 / tube 2 tellback (Cont) When the tank is in the tube 1 position, U7 and U8 on the auxiliary board are off, and the collector of U7 will be high. In the tube 2 position, U7 and U8 are turned on, and the collector of U7 will be low. If a mismatch is detected, the base of Q8 is pulled high, turning Q8 on. With Q8 turned on, Q15 on the auxiliary board will be turned off, and the prep command will be inhibited as described above. When U8 on the auxiliary board is on (tube 2 position), U3 on the generator CPU board will be turned on. The output of U3 and the TUBE 1 / TUBE 2 SELECT signal are connected to U35 on the generator CPU board. U35 decodes the binary inputs, and lights DS5 or DS6 as appropriate. 7.2.11 AEC (MD-0757) Refer to MD-0757, sheet 1: This shows the circuits on the generator interface board that connect to the A2EC2 detector, and the circuits between the generator CPU and the AEC board. Eight lines supply the AEC chamber select signals, the field select signals, and the start signal to the AEC board via U25 / U23 and driver U33 on the generator interface board. The AEC start signal is also connected to the base of Q7 on the generator interface board, where it turns Q7 on when the start signal is present, taking J14-3 high. The AEC ramp (PT RAMP) from the AEC board is buffered by U23C on the generator CPU board, and fed to A/D converter U37 such that it can be monitored by the CPU. D/A converter U18 on the generator CPU board generates the AEC reference voltage. This is buffered by U14C, and fed to the AEC board via J10-10 on the generator interface board. The magnitude of the AEC reference voltage is determined by the CPU, and will be a value between 0 and 10 volts. The AEC reference is also taken to the A2EC2 detector via J14-1. The AEC board generates the PT stop signal when the magnitude of the AEC ramp is equal to the AEC reference voltage. This signal will switch low when the exposure is to be terminated. An active PT stop signal will pull the base of Q5 low, turning Q5 off, thus turning Q6 on. The output of Q6 is connected to one of the interrupt inputs on the CPU via U45C on the generator CPU board, where it will terminate the AEC exposure immediately when the interrupt is received. Refer to MD-0757, sheet 2: The A2EC2 system, in conjunction with GenWare®, establishes AEC calibration curves by using a pair of photo diode detectors to measure the light output from the cassette screens. When A2EC2 calibration is about to be performed, and the exposure starts, the opto coupler that is connected to J2-3 / J2-4 on the A2EC2 detector circuit is energized. This releases the short on the integrating capacitor, which is part of the integrator circuit, via the analog switch. The integrator will then generate a ramp whose slope is proportional to the light sensed by the photo diode detectors. The integrator output is amplified and compared to the AEC reference voltage. The output of the comparator circuit drives U46 on the generator interface board when S1 is closed. The output of U46 will be low when the magnitude of the ramp at the comparator input is equal to the AEC reference voltage. This will terminate the exposure by generating an interrupt at the CPU as described for the PT stop signal on the previous page. The A2EC2 detector assembly includes on-board +/-8 VDC regulators. Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-06 Rev. L Page 7-17 7 Theory of Operation CPI Canada Inc 7.2.11 AEC (Cont) Refer to MD-0757, sheet 3: This page shows the functional schematic of the AEC board used with solid-state AEC chambers. The signal from the AEC chamber is applied between the common anode and the cathode inputs of J1/J11, J2/J12, J3/J13, and / or J4/J14. The AEC board will either be fitted with 5 pin in-line connectors, or circular style connectors, depending on the application. U11A, U11B, U1A, and U1B are extremely high gain preamplifiers that convert the current output from the AEC diodes (several hundred pico amps, typically) to a useable voltage. The output of each preamplifier is connected to the AEC gain adjustment potentiometers, R1 to R4, used for AEC calibration. The AEC signal is then taken to the input of analog switches U6A to U6D. The chamber-select signals exit on the generator interface board as per sheet 1. Only one chamber may be active at one time, and the active channel is indicated by DS1 to DS4 on the AEC board. The chamber-select signals are inverted by U2A to U2D; and then connected to the control inputs of analog switches U6A to U6D. The analog switch corresponding to the selected AEC input channel will be closed when that channel is selected, thus connecting the preamplifier for the active channel to gain stage U9B. The field select signals from the generator interface board are also active-low. An active field select signal will pull the base of Q1, Q2, or Q3 low. This will turn on that transistor, supplying +12 V at the field select lines connected to D30, D18, or D19. More than one field may be active at one time. The field select signals are connected to the control inputs of analog switches at the inputs of U11A, U11B, U1A, and U1B. This will switch the selected combination of AEC inputs (L, M, R) to the summing node of each preamplifier. The voltage output of the preamplifiers will be proportional to the number of fields selected, i.e. the preamplifier output when 3 fields are selected will be 3 times that with a single field selected. The field select signals are also connected to three analog switches in the feedback loop of U9B. One of these switches will be closed for each AEC field that is selected. With one field selected, the gain of this stage will be maximum; with three fields selected the gain of this stage will be divided by three. The variable gain of U9B, which depends on the number of fields selected, compensates for the variable voltage output of the preamplifiers as described in the previous paragraph, thus keeping the signal output from U9B constant relative to the number of fields that are selected. The output of U9B drives the input of difference amplifier U10B, which subtracts the sample and hold voltage from the input voltage as described in the next paragraph. The start signal also exits from the generator interface board. This signal, when active, will cause DS5 on the AEC board to light. The start signal is buffered and inverted by U2F and U2E, and will be logic low at the output of U2E when the start signal is active. This opens the analog switch that is part of the sample and hold circuit at the input of U10B, and also opens analog switch U12 during an AEC exposure. These analog switches are closed at all other times. The sample and hold circuit will sample any electrical noise at the output of U9B during standby operation, and subtract this noise from the AEC signal during an AEC exposure. This ensures that the output of U10B is proportional to the AEC chamber output current only, and is not influenced by noise. The output of 10B drives integrating amplifier U10A. Analog switch U12 opens when an AEC exposure starts, allowing C37 to start integrating the AEC voltage. This will produce a ramp whose slope is proportional to the input voltage at U10A. The AEC ramp is taken to the generator interface board where it is processed as described earlier in this section, and also fed to comparator U13 on the AEC board where it is compared to the AEC reference voltage. The output of U13 is normally high, switching low when the magnitude of the AEC ramp equals the reference voltage. This PT stop signal is further processed on the generator interface board. Page 7-18 Rev. L Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-06 CPI Canada Inc Theory of Operation 7 7.2.11 AEC (Cont) Refer to MD-0757, sheet 4: This is the functional schematic of the AEC board used with ionization type AEC chambers. The AEC chambers are connected to J1/J11, J2/J12, J3/J13, and / or J4/J14. The AEC board will either be fitted with 12 pin in-line connectors, or 9 pin ‘D’ connectors, depending on the application. The AEC signal from the AEC chamber(s) is routed to the input of analog switches S1A to S1D on the AEC board. These analog switches are controlled by the chamber-select signals. The chamber-select signals exit on the generator interface board as per sheet 1. Only one chamber may be active at one time, and the active channel is indicated by DS1 to DS4 on the AEC board. The chamber-select signals are inverted by U3B, U3C, U3D, and U3F; and connected to the control inputs of the analog switches described in the previous paragraph. The analog switch corresponding to the selected AEC input channel will be closed when that channel is selected, thus connecting the AEC signal to preamplifier U1A, which provides voltage gain. The input of U1A will be configured such that U1A is a non-inverting amplifier for use with AEC chambers that have a positive going output, and as an inverting amplifier for use with chambers with a negative voltage output. The start signal also exits from the generator interface board. This signal, when active, will cause DS5 on the AEC board to be lit. The start signal is buffered and inverted by U3E and U3A, and will be logic low at the output of U3A when the start signal is active. This opens the analog switch that is part of the sample and hold circuit at the input of U2A during an AEC exposure. This analog switch is closed at all other times. The sample and hold circuit will sample any electrical noise at the output of U1A during standby operation, and subtract this noise from the AEC signal during an AEC exposure. This ensures that the output of U2A is proportional to the AEC chamber output voltage only, and is not influenced by noise. The output of U2A connects to the common inputs of analog switches S2A to S2D. These analog switches are controlled by the chamber-select signal, and the switch corresponding to the active channel will be closed. This connects the output of U2A to the AEC gain adjustment potentiometer R1 to R4 corresponding to the active channel. The AEC signal, which will be either a ramp or a DC voltage depending on AEC chamber type, is now fed to the input of U2B. This will be factory configured as an integrating amplifier by connecting C4 into the circuit for use with AEC chambers that output a DC output voltage, or U2B will be configured as a linear amplifier by connecting R32 into the circuit for use with AEC chambers that provide a ramp voltage. The start signal also connects to analog switch S4. This switch opens when an AEC exposure starts, allowing U2B to start integrating or amplifying the AEC signal. The output of U2B will be a positive going ramp regardless of the AEC chamber type in use. This ramp voltage is processed by U4A and U4B, and also fed to the short AEC exposure time compensation circuit consisting of R11 to R14, S3A to S3D, R53 and C11. Analog switches S3A to S3D are controlled by the chamber-select signal. The switch corresponding to the active channel will be closed, connecting the phase-lead network C11 / R53 to the wiper of the AEC short-time adjustment potentiometer. This circuit is disabled when the wipers of R11 to R14 are at the ground end of the potentiometers, and maximum short-time compensation is provided when the wipers are set to the end of the potentiometers connected to U2B. The AEC ramp from U4B is taken to the generator interface board where it is processed as described earlier in this section, and also fed to comparator U6 on the AEC board where it is compared to the AEC reference voltage. The output of U6 is normally high, switching low when the magnitude of the AEC ramp equals the reference voltage. This PT stop signal is further processed on the generator interface board. The START, and LEFT, MIDDLE, and RIGHT field select signals are brought to the AEC chambers via J1/J11, J2/J12, J3/J13, and J4/J14. The AEC board will be factory configured to directly output the active low signal from the generator interface board to the AEC chamber if required, or to output +12 V or +24 V if the chamber requires active high signals. For AEC chambers that require active high outputs, the start, left, middle, or right field select signal is taken from the collector of Q1 to Q4, respectively. The active low signals from the generator control board turn on Q1 to Q4, outputting either +12 V or +24V (depending on factory configuration) at the collector when active. Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-06 Rev. L Page 7-19 7 Theory of Operation CPI Canada Inc 7.2.11 AEC (Cont) Jumpers JW1 to JW8 swap the left and right fields on J11 to J14. Jumpering pins 2-3 of the field selector jumpers (JW7 / JW8 for channel 1, JW5 / JW6 for channel 2, JW3 / JW4 for channel 3, JW1 / JW2 for channel 4) connects the right field select signal to pin 6 and the left field select signal to pin 2. Jumpering pins 1-2 of the field selector jumpers connects the right field select signal to pin 2 and the left field select signal to pin 6. The AEC board also contains a DC to DC converter that produces +45 V, + or - 300 V, and +500 VDC. The converter circuit consists of U7, T1, output voltage adjustment potentiometer R79, and associated components. The +45 V output is hard wired to all of the AEC chamber connectors, and + or - 300 V is permanently connected to J1 to J4. Additionally, the AEC board will be factory configured to supply either + or - 300 V or +500 V to J11 to J13, and to pin 1 on J1 to J4 (in addition to the + or - 300 V fixed output at pin 2). Refer to MD-0757, sheet 5: Refer to schematics 734628 and 728401 for the universal AEC board. Schematic 728401 shows the DC to DC converter (U3 and associated components) that produces +50, +300 and +500 VDC for use with ion chambers, and up to -1000 VDC for photo multiplier tubes. R10 adjusts the high voltage output when ABS operation is selected. R24 adjusts the high voltage output when AEC channel 1, 2, or 3 is selected. R19 adjusts the high voltage output when AEC channel 4 is selected. Refer to chapter 3D, the section Universal AEC Board With Short AEC Time Compensation for further details. The AEC chambers are connected to J1 to J4, and the high voltage for the PMT is taken from J7 on the AEC interface board. J6 interconnects the signals between the AEC board and connectors J1 to J4 on the AEC interface board. Schematic 734628, sheet 1, shows the amplifier and control portion of the AEC circuits. These boards are factory configured via jumpers JW2, JW3, and JW5-74 such that the AEC board is compatible with the AEC chamber types that were specified at the time of the generator order. The individual AEC channels are selected under software control, with the switching being done via analog switches on the AEC board. R1 to R4 are the AEC gain potentiometers, and R91 to R94 are used for short time compensation. Schematic 734628, sheet 2, shows the switching circuits for the start and field select signals. This also shows the analog switches that switch the inputs from solid-state AEC chambers. Schematic 734628, sheets 3 to 5 show the required jumper positions and circuit modifications needed for compatibility with various AEC chambers. It is not recommended that the universal AEC board be field reconfigured. 7.2.12 ABS (MD-0758) The composite video signal is fed into J8 on the generator interface board, and proportional DC is applied to J7. The jumpers (designated JW__) select the input source, input polarity, gain, etc. Refer to chapter 3E for the required positions for these jumpers. Composite video applied to J8 is amplified by U17D and applied to gain stages U17A and U17B. Generators with the conventional fluoro option are fitted with analog gain potentiometer R48, and units with the pulsed fluoro option use digital pot U49. The processed ABS signal exits the generator interface board at J11-3, and is buffered by U23D on the generator CPU board. The ABS signal is then fed to the sample and hold circuit, which smoothes out the ABS feedback signal during pulsed fluoro operation. The CPU monitors the output of the sample and hold circuit via A/D converter U37, and uses this information to maintain constant image brightness by regulating the fluoro kV and / or mA. Page 7-20 Rev. L Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-06 CPI Canada Inc Theory of Operation 7 7.2.12 ABS (Cont) The output of the PMT at J7-12 of the generator interface board is split by R118 and fed to J7-10 such that the PMT output is also available for AEC control. This is applicable if a PMT is to be used for AEC control on AEC channel 4. Refer to chapter 3D, the section AEC USING A PMT for further details. 7.2.13 Remote fluoro control (MD-0766) The remote fluoro control communicates with the generator via an RS-232 protocol. Serial communication is handled by U20 and U11 on the generator CPU board, and U7 on the remote fluoro control board. DS15 on the generator CPU board will flash to indicate that the generator is sending data to the remote fluoro control, and DS19 will flash to indicate that the remote fluoro control is sending data back to the generator. The micro controller on the remote fluoro control board handles all remote fluoro functions. It decodes serial data from the generator and decodes inputs from the remote fluoro keyboard assembly. The micro controller drives the speaker on the remote fluoro control board, transmits data to the data latches on the remote fluoro display board in order to drive the desired LEDs, and sends data to the generator in order to set up the requested fluoro parameters. 7.2.14 Digital interface (MD-0767) Refer to MD-0767, sheet 1: This page shows the interface circuits between the generator CPU and the digital I/O board. Included are eight data and address lines, and four control lines for the data and address bus. The HV ON signal that originates on the generator CPU board is described in 7.2.5, and is routed to the digital I/O board as shown. The EXPOSURE ENABLE command is generated by some imaging systems, and is OR’ed with the output of U22 on the generator interface board as shown in MD-0761. When this line is pulled low, U46 on the generator CPU board is energized, enabling an X-ray exposure as described in 7.2.4. Some imaging systems generate a “DIGITAL IMAGING” ABS signal. This is fed into the input of U17B on the generator interface board when JW21 is in the appropriate position to select that ABS signal source. Refer to 7.2.12 for details. A sync signal that synchronizes the start of exposures is fed to the CPU via U51, U45A / U45B, and U28 on the generator CPU board. Depending on the position of JW22 on the generator interface board, the sync signal will be either 50 / 60 Hz line frequency pulses from the zero crossing circuit U40 on MD-0788, or these may be sync pulses supplied by the digital imaging system. DS40 on the generator CPU board will light when sync pulses are present. This document does not detail the imaging system pin-outs. Refer to the imaging system documentation and the appropriate CPI digital imaging supplement for this information. Refer to MD-0767, sheet 2: This is the functional schematic of digital I/O board assembly 733752. The address decoder circuits decode the address and data bus. U4 latches the output data, and driver U6 provides the required current gain to drive the output devices. The emitter of U10 is taken low when the generator is ready to make an exposure, and the imaging system will request an exposure by taking the cathode of U10 low. This results in the collector of U10 being pulled low when the generator is ready and the imaging system requests an exposure. The output of U10 is the EXPOSURE ENABLE command, described on sheet 1. DS4 and DS6 to DS10 indicate the status of the outputs. Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-06 Rev. L Page 7-21 7 Theory of Operation CPI Canada Inc 7.2.14 Digital interface (Cont) Multiplexer U7 selects one of two ABS feedback signals, these are designated as the “DIGITAL IMAGING” ABS signal, and fed back to the generator interface board as shown on sheet 1. The digital outputs from the imaging system (inputs to the digital I/O board) are connected to U11 to U13. When active, these opto couplers will light DS3 to DS1 respectively, and pull the inputs of U8 low. The output of U8 is read by the generator CPU via the address decoder circuits on the digital I/O board. The HV ON signal is applied directly to U6, which drives DS4 (EXON) and the corresponding input on the imaging system. U14 and U16 provide isolation for the corresponding outputs on the digital I/O board. SW1 must be set as defined in the digital imaging supplement. This configures the software specifically to be compatible with the imaging system in use. Refer to MD-0767, sheet 3: This is the functional schematic of digital I/O board assembly 733947. The address decoder circuits decode the address and data bus. U13 and U14 latch the output data, and drivers U15 and U16 provide the required current gain to drive the output devices. Q2 and Q3 provide level translation for these two outputs (Q2 and Q3 source +24 VDC when active). The HV ON signal is applied to Q1 via D3. This takes the collector of Q1 low when the high voltage is on. Monostable timer U17 is triggered at the start of the HV ON signal, generating a 13 millisecond pulse. This ensures that the high voltage remains on for a minimum of 13 milliseconds, while having no effect on high voltage pulses longer than 13 milliseconds. The digital outputs from the imaging system (inputs to the digital I/O board) are connected to U3 to U8. When active, these opto couplers will pull the inputs of U12 low. The output of U12 is read by the generator CPU via the address decoder circuits on the digital I/O board. SW1 must be set as defined in the digital imaging supplement. This configures the software specifically to be compatible with the imaging system in use. Refer to MD-0767, sheet 4: This is the functional schematic of digital I/O board assembly 735921. The circuits that interface with the digital imaging system are the same as those on assembly 733947. These circuits are shown reduced in size on sheet 4 (within the dashed outline), and full size on sheet 3. Digital I/O board assembly 735921 is used with some imaging systems that have integrated generator control functions. Such installations do not need a separate console to control and monitor the X-ray exposure parameters, but require “X-ray mini consoles” with on / off and prep / X-ray controls, and prep and X-ray exposure indicators. Assembly 735921 includes the circuits described on sheet 3, plus data latch U18, driver U19, and connectors J4 to J7. J4 on this board connects to the control console connector, J4, on the generator interface board. The X-ray mini consoles connect to J6 and J7. The on / off and prep and X-ray commands originate on the X-ray mini console as described on page 5. These signals are then taken from J6 on the digital I/O board to J4 on the generator interface board. These functions are as described in MD-0762 and MD-0761 when using the X-ray mini console. U18 latches the data to drive the speakers and the prep / exposure indicators on the mini consoles, and U19 provides the required current gain to drive these devices. A version of this board exists without the digital imaging interface circuits that are shown within the dashed outline. This board is used with some imaging systems that have integrated generator control functions, and connect to the generator via a serial port instead of the digital I/O board. Page 7-22 Rev. L Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-06 CPI Canada Inc Theory of Operation 7 7.2.14 Digital interface (Cont) Refer to MD-0767, sheet 5: This sheet shows the optional CPI “mini consoles”. These are typically used in installations where the digital imaging system has integrated generator control functions. Such systems allow control and monitoring of generator exposure parameters, but typically do not contain on / off and prep / X-ray controls and indicators. The CPI mini consoles provide these control and monitoring functions in installations requiring them. The X-ray mini console connects to J6 on the digital I/O board. This includes on / off and prep / X-ray controls as shown. These functions are routed to J4 on the generator interface board, and perform the on / off and prep / X-ray functions as described in MD-0762 and MD-0761. An optional hand switch connects to E1, E2, and E3 on the X-ray mini console board. Power ON indicator DS4 is connected to J6-5 (ground), and lights whenever the generator is switched on. The appropriate bit in U18 is latched high or low in order to turn on / turn off LS1, LS2 and DS1 to DS3. Driver U19 provides current gain to drive these devices via J6-3, J6-4, and J6-6 to J6-8. The optional mini console X-ray exposure indicator connects to J7 on the digital I/O board, and contains prep and exposure indicators and two speakers. U19 drives DS1, DS2, and LS1, LS2 via J7-1, J7-4, J75, and J7-7 as described above. Refer to MD-0767, sheet 6: This is the functional schematic of digital I/O board assembly 735406. The address decoder circuits decode the address and data bus. U4 latches the output data, and driver U6 provides the required current gain to drive U7, U10, and U16. U7 and U10 pull the associated inputs on the imaging system low when active. The emitter of U14 is taken low when the generator is ready to make an exposure, and the imaging system will request an exposure by taking the anode of U14 high. This results in the collector of U14 being pulled low when the generator is ready and the imaging system requests an exposure, turning on U16. The output of U16 is the EXPOSURE ENABLE command, described on sheet 1. The output of U15, which will also be low when an exposure is requested, is monitored by generator CPU via U8 and the address decoder circuits on the digital I/O board. The digital outputs from the imaging system (inputs to the digital I/O board) are connected to U11 and U13. When active, these opto couplers will pull the corresponding inputs of U8 low. The output of U8 is read by the generator CPU via the address decoder circuits on the digital I/O board. This I/O board assembly includes an on-board +5 VDC regulator, U12, that connects to J2-21 and to the anode of U11. SW1 must be set as defined in the digital imaging supplement. This configures the software specifically to be compatible with the imaging system in use. Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-06 Rev. L Page 7-23 7 Theory of Operation CPI Canada Inc 7.2.14 Digital interface (Cont) Refer to MD-0767, sheet 7: This is the functional schematic of digital I/O board assembly 736153. The address decoder circuits decode the address and data bus. U4 latches the output data, and driver U6 provides the required current gain to drive U7, U10, and U13 to U15. These opto couplers pull the associated inputs on the imaging system low when active. DS3, DS4, and / or DS7 to DS9 light to indicate the active outputs. The HV ON signal is NAND’ed with an output from U4 at the input of U3C. With both inputs to U3C high, the output of U3D will be high. This energizes U15 via driver U6 and DS9 / R9. The digital outputs from the imaging system (inputs to the digital I/O board) are connected to U11 and U12. When these inputs are active, DS5 and / or DS6 will light, and the corresponding inputs of U8 will be low. The output of U8 is read by the generator CPU via the address decoder circuits on the digital I/O board. SW1 must be set as defined in the digital imaging supplement. This configures the software specifically to be compatible with the imaging system in use. Refer to MD-0767, sheet 8: This is the functional schematic of digital I/O board assembly 736894. CPLD U1 decodes the address and data bus, and latches the output data. The output data is applied to driver U3, U11, and U17. U3 and U11 provide the required current gain to drive the corresponding inputs on the imaging system. The associated LEDs will light to indicate which outputs are active. U17 drives the base of Q1, which provides level translation for that output (sources +24 VDC when active). U17 also energizes K1, and pulls the emitters of U5, U7, U14, and U16 low when the generator is ready to make an exposure. Signals from the table or imaging system will request an exposure by taking the anode of U4, U6, U13, or U15 high. This will energize opto couplers U4 / U5, U6 / U7, U13 / U14, or U15 / U16 respectively. The outputs of U5, U7, U14, and U16 are OR’ed together, and provide the EXPOSURE ENABLE command, described on sheet 1. The outputs of U4, U6, U13, U15, and U8 are monitored by the generator CPU via U1. The digital outputs from the imaging system (inputs to the digital I/O board) are connected to U2, U9, U10, and U12. The outputs of these drivers are monitored by the generator CPU via U1. The LED in series with each input will light to indicate the status of that input. The “DIGITAL IMAGING” ABS signal is taken directly from the imaging system to J1-20. Refer to MD-0767, sheet 9: This is the functional schematic of digital I/O board assembly 737950. The address decoder circuits decode the address and data bus. U4, U6, and U17 latch the output data, and driver U18 provides the required current gain to drive outputs via J6 and J7. U11 – U13 provide level translation for the X-ray, prep, and generator outputs, resulting in TTL level (5V) differential outputs. The output associated with U14 is not used at this time. The HV ON signal is applied to U10 via U3D and U3C. This takes the output of U3C high when the high voltage is on. Monostable timer U7 is triggered at the start of the HV ON signal, generating a 13 millisecond pulse. This ensures that the high voltage remains on for a minimum of 13 milliseconds, while having no effect on high voltage pulses longer than 13 milliseconds. U10 provides level translation for the HV ON signal, providing a TTL level differential output. With the input to U16 low, the base of Q1 will be pulled high, taking the collector of Q1 low. The collector of Q1 is monitored by the generator CPU via U8. U15 is not used at this time. SW1 must be set as defined in the digital imaging supplement. This configures the software specifically to be compatible with the imaging system in use. Page 7-24 Rev. L Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-06 CPI Canada Inc Theory of Operation 7 7.2.15 DAP (MD-0828) The DAP circuit consists of micro-controller U1, RS-232 driver U2, and associated components on the DAP interconnect board. Micro-controller U1 operates under control of the CPU on the generator CPU board via U31 and U38, and controls all DAP functions (switches the +15 V supply via Q1, Q2, Q3 / Q4, Q5 / Q6, Q7 / Q8, and Q9 / Q10 as required to control and test the DAP devices. The micro-controller also counts the DAP pulses via U5 for DAP chamber #1, and U6 for DAP chamber #2). DS2 and DS3 on the DAP interconnect board indicate that the DAP chambers are sending pulses back to the micro-controller, and DS29 and DS32 on the generator CPU board indicate that the CPU is transmitting and receiving data respectively. +24 VDC is supplied to the DAP interconnect board from the room interface board. Regulators on the DAP interconnect board regulate this to +15 V and +5 V. 7.2.16 Serial communications (MD-0829) Refer to MD-0829, sheet 1: The console board shown on sheet 1 is used on the 31 X 42 cm console. The console for the other Indico 100 console types is shown on sheet 2. When the generator is switched on and the start-up diagnostics are completed, the console CPU will attempt to communicate with the generator CPU. The console will send data to the generator, and then wait for a response from the generator. If the console receives a response, communication may continue. If the console CPU does not receive a response from the generator CPU, a communication error message will be presented. When the console is sending data to the generator, DS41 on the console board and DS3 on the generator CPU board will flash. DS1 on the generator CPU board and DS42 on the console board will flash to indicate that the generator CPU board is sending data to the console. The console communicates with the generator via RS-232 drivers U23 (console board) and U12 (generator CPU board). U27 on the console board is an RS-232 driver for the serial port, J2. DS44 and DS43 will flash to indicate that data is being sent to, and received from the serial port. The generator CPU board may include optional communications ports J1 and J2. These are driven via U31 and U42 / U38. Communication to and from these ports is indicated by DS29, DS32, DS43, and DS44. DS40 on the console board will flash at a consistent 1 Hz rate if the CPU is operational. Refer to MD-0829, sheet 2: Sheet 2 shows the console board for the 23 X 56 cm console, and for the Rad only console. Also shown are optional communications ports on the generator CPU board. The generator CPU board may include optional communications ports J15 and J16. These are driven via U50. Communication to and from these ports is indicated by DS45 to DS48. DS16 on the generator CPU board will flash at a consistent 1 Hz rate if the CPU is operational. Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-06 Rev. L Page 7-25 7 Theory of Operation CPI Canada Inc 7.2.16 Serial communications (Cont) For the 23 X 56 cm console: When the console is sending data to the generator, D4 on the console board will flash. D3 on the console board will flash to indicate that the generator CPU board is sending data to the console. The console communicates with the generator via RS-232 driver U6, or RS-422 drivers U5 / U9 for special applications. U20 on the console board is an RS-232 driver for the serial port, J2. D2 and D1 will flash to indicate that data is being sent to, and received from the serial port. D6 on the console board will flash at a consistent 1 Hz rate if the CPU is operational. For the Rad-only console: When the console is sending data to the generator, DS2 on the console board will flash. DS3 on the console board will flash to indicate that the generator CPU board is sending data to the console. The console communicates with the generator via RS-232 driver U8. U11 on the console board is an RS-232 driver for the serial port, J4. DS4 and DS5 will flash to indicate that data is being sent to, and received from the serial port. DS1 on the console board will flash at a consistent 1 Hz rate if the CPU is operational. Sheet 3 does not apply to Indico 100. Page 7-26 Rev. L Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-06 CPI Canada Inc Spares 8 CHAPTER 8 SPARES CONTENTS: Section Title 8.1.0 INTRODUCTION.................................................................................................................................................... 8-1 8.2.0 SPARE PARTS LIST INDICO 100 GENERATOR................................................................................................. 8-2 8.1.0 INTRODUCTION This chapter contains the list of recommended spare parts for the various models of Indico 100 generators. Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-07 Rev. V Page 8-1 8 Spares 8.2.0 CPI Canada Inc SPARE PARTS LIST INDICO 100 GENERATOR DESCRIPTION Generator CPU board Generator interface board Room interface board Power supply control board Filament board Auxiliary board Inverter board Power input board Resonant Board AEC board Console CPU board Console display board Display assy, LCD Remote fluoro display board Remote fluoro control board Low speed starter board Digital I/O board DAP interface board Dual speed starter board Dual speed starter subassembly Hand switch assembly Battery, lithium 3.0V Capacitor, DC bus 470 uF 450 VDC Capacitor, DC bus 9000 uF 400 VDC Contactor, line Diode, mains rectifier 160MT120K Diode, mains rectifier DD89N12K, DD90N12L, IRKD91-12 Fuse, A70QS10-14F Fuse, FNM-3 Fuse, FNQ-2 Fuse, FNQ-10 Fuse, GDC-1.6 Fuse, GDC-2 Fuse, GDC-2.5 Fuse, GDC-5 Fuse, MDA-2 Fuse, MDA-5 Fuse, MDA-7 Fuse, MDA-10 Fuse, MDA-12 Fuse, MDL-1 1/2 Page 8-2 PART NUMBER See note ⇒ See note ⇒ 733184-00 732816-03 See note ⇒ 732221-02 See note ⇒ See note ⇒ See note ⇒ See note ⇒ See note ⇒ See note ⇒ See note ⇒ 729053-00 729038-00 See note ⇒ See note ⇒ 735992-00 728877-03 See note ⇒ See note ⇒ 7412290100 4150394100 4155001400 SC2715 6623071100 NOTE 1b 1c 2 1a 3 4 5 6 7 8 1b 9 19 10 10 11 17 22 12 12 20 2 13 14a 2 13 SUGGESTED QTY ⇐ See note ⇐ See note 1 1 ⇐ See note 1 ⇐ See note 1 1 1 ⇐ See note 1 1 ⇐ See note ⇐ See note ⇐ See note ⇐ See note ⇐ See note ⇐ See note ⇐ See note ⇐ See note 2 6 4 1 1 6623507000 6739951800 6711907400 5550005300 6711905500 5550033300 5550032600 5550034400 5550035600 6713000400 6713000100 6713000500 6713000200 6713746500 6713541500 14a 12 21 21 13 2 2 2 2 2 11 2 14a 2 14b 1 7 ⇐ See note ⇐ See note 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 Rev. V Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-07 CPI Canada Inc 8.2.0 Spares 8 SPARE PARTS LIST INDICO 100 GENERATOR (Cont) DESCRIPTION Fuse, MDL-4 Fuse, NLN-100 Fuse, OTS-60 Relay, DPST, 12V Connector, 4 pin Fan, axial Transformer, aux power supply Transformer, room I/F HT tank assembly (complete) PART NUMBER 6713544000 6711906500 SC3434 7213011800 5618931800 2084022900 732417-00 735496-01 See note ⇒ NOTE 2 14a 13 2 12 18 2 2 15 SUGGESTED QTY 5 5 5 2 1 1 1 1 ⇐ See note NOTE: 1a. The part number shown is the suggested replacement for the original power supply control board. The spares board is “full featured” and will replace the original board in your generator regardless of configuration. This is intended to eliminate the need to stock multiple configurations of this board. 1b. Two versions of generator CPU boards and four versions of console CPU boards are used in Indico 100 generators. Please confirm the original part number(s) of these boards in your generator before ordering spares. If your original generator CPU board is part number 732174-XX (where XX is a number from 00 to 08), order part number 732174-12. In this case, upgraded firmware will be required along with the new CPU board. Please consult the factory for details. If the original generator CPU board is part number 732174-12, it will be replaced with the same part number. In this case, a firmware upgrade is not required. If your original generator CPU board is part number 734573-00, order part number 734573-02. In this case, upgraded firmware will be required along with the new CPU board. Please consult the factory for details. If the original generator CPU board is part number 734573-02, it will be replaced with the same part number. In this case, a firmware upgrade is not required. The generator CPU board and the console CPU board must be matched per the table below: APPLICATION 23 X 56 cm console 23 X 56 cm console 31 X 42 cm console Rad-only console GENERATOR CPU BOARD If the original board is 732174XX, order part number 732174-12 for spares usage. See note 1b. If the original board is 734573XX, order part number 734573-02 for spares usage. See note 1b. If the original board is 734573XX, order part number 734573-02 for spares usage. See note 1b. If the original board is 734573XX, order part number 734573-02 for spares usage. See note 1b. Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-07 <MUST USE WITH> CONSOLE CPU BOARD 732218-00 <MUST USE WITH> 733903-00 <MUST USE WITH> 735852-00 <MUST USE WITH> 736805-00 Rev. V Page 8-3 8 Spares CPI Canada Inc NOTE (Cont): 1c. Two different generator interface boards are used in Indico 100 generators. For rad and R&F generators, use part number 732177-06, for pulsed fluoro generators use part number 732177-08. Spares should be stocked accordingly. 2. This part is common to all models of Indico 100 generators. 3. Three different filament boards are used in Indico 100 generators. RAD only generators use ONE filament board, part number 731407-00. R&F generators use TWO filament boards, part number 731407-01 (large focus) and part number 731407-02 (small focus). Spares should be stocked accordingly. 4. The part number shown is the suggested replacement for the original auxiliary board. The spares board is “jumper configurable” in the field and as such will replace the original auxiliary board. This is intended to eliminate the need to stock multiple configurations of this board. 5. Three different inverter board part numbers are used in Indico 100 generators. For 230 VAC 1 phase and 480 VAC 3 phase generators use part number 732813-00, for 400 VAC 3 phase 30 / 50 / 80 kW generators use part number 732813-04, for 230 VAC 1 phase 37.5 kW and for 400 VAC 3 phase 37.5 / 65 kW generators use part number 732813-05 (see note 17 for the definition of mains input voltage). 30 and 37.5 kW generators require one inverter board, 50 and 65 kW generators require two inverter boards, and 80 kW generators require three inverter boards. Spares should be stocked accordingly. 6. Two part numbers of power input boards are used for spares. For 1 phase 230 VAC generators use part number 733798-01, for 3 phase 400 or 480 VAC generators use part number 732161-01. 7. Five different resonant boards are used in Indico 100 generators. Refer to the table below for the correct part number for your generator. O/P POWER (kW) & MAINS VOLTS 30 kW (230 VAC 1φ, 400 / 480 VAC 3φ) 37.5 / 40 kW (230 VAC 1φ, 400 VAC 3φ) 50 kW (400 VAC 3φ) 50 kW (480 VAC 3φ) 65 kW (400 VAC 3φ) 80 kW (400 VAC 3φ) 80 kW (400 / 480 VAC 3φ) RESONANT BOARD RAD POWER SUPPLIES 732808-00 732808-05 RESONANT BOARD R&F POWER SUPPLIES 732808-01 732808-02 732808-06 732964-00 732964-02 732964-03 732964-01 732808-03 8. The AEC board for your generator was selected to be compatible with specific AEC device(s). To maintain full compatibility, the original part number must be ordered as a replacement. Refer to chapter 9, section 9.2.0 for the part number of the original AEC board shipped in the generator for which this manual was prepared. 9. THE CONSOLE DISPLAY BOARD IS ONLY USED WITH THE 23 X 56 CM CONSOLE. The console display board is supplied pre-mounted to the console front panel switch assembly. Consult the factory for the required spares part number for this assembly. Page 8-4 Rev. V Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-07 CPI Canada Inc Spares 8 NOTE (Cont): 10. Remote fluoro control is an option; spares should be stocked accordingly. 11. These items only used on generators fitted with low speed starter, spares should be stocked accordingly. The low speed starter part number with a 33µF phase shift capacitor for standard “R” type stators is 732752-00. The part number with a 12.5µF phase shift capacitor is 732752-01, and the part number with a 45µF phase shift capacitor is 732752-02. 12. These items only used on dual speed starter option, spares should be stocked accordingly. Several part numbers of dual speed starter (which are tube stator dependent) are used in Indico 100 generators. To determine which dual speed starter assembly is in your generator, note the DUAL SPEED STARTER ASSY part number on a label on the dual speed starter chassis. This will be the part number that must be ordered for spares usage. For reference, this will be part number 733317-XX or 735925-XX where XX is a two digit number designating the exact configuration. The dual speed starter fuses listed are used on all versions of dual speed starter. 13. These items are used on the 400/480 VAC 3 phase power input board. Spares should be stocked accordingly. 14a. These items are used on 1 phase 230 VAC units only (on the DC bus assembly or on the 1 phase power input board). Spares should be stocked accordingly. 14b. This fuse used on 1 phase 230 VAC rad two tube generators, and on 1 phase 230 VAC R & F one tube and two tube generators. Spares should be stocked accordingly. 15. For replacement HT oil tank part numbers, consult factory. 16. NOTE REGARDING MAINS (LINE) VOLTAGE AS DESCRIBED IN THIS SECTION: The mains voltage referenced in this section is the mains voltage at the input to the generator (at the main fuses on the power input board). This is not necessarily the same as the voltage at the main disconnect box in the room, the reason being that an optional line adjusting transformer may be used with the generator which steps the incoming line voltage to the generator up or down. To ensure that the correct part number is selected for spares, it is suggested that the mains voltage be noted at the main input fuses INSIDE THE GENERATOR. 17. The digital I/O board is optional, and used on generators intended to interface with digital imaging systems. To ensure full compatibility, please order the same part number that is in your generator(s). 18. A cooling fan is used on R&F power supplies only. Spares should be stocked accordingly. 19. For 23 X 56 cm consoles, use LCD display assembly part number 733396-00. For 31 X 42 cm consoles, use LCD display assembly part number 735895-00. 20. For 23 X 56 cm consoles, use hand switch assembly part number 733176-00. For 31 X 42 cm consoles, use hand switch assembly part number 735203-00. 21. Single phase generators use fuse FNM-3, three phase generators use FNQ-2. Spares should be stocked accordingly. 22. DAP is an option, spares should be stocked accordingly. Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-07 Rev. V Page 8-5 8 Spares CPI Canada Inc (This page intentionally left blank) Page 8-6 Rev. V Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-07 CPI Canada Inc Schematics 9 CHAPTER 9 SCHEMATICS CONTENTS: 9.1.0 INTRODUCTION ........................................................................................................................................... 9-2 9.2.0 FUNCTIONAL SCHEMATIC INDEX.............................................................................................................. 9-2 9.3.0 FUNCTIONAL DRAWINGS ........................................................................................................................... 9-2 Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-08 Rev. B Page 9-1 9 Schematics 9.1.0 CPI Canada Inc INTRODUCTION This chapter contains the functional schematics for your X-ray generator. Each schematic represents a major function in the Indico 100 generator; the fourteen functional schematics in this chapter represent all of the major functional blocks in Indico 100 generators. 9.2.0 FUNCTIONAL SCHEMATIC INDEX The functional schematic index follows this page. The part number for the AEC board originally shipped in your generator is listed at the bottom of this form. 9.3.0 FUNCTIONAL DRAWINGS The functional schematics immediately follow the functional schematic index. Page 9-2 Rev. B Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-08 CPI Canada Inc Functional Drawing Index INDICO 100 FUNCTIONAL DRAWINGS DESCRIPTION DC Bus and Power Distribution System ON Room Interface X-Ray Exposure - Rad / Fluoro kV Control and Feedback Filament Drive and mA Control Low Speed Starter Dual Speed Starter Rad / Fluoro and Power Mode Select Interlocks and Tube 1 / Tube 2 Tellback Automatic Exposure Control (AEC) Automatic Brightness Stabilization (ABS) Remote Fluoro Control Digital Interface DAP (Dose Area Product) Serial Communications DRAWING NUMBER MD-0788 MD-0762 MD-0763 MD-0761 MD-0759 MD-0760 MD-0764 MD-0765 MD-0786 MD-0787 MD-0757 MD-0758 MD-0766 MD-0767 MD-0828 MD-0829 INDICO 100 SCHEMATICS DESCRIPTION Schematic, AEC Interface Board Schematic, AEC Board SCHEMATIC NUMBER 728401 734628 THE PART NUMBER OF THE ORIGINAL AEC BOARD IN THE GENERATOR FOR WHICH THIS MANUAL WAS PREPARED IS LISTED BELOW: AEC BOARD PART NUMBER (AS ORIGINALLY SHIPPED) N/A MF-0718E 9 Schematics CPI Canada Inc (This page intentionally left blank) Page 9-4 Rev. B Indico 100 Series Service Manual Ch # 740895-08 3 PHASE AC MAINS INPUT F5A PHASE 3 F5C GROUND R11 R10 NEUTRAL + R20 PHASE 2 ~ ~ ~ E23 K1 2 - E16 D3 K1 S.S. OK JW2 1 1 J4-8 J4-8 5 1 U2 U1 4 +12V 2 +12VDC OK D2 K2 DC BUS OK 4 5 2 1 F2 E10 F1 380/400/480 VAC J6-1 3 D2 J6-5 D9 120 VAC J6-6 J4-13 J4-2 J4-2 52 VAC J2-2 P2-2 F1 K2 D8 SOFT START FAULT SIGNAL TO AUXILIARY BOARD, PAGE 3 R1, R2 K1 J4-1 J4-1 J4-4 J4-4 +12V 4 D5 J4-3 TP1 5 TUBE 1 / TUBE 2 SELECT COMMAND TO MD-0787 J5-3 J1-3 J5-4 J1-4 J3-3 J2-3 +12V J4-3 F1 120 / 240 VAC F2 J4-14 J3-4 J2-4 J4-15 J4-15 J3-2 J2-2 J4-16 J4-16 J4-18 J4-18 J3-9 J2-9 K3 TP4 TP1 REFER TO MD-0764 LOW SPEED STARTER BOARD J4-17 J10-3 K4 +12V FLUORO FAN TIMER / DRIVER CIRCUIT (U11, Q9, ETC) D37 FLUORO FAN ON J4-5 D6 J5-3 J5-4 J1-6 J1-5 J1-3 K3 K4 J11-4 AUXILIARY BOARD E21 240V *** J8-1 F3 J7-1 J7-3 180V T1 AND T2 MUST BE TAPPED IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE NOMINAL AC MAINS VOLTAGE. REFER TO CHAPTER 2 OF THE GENERATOR SERVICE MANUAL. THIS VOLTAGE IS APPROXIMATELY 560 VDC FOR 400 V GENERATORS, AND APPROXIMATELY 680 VDC FOR 480 V GENERATORS 0V 240V 200V CONTINUED ON PAGE 4 OPTIONAL 400/480 VAC *** 480 VAC GENERATORS *** 230/277 VAC NEUTRAL OPTIONAL GROUND ROOM INTERFACE CHASSIS 3 PHASE POWER INPUT BOARD (REFER TO PAGE 2 FOR 1 PHASE POWER INPUT BOARD) DRAWN G. SANWALD CHECKED________ DES.\MFG.\AUTH. HTW 0V H.T. TANK TUBE 1 /TUBE 2 SOLENOID (TWO TUBE HT TANKS ONLY) J8-3 T2 (SHOWN TAPPED * FOR 400 VAC MAINS) J7-5 ** J5-6 THREE FAN UNITS ONLY E17 200V FROM PAGE 3 * J5-4 F2 J11-6 R&F GENERATORS ONLY J5-7 FAN(S) USED ON FLUORO GENERATORS ONLY. DEPENDING ON THE APPLICATION, ONE, TWO, OR THREE FANS MAY BE USED J10-1 +12V 6 J4-5 COMMON +12V D7 R72 52 / 73 / 94 VAC F3 +12V J4-14 J4-17 RETURN J1-1 F4 K1 +12V CONTINUED ON PAGE 3 73 VAC K5 D4 J4-13 T1 208 VAC N/C J2-1 P2-1 CNCTR CLOSED * 94 VAC R31 SOFT START DRIVER CIRCUIT (U3B, Q6, ETC) DUAL SPEED STARTER IS OPTIONAL. LOW SPEED STARTER IS STANDARD IN INDICO 100 GENERATORS 240 VAC J6-7 J5-6 + -** 560 VDC +12V JUMPER POSITION: 1 PHASE GENERATORS 2 JUMPER PINS 2-3 3 PHASE GENERATORS 3 JUMPER PINS 1-2 E2 - DUAL SPEED STARTER BOARD +12V J4-10 E2 - E9 DC BUS DISCHARGE CIRCUIT (Q1, D10) F1 J4-10 E1 + INVERTER BOARD R12 SOFT START OK PROTECTION CIRCUIT (U1C, Q7, ETC) R48 JW3 1 JUMPER POSITION: 1 PHASE GENERATORS 2 JUMPER PINS 2-3 3 PHASE GENERATORS 3 JUMPER PINS 1-2 E1 + INVERTER BOARD E2 - DC BUS CHARGED SENSING CIRCUIT (R5-R8, D3) F2 E1 + INVERTER BOARD E11 E8 +12V 3 PHASE INDICO 100 GENERATORS USE ONE, TWO, OR THREE INVERTER BOARDS DEPENDING ON GENERATOR OUTPUT POWER DC BUS OUT R16, R17 REFER TO PAGE 5 FOR LOGIC LEVELS, NOTES, ETC, REFERENCED BY HEXAGONAL SYMBOL: F5B D1 R18, R19 K5 PHASE 1 DATE 10 MAR 2000 ________ DC BUS & POWER DISTRIBUTION 10 MAR 2000 MD-0788 REV J SHEET 1 OF 6 K5 1 PHASE AC MAINS INPUT LINE 1 F5A LINE 2 F5B SINGLE PHASE INDICO 100 GENERATORS USE ONE OR TWO INVERTER MODULES DEPENDING ON GENERATOR OUTPUT POWER E33 MAINS RECTIFIER 230 VAC E34 BUS CAPACITORS R11 R10 K1 P1-4 P1-1 J12-4 J12-1 NO CONNECTION 5 J6-5 2 J6-6 J4-4 J6-7 K5 J5-4 +12V +12V J4-4 J3-3 F4 J4-14 J4-15 J4-16 J4-16 J4-18 J4-18 J4-17 J4-17 LOW SPEED STARTER BOARD REFER TO PAGE 1 J3-4 D5 J3-2 R12 J4-3 J4-14 RETURN J5-3 J4-1 J4-15 F1 J2-2 P2-2 K1 J4-3 73 VAC 52 VAC D8 AUXILIARY BOARD REFER TO PAGE 1 CONTINUED ON PAGE 3 D2 K2 J4-1 120 VAC K2 D4 J4-2 *T1 94 VAC DC BUS OK J2-1 P2-1 J4-2 380/400/480 VAC TAPS 208 VAC U1 +12V J4-13 J6-1 1 4 J4-13 E2 - J6-3 DC BUS CHARGED SENSING CIRCUIT (R6-R8, R16-R21, D3, ETC) 1 J4-8 E2 - 240 VAC F1 J4-8 E1 + INVERTER BOARD DC BUS ASSEMBLY F2 J4-10 E1 + INVERTER BOARD VOLTAGE DOUBLER CIRCUIT GROUND J4-10 650 VDC OUT D9 +12VDC OK J3-9 +12V D7 J10-3 K3 K4 FAN(S) USED ON FLUORO GENERATORS ONLY. DEPENDING ON THE APPLICATION, ONE OR TWO FANS MAY BE USED J10-1 +12V K3 6 J4-5 J4-5 D6 J11-4 J11-6 K4 H.T. TANK REFER TO PAGE 1 J8-3 E21 E17 J8-1 240V * T1 / T2 MUST BE TAPPED IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE NOMINAL AC MAINS VOLTAGE. REFER TO CHAPTER 2 OF THE GENERATOR SERVICE MANUAL. T2 (SHOWN TAPPED * FOR 240 VAC MAINS) F3 J7-1 J7-3 200V OPTIONAL 230 VAC J7-5 230 VAC OPTIONAL GROUND 180V ROOM INTERFACE CHASSIS 0V 240V CONTINUED ON PAGE 4 1 PHASE POWER INPUT BOARD DRAWN 200V G. SANWALD CHECKED________ DES.\MFG.\AUTH. HTW 0V DATE 10 MAR 2000 ________ DC BUS & POWER DISTRIBUTION 10 MAR 2000 MD-0788 REV J SHEET 2 OF 6 +35V 0V J7-3 26 VAC J7-6 R71 F4 C22 R65 J7-1 C21 R64 26 VAC +12V +12V T1 D31 J7-4 U34 J6-5 J7-5 +5 V REGULATOR +/-35V D32 +5V J6-4 TP16 F3 FROM PAGE 1, 2 TP5 J7-2 15 VAC U5,U6 -35V F1 J7-4 C24, C25 J7-5 15 VAC F2 TO PAGE 1 J6-1 J7-1 J6-2 J7-2 J6-3 J7-3 +12V -12V R70 +12 VDC REGULATOR 0V D29 TP1 TP15 -12V D27 +12V U4 D33 R68 -12 VDC REGULATOR D16 D30 C19 +12V -12V TO MD-0786 +12V +12V D28 -12V J4-1 J1-1 J4-3 J1-3 J4-5 J1-5 J4-7 J1-7 U27 J4-9 J1-9 +5 V REGULATOR J4-11 J1-11 J4-12 J1-12 J4-13 J1-13 J4-15 J1-15 J4-17 J1-17 J4-19 J1-19 +5V R32 +12V D1 +12V +/- 12V/SS FAULT 5.1V REF J5-7 J5-6 J5-3 J5-4 J1-5 J1-6 J1-3 J6-7 J8-6 J6-4 J6-3 J8-5 J8-3 + 9 18 TUBE 1/TUBE 2 SELECT SIGNAL TO MD-0765 CONTACTOR CLOSED SIGNAL TO MD-0765 FLUORO RAD + JUMPER POSITION: RAD GENERATORS JUMPER "RAD" R&F GENERATORS JUMPER "FLUORO" + 2 J1-4 J9-3 J1-3 J9-2 J1-2 J9-5 J1-5 J9-6 J1-6 -12V 12VDC / SOFT START FAULT SIGNAL TO MD-0764, PAGE 1 SOFT START FAULT SIGNAL FROM AUXILIARY BOARD, PAGE 1 R227 R217 1 -35V AUXILIARY BOARD 1 2 U41 J1-1 J1-10 J1-29 J1-18 J1-19 J2-14 J2-6 J2-15 J2-7 J1-4 J10-25 J10-6 J10-10 J10-29 J10-18 J10-19 J3-14 J3-6 J3-15 J3-7 +15V R10 -35V +35V J1-6 R11 -12V FILAMENT BOARD J1-25 R2 +12V F1 TP2 R225 U40 J9-4 F2 U3A 5 4 R228 1 U7 5 R226 4 RN2C RN2D 5 J1-1 - R21 CONTROL BOARD +35V J9-1 R27, R32 RN4F 2 +12V U3D +12V R223 R123 R20 4 DUAL SPEED STARTER IS OPTIONAL. LOW SPEED STARTER IS STANDARD IN INDICO 100 GENERATORS U3C +12V R22 +12V Q16 DUAL SPEED STARTER BOARD CONTROL BOARD -12V +12V Q1 +/- 12V/SS FAULT TO GENERATOR READY DETECTOR CIRCUIT ON CONTROL BOARD, SEE MD-0761 - JW1 5 J6-5 +35V 8 7 J5-5 AUXILIARY BOARD - J6-6 D19 F2 ONE FILAMENT BOARD IS STANDARD IN INDICO 100 GENERATORS, THE SECOND FILAMENT BOARD IS OPTIONAL +12V J1-3 TO 2.1 V CURRENT SINK 2 1 5 5 4 1 2 R33 14 12 P/S ON -15V DS34 DS35 GRN RED 15 TO 2.1 V CURRENT SINK DATA LATCH, BUFFER, & DRIVER U27, U19 & U16 U17 +5V 12 11 Q4 4 +5V 11 DRIVER DRIVER U16 U16 TUBE 1/TUBE 2 SELECT SIGNAL TO MD-0787 DS22 FLUORO 16 TP2 +5V FILAMENT BOARD Q1 DS23 FLUORO TO 2.1 V CURRENT SINK DS2 LOW 17 DS4 HIGH TO 2.1 V CURRENT SINK U24 BUFFER * DATA BUS D0..D7 BIT 0 DATA LATCH & BUFFER U27, U19 BIT 2 DATA LATCH -35V J1-6 R9 U9 10 D1 R14 DS10 RED -12V J1-5 R13 DS9 GRN F1 +5V RN11I CONT. J1-2 13 RN11A RN7F +5V * THE POWER SUPPLY ON COMMAND (P/S ON) WHICH ENERGIZES K1 / K2 ON THE POWER INPUT BOARD IS ISSUED BY THE GENERATOR CPU BOARD AFTER THE +5 VDC RAIL IS DETECTED BY THE CPU. THE DC RAILS, INCLUDING THE +5 VDC RAIL, ARE ESTABLISHED WHEN THE SYSTEM ON COMMAND IS RECEIVED. REFER TO MD-0762. DATA LATCH U27 U49 BIT 7 BIT 3 GENERATOR CPU BOARD DRAWN G. SANWALD CHECKED________ DES.\MFG.\AUTH. HTW DATE 10 MAR 2000 ________ DC BUS & POWER DISTRIBUTION 10 MAR 2000 MD-0788 REV J PAGE 3 SHEET 3 OF 6 24 VDC RETURN K3 24 VDC F5 D3 C10 0V +5V J1-1 F3 18 VAC FROM PAGE 1, 2 K2 J1-4 D1 C16 0V F4 J1-7 F2 J1-9 F1 J16-8 -12V TP5 110 VAC U40 220 VAC 300 VAC BACKLIGHT POWER SUPPLY (Q7, Q8, T1, C57, ETC) J10-1 FLUORESCENT LAMP J10-4 LINE SYNC TO MD-0767 ZERO CROSS DETECTOR 220 VAC 220 VAC R4 +24V R78 TO RAD-ONLY CONSOLE (PAGE 5) CONSOLE BOARD (31 X 42 CM CONSOLE) -15V K1 -15V LCD DISPLAY ASSEMBLY TP6 110 VAC 19 TP7 -15 V REGULATOR -24V TP9 J16-3 +12V R6 U4 R5 220 VAC + 5 / -15VDC POWER SUPPLY & REGULATOR (U28, L1, D9-D13, ETC) F1 +12 V REGULATOR -12 V REGULATOR 18 VAC 110 VAC J5-15 CONSOLE BOARD & LCD DISPLAY ASSEMBLY SHOWN WITHIN DASHED LINES USED ON 31 X 42 CM CONSOLE ONLY. REFER TO PAGE 5 FOR 23 X 56 CM CONSOLE AND FOR RAD-ONLY CONSOLE. TP7 +5V TP2 TP3 U3 U2 J1-5 J4-15 +5V TP8 TP10 R3 +5 / +16VDC POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT (U47, Q4, T1, D17, D18, ETC.) F6 J1-3 J4-13 J5-13 REFER TO SYSTEM ON, MD-0762 TP11 R1 R81 J1-2 J5-14 TP1 U5 +15 V REGULATOR R2 TP13 TP13 18 VAC J5-12 J4-14 +15V +24V T2 J4-12 J2-1 J1-1 J2-3 J1-3 J2-6 J1-6 J2-7 J1-7 J2-8 J1-8 J2-9 J1-9 110 VAC +24VDC R7 DS1 D15 POWER ON ROOM INTERFACE BOARD +12V +12V K1 +24V +24V J10-13 J10-19 K2 J10-11 REFER TO SYSTEM ON, MD-0762 REFER TO MD-0757 (AEC) FOR PINOUTS OF THE DC RAIL CONNECTIONS ON THE AEC BOARD J10-16 J10-17 -12V -12V -24V -24V K3 +24V J17-3 GENERATOR INTERFACE BOARD J13-21 J13-23 J13-11 J13-13 J13-17 J3-6 J13-6 J3-1 J13-1 J3-8 J13-8 J3-5 J13-5 -15V +5V TP16 -12V J13-4 J13-7 DS38 DS37 TP18 TP21 J3-7 J11-1 DS33 J11-5 TO REMOTE FLUORO CONTROL, PAGE 5 TP20 J13-2 J3-4 +12V R89 -15V J3-2 +5V R75 R80 TP4 +24V +12V TP19 DS36 -15V +15V +15V +12V R85 -12V +5V TP17 R77 J13-15 THE DIGITAL I/O BOARD IS OPTIONAL WITH R&F GENERATORS REFER TO MD-0767 (DIGITAL INTERFACE) FOR PINOUTS OF THE DC RAIL CONNECTIONS SHOWN TO THE RIGHT OF THIS TEXT +5V J13-3 R76 -15V J3-3 -15V DS39 R90 +12V J13-9 +15V +15V +24V R86 +15V R81 +5V J17-4 R78 TO COIL OF POWER DISTRIBUTION RELAY (CUSTOMER SUPPLIED) MAXIMUM 100 MA AEC BOARD -12V GENERATOR CPU BOARD DIGITAL I/O BOARD DRAWN G. SANWALD CHECKED________ DES.\MFG.\AUTH. HTW DATE 10 MAR 2000 ________ DC BUS & POWER DISTRIBUTION 10 MAR 2000 MD-0788 REV J SHEET 4 OF 6 +12V +12V +5V U8 J11-1 P1-1 J11-5 P1-5 +5 V REGULATOR D4 +5V +12V GENERATOR CPU BOARD (FROM PAGE 4) +5V J1-17 J2-17 J1-18 J2-18 J1-15 J2-15 J1-19 J2-19 J1-20 J2-20 +12V REMOTE FLUORO DISPLAY BOARD REMOTE FLUORO CONTROL BOARD REMOTE FLUORO CONTROL OPTIONAL WITH INDICO 100 R&F GENERATORS J5-12 FROM GENERATOR INTERFACE BOARD (PAGE 4) +5V +5V REFER TO SYSTEM ON, MD-0762 J5-14 +5V TP2 J5-13 F1 J5-15 + 5 / -20VDC POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT (U30, Q5, T1, D7, D8, ETC.) J8-1 J1-1 J8-2 J1-2 J8-23 J1-23 U31 -12 V REGULATOR -12V J8-24 J1-24 J8-25 J1-25 J8-26 J1-26 CONSOLE DISPLAY BOARD U32 THESE ITEMS ARE USED ON THE 23 X 56 CM CONSOLE ONLY. 300 VAC BACKLIGHT POWER SUPPLY J10-1 -12V FLUORESCENT LAMP J10-5 CONSOLE CPU BOARD (23 x 56 CM CONSOLE) J16-3 J8-3 LCD DISPLAY ASSEMBLY +5V TP3 FROM GENERATOR INTERFACE BOARD (PAGE 4) TP7 TP2 J16-4 J8-8 F1 + 5 / -20VDC POWER SUPPLY CIRCUIT (U12, L1, D2, D3-D7, ETC.) TP8 +5V THESE ITEMS ARE USED ON THE “RAD-ONLY” CONSOLE ONLY. TP9 -20V 19 300 VAC BACKLIGHT POWER SUPPLY (Q1, Q2, T1, C36, ETC.) J5-1 FLUORESCENT LAMP J5-5 DRAWN CONSOLE BOARD (RAD-ONLY CONSOLE) LCD DISPLAY ASSEMBLY G. SANWALD CHECKED________ DES.\MFG.\AUTH. HTW DATE 10 MAR 2000 ________ DC BUS & POWER DISTRIBUTION 10 MAR 2000 MD-0788 REV J SHEET 5 OF 6 NOTE REFERENCE REMARKS 1 THIS VOLTAGE WILL BE APPROXIMATELY 0 VDC WHEN THE DC BUS CAPACITORS ARE NOT CHARGED. THIS WILL RISE TO APPROXIMATELY 6 VDC WHEN THE DC BUS CAPACITORS ARE FULLY CHARGED. 2 THE DC BUS CAPACITORS MUST CHARGE WITHIN APPROXIMATELY 0.25 SECONDS OF THE GENERATOR BEING SWITCHED ON. IF THE DC BUS CAPACITORS DO NOT CHARGE NORMALLY, THE SOFT START OK PROTECTION CIRCUIT ENERGIZES RELAY K1 (SEE # 4) AND INHIBITS OPERATION OF THE SOFT START DRIVER CIRCUIT (SEE # 3). 3 “LOW” (APPROXIMATELY 0 VDC) COMMANDS THE MAIN CONTACTOR K5 ON THE POWER INPUT BOARD TO CLOSE. “HIGH” (APPROXIMATELY 12 VDC) = CONTACTOR OPEN. THIS OUPUT WILL NOT SWITCH “LOW” IF THE DC BUS CAPACITORS ARE NOT CHARGED (SEE # 1 & 2). 4 K1 REMAINS DE-ENERGIZED (CONTACTS AS SHOWN) IF NO SOFT-START FAULT IS DETECTED. THEREFORE, K1 AND K2 ON THE POWER INPUT BOARD WILL ENERGIZE WHEN THE GENERATOR IS SWITCHED ON. A SOFT-START FAULT ENERGIZES K1 ON THE AUXILIARY BOARD, DE-ENERGIZING K1 ON THE POWER INPUT BOARD. THIS WILL INHIBIT FURTHER DC BUS CHARGING. 5 “LOW” (APPROXIMATELY 0 VDC) = TUBE 2 SELECTED, “HIGH” (APPROXIMATELY 12 VDC) = TUBE 1 SELECTED. “LOW” (APPROXIMATELY 0 VDC) = FLUORO FAN(S) ON, “HIGH” (APPROXIMATELY 12 VDC) = FLUORO FAN(S) OFF. FAN(S) ARE SWITCHED ON DURING PULSED OR CONTINUOUS FLUORO OPERATION, AND REMAIN ON FOR APPROXIMATELY 20 MINUTES AFTER SWITCHING TO RAD MODE. “LOW” INDICATES CONTACTOR CLOSED (SEE # 3). THE CONTACTOR CLOSED SIGNAL OCCURS APPROXIMATELY 10 SECONDS AFTER INITIAL GENERATOR TURN-ON, ASSUMING NORMAL DC BUS CHARGING. “HIGH” (APPROXIMATELY 12 VDC) = RAD / PULSED FLUORO MODE. “LOW” (APPROXIMATELY 0 VDC) = CONTINUOUS FLUORO MODE. USED ON R&F GENERATORS ONLY. “HIGH” (APPROXIMATELY 12 VDC) = PULSED FLUORO / LOW POWER MODE. “LOW” (APPROXIMATELY 0 VDC) = HIGH POWER RAD MODE. NOT USED ON ALL MODELS, REFER TO MD-0786 FOR DETAILS. 24 VDC (APPROXIMATELY) ENERGIZES K1 AND / OR K2 ON THE POWER INPUT BOARD, INITIATING THE POWER-ON SEQUENCE. SEE # 4. “HIGH” (APPROXIMATELY 5 VDC) = TUBE 2 SELECTED. “LOW” (APPROXIMATELY 0 VDC) = TUBE 1 SELECTED. “HIGH” (APPROXIMATELY 5 VDC) = RAD / PULSED FLUORO MODE. “LOW” (APPROXIMATELY 0 VDC) = CONTINUOUS FLUORO MODE. USED ON R&F GENERATORS ONLY. “HIGH” (APPROXIMATELY 5 VDC) = PULSED FLUORO / LOW POWER MODE. “LOW” (APPROXIMATELY 0 VDC) = HIGH POWER RAD MODE. NOT USED ON ALL MODELS, REFER TO MD-0786 FOR DETAILS. DS9 LIT = CONTACTOR CLOSED, DS10 LIT = CONTACTOR NOT CLOSED. DS34 LIT = GENERATOR ON COMMAND ISSUED (CONSOLE PASSED ALL SELF TESTS). DS35 LIT = GENERATOR ON COMMAND NOT ISSUED (DURING CONSOLE SELF TESTS, OR IF SELF TESTS FAILED). 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 DS22 LIT = FLUORO SELECTED, DS23 LIT = RAD SELECTED. DS2 LIT = PULSED FLUORO / LOW POWER MODE. DS4 LIT = HIGH POWER RAD MODE. SEE # 13. D1 LIT INDICATES + OR - 12 VDC FAULT, OR SOFT START FAULT. THE VOLTAGE WAVEFORM AT THIS TEST POINT IS DEPICTED IN FIGURE 1 BELOW. 18 s 4V FIGURE 1 -8 V DRAWN G. SANWALD CHECKED________ DES.\MFG.\AUTH. HTW DATE 10 MAR 2000 ________ DC BUS & POWER DISTRIBUTION 10 MAR 2000 MD-0788 REV J SHEET 6 OF 6 24 VDC RETURN T2 F5 D3 J17-2 J17-1 + 24 VDC * S3 Q1 Q2 R15 24 VDC SUPPLY FOR SYSTEM ON/OFF. SEE MD-0788, PAGE 4 LOCKOUT NORMAL D4 S1 OFF K3 D16 K2 31 X 42 CM CONSOLE J3-3 J5-10 J4-10 P1-2 J3-2 J5-11 J4-11 R13 Q3 P1-3 DS1 ON S2 ON K1 3 OFF P1-1 J3-1 J5-12 J4-12 JW1 23 X 56 CM CONSOLE CONSOLE BOARD KEYBOARD ASSEMBLY ON P1-3 J2-3 J3-9 J6-9 J5-10 J4-10 1 P1-2 J2-2 J3-7 J6-7 J5-11 J4-11 2 P1-1 J2-1 J3-5 J6-5 J5-12 J4-12 REFER TO DC BUS & POWER DISTRIBUTION, MD-0788, PAGE 4 3 2 1 JUMPER POSITION: TO ENERGIZE K1 ONLY WHEN THE CONSOLE IS SWITCHED ON JUMPER JW1 PINS 1-2 TO ENERGIZE K1 AT ALL TIMES THAT THE GENERATOR AC MAINS IS ON JUMPER JW1 PINS 2-3 (K1 SWITCHES THE 110 & 220 VAC SUPPLIES TO THE ROOM INTERFACE BOARD) OFF KEYBOARD ASSEMBLY RAD-ONLY CONSOLE DISPLAY BOARD ON CONSOLE CPU BOARD P1-16 J7-16 J8-7 J16-7 P1-15 J7-15 J8-6 J16-6 P1-17 J7-17 J8-3 J16-3 OFF CONSOLE BOARD KEYBOARD ASSEMBLY GENERATOR INTERFACE BOARD USE DRAWING DC BUS & POWER DISTRIBUTION, MD-0788, IN CONJUNCTION WITH THIS DOCUMENT TOUCH SCREEN CONSOLE P1-2 J5-2 J2-10 J4-10 * TO CONNECT AN EMERGENCY-OFF SWITCH, REMOVE JUMPER FROM J17-1 TO J17-2. THEN CONNECT THE EMERGENCY OFF SWITCH TO J17-1 AND J17-2. ON P1-3 J5-3 J2-11 J4-11 P1-4 J5-4 J2-12 J4-12 OFF KEYPAD ASSEMBLY TOUCH SCREEN INTERFACE BOARD DRAWN G. SANWALD CHECKED_________ DATE 02 JUN 2000 _________ DES.\MFG.\AUTH. L. FOSKIN 02 JUN 2000 SYSTEM ON MD-0762 REV E SHEET 1 OF 2 NOTE REFERENCE REMARKS 1 MOMENTARILY PRESSING ON CONNECTS THIS LINE TO “24 VDC RETURN”. THIS LATCHES RELAY DRIVERS ON THE GENERATOR INTERFACE BOARD, ENERGIZING K2 AND K3, AND POSSIBLY K1 (DEPENDING ON JW1 SETTING). SEE NOTE ADJACENT TO JW1 ON THIS DOCUMENT. 2 MOMENTARILY PRESSING OFF CONNECTS THIS LINE TO “24 VDC RETURN”. THIS UNLATCHES RELAY DRIVERS ON THE GENERATOR INTERFACE BOARD, DE-ENERGIZING K2 AND K3, AND POSSIBLY K1 (DEPENDING ON JW1 SETTING). 3 DS1 LIT INDICATES THE PRESENCE OF THE 24 VDC SUPPLY SHOWN. THIS 24 VDC SUPPLY WILL BE PRESENT IF THE GENERATOR IS CONNECTED TO A LIVE AC MAINS SUPPLY. DRAWN G. SANWALD CHECKED_________ DATE 02 JUN 2000 _________ DES.\MFG.\AUTH. L. FOSKIN 02 JUN 2000 SYSTEM ON MD-0762 REV E SHEET 2 OF 2 +24V NOTE * TABLE STEPPER INPUT BUCKY CONTACTS TB1-5 J2-15 J9-15 TB1-4 J2-16 J9-16 4 TB2-5 J2-13 J9-13 TB2-4 J2-14 J9-14 TB2-7 J2-11 J9-11 +24V TB2-6 J2-12 3 2 J2-24 J9-24 TB3-4 J2-25 J9-25 3 1 JW10 1 5 2 4 2 JW9 1 R53 R55 R66 J9-12 TB3-5 4 NOTE * 1 5 2 4 1 JW7 1 5 U7, U12, U18, U19, U25 U21 R54 4 2 U31 R56 +24V U29 R67 REMOTE TOMO SELECT 2 +24V NOTE * 4 COLLIMATOR INTERLOCK 3 NOTE * 4 3 2 1 JW2 SEE MD-0761 D0 J12-1 J6-1 D1 J12-2 J6-2 D2 J12-3 J6-3 D3 J12-4 J6-4 D4 J12-5 J6-5 D5 J12-6 J6-6 D6 J12-7 J6-7 D7 J12-8 J6-8 R23 TOMO EXPOSURE TB3-7 J2-22 J9-22 TB3-6 J2-23 J9-23 TB4-4 J2-21 J9-21 U8 U10 R21 ROOM DOOR INTERLOCK +24V U14 TB4-5 R29 J2-20 R38 4 2 1 5 2 4 J9-20 R34 R36 TB4-7 4 U13 3 J2-19 T2 FROM MD-0787 J9-19 R33 2 +24V R32 TB4-8 THERMAL SWITCH 1 +24V NOTE * +24V TB4-6 THERMAL SWITCH 2 5 1 JW3 1 5 BUFFER, DRIVER AND ADDRESS DECODER CIRCUITS U9 R22 U16 1 4 2 R37 TB4-9 T1 FROM MD-0787 MULTIPLE SPOT EXPOSURE I.I. SAFETY TB5-12 J2-17 J9-17 TB5-11 J2-18 J9-18 TB6-4 J2-9 J9-9 TB6-3 J2-10 J9-10 +24V NOTE * +24V 4 NOTE * 3 2 R35 4 3 2 JW8 1 1 JW6 1 5 2 4 U20 J2-8 TB6-5 REMOTE FLUORO EXPOSURE REMOTE PREP +24V J9-8 TB6-6 J2-7 J9-7 TB6-8 J2-5 J9-5 TB6-7 J2-6 J9-6 R68 ** U30, U42, U44 R70 R71 1 5 2 4 R52 U27 R69 DATA BUS DO..D7 +24V NOTE * REMOTE EXPOSURE TB6-10 J2-3 J9-3 TB6-9 J2-4 J9-4 4 TP14 J2-1 J2-2 +24V NOTE * 4 J9-1 J9-2 3 2 R77 R76 JW15 1 3 1 JW14 1 5 2 4 2 R75 U28 R74 ** U41, U43 ROOM INTERFACE BOARD GENERATOR INTERFACE BOARD THIS PAGE SHOWS THE ROOM INTERFACE INPUTS. ROOM INTERFACE OUTPUTS ARE SHOWN ON PAGE 2 ** ADDITIONAL CIRCUITS ARE USED IN THE AREAS INDICATED **. THESE CIRCUITS ARE NOT RELEVANT TO THIS ROOM INTERFACE DIAGRAM, HOWEVER, THEY ARE PART OF THE X-RAY EXPOSURE FUNCTION AND ARE SHOWN ON MD-0761 * 24 VDC EXTERNAL INPUT POSITION FOR JW2, JW3, JW6, JW7, JW8, JW9, JW10, JW14, JW15 SHOWN. JUMPER CONNECTS PINS 2-3; 24 VDC APPLIED EXTERNALLY ACTIVATES THE INPUT(S) BY ENERGIZING THE APPROPRIATE OPTO-COUPLER. GENERATOR CPU BOARD * DRY CONTACT INPUT POSITION FOR JW2, JW3, JW6, JW7, JW8, JW9, JW10, JW14, JW15 SHOWN. JUMPER CONNECTS PINS 1-2 AND 3-4; AN EXTERNAL DRY CONTACT CLOSURE ACTIVATES THE INPUT(S) BY ENERGIZING THE APPROPRIATE OPTO-COUPLER. DRAWN G. SANWALD CHECKED S. BLAKE DES.\MFG.\AUTH. L. FOSKIN DATE 13 APR 2000 14 APR 2000 ROOM INTERFACE 13 APR 2000 MD-0763 REV C SHEET 1 OF 2 FOR +24 VDC SOURCE, REFER TO MD-0788, PAGE 4, ON GENERATOR INTERFACE BOARD +24V +24V C2 U6, U7, U11, U12 U24, U25, U34 DRIVE 1 J9-40 J2-40 J9-39 J2-39 J9-30 J2-30 TB1-2 JW12 R2 K1 TB1-1 C1 K1 JW1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 DRIVE 2 TB1-11 JW9 R1 K2 DRY * LIVE * J9-29 TOMO / BUCKY 4 SELECT TB1-12 J2-29 BUCKY 3 SELECT K2 TB11 J9-28 DRIVE 3 J6-1 J12-1 J2-28 K6 K3 D0 K3 K4 J9-27 DRIVE 4 J6-2 J12-2 J12-3 K1 K4 D1 J9-34 DRIVE 5 J6-3 J2-27 K2 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 DRY * LIVE * 2 3 C3 4 TB2-2 JW11 R3 K3 5 TB2-1 BUCKY 2 SELECT C4 J2-34 220 VAC K5 D2 JW2 1 JW3 1 2 3 4 TB10 5 6 7 8 TB2-11 JW10 R4 K4 DRY * LIVE * TB2-12 BUCKY 1 SELECT 1 J9-32 DRIVE 6 J6-4 J6-5 J12-4 J12-5 J2-32 D3 D4 ADDRESS DECODERS, BUFFER, REGISTER, AND DRIVER CIRCUITS TB3-1 2 K6 3 JW4 J2-31 3 4 5 6 7 K5 8 TB3-12 JW14 C6 J2-35 1 J6-7 J12-7 J2-36 3 K9 D6 JW5 1 2 3 4 J9-37 J6-8 J12-8 5 6 7 8 TB4-1 K10 24 VDC TB8 J9-38 DRIVE 11 J2-38 DATA BUS DO..D7 2 3 J9-33 J2-33 J9-26 NOTE THE FOLLOWING IF USING JW1, JW2, JW3, JW4, OR JW5 IN THE LIVE CONTACT POSITION: +24V JW6 1 2 3 K9 4 K13 TUBE 1 / TUBE 2 INDICATOR (COMM) TUBE 1 INDICATOR TUBE 2 INDICATOR TB5-4 MAG 3 TB5-3 DRY ** K10 LIVE 24 VDC ** TB5-7 TB5-6 5 MAG 2 TB5-5 J2-26 DRIVE 1 TO DRIVE 13 = “LOW” ENERGIZES THE RELAYS ROOM LIGHT TB5-2 4 K12 DRIVE 13 TB4-2 A JUMPER WIRE MUST BE CONNECTED TO TB11 PIN 1, 2, 3, 4 OR 5 AS APPROPRIATE FROM TB8, TB9, OR TB10 IN ORDER TO SUPPLY 24 VDC, 110 VAC, OR 220 VAC FROM THE SELECTED OUTPUT 1 K11 DRIVE 12 TB4-3 K7 J2-37 D7 TB4-12 DRY * LIVE * 4 5 DRIVE 10 K8 JW13 2 J9-36 DRIVE 9 TOMO / BUCKY START TB4-11 C5 K6 R5 D5 R6 TB9 K8 COLLIMATOR BYPASS TB3-11 K7 J9-35 TB3-2 DRY * LIVE * 5 110 VAC J12-6 2 4 J9-31 DRIVE 7 DRIVE 8 J6-6 1 TB5-8 K12 TB7 1 K11 +24V 2 TB5-10 MAG 1 TB5-9 3 JW7 4 K13 1 2 3 +24V DRY ** 5 TB5-1 4 TB6-1 LIVE 24 VDC ** JW8 1 2 3 TB6-2 4 ALE OUTPUT TB6-11 DRY ** GENERATOR CPU BOARD GENERATOR INTERFACE BOARD THIS PAGE SHOWS THE ROOM INTERFACE OUTPUTS. ROOM INTERFACE INPUTS ARE SHOWN ON PAGE 1 ROOM INTERFACE BOARD * LIVE CONTACT DRY CONTACT DRY CONTACT POSITION FOR JW1 TO JW5 SHOWN. JUMPER CONNECTS PINS 4-6 LIVE CONTACT DRY CONTACT LIVE CONTACT POSITION FOR JW1 TO JW5 SHOWN. JUMPER CONNECTS PINS 6-8 TB6-12 LIVE 24 VDC ** ** LIVE CONTACT 24VDC SPARE OUTPUT LIVE CONTACT 24VDC DRAWN DRY CONTACT DRY CONTACT DRY CONTACT POSITION FOR JW6 TO JW8 SHOWN. JUMPER CONNECTS PINS 2-3 LIVE CONTACT 24VDC POSITION FOR JW6 TO JW8 SHOWN. JUMPERS CONNECT PINS 1-2 AND 3-4 G. SANWALD CHECKED S. BLAKE DES.\MFG.\AUTH. L. FOSKIN DATE 13 APR 2000 14 APR 2000 ROOM INTERFACE 13 APR 2000 MD-0763 REV C SHEET 2 OF 2 +24V +24V 2 4 1 5 U22 5 2 4 2 4 LAST IMAGE HOLD CIRCUIT (U39, C30, ETC.) REMOTE FLUORO EXPOSURE INPUT TP5 TP6 +5V +5V J5-6 J4-6 J5-7 J4-7 J5-8 J4-8 R19 1 FROM RAD-ONLY CONSOLE (PAGE 3) U15 R25 2 4 1 5 2 4 ADDRESS DECODER, DATA LATCH, AND DRIVER 1 5 U18, U25 2 4 U37 R18 2 J13-7 R72 COM CPU 1 5 2 4 U46 RN14C J12-5 J6-5 RN14D 5 U25, U12, U7 BUFFER AND ADDRESS DECODER J12-7 J6-7 RN14B J6-4 RN14E 4 J12-4 5 KV CONTROL REFER TO MD-0759 5 1 4 2 4 5 3 2 JW15 1 SEE NOTE 1 1 J9-3 U26 4 MA CONTROL REFER TO MD-0760 R77 2 J9-4 J13-9 1 5 2 4 1 5 2 4 U25, U12, U7 U43 X-RAY TO 2.1 V CURRENT SINK +24V U25 HAND SWITCH DS41 U28 1 U24 4 PREP DS42 4 +24V J16-4 J16-5 FOOT SWITCH 5 R102 R121 J4-9 BUFFER AND ADDRESS DECODER J16-3 5 J6-6 U18, U25 +24V U38 U18 DATA BUS D0..D7 J12-6 2 R20 +5V CPU EXP SWT 4 2 R70 +5V +12V SEE NOTE 1 J5-9 R120 J9-8 U30 R119 R118 R113 1 EXPOSURE ENABLE COMMAND FROM MD-0767, PAGE 1 BUFFER AND ADDRESS DECODER (U18, U25) 5 R24 TP4 EXPOSURE ENABLE COMMAND TO J10-35 (PAGE 2) 3 ADDRESS DECODER, DATA LATCH, AND DRIVER 4 1 J6-17 U25, U12, U7 U42 2 J12-17 U32 U44 REFER TO PAGE 4 FOR LOGIC LEVELS, NOTES, ETC, REFERENCED BY HEXAGONAL SYMBOL: 1 R92 5 5 R82 1 1 RN19B NOTE: THE PORTION OF THE REMOTE FLUORO EXPOSURE, REMOTE EXPOSURE, AND REMOTE TOMO SELECT INPUTS SHOWN WITHIN THE DASHED OUTLINES IS DETAILED ON MD-0763, PAGE 1 R39, R57 1. J13-3 REMOTE EXPOSURE INPUT J13-1 R76 J13-5 J3-18 CONSOLE BOARD J3-19 ADDRESS DECODER, DATA LATCH, AND DRIVER J12-5 RN14D J6-5 4 BUFFER AND ADDRESS DECODER (U18, U25) U41 J3-20 +24V 4 P1-18 3 2 JW2 1 SEE NOTE 1 RN14A J9-24 P1-19 PREP THE CONSOLE BOARD & KEYBOARD ASSEMBLY SHOWN ON THIS PAGE IS USED ON THE 31 X 42 CM CONSOLE ONLY. REFER TO PAGE 3 FOR THE 23 X 56 CM CONSOLE AND THE RAD-ONLY CONSOLE, AND PAGE 4 FOR THE TOUCH SCREEN CONSOLE. R23 J9-25 1 5 X-RAY P1-20 KEYBOARD ASSEMBLY 2 4 REMOTE TOMO SELECT INPUT 1 5 R21 2 J6-8 U25, U12, U7 U8 ADDRESS DECODER, DATA LATCH, AND DRIVER DATA BUS D0..D7 J12-8 BUFFER AND ADDRESS DECODER (U18, U25) GENERATOR CPU BOARD 4 DRAWN U10 G. SANWALD CHECKED S. BLAKE DES.\MFG.\AUTH. 4 GENERATOR INTERFACE BOARD L. FOSKIN DATE 26 APR 2000 26 APR 00 26 APR 2000 X-RAY EXPOSURE RAD/FLUORO MD-0761 REV G SHEET 1 OF 4 TUBE 1 / TUBE 2 MISMATCH & THERMOSTAT OPEN SIGNAL FROM MD-0787 13 J1-4 GRN 6 R174 RN11D DS31 RED TO 2.1 V CURRENT SINK DS27 GRN 7 U27 D19 +5V 14 DS26 X-RAY DS28 9 5 2 4 RN5E J1-33 RN2A J3-9 J9-7 J3-7 H.T. TANK +12V U19, U16 D21 TP18 J10-15 J1-15 “PREP ENABLED” DETECTOR CKT (U11B, U10C, ETC) RN1C 5 1 11 12 J1-34 RN4B “GENERATOR READY” DETECTOR CIRCUIT (U10A, Q6, D37, ETC) J10-16 J1-3 D25 4 2 RN1D PREP COMMAND TO MD-0764 & MD-0765 D24 U2 18 J1-22 CONTINUED ON PAGE 3 R133 Q12 J10-35 +/- 12V/SS FAULT FROM MD-0788, PAGE 3 (CONTROL BOARD) J1-16 RN1H 1 5 “X-RAY REQUEST” DETECTOR CKT (U11D, RN7, ETC) FILAMENT FAULT FROM MD-0760, PAGE 1 STATOR FAULT FROM MD-0764 & MD-0765 U5 J1-35 RN1F 2 4 HIGH KV / INVERTER FAULT FROM MD-0759, PAGE 1 & HIGH MA FAULT FROM MD-0760, PAGE 2 16 HV / MA FAULT TO MD-0760, PAGE 1 TP12 RN1G 1 5 2 4 U3 RN1E GENERATOR CPU BOARD J9-9 ENABLE COMMAND TO MD-0764 15 J10-33 J10-34 EXPOSURE ENABLE COMMAND FROM PAGE 1 RESET COMMAND TO MD-0759, PAGE 1 & MD-0760, PAGE 2 10 BUFFER AND DRIVER DATA BUS D0..D7 12 U4 J10-14 RED DATA LATCH 1 “KV ENABLED” DETECTOR CKT (U11A, RN8, ETC) RN2B 8 TO 2.1 V CURRENT SINK U33F 13 TP10 J1-14 YEL PREP R173 RN2F DS30 KV EN +12V J8-4 +5V RN11C RN11B +5V AUXILIARY BOARD “X-RAY REQUEST” DETECTOR CKT (U10D, RN7, ETC) TP14 LOGIC “OR / NOR” CIRCUITS (U10B, U14, Q4, Q13, D91, ETC) 17 DRIVE ENABLE COMMAND TO MD-0759, PAGE 1 CONTROL BOARD DRAWN G. SANWALD CHECKED S. BLAKE DES.\MFG.\AUTH. L. FOSKIN DATE 26 APR 2000 26 APR 00 26 APR 2000 X-RAY EXPOSURE RAD/FLUORO MD-0761 REV G SHEET 2 OF 4 +5V P/S READY DS17 OPTO-COUPLER “ON” = GENERATOR READY J1-3 FROM PAGE 2 J1-22 J5-6 TO 2.1 V CURRENT SINK J5-7 U24 J5-8 1 5 2 4 5 1 U14 U6 J10-22 5 1 BUFFER J10-3 R9 RED R8 GRN 19 1 DS18 R10 RN7D +5V 4 5 2 4 J4-7 J4-8 U10 U12 2 1 J4-6 4 2 J5-9 U3 TO GENERATOR INTERFACE BOARD (PG 1) J4-9 BUFFER DATA BUS D0..D7 CONTROL BOARD 5 GENERATOR CPU BOARD 5 1 U21 1 4 4 2 5 1 4 2 U11 U13 2 DATA BUS D0..D7 1 TP12 +5V TB1-1 TP13 J8-4 +5V J8-5 R66 R67 J8-3 J16-4 J16-5 J16-3 TO GENERATOR INTERFACE BOARD (PG 1) FOOT SWITCH PREP U17 HAND SWITCH X-RAY TB1-2 TB1-3 TB1-4 CPU COM 5 DATA BUS D0..D7 PREP HAND SWITCH X-RAY 1 U9 5 1 4 2 TB1-5 J6-6 CONSOLE CPU BOARD J6-8 J6-10 U10 4 2 P1-18 J2-18 J3-6 P1-19 J2-19 J3-8 P1-20 J2-20 J3-10 J3-3 PREP J3-1 X-RAY COM J3-5 J7-3 CONSOLE CPU BOARD J7-2 J7-1 KEYBOARD ASSEMBLY CIRCUITS SHOWN WITHIN DASHED LINES ARE USED ON THE 23 X 56 CM CONSOLE ONLY. DISPLAY BOARD P1-3 P1-2 PREP X-RAY DRAWN P1-1 KEYBOARD ASSEMBLY CIRCUITS SHOWN WITHIN DASHED LINES ARE USED ON RAD-ONLY CONSOLE. G. SANWALD CHECKED S. BLAKE DES.\MFG.\AUTH. L. FOSKIN DATE 26 APR 2000 26 APR 00 26 APR 2000 X-RAY EXPOSURE RAD/FLUORO MD-0761 REV G SHEET 3 OF 4 PREP P1-6 J5-6 J3-7 P1-7 J5-7 J2-8 P1-5 J5-5 J2-9 J4-7 J4-8 X-RAY TO GENERATOR INTERFACE BOARD (PG 1) J4-9 KEYPAD ASSEMBLY PREP HAND SWITCH CIRCUITS SHOWN WITHIN DASHED LINES ARE USED ON THE TOUCH SCREEN CONSOLE ONLY. NOTE REFERENCE X-RAY COM J3-3 J3-1 J3-5 TOUCH SCREEN INTERFACE BOARD REMARKS 1 “LOW” (APPROXIMATELY 1 VDC) AT THESE POINTS INDICATES FOOT SWITCH INPUT CLOSED, PREP SWITCH PRESSED, OR X-RAY SWITCH PRESSED RESPECTIVELY. “HIGH” (APPROXIMATELY 24 VDC) = OPEN CIRCUIT (I.E. NOT PRESSED) FOOT SWITCH, OR PREP SWITCH, OR X-RAY SWITCH. FOR RAD-ONLY CONSOLE, “LOW” INDICATES PREP SWITCH PRESSED, OR X-RAY SWITCH PRESSED, RESPECTIVELY. 2 3 “LOW” (APPROXIMATELY 1 VDC) = AN X-RAY EXPOSURE HAS BEEN REQUESTED VIA ONE OF SEVERAL EXPOSURE INPUTS. “HIGH” (APPROXIMATELY 24 VDC) = NO X-RAY EXPOSURE HAS BEEN REQUESTED. EXPOSURE ENABLE LINE. “LOW” (APPROXIMATELY 0 VDC) INDICATES AN X-RAY EXPOSURE REQUEST, “HIGH” (APPROXIMATELY 5 VDC) = NO X-RAY EXPOSURE HAS BEEN REQUESTED. 4 THE CATHODE OF THE ASSOCIATED LED IS HELD “LOW” UNDER CPU CONTROL DURING AN X-RAY EXPOSURE REQUEST ONLY. NO MEANINGFUL MEASUREMENTS CAN BE MADE ON THIS LINE AS THIS IS A DATA LINE. THE REQUIRED DATA IS LATCHED BY THE REGISTER CIRCUIT(S) AT THE APPROPRIATE TIME. 5 THE OUTPUT OF THE ASSOCIATED LED IS LATCHED BY A REGISTER. THIS IS THEN READ BY THE DATA BUS AT THE APPROPRIATE TIME. AS THIS IS A DATA LINE, NO MEANINGFUL MEASUREMENTS CAN BE MADE AT THIS CONNECTION. 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 DS30 LIT = KV ENABLE REQUEST SENT. THIS IS NECESSARY TO MAKE AN X-RAY EXPOSURE. DS31 LIT = KV ENABLE NOT REQUESTED. DS27 LIT = PREP REQUEST SENT. DS28 LIT = PREP NOT REQUESTED. DS26 LIT = X-RAY EXPOSURE IN PROCESS. “HIGH” (APPROXIMATELY 5 VDC) = KV ENABLED, “LOW” (APPROXIMATELY 0 VDC) = KV NOT ENABLED. “HIGH” (APPROXIMATELY 5 VDC) = PREP REQUESTED. “LOW” (APPROXIMATELY 0 VDC) = PREP NOT REQUESTED. “HIGH” (APPROXIMATELY 5 VDC) = X-RAY REQUESTED. “LOW” (APPROXIMATELY 0 VDC) = X-RAY NOT REQUESTED. “LOW” = X-RAY EXPOSURE REQUESTED AS PER # 3. THIS LINE MUST BE “LOW” IN ORDER FOR THE X-RAY EXPOSURE LED’S ON THE CONTROL BOARD TO BE ENERGIZED (SEE # 16). “LOW” = (APPROXIMATELY 0 VDC) = TUBE 1 / TUBE 2 MISMATCH OR THERMOSTAT OPEN FAULT. “HIGH” (APPROXIMATELY 12 VDC) = NO FAULT. “HIGH” (APPROXIMATELY 12 VDC) = KV ENABLED, “LOW” (APPROXIMATELY 0 VDC) = KV NOT ENABLED. “HIGH” (APPROXIMATELY 12 VDC) = PREP REQUESTED, “LOW” (APPROXIMATELY 0 VDC) = PREP NOT REQUESTED. “HIGH” (APPROXIMATELY 12 VDC) = X-RAY REQUESTED, “LOW” (APPROXIMATELY 0 VDC) = X-RAY NOT REQUESTED. “HIGH” (APPROXIMATELY 5 VDC) = OUTPUT DRIVE ENABLED, “LOW” (APPROXIMATELY 0 VDC) = OUTPUT DRIVE DISABLED. 18 ALL INPUTS TO THE “GENERATOR READY DETECTOR CIRCUIT” MUST BE AT THE CORRECT LOGIC LEVEL IN ORDER TO BE ABLE TO MAKE AN X-RAY EXPOSURE. THIS MEANS ALL FOUR FAULT INPUTS SHOWN MUST BE CLEARED, AND THE KV ENABLE AND PREP COMMANDS MUST BE PRESENT. 19 DS17 LIT INDICATES GENERATOR READY TO MAKE AN EXPOSURE. THIS REQUIRES THAT ALL CONDITIONS PER # 18 BE SATISFIED. DS18 LIT INDICATES A “GENERATOR READY DETECTOR CIRCUIT” INPUT IS NOT SATISFIED TO ENABLE AN X-RAY EXPOSURE. DRAWN G. SANWALD CHECKED S. BLAKE DES.\MFG.\AUTH. L. FOSKIN DATE 26 APR 2000 26 APR 00 26 APR 2000 X-RAY EXPOSURE RAD/FLUORO MD-0761 REV G SHEET 4 OF 4 TP9 TP8 J1-31 R89 7 + U16A +12V D80 R208 HIGH KV DETECTOR AND LATCH (U31, U32A, U33A) HV ON DETECTOR CIRCUIT (U30C U30D, Q6, ETC) JW3 125kV 150kV “OR” LOGIC JUMPER POSITION: 125kV GENERATORS JUMPER “125kV” 150 kV GENERATORS JUMPER “150kV” R25 1 - 1 J10-7 J1-7 3+ J1-26 R25, R44 D93 CATHODE OVERVOLTAGE SIGNAL TO MD-0760, PG 2 R220 INVERTER 1 FAULT LATCH & LOGIC INVERTER (U39B, U35F) INVERTER 1 FAULT DETECTOR (T3, U36, D83, ETC) INVERTER 2 FAULT LATCH & LOGIC INVERTER (U39C, U35E) INVERTER 2 FAULT DETECTOR (T4, U37, D84, ETC) INVERTER 3 FAULT LATCH & LOGIC INVERTER (U39D, U35D) INVERTER 3 FAULT DETECTOR (T5, U38, D85, ETC) J14-1 J14-3 J15-1 INVERTER FAULT SIGNALS FROM PAGE 2 J15-3 J16-1 J16-3 4 1 R71 ERROR AMPLIFIERS INCLUDES U13B, U21A R70 U13A - R106 D49 - D35 R107 65+ + + U13B R43 U21A R175 7 VCO INCLUDES U19, U20, U23, U25, U27, Q10 U21B R108 +12V ANODE OVERVOLTAGE SIGNAL TO MD-0760, PG 2 TP17 TP19 D48 2- J10-26 D92 +5V R26, R45 U14A J9-8 R50 U12B R132 2 3+ 6 5 INV 1 R46 U24A 2 1 U26A 3 2 DRIVE PULSES CONTINUED ON PAGE 2 U26B U24B 5 4 7 6 4 5 D66 D70 DATA BUS D0..D7 Ir R62 3 2 + - D27-D30 R66 U15 R64 7 R63 HIGH RESONANT CURRENT LATCH & LOGIC INVERTER (U32D, U33D) CURRENT SENSE R65 D/A CONVERTER KV FEEDBACK SIGNAL FROM PAGE 3 D87-D89, U35C D86 U22 + D82 INV 2 11 kV D63 TP2 7 +12V D81 INV 3 D69 U33E TP26 +12V R172 10 3 R69 R221 RESET COMMAND FROM MD-0761, PG 2 J9-5 J9-7 R54 R23 HV ON SIGNAL TO MD-0767, PG 1 A/D CONVERTER 5 U16B HIGH KV / INVERTER FAULT TO GENERATOR READY DETECTOR CIRCUIT ON CONTROL BOARD, SEE MD-0761, PG 2 +12V U37 6 R171 RN2B - R48 2 3 R180 J10-12 J9-6 R49 U12A R37 - 1 2 3 R52 R24 J1-12 + 3 U15A RN4B J10-31 R67 R72 RN2A R91 R210 + 2 + R209 R31 - 1 - 1 R215 RN4A R68 R42 R26 5 U15B R35 + 6 R36 - R41 TP6 TP8 7 R53 2 2 T1 T2 DRIVE ENABLE COMMAND FROM MD-0761, PAGE 2 -12V GENERATOR CPU BOARD CONTROL BOARD J13-4 J13-1 H.T. PRIMARY CURRENT SENSE FROM PAGE 2 DRAWN G. SANWALD CHECKED S. BLAKE DES.\MFG.\AUTH. L. FOSKIN DATE 18 MAY 2000 18 MAY 2000 18 MAY 2000 KV CONTROL & FEEDBACK MD-0759 REV C SHEET 1 OF 4 E1: 560 / 650 VDC (+) J2-1 J2-3 J10-1 J1-1 J10-2 J1-2 J10-3 J1-3 J10-4 J1-4 * USED ON R&F GENERATORS ONLY TO J14-1 TO J14-3 K1 * REFER TO MD-0786 FOR K1 DRIVE CIRCUITS INVERTER FAULT SIGNAL, TO PAGE 1 MOSFET SWITCHES MOSFET SWITCHES E3 MOSFET SWITCHES MOSFET SWITCHES * E4 INVERTER BOARD #1 E2: 560 / 650 VDC (-) E1: 560 / 650 VDC (+) J2-1 J2-3 GATE DRIVE CIRCUIT FOR MOSFET INVERTER (INCLUDES Q19 TO Q26) J11-1 J1-1 J11-2 J1-2 TO J15-1 TO J15-3 INVERTER FAULT SIGNAL, TO PAGE 1 MOSFET SWITCHES MOSFET SWITCHES H.T. PRIMARY CURRENT CONTINUED ON PAGE 3 E3 J11-3 J1-3 J11-4 J1-4 MOSFET SWITCHES MOSFET SWITCHES E4 INVERTER BOARD #2 E2: 560 / 650 VDC (-) E1: 560 / 650 VDC (+) J2-1 J2-3 J12-1 J12-2 J12-3 J12-4 DRIVE PULSES FROM PAGE 2 J1-1 POWER MODE SELECT BOARD (REFER TO MD-0786) J1-2 TO J16-1 TO J16-3 INVERTER FAULT SIGNAL, TO PAGE 1 MOSFET SWITCHES MOSFET SWITCHES E3 J1-3 J1-4 MOSFET SWITCHES MOSFET SWITCHES E4 CONTROL BOARD INVERTER BOARD #3 E2: 560 / 650 VDC (-) INDICO 100 GENERATORS USE ONE, TWO, OR THREE INVERTER MODULES DEPENDING ON GENERATOR OUTPUT POWER RESONANT BOARD H.T. PRIMARY CURRENT SENSE, TO PAGE 1 J1-1 J1-4 TO J13-1 TO J13-4 DRAWN G. SANWALD CHECKED S. BLAKE DES.\MFG.\AUTH. L. FOSKIN DATE 18 MAY 2000 18 MAY 2000 18 MAY 2000 KV CONTROL & FEEDBACK MD-0759 REV C SHEET 2 OF 4 HV ANODE BOARD J1 ANODE S C L TO J9-8 KV FEEDBACK SIGNAL TO PAGE 1 TO J9-7 TO J9-5 TO J9-6 J3-8 HV MULT ASSY + (ANODE) J3-7 J3-5 J3-6 E9 HV MULT ASSY(CATHODE) E10 FROM PAGE 2 C L S TANK LID BOARD RESONANT BOARD HV CATHODE BOARD J2 CATHODE PART OF H.V. OIL TANK ** ONE TUBE H.T. OUTPUTS ARE SHOWN. TWO TUBE TANKS WILL HAVE A SECOND PAIR OF H.T. OUTPUTS DRAWN G. SANWALD CHECKED S. BLAKE DES.\MFG.\AUTH. L.FOSKIN DATE 18 MAY 2000 18 MAY 2000 18 MAY 2000 KV CONTROL & FEEDBACK MD-0759 REV C SHEET 3 OF 4 NOTE REFERENCE REMARKS 1 2 3 kV REFERENCE OUTPUT, GENERATED BY THE CPU. SCALING IS 1 VOLT OUT = 15 kV OF GENERATOR OUTPUT. kV FEEDBACK TO THE CPU. SCALING IS 1V = 20 KV OF GENERATOR OUTPUT. HV ON SIGNAL. THIS IS “HIGH” (APPROXIMATELY 5 VDC) WHEN HIGH VOLTAGE IS ON, “LOW” (APPROXIMATELY 0 VDC) WHEN HIGH VOLTAGE IS OFF. 4 THE VOLTAGE AT TP17 AND TP19 SHOULD BE A 50% DUTY CYCLE SQUARE WAVE, RANGING IN FREQUENCY FROM APPROXIMATELY 80 kHz TO APPROXIMATELY 250 kHz, DEPENDING ON GENERATOR OUTPUT POWER. SEE FIGURE 1. 12 VDC 0 VDC FIGURE 1 DRAWN G. SANWALD CHECKED S. BLAKE DES.\MFG.\AUTH. L.FOSKIN DATE 18 MAY 2000 18 MAY 2000 18 MAY 2000 KV CONTROL & FEEDBACK MD-0759 REV C SHEET 4 OF 4 +5V J2-8 RN7C JW1 5.5 A 6.5 A 1 3 2 J2-7 FIL BUFFER & CURRENT LIMIT CIRCUIT J2-9 DS14 DS13 JW1 SELECTS MAXIMUM FILAMENT CURRENT 5.5 OR 6.5 AMPS ERROR AMPLIFIER & DRIVER CIRCUIT +12V RED TP2 TO 2.1 V CURRENT SINK U24 OPTO-COUPLER “ON” = NO FILAMENT FAULT BUFFER 5 RN7E +5V FILAMENT CURRENT FEEDBACK SIGNAL (SM) TO PAGE 2 2 J10-23 J1-23 RN4D R137 5 1 4 2 J10-5 J1-5 J10-24 J1-24 3 RN2G R136 OPTO-COUPLER “ON” = NO HV / MA FAULT 1 TP3 HV / MA FAULT FROM MD-0761, PAGE 2 J2-6 JW1 J2-2 J3-8 J3-10 J2-10 J3-7 TP2 5 - 7 R24 J10-9 J1-9 J3-6 J10-28 J1-28 J3-5 RN11E LARGE U27 JW5 JUMPER POSITION: INDICO GENERATORS JUMPER PINS 1-2 DO NOT USE JUMPER POSITION 2-3 SMALL TO 2.1 V CURRENT SINK 2 BUFFER AND DRIVER DATA LATCH 3 RN6E +5V U24 J2-6 U19, U16 2 J10-17 J1-17 J10-36 J1-36 OPTO-COUPLER “ON” = LARGE FOCUS SELECTED “LG/SM REQUEST” DETECTOR CKT RN1A (U11C, Q2, ETC) 5 1 JW1 J3-11 TO J3-6, J3-5, J3-9, J3-10 ON CONTROL BOARD BUFFER 5 FIL CURRENT FEEDBACK SIGNAL (SM) TO PAGE 2 RN2E J1-8 1 2 J2-4 J2-3 J2-2 FIL CURRENT FEEDBACK SIGNAL (LG) TO PAGE 2 4 J10-27 J1-27 BUFFER & CURRENT LIMIT CIRCUIT J2-9 ERROR AMPLIFIER & DRIVER CIRCUIT TP1 U10 DATA BUS D0..D7 LARGE FILAMENT DRIVE CONTINUED ON PAGE 2 JW1 SELECTS MAXIMUM FILAMENT CURRENT 5.5 OR 6.5 AMPS J2-10 +12V J10-8 J5-1 3 4 2 RN1B 5.5 A 6.5 A 1 3 2 J2-5 4 U1 OPTO-COUPLER “ON” = SMALL FOCUS SELECTED J8 INDICO 100 GENERATORS WITH STANDARD SINGLE FILAMENT BOARD (TYPICALLY USED IN RAD ONLY GENERATORS) USE THE FILAMENT BOARD CONFIGURATION SHOWN BELOW JW5 1 J5-2 INDICO 100 GENERATORS WITH OPTIONAL TWO FILAMENT BOARDS (TYPICALLY USED IN R&F GENERATORS) USE THE FILAMENT BOARD CONFIGURATION SHOWN ABOVE +5V DS25 J2-1 T1 RMS CONVERTER CIRCUIT FILAMENT SUPPLY BOARD (LARGE) + U14B DS24 C22 BUFFER / AMPLIFIER & FILAMENT CURRENT COMPARATOR J2-2 R11 6 D/A CONVERTER TP1 FILAMENT CURRENT FEEDBACK SIGNAL (LG) TO PAGE 2 R17 U22 SMALL FILAMENT DRIVE CONTINUED ON PAGE 2 ERROR AMPLIFIER & DRIVER CIRCUIT J2-10 TP1 1 J5-3 3 J3-9 TP21 U14D J4 JW1 SELECTS MAXIMUM FILAMENT CURRENT 5.5 OR 6.5 AMPS BUFFER & CURRENT LIMIT CIRCUIT J2-9 R7 14 5.5 A 6.5 A 1 3 2 J2-5 J3-2 R5 R10 Q14 J5-4 FILAMENT SUPPLY BOARD (SMALL) RN4C U8 BUFFER J2-3 T1 RMS CONVERTER CIRCUIT J3-10 Q15 +12V RED C22 BUFFER / AMPLIFIER & FILAMENT CURRENT COMPARATOR J2-4 DS12 U24 12 + J1-4 HV TO 2.1 V CURRENT SINK D/A CONVERTER TP1 1 4 GRN 13 - J10-4 3 J2-10 FILAMENT FAULT TO MD-0761, PAGE 2 U7 DS11 U18 RN2H GRN RN4A R75 J2-1 C22 T1 BUFFER / AMPLIFIER & FILAMENT CURRENT COMPARATOR RMS CONVERTER CIRCUIT TP2 J2-11 Q3 J5-3 J5-4 +12V K1 K1 SMALL FILAMENT DRIVE CONTINUED ON PAGE 2 J5-1 J5-2 LARGE FILAMENT DRIVE CONTINUED ON PAGE 2 FILAMENT SUPPLY BOARD (UNIVERSAL) GENERATOR CPU BOARD REFER TO PAGE 4 FOR LOGIC LEVELS, NOTES, ETC, REFERENCED BY HEXAGONAL SYMBOL: CONTROL BOARD DUE TO SPACE RESTRICTIONS, THIS PAGE SHOWS ONLY THE MAJOR FILAMENT BLOCKS. REFER TO PAGE 3 FOR A MORE DETAILED FUNCTIONAL DIAGRAM OF THE FILAMENT SUPPLY BOARD. DRAWN G. SANWALD CHECKED S. BLAKE DES.\MFG.\AUTH. L. FOSKIN DATE 12 MAY 2000 12 MAY 2000 FILAMENT DRIVE & MA CONTROL 15 MAY 2000 MD-0760 REV E SHEET 1 OF 4 LARGE J5-1 J4-1 J5-2 J4-2 FROM J2-4 FILAMENT CURRENT FEEDBACK SIGNAL (LG) FROM PAGE 1 FROM J2-2 FROM J2-3 J3-4 J2-3 J3-3 J2-11 SM FILAMENT FEEDBACK CONTINUED ON PAGE 3 J2 ** CATHODE C S L 5 FROM PAGE 1 FILAMENT CURRENT FEEDBACK SIGNAL (SM) FROM PAGE 1 FROM J2-1 J3-2 J1-13 J3-1 J1-32 LG FILAMENT FEEDBACK CONTINUED ON PAGE 3 8 J4-4 6- 7 R4 J1-11 U30B R3 J1-30 R15 J2-1 R14 J2-9 5+ - 9 6 TP6 TP7 + U9 7 C L HIGH MA FAULT TO GENERATOR READY DETECTOR CIRCUIT ON CONTROL BOARD, SEE MD-0761, PAGE 2 +12V TP2 TP3 J3-1 RN6C, RN6D J3-2 6- E18 10 FLUORO MA FEEDBACK CONTINUED ON PAGE 3 U33E ANODE I D65 D95 R38 U6B D72 HIGH ANODE CURRENT LATCH & LOGIC INVERTER (U32C, U33C) ANODE OVERCURRENT DETECTOR (U18, RN9E-H, ETC.) 7 5+ RN6A, RN6B J9-2 ANODE OVERVOLTAGE SIGNAL FROM MD-0759, PG 1 R19 R8 J9-1 R212 R179 R9 R7 R34 RAD MA FEEDBACK CONTINUED ON PAGE 3 11 S HV ANODE BOARD 3 R36 R33, R32 R164 R213 H.T.TANK 2 J1 ANODE R165 R216 FILAMENT SUPPLY BOARD R5 R163 CATHODE H.T. BOARD R6 J5-4 TP4 TP5 R16 J4-3 R17 SMALL J5-3 mA TEST JACK RESET COMMAND FROM MD-0761, PG 2 + E17 R177 +12V CATHODE OVERVOLTAGE SIGNAL FROM MD-0759, PG 1 R39 RN6G, RN6H J9-4 2- R18 J3-4 J3-3 RN6F, RN6E 1 U6A D96 HIGH CATHODE CURRENT LATCH & LOGIC INVERTER (U32B, U33B) CATHODE D64 C S J2 CATHODE R40 L J9-3 3+ CATHODE OVERCURRENT DETECTOR (U17, RN9A-D, ETC.) D71 H.T.TANK HV CATHODE BOARD TANK LID BOARD PART OF HV OIL TANK ** ONE TUBE H.T. OUTPUTS ARE SHOWN. TWO TUBE TANKS WILL HAVE A SECOND PAIR OF H.T. OUTPUTS DRAWN CONTROL BOARD G. SANWALD CHECKED S. BLAKE DES.\MFG.\AUTH. L. FOSKIN DATE 12 MAY 2000 12 MAY 2000 FILAMENT DRIVE & MA CONTROL 15 MAY 2000 MD-0760 REV E SHEET 2 OF 4 MAXIMUM FILAMENT CURRENT LIMIT CIRCUIT 6 JW1 TP25 TP24 R57 + - U1A RN8D 2 6.5 A 1 5.5 A +35V -12V RN9D 65 J3-3 R63 7 + U30B RN8C RN9C D6 R62 J3-11 ERROR AMPLIFIER, PWM REGULATOR, AND FILAMENT CURRENT DRIVERS 3 R61 SM FILAMENT FEEDBACK FROM ON PAGE 2 SET MAX CURRENT 11 RN3G J2-8 RN2A J2-7 RN2B 6- 7 5+ 6 R64 RN1A J2-5 RN1B Q12 + U4B RN3F J2-6 Q6 TP3 U3 RN4H U1B TP23 TP22 R67 RN5G PWM REGULATOR RN8B J10-13 R59 1 + U30A RN8A RN9A RN3H 23 Q13 Q7 R60 J10-32 LG FILAMENT FEEDBACK FROM ON PAGE 2 RN9B J2-9 3 U37 11 +12V RN5D A/D CONVERTER R38 R39 RN2D 910 + K1 IS FITTED ON “UNIVERSAL” (LARGE/SMALL) FILAMENT BOARDS. J8 IS FITTED ON LARGE FILAMENT BOARDS, AND J4 IS FITTED ON SMALL FILAMENT BOARDS. J10-11 - 12 + R34 J5-3 J8 14 U15D R23 RN1C J5-4 J4 13 U15C RN2C K1 J2-11 R29 8 J5-1 K1 RN1D J10-30 J5-2 TP4 TP2 TP10 TP7 RAD MA FEEDBACK FROM ON PAGE 2 -35V 10 TP1 J2-10 C22 12 J2-4 RN2C J2-3 RN2D U4A 1.7 V Ref U2A - TP11 TP14 R45 R50 J2-2 RN1C J2-1 RN1D D12, 13 D27, 28 U7 Q1 + T1 RMS CONVERTER - + RN4C - 3+ J3-1 1 + U2B U23A RN5D R79 R21 FILAMENT CURRENT SENSE, RMS CONVERTER, AND FILAMENT FEEDBACK R87 2- R88 FLUORO MA FEEDBACK FROM ON PAGE 2 RN5C RN4D J3-9 GENERATOR CPU BOARD DATA BUS D0..D7 FILAMENT SUPPLY BOARD DRAWN G. SANWALD CHECKED S. BLAKE DES.\MFG.\AUTH. L. FOSKIN DATE 12 MAY 2000 12 MAY 2000 FILAMENT DRIVE & MA CONTROL 15 MAY 2000 MD-0760 REV E SHEET 3 OF 4 NOTE REFERENCE REMARKS 1 2 3 4 5 6 FILAMENT REFERENCE OUTPUTS, GENERATED BY THE CPU. SCALING IS 1 VOLT OUT = 1 AMP OF FILAMENT CURRENT. “HIGH” (APPROXIMATELY 5 VDC) = LARGE FOCUS SELECTED, “LOW” (APPROXIMATELY 0 VDC) = SMALL FOCUS SELECTED. THIS SIGNAL IS USED IN SINGLE FILAMENT SUPPLY GENERATORS ONLY. “HIGH” (APPROXIMATELY 12 VDC) = FILAMENT FAULT (FILAMENT CURRENT < 2 A). “LOW” (APPROXIMATELY 0 VDC) = NO FILAMENT FAULT. “HIGH” (APPROXIMATELY 12 VDC) = LARGE FOCUS SELECTED, “LOW” (APPROXIMATELY 0 VDC) SMALL FOCUS SELECTED. 7 THESE TEST POINTS ALLOW MEASUREMENT OF A VOLTAGE PROPORTIONAL TO ANODE CURRENT. THE SCALING IS 0.4 VDC = 100 mA. SHORT EXPOSURE TIMES MUST BE CONSIDERED AND APPROPRIATE MEASUREMENT TECHNIQUES MUST BE USED. 8 9 10 11 THESE TEST POINTS ARE SCALED 1 VDC = 100 mA OF X-RAY CURRENT. THESE TEST POINTS ARE SCALED 1 VDC = 2.5 mA OF X-RAY CURRENT (R&F GENERATORS ONLY). FILAMENT FEEDBACK CURRENT TEST POINT. THIS IS SCALED 1 VDC = 1 AMP OF FILAMENT CURRENT. PWM OUTPUT. THE WAVEFORM WILL BE AS PER FIGURE 1 FOR LOW AND HIGH FILAMENT CURRENT DEMAND. PRIMARY FILAMENT CURRENT AT THESE POINTS MAY BE CONFIRMED USING A CURRENT PROBE ON ONE OF THE OUTPUT LEADS ON THE SMALL OR LARGE PAIR OF OUTPUTS. THE VOLTAGE AT THESE TEST POINTS WILL BE APPROXIMATELY 1 VDC = 1 AMP OF FILAMENT CURRENT. Approx 25 usec (40 kHz) +12 V LOW FILAMENT DEMAND 0V FIGURE 1 +12 V HIGH FILAMENT DEMAND 0V DRAWN G. SANWALD CHECKED S. BLAKE DES.\MFG.\AUTH. L. FOSKIN DATE 12 MAY 2000 12 MAY 2000 FILAMENT DRIVE & MA CONTROL 15 MAY 2000 MD-0760 REV E SHEET 4 OF 4 REFER TO PAGE 2 FOR LOGIC LEVELS, NOTES, ETC, REFERENCED BY HEXAGONAL SYMBOL: +12V TUBE 1 SHIFT J3-3 MAIN R1 J3-9 J1-1 K2 +12V J1-20 C3 R121 CONTINUED ON PAGE 2 RN4E R138 J6-10 Q18 J5-10 2 D7 R29 J4-9 J4-9 J3-8 J2-8 1 R30 Q3 COMM K4 +12V TUBE 2 K1 STATOR FAULT TO GENERATOR READY DETECTOR CIRCUIT ON CONTROL BOARD, SEE MD-0761 J3-7 SHIFT J3-5 MAIN J3-1 COMM K3 TP1 3 J5-8 COMMON FROM J1-4. REFER TO LOW SPEED STARTER BOARD ON MD-0788, PAGE 1 JUMPER POSITION: INDICO 100 GENERATORS JUMPER “1.5S” FOR 1.5 SEC BOOST, NO JUMPERS FOR 2.5 SEC BOOST. REFER TO CH. 2 OF SERVICE MANUAL. DO NOT USE JUMPER POSITION “.15S” JW1 TP3 R36 4 BOOST AND RUN LOGIC CIRCUIT (U1, U10, U18 Q2, Q12, ETC.) .15S 1.5S 120 / 240 VAC FROM J1-1. REFER TO LOW SPEED STARTER BOARD ON MD-0788, PAGE 1 J4-11 J3-7 52 / 73 / 94 VAC FROM J1-3. REFER TO LOW SPEED STARTER BOARD ON MD-0788, PAGE 1 TP4 6 J8-4 J1-4 R35 J4-12 J3-6 F2 Q1 U1 ZERO CROSS CIRCUIT J2-6 +12V D1 8 K1 J4-6 J4-6 J3-10 +12V J2-10 D15 D2 J2-9 POWER INPUT BOARD CONTROL BOARD U2 TP2 J4-12 Q15 D17 +12V ZERO CROSS CIRCUIT +12V R46 ENABLE COMMAND FROM MD-0761, PAGE 2 D18 R45 7 Q2 J2-7 5 12 VDC / SOFT START FAULT SIGNAL FROM MD-0788, PAGE 3 +12V F1 TP3 J4-11 TUBE 1 / TUBE 2 MISMATCH & THERMOSTAT OPEN SIGNAL FROM MD-0787 F3 R5 J6-8 R1 PREP COMMAND FROM MD-0761, PAGE 2 TUBE SELECT SIGNAL FROM J2-9. REFER TO LOW SPEED STARTER BOARD ON MD-0788, PAGE 1 K4 LOW SPEED STARTER BOARD AUXILIARY BOARD DRAWN G. SANWALD CHECKED________ DES.\MFG.\AUTH. HTW DATE 10 MAR 2000 ________ LOW SPEED STARTER 10 MAR 2000 MD-0764 REV E SHEET 1 OF 2 RN7A +5V DS20 GRN U24 9 ROTOR DS21 RED TO 2.1 V CURRENT SINK OPTO-COUPLER “ON” = NO FAULT J10-1 BUFFER 5 J1-1 1 FROM PAGE 1 U5 4 2 J10-20 J1-20 DATA BUS D0..D7 GENERATOR CPU BOARD NOTE REFERENCE CONTROL BOARD REMARKS 1 2 3 4 5 6 “HIGH” (APPROXIMATELY 6-11 VDC) = NO STATOR FAULT, “LOW” (<APPROXIMATELY 2 VDC) = STATOR FAULT (LOW OR NO STATOR CURRENT). “LOW” (APPROXIMATELY 0 VDC) = NO STATOR FAULT, “HIGH” (APPROXIMATELY 12 VDC) = STATOR FAULT (LOW OR NO STATOR CURRENT). “HIGH” (APPROXIMATELY 10 VDC) = PREP REQUESTED, “LOW” (APPROXIMATELY 1 VDC) = PREP NOT REQUESTED. “LOW” (APPROXIMATELY 0 VDC) = BOOST REQUESTED, “HIGH” (APPROXIMATELY 12 VDC) = BOOST NOT REQUESTED (BOOST REQUESTED FOR APPROXIMATELY 1.5 SEC AFTER PREP INITIATED). “LOW” (APPROXIMATELY 0 VDC) = RUN REQUESTED, “HIGH” (APPROXIMATELY 12 VDC) = RUN NOT REQUESTED (RUN REQUESTED AFTER BOOST COMPLETE, AND FOR DURATION THAT PREP IS PRESSED). “HIGH” (APPROXIMATELY 12 VDC) = LOW SPEED STARTER ENABLED, “LOW” (APPROXIMATELY 0 VDC) = STARTER DISABLED (SEE # 7). 7 THIS POINT MUST BE “HIGH” (AS PER # 6) TO ENABLE THE LOW SPEED STARTER. THIS REQUIRES THE ENABLE COMMAND TO BE PRESENT (”HIGH”), AND THE TUBE 1 /TUBE 2 MISMATCH &THERMOSTAT OPEN SIGNAL TO BE “HIGH”. IF THE 12 VDC / SOFT START FAULT SIGNAL IS LOW (INDICATING A FAULT), J1-4 WILL NOT BE PULLED LOW DUE TO THE DIODE SHOWN CONNECTED TO THIS PIN ON PAGE 1. 8 “LOW” (APPROXIMATELY 0 VDC) ENERGIZES K1 ON THE LOW SPEED STARTER BOARD, ENABLING THE STARTER. “HIGH” (APPROXIMATELY 12 VDC) DE-ENERGIZES K1 ON THE LOW SPEED STARTER BOARD. AS PER # 6 AND 7, NO ENABLE COMMAND, OR PRESENCE OF A TUBE 1 / TUBE 2 MISMATCH & THERMOSTAT OPEN FAULT, OR A 12 VDC / SOFT START FAULT WILL INHIBIT LOW SPEED STARTER OPERATION. 9 DS20 LIT INDICATES NORMAL STATOR CURRENTS. DS 21 LIT INDICATES STATOR FAULT, OR LOW SPEED STARTER IS IN STANDBY MODE. DRAWN G. SANWALD CHECKED________ DES.\MFG.\AUTH. HTW DATE 10 MAR 2000 ________ LOW SPEED STARTER 10 MAR 2000 MD-0764 REV E SHEET 2 OF 2 CS1, U10, U11 +5V SW2 * LS TO 2.1 V CURRENT SINK DATA LATCH R40 BUFFER AND DRIVER J10-2 J1-2 J10-21 J1-21 2 J4-6 J1-6 J4-8 J1-8 PREP COMMAND FROM MD-0761 R96 CONTACTOR CLOSED SIGNAL FROM MD-0788, PAGE 3 J1-2 J4-4 J1-4 RN7A IGBT SWITCH (Q3) 6 1 5 2 4 560 / 650 VDC (-) +12V TUBE 1 DUAL SPEED STARTER CPU, BUFFERS, DRIVERS PREP INITIATED K1-A K5 R42 J4-14 J1-14 J4-16 J1-16 1 2 4 K6 R32 K3 HIGH SPEED PHASE SHIFT CAPACITOR J10-1 1 4 2 COMM TUBE 2 K4 SHIFT TB3-2 MAIN TB3-1 COMM R1 TB3-3 J1-1 +12V J1-20 R121 U5 J10-20 TB2-1 K1-B K2-B 5 MAIN +12V K5 C22 TUBE 2 SELECT +12V BUFFER TB2-2 D47 K6 OPTO-COUPLER “ON” = NO FAULT SHIFT Q5 K2 TUBE 1/TUBE 2 SELECT SIGNAL FROM MD-0788, PAGE 3 TB2-3 K2-A K1 5 U14 +5V 8 IGBT SWITCH (Q1) U13 4 U24 IGBT SWITCH (Q4) R41 J4-2 3 TO 2.1 V CURRENT SINK 4 IGBT SWITCH (Q2) +12V R94 RED 2 DRIVER CIRCUIT AND FAULT CURRENT LATCH (U1-U10, T1-T4, ETC). HIGH SPEED SELECT Q7 GRN 5 K4 D47 ROTOR 1 U12 +12V DS21 5 U17, U18 U19, U22, U24 U19, U16 DS20 560 / 650 VDC (+) R31 U27 R24 HS 1 DS1 INVERTER FAULT DS7 DS8 INVERTER FAULT DETECTOR +5V RN7G SW1 * RN4E K3 J4-10 J1-10 7 LOW SPEED PHASE SHIFT CAPACITOR R138 Q18 STATOR FAULT TO GENERATOR READY DETECTOR CIRCUIT ON CONTROL BOARD, SEE MD-0761 DATA BUS D0..D7 GENERATOR CPU BOARD CONTROL BOARD DUAL SPEED STARTER BOARD * REFER TO CHAPTER 2 OF SERVICE MANUAL FOR THE PROCEDURE TO SET DIP SWITCHES SW1 AND SW2 DRAWN G. SANWALD CHECKED STEVE BLAKE DES.\MFG.\AUTH. L.FOSKIN DATE 30 MAR 2000 30 MAR 2000 30 MAR 2000 DUAL SPEED STARTER MD-0765 REV C SHEET 1 OF 2 NOTE REFERENCE REMARKS 3 DS8 LIT INDICATES HIGH SPEED SELECTED, DS7 LIT INDICATES LOW SPEED SELECTED. “HIGH” (APPROXIMATELY 5 VDC) = HIGH SPEED SELECTED, “LOW” (APPROXIMATELY 0 VDC) = LOW SPEED SELECTED. “LOW” (APPROXIMATELY 7 VDC) = CONTACTOR CLOSED AND PREP REQUESTED. THIS INITIATES THE BOOST CYCLE. “HIGH” (APPROXIMATELY 12 VDC) = BOOST NOT REQUESTED (PREP COMMAND NOT RECEIVED, OR CONTACTOR IS NOT CLOSED). 4 “LOW” (APPROXIMATELY 0 VDC) = TUBE 2 SELECTED, “HIGH” (APPROXIMATELY 12 VDC) = TUBE 2 DESELECTED. THIS CONDITION DEFAULTS TO TUBE 1. 5 DS1 LIT INDICATES AN INVERTER CURRENT FAULT. POSSIBLE CAUSES INCLUDE INCORRECT DIP SWITCH SETTINGS FOR THE TUBE IN USE (SEE ** ON PAGE 1), INCORRECT STATOR IMPEDANCE, OR DEFECTIVE STATOR CABLE. 6 7 8 K4 OPEN CIRCUITS THE STATOR COMMON LEAD AT ALL TIMES THAT THE DUAL SPEED STARTER IS IN STANDBY MODE. “LOW” (APPROXIMATELY 0 VDC) = NO STATOR FAULT, “HIGH” (APPROXIMATELY 12 VDC) = STATOR FAULT (LOW OR NO STATOR CURRENT). DS20 LIT INDICATES NORMAL STATOR CURRENTS. DS21 LIT INDICATES STATOR FAULT, OR DUAL SPEED STARTER IS IN STANDBY MODE. 1 2 DRAWN G. SANWALD CHECKED STEVE BLAKE DES.\MFG.\AUTH. L.FOSKIN DATE 30 MAR 2000 30 MAR 2000 30 MAR 2000 DUAL SPEED STARTER MD-0765 REV C SHEET 2 OF 2 NOTE REFERENCE K1 REFER TO MD-0759 PAGE 2 REMARKS 1 D36 LIT INDICATES RAD OR PULSED FLUORO MODE. D36 NOT LIT INDICATES CONTINUOUS FLUORO MODE. 2 “LOW” (APPROXIMATELY 0 VDC) = K1 ON RESONANT BOARD ENERGIZED IN RAD / PULSED FLUORO MODE. “HIGH” (APPROXIMATELY 12 VDC) = K1 ON RESONANT BOARD DE-ENERGIZED IN CONTINUOUS FLUORO MODE. 3 “LOW” (APPROXIMATELY 0 VDC) = K1 ON POWER MODE SELECT BOARD ENERGIZED IN FLUORO OR LOW POWER RAD MODE (< 20 kW APPROX). “HIGH” (APPROXIMATELY 12 VDC) = K1 ON POWER MODE SELECT BOARD DE-ENERGIZED IN HIGH POWER RAD MODE (> 20kW APPROX). R44 +12V +12V D36 J2-1 1 FROM J1-5 (AUXILIARY BOARD), SEE MD-0788, PAGE 3 RAD MODE J2-2 R79 THESE CIRCUITS USED ON R&F GENERATORS ONLY J2-1 K1 J2-2 Q5 R47 2 RESONANT BOARD +12V D38 J10-1 D44 J10-2 K1 J3-2 THE POWER MODE SELECT BOARD IS USED ON 65 / 80 kW GENERATORS WITH THREE INVERTER BOARDS ONLY D1 R69 Q4 3 R66 FROM J1-3 (AUXILIARY BOARD) SEE MD-0788, PAGE 3 J3-1 AUXILIARY BOARD ENERGIZING K1 DISABLES DRIVE TO INVERTER BOARD No. 3 J12-1 J1-1 J12-2 J1-2 J12-3 J1-3 K1 J4-1 INVERTER DRIVE SIGNAL FROM MD-0759 J12-4 CONTROL BOARD J1-1 J4-2 J1-2 J4-3 J1-3 J4-4 J1-4 J1-4 POWER MODE SELECT BOARD INVERTER DRIVE SIGNAL TO MD-0759 INVERTER BOARD DRAWN G. SANWALD CHECKED________ DES.\MFG.\AUTH. HTW DATE 21 MAR 2000 ________ RAD / FLUORO AND POWER MODE SELECT 21 MAR 2000 MD-0786 REV B SHEET 1 OF 1 4 +12V D42 R41 JW4 JUMPER POSITION: R&F GENERATORS (WITH THERMAL SWITCH) JUMPER JW4 PINS 1-2 (ON) RAD GENERATORS (NO THERMAL SWITCH) JUMPER JW4 PINS 2-3 (OFF) ON OFF 3 1 2 R39 +12V THERMAL CUTOFF OPEN R40 J2-4 R43 Q10 J2-3 +12V D26 1 5 FOR TUBE 1 / TUBE 2 SOLENOID DRIVE CIRCUITS SEE MD-0788, PAGE 1 2 4 1 5 2 4 TUBE 1 / TUBE 2 TELLBACK LOGIC CIRCUIT (U9, U10, R84) R7 Q8 +5V INVERTER BOARD TUBE 1 / TUBE 2 SELECT SIGNAL FROM MD-0788, PAGE 3 U8 TUBE 1 / TUBE 2 RELAY CONTACTS (SHOWN IN TUBE 1 POSITION) J5-1 J11-1 J4-20 J4-20 J5-2 J11-2 J4-19 J4-19 TUBE 1 / TUBE 2 SELECT COMMAND FROM MD-0788, PAGE 1 R28 TUBE 2 SELECTED 1 DS5 DS6 TUBE 2 TUBE 1 U35 +12V D39 R38 +5V RN7H U7 TUBE 1 / TUBE 2 MISMATCH & THERMOSTAT OPEN SIGNAL TO MD-0764 AND MD-0761, PAGE 2 5 R8 +12V RN11H R6 THERMAL SWITCH ON INVERTER HEATSINK (R&F UNITS ONLY) 3 DECODER/ DEMULTIPLEXER J1-2 J8-2 J2-5 J3-5 J1-1 J8-1 J2-13 J3-13 2 1 5 2 4 U3 OPTO COUPLER “ON” = TUBE 2 SELECTED H.T. TANK POWER INPUT BOARD AUXILIARY BOARD CONTROL BOARD GENERATOR CPU BOARD REFER TO MD-0763 (ROOM INTERFACE) FOR INTERLOCKS ACCESSED VIA THE ROOM INTERFACE BOARD TUBE 1 STATOR TERMINAL BLOCK J5-1 NOTE REFERENCE REMARKS 1 2 “LOW” (APPROXIMATELY 0 VDC) = TUBE 2 SELECTED, “HIGH” (APPROXIMATELY 10 VDC) = TUBE 1 SELECTED. “LOW” (APPROXIMATELY 0 VDC) = TUBE 2 SELECTED, “HIGH” (APPROXIMATELY 12 VDC) = TUBE 1 SELECTED. 3 DS6 LIT INDICATES TUBE 1 SELECTED. DS5 LIT INDICATES TUBE 2 SELECTED. NEITHER LED LIT INDICATES A MISMATCH BETWEEN THE TUBE THAT HAS BEEN REQUESTED, AND THE TUBE THAT HAS ACTUALLY BEEN SELECTED (SEE # 5). 4 5 “LOW” (APPROXIMATELY 0 VDC) = INVERTER THERMAL SWITCH CLOSED (OR JUMPERED VIA JW4), “HIGH” (APPROXIMATELY 12 VDC) = INVERTER THERMAL SWITCH OPEN, OR JW4 JUMPER OMITTED ON RAD GENERATORS. THERMAL SWITCH TUBE 1 THERMOSTAT TO T1 ON MD-0763, PAGE 1 J5-2 TUBE 2 STATOR TERMINAL BLOCK J5-3 TUBE 2 THERMOSTAT TO T2 ON MD-0763, PAGE 1 THERMAL SWITCH J5-4 THE TUBE 1 / TUBE 2 TELLBACK LOGIC CIRCUIT ENSURES THAT THE TUBE ACTUALLY SELECTED MATCHES THE TUBE THAT WAS REQUESTED. FOR EXAMPLE, IF TUBE 2 WAS REQUESTED BY THE CONSOLE BUT TUBE 1 WAS ACTUALLY SELECTED BY THE H.T. TANK, THE LOGIC CIRCUIT WILL INDICATE A FAULT CONDITION. GENERATOR INTERFACE BOARD DRAWN G. SANWALD CHECKED S. BLAKE DES.\MFG.\AUTH. L. FOSKIN DATE 18 MAY 2000 18 MAY 2000 INTERLOCKS & TUBE 1 / TUBE 2 TELLBACK 18 MAY 2000 MD-0787 REV C SHEET 1 OF 1 REFER TO PAGE 3 FOR LOGIC LEVELS, NOTES, ETC, REFERENCED BY HEXAGONAL SYMBOL: +24V +12V J10-13 GAIN CONTROL SIGNAL FROM MD-0758 (NOT USED AT THIS TIME) J10-19 J10-16 J10-11 -24V U25, U23 RN14H D0 RN14G D1 RN14F D2 RN14E D3 RN14D D4 RN14C D5 RN14B D6 RN14A D7 -12V U33 J6-1 J12-1 8 11 4 CH 4 SELECT J10-2 J6-2 J12-2 7 12 4 CH 3 SELECT J10-3 J6-3 J12-3 6 13 4 CH 2 SELECT J10-4 J6-4 J12-4 5 14 4 CH 1 SELECT J10-5 15 5 “L” FIELD SELECT J10-7 BUFFER & DATA LATCH DRIVER J6-5 J12-5 J6-6 J12-6 3 16 5 “M” FIELD SELECT J10-8 J6-7 J12-7 2 17 5 “R” FIELD SELECT J10-9 J6-8 J12-8 1 18 7 START J10-6 4 CONTINUED ON PAGES 3 TO 5 R88 +5V R87 +5V TP10 9 10 8 CPU R99 1 U28 R100 J7-19 J11-19 Q6 U45C PTSTOP J10-1 PTRAMP J10-15 PTREF J10-10 R85 TP12 R42 R44 TP9 6 R86 Q5 2 TP11 J11-4 2 U37 9 J7-4 10 J11-1 3 TP12 RN5B U23C +12V TP4 U18 9 D/A CONVERTER - 10 + 8 4 5 2 1 J10-17 R89 U46 R30 3 R117 + Q7 +12V R116 8 A/D CONVERTER J7-1 -12V U14C GENERATOR INTERFACE BOARD J14-6 J14-7 J14-14 J14-3 J14-1 J14-2 J14-4 J14-12 J14-13 J14-15 J14-8 J14-9 J14-10 J14-11 DATA BUS DO..D7 GENERATOR CPU BOARD 2 2 TO A EC DETECTOR CIRCUIT CONTINUED ON PAGE 2 DRAWN G. SANWALD CHECKED __________ DATE 02 JUN 2000 __________ DES.\MFG.\AUTH. L. FOSKIN 02 JUN 2000 AEC MD-0757 REV C SHEET 1 OF 5 FROM GENERATOR INTERFACE BOARD, PAGE 1 J2-3 J2-4 J2-1 J2-6 J2-7 J2-14 J2-2 J2-12 J2-13 J2-15 J2-8 J2-9 J2-10 J2-11 OPTO-COUPLER "ON" = AEC START S1 +8V +8 VDC REGULATOR CIRCUIT ANALOG SWITCH J1-1 -8V J1-2 PHOTO DIODE DETECTORS J1-3 -8 VDC REGULATOR CIRCUIT INTEGRATOR CIRCUIT AMPLIFIER CIRCUIT COMPARATOR & DRIVER CIRCUIT J1-4 PHOTO DIODE DETECTOR UNIT A2EC2 DETECTOR CIRCUIT 2 OPTIONAL A EC 2 DRAWN G. SANWALD CHECKED __________ DATE 02 JUN 2000 __________ DES.\MFG.\AUTH. L. FOSKIN 02 JUN 2000 AEC MD-0757 REV C SHEET 2 OF 5 J5-4 J7-5 “R” SELECT U2D R30 D10 U2B R29 D11 D14 R41 R28 D15 “L” SELECT J7-7 J5-7 J7-8 J5-8 J7-9 J5-9 +12V +12V Q1 R45 D19 R22 D18 DS5 R82 +12V R57 J12-1 U11B “L” SELECT R11 J3-4 R20 J7-12 J5-12 -12V 2 TP3 J5-10 J7-1 J5-1 J13-1 R19 SAMPLE & HOLD U12 1 - U10A R23 2 R60 - “L” SELECT - U10B + U9B CATH (M) CATH (R) AEC CH 4 J4-2 “R” SELECT ANODE J4-3 J4-4 “M” SELECT CATH (L) J4-5 R6 R5 - 7 R84 + + U13 3 U1B R85 2 J4-6 R56 5 R70 J14-1 J14-2 J14-3 J14-4 J14-5 AEC BOARD DESIGNATES AN ANALOG SWITCH. THESE ARE I.C. “SWITCHES” THAT ARE SWITCHED ON / OFF BY APPLYING THE APPROPRIATE LOGIC LEVEL (0V = OFF, 12V = ON). CATH (R) J4 (shell) 6 R4 - R50 7 REFER TO CHAPTER 3D FOR INSTALLATION AND CALIBRATION DETAILS. CATH (L) J4-1 + 3 TP5 THIS SHEET APPLIES TO AEC BOARD ASSEMBLY 733347 ANODE J13-3 J13-4 6 GENERATOR INTERFACE BOARD GROUND J13-2 J13-5 + D31 CATH (M) GROUND U6C R88 D33 R17 C37 R14 J5-15 3 U1A R51 TP1 3 J7-10 + TP4 R18 JW3 J5-11 J7-15 J3-6 JW4 J7-11 1 R33 J5-18 TP2 CATH (L) CATH (R) J3 (shell) 2 R3 J7-18 +12V - R81 J5-17 D20 R80 J7-17 ANODE J3-3 J3-5 R21 J5-14 AEC CH 3 J3-1 J3-2 J5-13 J7-14 CATH (M) CATH (R) U6B “M” SELECT U2E CATH (L) J12-4 “R” SELECT U2F ANODE J12-3 R26 J7-13 CATH (M) GROUND GROUND J12-2 J12-5 D30 D24 R58 5 + “L” SELECT J2-6 R2 R62 R64 FROM PAGE 1 “M” SELECT CATH (L) CATH (R) J2 (shell) 6 - 7 Q2 “R” SELECT J2-4 J2-5 R61 R54 ANODE J2-3 R77 R76 R69 R87 AEC CH 2 J2-1 “M” SELECT +12V Q3 PT STOP CATH (M) CATH (R) J2-2 “R” SELECT R55 PT REF CATH (L) U6A J5-6 R63 PT RAMP ANODE J11-3 JW2 J7-6 D16 CATH (M) GROUND GROUND J11-2 J11-4 R59 RIGHT FIELD SELECT R71 J11-5 R86 MIDDLE FIELD SELECT J1-6 J11-1 U11A U2C R72 3 + CATH (R) J1 (shell) 2 - 1 R31 D12 R74 R75 R43 D13 LEFT FIELD SELECT CATH (L) J1-5 U2A START J1-4 “M” SELECT D6 J5-5 ANODE J1-3 JW1 J7-4 AEC CH 1 J1-1 J1-2 R1 J5-3 DS4 R42 CHAMBER 1 SELECT J7-3 “L” SELECT R32 CHAMBER 2 SELECT J5-2 DS3 R38 R37 CHAMBER 3 SELECT J7-2 +12V R40 DS2 DS1 CHAMBER 4 SELECT +12V R73 +12V R39 +12V CATH (M) GROUND GROUND ANODE CATH (L) CATH (M) CATH (R) U6D DRAWN G. SANWALD CHECKED __________ DATE 02 JUN 2000 __________ DES.\MFG.\AUTH. L. FOSKIN 02 JUN 2000 AEC MD-0757 REV C SHEET 3 OF 5 +500V DS5 CHAMBER 2 SELECT CHAMBER 1 SELECT START J10-3 J10-4 J10-5 J10-6 J5-2 DS3 CH 4 D5 U3B U3F CONVERTER CIRCUIT 12 VDC TO 45 VDC AND 300 / 500 VDC +12V +24V RN3C * RN3A CH 1 U3D J5-6 RN3D CH 2 D4 D11 Q1 SET VALUE * U3A +12V +24V 11 LEFT FIELD SELECT MIDDLE FIELD SELECT RIGHT FIELD SELECT J5-7 J10-8 J5-8 J10-9 J5-9 D30 D65 Q2 Q3 J12-4 START J12-3 MIDDLE J12-2 J12-6 Q4 * LEFT * MIDDLE R67 S1C J10-19 TP17 J5-19 TP20 2 TP23 J10-13 J10-17 TP5 +12V TP6 TP7 + CH 2 S4 J5-17 U4A U4B TP4 J10-16 S2A R1 STRT + J2-11 J12-9 R2 R32 C4 J5-11 -12V CH 1 TP21 J5-16 S3A -24V S2C R3 CH 4 R53 TP3 3 CH 2 TP19 S1B 9 PT REF PT STOP J10-15 J10-10 J10-1 J5-15 R54 J13-6 RN4C J5-10 CH 3 R13 - CH 4 + S3D U2A R56 + D22 3 STRT 2 SAMPLE & HOLD U6 J3-12 J3-7 J4-2 J14-4 START J14-3 MIDDLE J14-2 J14-6 13 J4-1 J4-3 +45V TP14 R35 J4-8 J4-10 L/R J4-9 R/L J4-11 J14-5 J14-9 CH 4 S1A R FIELD SEL SIGNAL GROUND AEC CH 2 +/-300 V +/-300/+500 V +45 V START M FIELD SEL L FIELD SEL R FIELD SEL SIGNAL GROUND AEC CH 3 +/-300 V +/-300/+500 V +45 V START M FIELD SEL L FIELD SEL R FIELD SEL SIGNAL GROUND J4-12 J4-7 AEC CH 4 +/-300 V +/-300/+500 V +45 V START M FIELD SEL L FIELD SEL R FIELD SEL SIGNAL GROUND R36 AEC BOARD THIS SHEET APPLIES TO AEC BOARD ASSEMBLY 734614 DESIGNATES AN ANALOG SWITCH. THESE ARE I.C. “SWITCHES” THAT ARE SWITCHED ON / OFF BY APPLYING THE APPROPRIATE LOGIC LEVEL. REFER TO CHAPTER 3D FOR INSTALLATION AND CALIBRATION DETAILS. THE -24V OUTPUTS ON J1 TO J4 AND THE +/- 12V OUTPUTS ON J1 TO J4 AND J11 TO J14 ARE NOT SHOWN ON THIS DIAGRAM. THESE ARE DETAILED ON THE CONNECTOR PIN OUT TABLES IN CHAPTER 3D. J3-11 J14-1 RN4B GENERATOR INTERFACE BOARD J3-9 J13-9 H.V. JW1 1 2 3 U1A R14 7 J3-8 J3-10 R/L J13-5 R57 LEFT + D27 J3-1 L/R +/-300V JW2 1 2 3 S3C J5-1 L FIELD SEL R58 RIGHT R12 START M FIELD SEL TP2 10 S3B PT RAMP J13-2 CH 3 U2B R11 J13-3 MIDDLE 13 S2D R4 + J13-4 START TP13 - J2-7 J3-3 +45V JW3 1 2 3 CH 3 * J2-12 J3-2 J13-1 H.V. LEFT S2B J2-10 R/L +/-300V JW4 1 2 3 CH 1 - J5-13 C11 J10-11 8 +24V +/-300/+500 V +45 V R68 RIGHT TP18 J2-8 J2-9 CH 2 FROM PAGE 1 J2-1 L/R J12-5 13 RIGHT J1-7 J2-3 +45V TP12 * J1-12 J2-2 J12-1 H.V. JW5 1 2 3 * D40 J1-11 +/-300V JW6 1 2 3 +12V +24V * * J1-9 R/L J11-9 LEFT J10-7 L/R J11-5 R89 J1-8 J1-10 AEC CH 1 +/-300 V R90 RIGHT START +12V +24V J11-6 CH 1 S1D STRT J11-2 13 +45V INCLUDES U7 AND T1 J11-3 MIDDLE TP11 D16 RN3B U3E J11-4 START JW7 1 2 3 TP9 CH 3 D12 J5-5 H.V. RN4A U3C J5-4 * J1-1 J1-3 +45V LEFT D6 J5-3 +/-300V TP24 DS4 J11-1 H.V. JW8 1 2 3 +12V TP22 J1-2 +/-300V RIGHT TP10 12 RN6E RN6D RN6A DS2 +12V R66 CHAMBER 3 SELECT J10-2 DS1 +12V R79 CHAMBER 4 SELECT +12V RN6C +12V RN6B +12V * DESIGNATES A FACTORY CONFIGURED LOGIC OR SIGNAL LEVEL. AEC BOARDS ARE CONFIGURED AT THE TIME OF ORDER TO BE COMPATIBLE WITH THE SPECIFIED AEC CHAMBER(S). FOR EXAMPLE, THE START SIGNAL TO THE CHAMBER MAY BE FACTORY CONFIGURED TO BE ACTIVE LOW (0 V), ACTIVE HIGH +12 V, OR ACTIVE HIGH +24 V. DRAWN G. SANWALD CHECKED __________ DATE 02 JUN 2000 __________ DES.\MFG.\AUTH. L. FOSKIN 02 JUN 2000 AEC MD-0757 REV C SHEET 4 OF 5 FOR “UNIVERSAL” AEC ASSEMBLY 734630, REFER TO SCHEMATICS 734628, 728401 NOTE REFERENCE 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 REMARKS “HIGH” (APPROXIMATELY 5 VDC) = NO PTSTOP (PHOTOTIMER STOP) SIGNAL RECEIVED FROM AEC BOARD. “LOW” (APPOXIMATELY 0 VDC) = PTSTOP SIGNAL RECEIVED FROM AEC BOARD. “PTRAMP” IS THE AEC RAMP FROM THE AEC BOARD. THE RAMP SLOPE AND MAGNITUDE WILL DEPEND ON THE AEC TECHNIQUE IN USE. THE MAXIMUM POSSIBLE RAMP MAGNITUDE IS 5 TO 10 VDC, DEPENDING ON MODEL. “PTREF” (THE AEC REFERENCE VOLTAGE FROM THE CONSOLE) WILL VARY FROM 0 TO 10 VDC, DEPENDING ON TECHNIQUE. “HIGH” (> 10 VDC) = AEC CHANNEL DESELECTED, “LOW” (APPROXIMATELY 0 VDC) = AEC CHANNEL SELECTED. “HIGH” (> 10 VDC) = L, M, R, FIELD DESELECTED, “LOW” (APPROXIMATELY 0 VDC) = L, M, R, FIELD SELECTED. “HIGH” (> 10 VDC) = NO AEC STOP REQUEST (INSUFFICIENT RAMP TO TERMINATE AEC EXPOSURE), “LOW” (APPROXIMATELY 0 VDC) = AEC STOP REQUESTED (AEC EXPOSURE TERMINATED). “HIGH” (> 10 VDC) = AEC START NOT REQUESTED, “LOW” (APPROXIMATELY 0 VDC) = AEC START REQUESTED. THE VOLTAGE AND MAGNITUDE OF THE RAMP AT THIS POINT SHOULD BE APPROXIMATELY THE SAME AS AT TP17 ON THIS BOARD (NOTE REFERENCE 2) . THIS WILL BE A NEGATIVE DC VOLTAGE OR RAMP, DEPENDING ON AEC CHAMBER OUTPUT. THE MAGNITUDE OF THE DC VOLTAGE OR RAMP IS DEPENDENT ON THE AEC TECHNIQUE IN USE. THIS WILL BE A POSITIVE DC VOLTAGE OR RAMP, DEPENDING ON AEC CHAMBER OUTPUT. THE MAGNITUDE OF THE DC VOLTAGE OR RAMP IS DEPENDENT ON THE AEC TECHNIQUE IN USE. R79 ADJUSTS THE +45V, +300V, AND +500V OUTPUTS FROM THE DC TO DC CONVERTER CIRCUIT. REFER TO CHAPTER 3D FOR DETAILS. THE VOLTAGE AT TP22 SHOULD BE APPROXIMATELY AS SHOWN IN FIGURE 1 (BELOW). THE MAXIMUM DUTY CYCLE WILL BE APPROXIMATELY 45%, DEPENDING ON THE LOAD ON THE HV SUPPLIES. THE VOLTAGE AT THIS TEST POINT IS THE OUTPUT OF THE AEC CHAMBER. REFER TO THE AEC CHAMBER MANUFACTURERS DOCUMENTATION FOR DETAILS. 200 kHz 12 VDC 0 VDC FIGURE 1 DRAWN G. SANWALD CHECKED __________ DATE 02 JUN 2000 __________ DES.\MFG.\AUTH. L. FOSKIN 02 JUN 2000 AEC MD-0757 REV C SHEET 5 OF 5 “DIGITAL IMAGING” ABS FROM MD-0767, PAGE 1 2 3 R64 3 J7-10 6 5 - 7 R48 R41 9 + Set ABS gain U17B ** JW24 (IN) R118 - J11-3 8 13 - J7-3 12 + + U17C JW25 (OUT) 14 R56 SAMPLE AND HOLD CIRCUIT (U47, R95, C102, ETC.) A/D CONVERTER U23D TP8 C22 1 J7-5 TP9 J7-7 CONTROL SIGNALS FROM DATA BUS ADDRESS REGISTERS (U24, U25) -12V J7-12 DIGITAL POTENTIOMETER U49 2 COMPOSITE VIDEO INPUT JW19 * DATA BUS D0..D7 R49 3 R47 U34 13 - R28 C21 JW5 * 12 + R26 D11 14 GAIN CONTROL SIGNAL TO MD-0757 DRIVER U17D R46 R30 C20 JW20 * TP14 ** 1 J8 REFER TO CHAPTER 3E OF SERVICE MANUAL FOR DETAILS ON ABS INPUT CONNECTIONS 10 R50 PMT / PHOTO DIODE / PROPORTIONAL DC VIDEO INPUT & AEC OUTPUT U17A R61 +12V J7-4 U37 R52 D13 R45 + C19 R42 3 1 R44 4 - R51 R63 2 JW11 * JW4 * 2 R54 1 JW23 R27 JW21 * 1 R65 R58 R62 TP13 TP15 RN5A JW12 * 1 R43 R31 JW13 * JW23 INSTALLED FOR UNITS FITTED WITH ANALOG POTENTIOMETER, OMITTED FOR UNITS WITH DIGITAL POTENTIOMETER GENERATOR INTERFACE BOARD * REFER TO CHAPTER 3E OF SERVICE MANUAL TO DETERMINE REQUIRED JUMPER POSITIONS FOR THESE CONNECTORS. ** ANALOG POTENTIOMETER R48 IS USED ON GENERATORS WITH THE CONVENTIONAL (CONTINUOUS) FLUOROSCOPY OPTION. THE DIGITAL POTENTIOMETER IS FITTED ON GENERATORS WITH THE PULSED FLUORO OPTION. THE DIGITAL POTENTIOMETER IS ADJUSTED VIA THE ABS SETUP MENU ON THE CONTROL CONSOLE. GENERATOR CPU BOARD NOTE REFERENCE REMARKS 1 A DC VOLTAGE WILL BE PRESENT FROM TP8 (TO TP9 OR GROUND), AND FROM TP13 TO TP15 WHEN OPERATING WITH ABS ON. THIS VOLTAGE WILL TYPICALLY RANGE FROM 0.5 TO 5 VDC, AND WILL VARY DEPENDING ON THE NOMINAL DOSE VALUE IN THE ABS SETUP MENU. DRAWN G. SANWALD CHECKED KVR DES.\MFG.\AUTH. L. FOSKIN DATE 16 MAY 2000 ABS (AUTOMATIC BRIGHTNESS STABILIZATION) 16 MAY 2000 16 MAY 2000 MD-0758 REV C SHEET 1 OF 1 DS15 DS19 TXD RXD R43 U20 UART +5V LS1 R46 +5V U11 RS-232 TRANSMITTER / RECEIVER U7 RN3E RN3F RN3G RN3H J11-3 P1-3 J11-7 P1-7 J11-2 P1-2 J11-8 P1-8 RS-232 RECEIVER / DRIVER MICROCONTROLLER (CPU, EPROM **, J1-1 J2-1 J1-2 J2-2 J1-3 J2-3 J1-4 J2-4 J1-5 J2-5 J1-6 J2-6 J1-7 J2-7 J1-8 J2-8 J1-9 J2-9 J1-10 J2-10 J1-11 J2-11 J1-12 J2-12 J1-13 J2-13 J1-14 J2-14 ADDRESS DECODERS & LOGIC CIRCUITS) U1, U2, U3, U4 LED DISPLAYS DATA LATCHES (U6-U9) (7 SEGMENT DISPLAYS & STATUS LEDs) DS1-DS23 DRIVERS (U1-U4, U10) U5 ** U3 IS THE EPROM. BUFFER DATA & ADDRESS BUS DATA BUS D0..D7 GENERATOR CPU BOARD J1-1 P1-1 J1-2 P1-2 J1-3 P1-3 J1-4 P1-4 J1-5 P1-5 J1-6 P1-6 J1-7 P1-7 J1-8 P1-8 J1-9 P1-9 J1-10 P1-10 REMOTE FLUORO DISPLAY BOARD REMOTE FLUORO CONTROL BOARD FRONT PANEL KEYBOARD SWITCHES KEYBOARD ASSEMBLY REMOTE FLUORO CONTROL UNIT LIMITED TROUBLESHOOTING CAN BE PERFORMED ON THE REMOTE FLUORO CONTROL ASSEMBLY IN THE FIELD. THE DC RAILS CAN BE CHECKED (REFER TO MD-0788), AND THE TXD AND RXD LEDs ON THE GENERATOR CPU BOARD MAY BE OBSERVED (THESE WILL FLASH ON AND OFF TO INDICATE DATA FLOW). MEANINGFUL MEASUREMENTS CANNOT BE MADE ON COMMUNICATIONS, DATA, AND CONTROL LINES. DRAWN G. SANWALD CHECKED _________ DATE 02 JUN 2000 _________ DES.\MFG.\AUTH. L. FOSKIN 02 JUN 2000 REMOTE FLUORO CONTROL MD-0766 REV C SHEET 1 OF 1 +24V +15V +5V J13-11 J13-13 J13-17 J13-15 -15V RN14H D0 RN14G D1 RN14F D2 RN14E D3 RN14D D4 RN14C D5 RN14B D6 RN14A D7 J6-1 J12-1 J6-2 J12-2 J6-3 J12-3 J6-4 J12-4 J6-5 J12-5 J6-6 J12-6 J6-7 J12-7 J6-8 J12-8 J6-9 J12-9 RN4A RN4C RN4E RN4G RN3A J13-1 RN4B RN3B RN4D RN3D RN4F RN3F RN4H RN3H RN3C J13-2 J13-3 RN3E J13-4 J13-5 RN3G J13-6 J13-7 J13-8 J13-10 WRITE ENABLE J6-11 J12-11 READ ENABLE J6-13 J12-13 J13-12 RESET J6-20 J12-20 J13-16 J6-15 J12-15 J7-20 J11-20 R91 ADDRESS LATCH ENABLE HV ON SIGNAL FROM MD-0759, PAGE 1 4 5 6 DS40 U45B 1 2 3 U28 CPU U45A 3 2 JW3 1 DATA, ADDRESS, AND CONTROL BUS JUMPER POSITION: INVERTED SYNC JUMPER PINS 1-2 NON-INVERTED SYNC JUMPER PINS 2-3 GENERATOR CPU BOARD R84 J13-18 J13-19 EXPOSURE ENABLE COMMAND TO MD-0761, PAGE 1 J13-14 “DIGITAL IMAGING” ABS TO MD-0758 J13-20 RN19D +5V R115 EXTERNAL SYNC SYNC 1 4 2 J13-22 3 R97 5 CONTINUED ON PAGES 2 TO 6 J7-15 2 J11-15 JW22 1 U51 LINE SYNC FROM MD-0788, PAGE 4 JUMPER POSITION: INTERNAL (LINE SYNC) JUMPER PINS 1-2 EXTERNAL (DIGITAL IMAGING SYNC) JUMPER PINS 2-3 J13-9 J13-21 J13-23 GENERATOR INTERFACE BOARD DRAWN G. SANWALD CHECKED KVR DES.\MFG.\AUTH. L. FOSKIN DATE 16 MAY 2000 17 MAY 2000 17 MAY 2000 DIGITAL INTERFACE MD-0767 REV D SHEET 1 OF 9 +5V +15V +24V J1-11 J1-13 J3-7 J1-17 J3-1 J1-15 J3-3 TP1 U7 J1-20 TP2 R2 +24V J2-20 MUX R3 J2-21 R11 -15V +24V J3-9 1 5 2 4 R1 J1-14 DS4 J1-1 U4 J1-2 EXON U6 PFL DS7 DS8 HCF PREP DS10 GEN READY TOMO J1-6 J1-7 J1-8 J2-1 J2-7 J3-5 1 5 2 4 U14 J2-3 J1-4 J1-5 ADDRESS DECODER CIRCUITS (U1, U2, U3A, U6A) DATA LATCH J2-4 DRIVER J2-5 J3-6 J2-6 J2-22 J1-10 J3-2 +24V U8 BUFFER 5 1 4 2 J1-9 R7 J3-8 J2-9 DS1 U13 J1-21 J3-4 +24V OFL +24V +24V U9 R5 J1-23 SW1 5 1 BUFFER U12 2 STOP EXP. J2-2 +24V +24V R4 4 J2-23 DS2 5 1 DS3 U11 4 2 J2-10 J2-12 R9 J1-16 R8 J1-12 J1-18 J3-10 +24V DS9 J1-3 R6 FROM PAGE 1 DS6 F1 R17 2 U16 +24V +24V R16 4 U10 1 +24V R15 1 +24V R14 6 5 JW1 +24V R12 4 5 2 +24V R10 J1-19 U3B +24V R13 3 O.EXP J2-11 DIGITAL I/O BOARD THIS SHEET APPLIES TO DIGITAL I/O BOARD ASSEMBLY 733752. REFER TO THE DIGITAL IMAGING SUPPLEMENT IN THE SERVICE MANUAL FOR DETAILS REGARDING THE CONNECTIONS TO J2, J3. DRAWN G. SANWALD CHECKED KVR DES.\MFG.\AUTH. L. FOSKIN DATE 16 MAY 2000 17 MAY 2000 17 MAY 2000 DIGITAL INTERFACE MD-0767 REV D SHEET 2 OF 9 +24VR +5V +15V +24VR +24V J1-11 J1-13 J1-17 D6 F1 J1-15 D5 R10 12 U10D 11 13 J1-19 D3 U17 MONOSTABLE TIMER J3-25 J2-1 J3-27 J2-3 J3-29 J2-5 J3-31 J2-7 J3-33 J2-9 J3-35 J2-11 Q1 J2-13 J2-17 R9 -15V +24VR J2-19 J2-18 D4 U14 J2-20 U16 J2-14 J1-1 J2-12 J1-2 J2-10 J1-3 J1-4 DATA LATCH J1-5 J1-6 J2-8 DRIVER J2-6 +24V J1-7 J1-8 J1-10 U13 J1-12 J2-4 +24VR J2-2 R15 ADDRESS DECODER CIRCUITS (U1, U2, U9, U10C) R13 U15 J3-34 Q2 J1-16 J1-18 J3-30 D1 DATA LATCH J2-23 J3-32 J3-28 DRIVER J3-26 J3-36 FROM PAGE 1 +24VR +24VR +24V +24VR +24VR R14 U12 R12 J1-9 BUFFER 5 J1-21 1 R1 U3 J1-23 1 R2 U4 4 U11 5 1 R3 U5 4 2 5 4 2 Q3 J2-16 J3-47 J2-22 D2 2 J3-41 J3-39 SW1 J3-37 J3-38 BUFFER J3-40 J3-42 5 1 U6 R4 5 1 U7 4 2 R5 5 1 4 2 R6 J3-44 J3-46 U8 4 +24VR 2 J2-15 J3-45 R16 J3-43 J2-24 J3-48 J1-22 J2-21 J1-20 DIGITAL I/O BOARD THIS SHEET APPLIES TO DIGITAL I/O BOARD ASSEMBLY 733947. REFER TO THE DIGITAL IMAGING SUPPLEMENT IN THE SERVICE MANUAL FOR DETAILS REGARDING THE CONNECTIONS TO J2, J3. DRAWN G. SANWALD CHECKED KVR DES.\MFG.\AUTH. L. FOSKIN DATE 16 MAY 2000 17 MAY 2000 17 MAY 2000 DIGITAL INTERFACE MD-0767 REV D SHEET 3 OF 9 +24VR +5V +15V +24VR +24V +24VR J3-25 J2-1 J1-11 J3-27 J2-3 J1-13 J3-29 J2-5 J3-31 J2-7 J1-17 D6 F1 J1-15 D5 R10 12 U10D 11 13 J1-19 D3 U17 MONOSTABLE TIMER J2-9 J3-35 J2-11 J2-13 J2-17 R9 -15V J3-33 Q1 J2-19 J2-18 D4 U14 * THESE ARE SERIAL COMMUNICATION LINES. REFER TO MD-0829, SHEET 1, FOR THE CORRESPONDING CONNECTIONS ON THE GENERATOR INTERFACE BOARD. ** REFER TO MD-0761, SHEET 1, FOR THE PREP AND X-RAY INPUTS ON THE GENERATOR INTERFACE BOARD. *** REFER TO MD-0762, SHEET 1, FOR THE POWER ON & OFF INPUTS ON THE GENERATOR INTERFACE BOARD. J2-20 U16 J2-14 J1-1 J2-12 J1-2 J2-10 J1-3 J1-4 DATA LATCH J1-5 J1-6 DRIVER +24V J1-7 J1-8 J1-10 U13 J1-12 J4-1 J2-6 J4-2 J2-4 +24VR J4-5 R13 U15 J3-34 Q2 J1-16 J1-18 J3-32 J3-30 D1 DATA LATCH J2-23 J3-28 DRIVER J3-26 +24VR +24VR +24V J5-8 J4-7 PREP SW ** J4-8 X-RAY SW ** J5-5 J4-10 “ON” SW *** J4-11 “OFF” SW *** J4-9 +24VR ** R14 +24VR J5-7 J5-2 J4-12 COMMON*** J4-3 J3-36 U12 FROM J4 GENERATOR INTERFACE BOARD J5-3 * * * * J4-4 J2-2 R15 ADDRESS DECODER CIRCUITS (U1, U2, U9, U10C) J2-8 R12 J1-9 BUFFER 5 J1-21 1 R1 U3 J1-23 U11 1 R2 U4 4 FROM PAGE 1 5 1 4 2 R3 2 Q3 J3-47 U5 4 2 5 J2-16 J2-22 D2 J3-41 J3-39 SW1 J3-37 J3-38 BUFFER J3-40 J3-42 5 1 R4 U6 5 1 U7 4 2 R5 5 1 4 2 J3-44 R6 +15V J3-46 U8 4 2 J6-1 J2-15 +24VR J6-2 J3-45 R16 J3-43 J6-3 J2-24 J6-4 J3-48 J1-22 J6-6 J2-21 J1-20 J6-7 THE CIRCUITS WITHIN THE DASHED LINES ARE IDENTICAL TO THOSE ON PAGE 3. REFER TO PAGE 3 FOR THE FULL SIZED DIAGRAM J6-8 J6-11 +15V J6-12 J6-9 J7-2 J6-10 J7-3 J7-1 J7-4 U18 U19 DATA LATCH DRIVER TO X-RAY MINI-CONSOLE. (SHEET 5) J7-5 J6-13 TO MINI-CONSOLE X-RAY EXPOSURE INDICATOR. (SHEET 5) J6-5 J6-14 J7-7 DIGITAL I/O BOARD THIS SHEET APPLIES TO DIGITAL I/O BOARD ASSEMBLY 735921. REFER TO THE DIGITAL IMAGING SUPPLEMENT IN THE SERVICE MANUAL FOR DETAILS REGARDING THE CONNECTIONS TO J2, J3, J5. DRAWN G. SANWALD CHECKED KVR DES.\MFG.\AUTH. L. FOSKIN DATE 16 MAY 2000 17 MAY 2000 17 MAY 2000 DIGITAL INTERFACE MD-0767 REV D SHEET 4 OF 9 P1-1 P1-2 DS1 DS2 RAD EXP FLUORO EXP DS3 PREP DS4 PWR ON LS1 LS2 P1-4 P1-6 P1-3 P1-5 P1-7 FROM J6 (SHEET 4) P1-8 P1-9 P1-10 ON OFF P1-13 P1-11 E1 E2 P1-12 HAND SWITCH PREP X-RAY E3 P1-14 X-RAY MINI CONSOLE J3-2 J3-3 DS1 RAD EXP DS2 FLUORO EXP LS1 FROM J7 (SHEET 4) LS2 J3-1 J3-5 J3-7 J3-4 MINI CONSOLE X-RAY EXPOSURE INDICATOR DRAWN THE OPTIONAL “X-RAY MINI CONSOLE” AND OPTIONAL “MINI CONSOLE X-RAY EXPOSURE INDICATOR” ARE TYPICALLY USED WITH DIGITAL IMAGING SYSTEMS THAT HAVE INTEGRATED GENERATOR CONSOLE CONTROL FUNCTIONS. G. SANWALD CHECKED KVR DES.\MFG.\AUTH. L. FOSKIN DATE 16 MAY 2000 17 MAY 2000 17 MAY 2000 DIGITAL INTERFACE MD-0767 REV D SHEET 5 OF 9 +24V +15V J1-11 U12 J1-13 +5 V REGULATOR J1-17 F1 +5V(A) +24V +15V J1-1 GENERATOR READY J1-3 U4 U6 J1-6 J1-7 J1-8 4 2 EXPOSURE IN PROCESS (EIP) R2 DATA LATCH DS3 DRIVER R1 J1-10 J1-12 J1-18 DS2 5 1 4 U10 J2-11 4 2 R7 5 1 U8 4 2 5 1 J2-15 J2-4 J3-1 U16 J2-5 J3-4 J2-6 J3-3 U14 J1-9 J1-23 2 X-RAY J1-14 J1-21 5 R9 J1-16 J2-22 1 J2-13 +24V R8 FROM PAGE 1 ADDRESS DECODER CIRCUITS (U1, U2, U3A, U5A) +15V U7 DS4 J1-5 J2-8 5 1 J1-2 J1-4 J2-14 J2-21 R6 +5V J2-16 J3-10 BUFFER J2-18 J3-11 U15 +5V(A) U9 SW1 5 5 EXPOSE RDY U11 +24V BUFFER 4 1 4 2 1 R3 2 DS1 R4 R5 J2-17 J2-19 J3-12 DS5 U13 4 2 J2-9 J2-12 PREP DIGITAL I/O BOARD THIS SHEET APPLIES TO DIGITAL I/O BOARD ASSEMBLY 735406. REFER TO THE DIGITAL IMAGING SUPPLEMENT IN THE SERVICE MANUAL FOR DETAILS REGARDING THE CONNECTIONS TO J2, J3. DRAWN G. SANWALD CHECKED KVR DES.\MFG.\AUTH. L. FOSKIN DATE 16 MAY 2000 17 MAY 2000 17 MAY 2000 DIGITAL INTERFACE MD-0767 REV D SHEET 6 OF 9 +24V F1 +5V +15V +24V J2-13 J2-7 J2-8 J1-11 J2-9 J1-13 J2-12 J1-17 J2-5 J4-3 J2-6 J4-2 J2-20 +15V 1 5 2 4 U10 J1-1 U6 J1-2 DS3 U4 J1-3 R1 J1-4 J1-5 J1-6 FROM PAGE 1 J1-7 J1-8 J4-5 ADDRESS DECODER CIRCUITS (U1, U2, U3A, U5A) 5 1 4 2 DS4 5 1 4 2 R7 2 R8 J1-12 1 5 J2-23 +15V U14 DS8 J1-10 J2-21 +15V U13 DS7 DRIVER J2-22 +15V U7 R2 DATA LATCH J2-24 +15V 4 1 5 2 4 U15 DS9 J2-1 J3-2 R9 J1-16 J1-18 9 10 8 12 13 DS3 EXPOSURE IN PROCESS (EIP) 11 DS4 GENERATOR PREPPED U3D U3C J2-2 J3-1 J2-3 DS7 RAD HANGMODE J1-19 DS8 BUCKY START J3-4 J2-4 J3-5 DS9 X-RAY ON J2-11 J3-6 U8 J2-15 J3-8 J1-9 J1-21 J1-23 J2-16 BUFFER J3-7 J2-17 J3-12 U9 J2-18 SW1 J3-11 +24V 5 BUFFER 1 4 2 1 J3-10 U11 +24V 5 J2-19 4 2 DS5 R3 R4 U12 DS6 R5 R6 J2-10 BUCKY IN MOTION J2-25 SPARE INPUT DIGITAL I/O BOARD THIS SHEET APPLIES TO DIGITAL I/O BOARD ASSEMBLY 736153 REFER TO THE DIGITAL IMAGING SUPPLEMENT IN THE SERVICE MANUAL FOR DETAILS REGARDING THE CONNECTIONS TO J2, J3, J4. DRAWN G. SANWALD CHECKED KVR DES.\MFG.\AUTH. L. FOSKIN DATE 16 MAY 2000 17 MAY 2000 17 MAY 2000 DIGITAL INTERFACE MD-0767 REV D SHEET 7 OF 9 +5V +15V +24V U1 +24V U12 RATE 0 J1-11 * DS38 J1-13 * DRIVER J1-17 J2-8 RATE 1 DS40 RATE 2 * DS41 DS43 * U11 -15V J1-1 SPARE I/P J1-2 J1-3 J3-1 +24V J2-22 J2-13 J3-2 J2-23 J2-1 J3-3 J3-8 J2-2 J3-4 J3-27 J2-3 J3-5 J3-9 J2-4 J3-6 J3-28 J2-5 J3-7 J3-10 J2-6 J3-8 J3-29 J2-7 J3-9 J3-31 J2-8 J3-10 J2-9 J3-20 U9 DS45 SELECT DIGITAL RADIOGRAPHY * TABLE STEP SELECT EXPOSURE ON GENERATOR RDY TOMO SELECT EXP SAFETY ITLK EXPOSURE REQ PREP REQ DRIVER J3-17 J2-9 RATE 3 * J1-15 DS16 J2-17 * SELECT TOMO DS18 J2-4 * DRIVER J2-16 SPARE INPUT 1 DS20 * J2-3 SPARE INPUT 2 DS21 MAG MODE 0 MAG MODE 1 * J2-15 DS22 MAG MODE 2 * J2-2 DS23 * J2-14 DS24 J2-1 J1-4 J1-5 FLUORO REQUEST J1-6 J1-7 CPLD J1-8 DS29 DS27 * * U10 * * J1-12 DS25 * J1-18 * * DS37 DS36 * * * J2-5 DS26 DS28 DS30 SELECT CINE * FROM PAGE 1 J2-6 CINE TIME SEL 2 * SELECT HCF J2-7 TABLE STEP REQUEST DS34 DS6 DS4 * R77 * * DRIVER DS46 J3-21 J3-23 J2-11 J3-22 J3-4 J2-12 J3-23 J2-14 J3-24 J2-15 J3-25 J3-22 J3-3 J3-21 J3-2 J3-20 * DS3 * * * DS19 * J3-5 J3-24 SELECT STEP DIRECTION DS5 TOMO TIME SELECT 1 * J3-26 J2-17 J3-27 J2-18 J3-28 J2-19 J3-29 J2-20 J3-30 J2-21 J3-31 J2-22 J3-32 J2-23 J3-33 J2-25 J3-25 DS7 J2-16 J2-24 J3-6 TOMO TIME SELECT 0 J3-7 TOMO TIME SELECT 2 * D3 DS17 DS14 SELECT TABLE STEPPING DRIVER R72 * DS13 AEC CENTER FIELD SELECT DS1 * Q1 DS11 DS8 * U2 U17 R78 J2-10 J3-1 J2-20 * SPARE O/P 4 SPARE O/P 3 SPARE O/P 2 SPARE O/P 1 TABLE TUBE SELECT GENERATOR READY X-RAY ON J2-19 DS32 +24V +24V DRIVER J2-18 CINE TIME SEL 1 * U3 DS39 CINE TIME SEL 0 DRIVER J1-22 DS35 STEP TABLE J1-10 J1-19 DS33 DS31 J3-16 F1 J2-21 DS10 * J3-26 DS12 J3-34 J3-35 J3-36 J2 J3-37 1 2 5 1 TABLE FLUORO REQUEST 4 2 5 1 U15 READY ACQUIRE FLUORO -3 J3 J2 3 2 -1 4 -2 0 J2 -3 -3 J3 J2 J3 5 4 U6 1 1 -15V TABLE X-RAY REQUEST DS44 5 U 2 1 1 4 U4 DS9 5 U 1 1 5 U D2 1 DS2 R63 J1-20 U 1 D1 U -1 0 2 1 -1 +15V DS42 5 1 4 2 5 1 U13 READY ACQUIRE RAD/CINE/HCF DS15 5 1 4 2 U8 TABLE PREP REQUEST R30 +24V K1 J1-14 J1-9 U5 J1-21 U7 4 J1-23 2 R17 U16 4 2 R25 U14 4 2 R69 4 2 R68 24V FROM ROOM INTERFACE J5-1 J5-3 J3-18 J3-19 DIGITAL I/O BOARD THIS SHEET APPLIES TO DIGITAL I/O BOARD ASSEMBLY 736894 * DUE TO SPACE RESTRICTIONS, SERIES RESISTORS ARE NOT SHOWN FOR THE INDICATED LED’S REFER TO THE DIGITAL IMAGING SUPPLEMENT IN THE SERVICE MANUAL FOR DETAILS REGARDING THE CONNECTIONS TO J2, J3. DRAWN G. SANWALD CHECKED KVR DES.\MFG.\AUTH. L. FOSKIN DATE 16 MAY 2000 17 MAY 2000 17 MAY 2000 DIGITAL INTERFACE MD-0767 REV D SHEET 8 OF 9 +5V +15V +24V J1-11 +5V J1-13 +15V DS1 J1-17 R10 J1-19 J7-2 XRAY ON 12 U3D 11 13 U7 MONOSTABLE TIMER 4 5 U3B 9 10 6 U3C J7-3 U10 4 8 6 J2-20 (-) 7 J2-19 (+) DRIVER +15V J6-1 J7-1 J6-2 J7-4 J6-5 J7-5 J6-14 J7-7 U17 U18 J6-3 J1-1 J6-4 J1-2 J6-6 J1-3 J1-4 DATA LATCH J1-5 J1-6 J1-7 J1-8 J6-7 DRIVER J6-8 ADDRESS DECODER CIRCUITS (U1, U2, U3A, U5) J4-10 J6-9 J1-10 J1-16 4 J1-18 DATA LATCH U11 R8 XRAY DS4 DRIVER DRIVER 7 J2-14 (-) DS2 PREP 4 U14 GENRDY R9 U8 R7 J1-21 DS3 DS5 * DRIVER 1 DRIVER 6 J2-15 (+) 7 J2-16 (-) 6 J2-21 (+) 7 J2-22 (-) J2-1 (+) U15 BUFFER 6 DRIVER 7 SW1 J4-1 J4-2 J5-7 J4-5 J5-8 +5V R11 R12 XRAYEN Q1 * THE INPUTS / OUTPUTS MARKED “*” ARE SPARE, AND HAVE NOT BEEN ASSIGNED J4-9 J5-2 DS7 DS6 * J6-13 J4-3 J4-4 +5V R5 BUFFER J6-12 J5-3 J2-2 (-) U9 J4-8 J4-12 U12 4 J4-7 J6-11 J2-13 (+) J1-9 J1-23 J2-18 (-) 7 6 DATA LATCH J6-10 J2-17 (+) 6 R6 4 FROM PAGE 1 U6 J4-11 U13 U4 R4 J1-12 J2-25 (+) 5 1 4 2 J5-5 U16 J2-26 (-) DIGITAL I/O BOARD THIS SHEET APPLIES TO DIGITAL I/O BOARD ASSEMBLY 737950. REFER TO THE DIGITAL IMAGING SUPPLEMENT IN THE SERVICE MANUAL FOR DETAILS REGARDING THE CONNECTIONS TO J2, J4, J5, J6, AND J7. DRAWN G. SANWALD CHECKED KVR DES.\MFG.\AUTH. L. FOSKIN DATE 16 MAY 2000 17 MAY 2000 17 MAY 2000 DIGITAL INTERFACE MD-0767 REV D SHEET 9 OF 9 +15V Q6 +15V Q5 +5V J2-1 R2 Q4 +5V R31 Q3 DS1 J2-2 +5V U1 U2 RN12C RS-232 TRANSMITTER / RECEIVER UART RN12A RN12B J2-2 J1-2 J2-3 J1-3 J2-7 J1-7 J2-5 J1-5 R7 U5 J2-5 J2-8 J2-9 RS-422 DRIVER RS-232 TRANSMITTER / RECEIVER MICROCONTROLLER +5V SWITCHED +15V TEST +15V TEST +15V + DOSE DAP CHAMBER #1 - DOSE OPTO RELAY GROUND GROUND R9 U38 J2-4 DAP CHANNEL 1 DS3 R69 R71 DS29 U31 J2-3 +5V R5 +5V DS32 J2-7 R8 +5V J2-6 R10 Q1 R11 DATA BUS D0..D7 D2 +15V Q8 +15V Q7 GENERATOR CPU BOARD J3-1 Q10 J3-6 R44 Q9 TP2 +5V TP3 TB8 3 4 5 J4-1 J3-8 J3-9 RS-422 DRIVER +5 AND +15 VOLT REGULATORS (U7, U4, L1, D4 D5, ETC) +5V 1 2 U6 J3-5 TEST +15V TEST +15V + DOSE - DOSE OPTO DAP CHAMBER #2 RELAY GROUND GROUND R15 TB7 R45 +5V J3-4 DAP CHANNEL 2 DS2 J4-2 J3-3 R5 2 +5V R26 R25 1 J3-2 +5V R14 +15V R13 24 VDC J3-7 SWITCHED +15V R16 TP1 Q2 R17 3 4 5 D3 ROOM INTERFACE BOARD DAP INTERCONNECT BOARD DRAWN G. SANWALD CHECKED M. LODER DES.\MFG.\AUTH. L. FOSKIN DATE 16 JULY 2001 DAP 21 AUG 2001 28 AUG 2001 MD-0828 REV B SHEET 1 OF 1 +5V * FOR RS-232: U1, U2, AND R16 ARE NOT FITTED. FOR RS-422: U12, RN3C, RN3D, RN3A, AND RN3B ARE NOT FITTED. +5V DS3 DS1 TXD J5-1 J7-7 RXD (RS-232) * 14 RN3C 3 2 15 J4-2 J11-18 J7-18 CTS (RS-232) * 13 RN3D 4 4 13 * RN3A 1 3 14 * RN3B 2 5 12 J5-4 J4-4 J11-6 J7-6 TXD (RS-232) J5-5 J4-5 J11-17 J7-17 RTS (RS-232) J5-3 +5V TP3 TXD- (RS-422) 7 J11-10 J7-10 TXD+ (RS-422) 6 C40 Y2 RXD U23 J11-13 J7-13 RXD- (RS-422) 7 J11-12 J7-12 RXD+ (RS-422) 6 J11-9 J7-9 R122 14 J16-1 CPU C35 * U1 11 12 13 R123 9 8 R124 FROM RAD-ONLY CONSOLE (PAGE 2) RS-422 I/P 1 * R16 +5V J16-2 J16-3 J1 RS-232 3 7 J6-1 2 J6-2 8 +5V RS-422 4 O/P ALTERNATE CONSOLE CONNECTIONS +5V 3 14 6 RN12F 11 5 12 7 RN12G 10 2 15 8 RN12H 9 4 13 DS43 J2 RS-232 (LAPTOP) R116 R117 RXD U27 14 R126 10 7 R127 12 13 R128 8 R129 11 DATA BUS D0..D7 THIS SHEET SHOWS THE CONSOLE BOARD FOR INDICO 100 GENERATORS WITH THE 31 X 42 CM CONSOLE. REFER TO PAGE 2 FOR INDICO 100 GENERATORS WITH THE 23 X 56 CM CONSOLE AND THE RAD-ONLY CONSOLE. 9 3 J2 RS-232 7 3 TXD 2 7 RTS 8 2 RXD 8 CTS 5 RXD TXD U38 1 RN12A 16 3 14 2 RN12B 15 5 12 3 RN12C 14 2 15 4 RN12D 13 4 13 U31 +5V DS32 DS29 RXD TXD R71 -12V J6-4 TXD DS43 +5V RS-232 J6-3 DS44 DS44 U42 5 RN12E 12 5 +5V R98 TXD R115 U18 J7-11 DS42 R114 R101 DS41 J11-11 DUART DUART R69 1 Hz * U2 R93 +5V J4-3 SERIAL PORT FOR REMOTE FLUORO CONTROL. REFER TO MD-0766 FOR INDICO 100, OR SCHEMATIC 734571 FOR MILLENIA GENERATORS. RS-232 R72 DS40 U20 J11-7 15 +5V U12 J4-1 16 R15 RXD R18 CONSOLE CABLE RS-232 5 DATA BUS D0..D7 OPTIONAL COMMUNICATIONS PORTS ARE SHOWN ON PAGE 2 GENERATOR INTERFACE BOARD GENERATOR CPU BOARD CONSOLE BOARD (INDICO 100) DRAWN REFER TO PAGE 3 FOR MILLENIA GENERATORS. G. SANWALD CHECKED J. BARNES DES.\MFG.\AUTH. L. FOSKIN DATE 13 DEC 2001 9 JAN 2002 9 JAN 2002 SERIAL COMMUNICATIONS MD-0829 REV D SHEET 1 OF 3 COMMUNICATIONS PORTS SHOWN BELOW ARE OPTIONAL +5V * FOR RS-232: U5, U9, JP2, AND R6 ARE NOT FITTED. FOR RS-422: U6, RN4A, RN4C, RN4D AND R7 ARE NOT FITTED. DS16 +5V TXD 6 J5-4 1 RS-422 I/P 7 J5-5 D3 2 8 J5-3 5 2 RN2B R5 7 1 Q3 3 * U6 7 14 2 *RN4A 3 RN18B 4 3 14 5 RN18C 6 5 12 7 RN18D 8 2 15 1 RN18A 2 4 13 8 RN17D 7 7 10 5 RN17C 6 6 11 J15 JP2 CLOSED FOR RS-422, OPEN CIRCUIT FOR RS-232 11 TP5 RXD TXD 1 R65 TXD RN16B RXD RN16A DS48 U50 3 TO GENERATOR INTERFACE BOARD (PG 1) 3 * RXD 1 Hz U23 *JP2 R6 RN2A +5V Q4 DS46 RN16D J16 R94 D4 DS45 J5-2 * U5 +5V TP1 +5V DS47 RN16C J5-1 6 4 RS-422 O/P 7 D6 +5V 1 Hz * U9 +5V +5V U28 CPU RS-232 -12V 2 DATA BUS D0..D7 8 * 6 RN4C 5 8 *RN4D 8 7 GENERATOR CPU BOARD R7 RS-232 5 * +5V -12V +5V DS1 U17 DS2 DS3 TXD RXD R10 +5V TP1 1 Hz +5V R20 9 CPU 13 R19 12 D2 TXD Q1 Q2 U20 11 14 6 RN1C 5 10 7 4 RN1B 3 12 13 2 RN1A 1 9 8 8 RN1D 7 DATA BUS D0..D7 RS-232 TP10 J8-1 J16-1 R24 J8-2 J16-2 3 TXD 7 RTS 2 RXD 8 CTS +5V +5V J8-3 J16-3 DS5 DS4 TXD RXD RS-232 J4 U11 5 R25 R26 R27 R28 DATA BUS D0..D7 TO GENERATOR INTERFACE BOARD (PG 1) RS-232 (LAPTOP) THIS AREA SHOWS THE CONSOLE CPU BOARD FOR INDICO 100 GENERATORS WITH THE 23 X 56 CM CONSOLE. CONSOLE BOARD (INDICO 100) TP11 R23 CPU R21 RN2C RXD J2 R22 D1 U8 RS-232 (LAPTOP) RN2D +5V RS-232 3 TXD 7 RTS 2 RXD 8 CTS 5 DRAWN THIS AREA SHOWS THE CONSOLE CPU BOARD FOR INDICO 100 GENERATORS WITH RAD-ONLY CONSOLE. CONSOLE BOARD (INDICO 100) G. SANWALD CHECKED J. BARNES DES.\MFG.\AUTH. L. FOSKIN DATE 13 DEC 2001 9 JAN 2002 9 JAN 2002 SERIAL COMMUNICATIONS MD-0829 REV D SHEET 2 OF 3 +5V * FOR RS-232: U1, U2, AND R8 ARE NOT FITTED. FOR RS-422: U12, RN4C, RN4D, RN4A, AND RN4B ARE NOT FITTED. DS2 J4-1 J11-7 J7-7 RXD (RS-232) * 14 RN4C 3 13 12 4 RS-422 O/P 7 J5-2 J4-2 J11-18 J7-18 CTS (RS-232) * 13 RN4D 4 8 9 * RN4A 1 14 11 * RN4B 2 7 10 +5V D4 15 6 J5-4 J4-4 J11-6 J7-6 TXD (RS-232) 1 RS-422 I/P 7 J5-5 J4-5 J11-17 J7-17 RTS (RS-232) * U2 RXD *JP2 * 3 J5-3 J4-3 2 RN2B Q4 R6 +5V D3 J11-11 J7-11 TXD- (RS-422) 7 J11-10 J7-10 TXD+ (RS-422) 6 2 * RN4B J7-13 RXD- (RS-422) 7 J11-12 J7-12 RXD+ (RS-422) 6 J11-9 J7-9 1 10 7 4 12 13 * 6 RN4C 5 9 8 * 8 RN4D 7 R7 3 7 J6-1 2 J6-2 8 C35 ALTERNATE CONSOLE CONNECTIONS 11 6 RN13F 11 7 10 7 RN13G 10 13 12 8 RN13H 9 8 9 9 RS-232 14 6 RN1C 5 7 4 RN1B 3 13 2 RN1A 1 8 8 RN1D 7 Q12 R1 U29 +5V +5V DS31 TXD DS35 RXD DUART 3 3 TXD 7 7 RTS 2 2 RXD 8 8 CTS 5 Q9 U39 1 RN13A 16 14 11 2 RN13B 15 7 10 3 RN13C 14 13 12 4 RN13D 13 8 9 R65 RN2D Q2 J2 J2 U20 12 DATA BUS D0..D7 RS-232 Q8 RS-232 (LAPTOP) 10 DS48 RXD -12V J6-4 TXD RN2C 14 J6-3 D2 Q1 DS47 TXD U43 5 RN13E 12 5 +5V 11 +5V Q11 -12V Y2 +5V 3 * DUART 1 R8 J1 RS-232 D1 RS-422 I/P R64 14 J11-13 R48 * RN4A C30 R63 11 RXD C39 * U1 R66 U25 DUART Y1 JP2 CLOSED FOR RS-422, OPEN CIRCUIT FOR RS-232 * U6 +5V RS-422 4 O/P 1 Q3 C41 SERIAL PORT FOR REMOTE FLUORO CONTROL. REFER TO MD-0766 FOR INDICO 100, OR SCHEMATIC 734571 FOR MILLENIA GENERATORS. RS-232 R47 RN2A TXD U24 J5-1 16 TXD Q2 U12 6 * U5 DS1 RXD Q1 * U9 +5V R15 CONSOLE CABLE * FOR RS-232: U9, U5, JP2, AND R6 ARE NOT FITTED. FOR RS-422: U6, RN4A, RN4B, RN4C, RN4D, AND R7 ARE NOT FITTED. RS-232 5 GENERATOR INTERFACE BOARD DATA BUS D0..D7 -12V GENERATOR CPU BOARD CONSOLE CPU BOARD (MILLENIA) DRAWN THIS SHEET SHOWS THE SERIAL COMMUNICATIONS CIRCUITS FOR MILLENIA GENERATORS G. SANWALD CHECKED J. BARNES DES.\MFG.\AUTH. L. FOSKIN DATE 13 DEC 2001 9 JAN 2002 9 JAN 2002 SERIAL COMMUNICATIONS MD-0829 REV D SHEET 3 OF 3 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 REVISIONS NOTES: ZONE LTR 1. ALL RESISTOR VALUES ARE IN OHMS 1/4W 5% UNLESS OTHERWISE SPECIFIED. 2. ALL CAPACITOR VALUES ARE IN MICROFARADS UNLESS OTHERWISE SPECIFIED. DESCRIPTION DWN CHKD APPROVED DATE 2 INC PER ENG. J.C. Emir S.C 3 INC PER ECO No. 14083 Emir Emir G.SANWALD 27SEP94 A INC PER ECO No. 14084 Emir Emir G.SANWALD 27SEP94 B INC PER ECO No. 14133 Emir Emir G.SANWALD 20OCT94 C INC PER ECO No. 15473 Emir Emir M.PHILLIPS 10DEC96 D INC PER ECO No. 16111 Emir Emir E INC PER ECO No. 16121 Emir Emir F INC PER ECO No.18348 Emir Emir J.C. 01SEP94 3. TAB "-01" INSTALL ONLY J1-J6, TP5. J7 D 1 2 3 4 R7 R8 R9 R17 R18 1M 1M 1M 1M 1M S.CARTWRIGHT D.YAKE S.CARTWRIGHT 20JUN97 26JUN97 28FEB00 D -1000V R48 100K TP4 J1 R49 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 100K +12V -12V -24V D11 C4 T1 C9 R1 1K C8 5 1N3070 TP5 C15 .01 E2 START (1) L (1) N (1) R (1) SIG (1) D6 .01 600V L1 D5 D4 .01 600V D3 D2 .01 600V D1 2 23 uH 6 C3 C2 C1 .01 600V .01 600V .01 600V C18 C20 C22 +300V 4 C24 C25 +500V C5 E3 1 .01 200V D12 1 uF D13 D14 .01 200V D15 D16 .01 200V D17 D18 .01 200V D19 .01 200V D20 C14 C17 C19 C21 C23 .01 200V .01 200V .01 200V .01 200V .01 200V D21 3 +50V R44 100K R45 J2 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 C 100K C START (2) L (2) N (2) R (2) SIG (2) J6 1 1 1 1 1 9 7 5 3 1 9 7 5 3 1 2 1 1 1 1 1 0 8 6 4 2 0 8 6 4 2 +12V TP1 C16 R39 100K R47 R46 R43 R42 R41 R36 R35 R34 R26 R22 1M 1M 1M 1M 1M 1M 1M 1M 1M 1M C7 10 6.8nF R23 C6 1 R30 R11 J3 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 100K R40 R27 90.9K 100K R13 10K C12 .01 -12V R33 10K 220 220 D7 D9 Q3 Q1 TP2 6 5 7 U1B LF353N START (3) L (3) N (3) R (3) SIG (3) +12V C27 0.1 U3 2 1 3 C10 .01 R28 49K9 8 R21 1K +12V +V -V SYNC CT RT DISC CSS COMP SD VREF R20 1K C26 10 B OSC OUTA OUTB R31 R32 475K 5 6 7 9 10 16 R29 R25 E2 E3 2.74K 22 Q2 C13 2.2nF Q4 R14 R12 4 11 14 220 220 D8 D10 B SG3525 121K U2A 14016 2 TP3 R10 20K R19 20K R24 20K 1 SPARE R16 1K 1 3 U2D 14016 R37 9 R15 10K 8 C11 .01 R6 10 100K J4 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 R4 10 R3 10 R5 10 8 -24V 100K -12V +12V U2C 14016 J5 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 START (4) L (4) N (4) R (4) SIG (4) 3 2 6 U2B 14016 LF353N 3 R38 U1A 4 1 11 10 4 +12V 1 3 5 7 9 11 13 15 17 19 1 2 5 A A DRAWN HIGHEST REFERENCE DESIGNATIONS Emir 07SEP94 Emir 27SEP94 Communications & Power Industries Canada Inc. CHECKED C27, D21, J7, Q4, R49 APPROVAL DATE TP4, T1, U3 SCHEMATIC ENGINEER J.CUNNINGHAM SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM 27SEP94 DES/MFG AUTH. S.CARTWRIGHT REFERENCE DESIGNATIONS NOT USED NEXT ASSY COMPUTER GENERATED 6 5 SIZE CONTRACT No. 728399 7 MANUALS D 3 CAGE CODE DWG NO 02845 REV 728401 F USED ON February 28, 2000 4 INTERFACE ----------------------- R2 8 AUTOMATIC EXPOSURE CONTROL 27SEP94 SCALE 2 NTS SHEET LEVEL 3 1 1 OF 1